mirror of
				https://github.com/explosion/spaCy.git
				synced 2025-10-31 16:07:41 +03:00 
			
		
		
		
	Merge branch 'master' of https://github.com/honnibal/spaCy
This commit is contained in:
		
						commit
						1b5f8b888f
					
				
							
								
								
									
										6
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/AUTHORS
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										6
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/AUTHORS
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,6 @@ | |||
| Cognitive Science Laboratory | ||||
| Princeton University | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| http://wordnet.princeton.edu | ||||
| wordnet@princeton.edu | ||||
| 
 | ||||
							
								
								
									
										31
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/COPYING
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										31
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/COPYING
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,31 @@ | |||
| WordNet Release 3.0 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| This software and database is being provided to you, the LICENSEE, by   | ||||
| Princeton University under the following license.  By obtaining, using   | ||||
| and/or copying this software and database, you agree that you have   | ||||
| read, understood, and will comply with these terms and conditions.:   | ||||
|    | ||||
| Permission to use, copy, modify and distribute this software and   | ||||
| database and its documentation for any purpose and without fee or   | ||||
| royalty is hereby granted, provided that you agree to comply with   | ||||
| the following copyright notice and statements, including the disclaimer,   | ||||
| and that the same appear on ALL copies of the software, database and   | ||||
| documentation, including modifications that you make for internal   | ||||
| use or for distribution.   | ||||
|    | ||||
| WordNet 3.0 Copyright 2006 by Princeton University.  All rights reserved.   | ||||
|    | ||||
| THIS SOFTWARE AND DATABASE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND PRINCETON   | ||||
| UNIVERSITY MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR   | ||||
| IMPLIED.  BY WAY OF EXAMPLE, BUT NOT LIMITATION, PRINCETON   | ||||
| UNIVERSITY MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES OF MERCHANT-   | ||||
| ABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR THAT THE USE   | ||||
| OF THE LICENSED SOFTWARE, DATABASE OR DOCUMENTATION WILL NOT   | ||||
| INFRINGE ANY THIRD PARTY PATENTS, COPYRIGHTS, TRADEMARKS OR   | ||||
| OTHER RIGHTS.   | ||||
|    | ||||
| The name of Princeton University or Princeton may not be used in   | ||||
| advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software   | ||||
| and/or database.  Title to copyright in this software, database and   | ||||
| any associated documentation shall at all times remain with   | ||||
| Princeton University and LICENSEE agrees to preserve same.   | ||||
							
								
								
									
										9
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/ChangeLog
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										9
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/ChangeLog
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,9 @@ | |||
| Changes between WordNet 2.1 and 3.0 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Some changes were made to the graphical interface and WordNet library | ||||
| with regard to adjective and adverb searches.  The adjective search | ||||
| "Synonyms/Related Nouns" was relabeled "Synonyms", and, similarly, the | ||||
| adverb search "Synonyms/Stem Adjectives" was relabled "Synonyms".  A | ||||
| separate "Related Noun" search was inserted for adjectives, and a | ||||
| separate "Base Adjective" search was added for adverbs. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
							
								
								
									
										312
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/INSTALL
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										312
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/INSTALL
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,312 @@ | |||
| 
 | ||||
| 		WordNet 3.0 Installation Instructions | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Beginning with Version 2.1, we have changed the Unix package to a GNU | ||||
| Autotools package.  With Autotools, a system independent installation | ||||
| process builds and installs WordNet on your specific platform.  Read | ||||
| both the `Basic Installation' and `WordNet Installation' sections | ||||
| below before attempting to build and install WordNet. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| See the `Running WordNet' section for important information concerning | ||||
| environment variables and the commands to run WordNet. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The WordNet browser makes use of the open source Tcl and Tk | ||||
| packages. Many systems come with either or both pre-installed.  If | ||||
| your system doesn't (some systems have Tcl installed, but not Tk) | ||||
| Tcl/Tk can be downloaded from: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Linux - http://www.tcl.tk/  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| OS X - http://tcltkaqua.sourceforge.net/ (note that 10.4 comes with | ||||
| Tcl/Tk preinstalled, but earlier versions may not) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Some Linux systems come with the Tcl/Tk libraries installed, but not | ||||
| all the header files. If your build fails due to missing Tk headers, a | ||||
| subset that may be sufficient on your system can be found in the | ||||
| "include/tk" directory. Copy the header files to the "include" directory | ||||
| and try the make again.  If it fails, you should download and install | ||||
| a full copy of Tcl and/or Tk from the site above. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Tcl and Tk must be installed BEFORE you build and install WordNet. You | ||||
| must also have a C compiler before installing Tcl/Tk or WordNet. | ||||
| WordNet has been built and tested with the GNU gcc compiler.  This is | ||||
| pre-installed on most Unix systems, and can be downloaded from: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| http://gcc.gnu.org/ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Basic Installation | ||||
| ================== | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ******************************************************************** | ||||
|    These are generic installation instructions. Details specific to | ||||
|    WordNet follow in the `WordNet Installation' section below. | ||||
| ******************************************************************** | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    The `configure' shell script attempts to guess correct values for | ||||
| various system-dependent variables used during compilation.  It uses | ||||
| those values to create a `Makefile' in each directory of the package. | ||||
| It may also create one or more `.h' files containing system-dependent | ||||
| definitions.  Finally, it creates a shell script `config.status' that | ||||
| you can run in the future to recreate the current configuration, and a | ||||
| file `config.log' containing compiler output (useful mainly for | ||||
| debugging `configure'). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    It can also use an optional file (typically called `config.cache' | ||||
| and enabled with `--cache-file=config.cache' or simply `-C') that saves | ||||
| the results of its tests to speed up reconfiguring.  (Caching is | ||||
| disabled by default to prevent problems with accidental use of stale | ||||
| cache files.) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The simplest way to compile this package is: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   1. `cd' to the directory containing the package's source code and type | ||||
|      `./configure' to configure the package for your system.  If you're | ||||
|      using `csh' on an old version of System V, you might need to type | ||||
|      `sh ./configure' instead to prevent `csh' from trying to execute | ||||
|      `configure' itself. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|      Running `configure' takes awhile.  While running, it prints some | ||||
|      messages telling which features it is checking for. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   2. Type `make' to compile the package. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   3. Type `make install' to install the programs and any data files and | ||||
|      documentation. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   4. You can remove the program binaries and object files from the | ||||
|      source code directory by typing `make clean'.  To also remove the | ||||
|      files that `configure' created (so you can compile the package for | ||||
|      a different kind of computer), type `make distclean'.  There is | ||||
|      also a `make maintainer-clean' target, but that is intended mainly | ||||
|      for the package's developers.  If you use it, you may have to get | ||||
|      all sorts of other programs in order to regenerate files that came | ||||
|      with the distribution. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Compilers and Options | ||||
| ===================== | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    Some systems require unusual options for compilation or linking that | ||||
| the `configure' script does not know about.  Run `./configure --help' | ||||
| for details on some of the pertinent environment variables. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    You can give `configure' initial values for configuration parameters | ||||
| by setting variables in the command line or in the environment.  Here | ||||
| is an example: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|      ./configure CC=c89 CFLAGS=-O2 LIBS=-lposix | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    *Note Defining Variables::, for more details. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Compiling For Multiple Architectures | ||||
| ==================================== | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    You can compile the package for more than one kind of computer at the | ||||
| same time, by placing the object files for each architecture in their | ||||
| own directory.  To do this, you must use a version of `make' that | ||||
| supports the `VPATH' variable, such as GNU `make'.  `cd' to the | ||||
| directory where you want the object files and executables to go and run | ||||
| the `configure' script.  `configure' automatically checks for the | ||||
| source code in the directory that `configure' is in and in `..'. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    If you have to use a `make' that does not support the `VPATH' | ||||
| variable, you have to compile the package for one architecture at a | ||||
| time in the source code directory.  After you have installed the | ||||
| package for one architecture, use `make distclean' before reconfiguring | ||||
| for another architecture. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Installation Names | ||||
| ================== | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    By default, `make install' will install the package's files in | ||||
| `/usr/local/bin', `/usr/local/man', etc.  You can specify an | ||||
| installation prefix other than `/usr/local' by giving `configure' the | ||||
| option `--prefix=PATH'. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    You can specify separate installation prefixes for | ||||
| architecture-specific files and architecture-independent files.  If you | ||||
| give `configure' the option `--exec-prefix=PATH', the package will use | ||||
| PATH as the prefix for installing programs and libraries. | ||||
| Documentation and other data files will still use the regular prefix. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    In addition, if you use an unusual directory layout you can give | ||||
| options like `--bindir=PATH' to specify different values for particular | ||||
| kinds of files.  Run `configure --help' for a list of the directories | ||||
| you can set and what kinds of files go in them. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    If the package supports it, you can cause programs to be installed | ||||
| with an extra prefix or suffix on their names by giving `configure' the | ||||
| option `--program-prefix=PREFIX' or `--program-suffix=SUFFIX'. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Optional Features | ||||
| ================= | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    Some packages pay attention to `--enable-FEATURE' options to | ||||
| `configure', where FEATURE indicates an optional part of the package. | ||||
| They may also pay attention to `--with-PACKAGE' options, where PACKAGE | ||||
| is something like `gnu-as' or `x' (for the X Window System).  The | ||||
| `README' should mention any `--enable-' and `--with-' options that the | ||||
| package recognizes. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    For packages that use the X Window System, `configure' can usually | ||||
| find the X include and library files automatically, but if it doesn't, | ||||
| you can use the `configure' options `--x-includes=DIR' and | ||||
| `--x-libraries=DIR' to specify their locations. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Specifying the System Type | ||||
| ========================== | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    There may be some features `configure' cannot figure out | ||||
| automatically, but needs to determine by the type of machine the package | ||||
| will run on.  Usually, assuming the package is built to be run on the | ||||
| _same_ architectures, `configure' can figure that out, but if it prints | ||||
| a message saying it cannot guess the machine type, give it the | ||||
| `--build=TYPE' option.  TYPE can either be a short name for the system | ||||
| type, such as `sun4', or a canonical name which has the form: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|      CPU-COMPANY-SYSTEM | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| where SYSTEM can have one of these forms: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|      OS KERNEL-OS | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    See the file `config.sub' for the possible values of each field.  If | ||||
| `config.sub' isn't included in this package, then this package doesn't | ||||
| need to know the machine type. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    If you are _building_ compiler tools for cross-compiling, you should | ||||
| use the `--target=TYPE' option to select the type of system they will | ||||
| produce code for. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    If you want to _use_ a cross compiler, that generates code for a | ||||
| platform different from the build platform, you should specify the | ||||
| "host" platform (i.e., that on which the generated programs will | ||||
| eventually be run) with `--host=TYPE'. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Sharing Defaults | ||||
| ================ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    If you want to set default values for `configure' scripts to share, | ||||
| you can create a site shell script called `config.site' that gives | ||||
| default values for variables like `CC', `cache_file', and `prefix'. | ||||
| `configure' looks for `PREFIX/share/config.site' if it exists, then | ||||
| `PREFIX/etc/config.site' if it exists.  Or, you can set the | ||||
| `CONFIG_SITE' environment variable to the location of the site script. | ||||
| A warning: not all `configure' scripts look for a site script. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Defining Variables | ||||
| ================== | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    Variables not defined in a site shell script can be set in the | ||||
| environment passed to `configure'.  However, some packages may run | ||||
| configure again during the build, and the customized values of these | ||||
| variables may be lost.  In order to avoid this problem, you should set | ||||
| them in the `configure' command line, using `VAR=value'.  For example: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|      ./configure CC=/usr/local2/bin/gcc | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| will cause the specified gcc to be used as the C compiler (unless it is | ||||
| overridden in the site shell script). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| `configure' Invocation | ||||
| ====================== | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    `configure' recognizes the following options to control how it | ||||
| operates. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| `--help' | ||||
| `-h' | ||||
|      Print a summary of the options to `configure', and exit. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| `--version' | ||||
| `-V' | ||||
|      Print the version of Autoconf used to generate the `configure' | ||||
|      script, and exit. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| `--cache-file=FILE' | ||||
|      Enable the cache: use and save the results of the tests in FILE, | ||||
|      traditionally `config.cache'.  FILE defaults to `/dev/null' to | ||||
|      disable caching. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| `--config-cache' | ||||
| `-C' | ||||
|      Alias for `--cache-file=config.cache'. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| `--quiet' | ||||
| `--silent' | ||||
| `-q' | ||||
|      Do not print messages saying which checks are being made.  To | ||||
|      suppress all normal output, redirect it to `/dev/null' (any error | ||||
|      messages will still be shown). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| `--srcdir=DIR' | ||||
|      Look for the package's source code in directory DIR.  Usually | ||||
|      `configure' can determine that directory automatically. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| `configure' also accepts some other, not widely useful, options.  Run | ||||
| `configure --help' for more details. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| WordNet Installation | ||||
| ==================== | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| By default, WordNet is installed in `/usr/local/WordNet-3.0'.  You | ||||
| must usually be the `root' user to install something here.  If you | ||||
| choose to install WordNet in a different location, you must use the | ||||
| `--prefix=' option to `configure' and specify an installation | ||||
| directory. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| WordNet relies on the Tcl/Tk package, which you must have installed on | ||||
| your system prior to building the WordNet package.  If you have | ||||
| installed Tcl/Tk in a non-standard location, you must specify the | ||||
| `--with-tcl=' and `--with-tk=' options to `configure' and specify the | ||||
| directory that contains the `tclConfig.sh' and `tkConfig.sh' | ||||
| configuration scripts, respectively. (Note that these are usually the | ||||
| same directories.) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| If you're running OS X and installed the Aqua Tcl/Tk package from the | ||||
| web site above, use the following settings: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|      --with-tcl=/Library/Frameworks/Tcl.framework | ||||
|      --with-tk=/Library/Frameworks/Tk.framework | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| If `configure' can't find either `tclConfig.sh' or `tkConfig.sh', it | ||||
| will print an error and stop processing. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| After successfully running `configure', you must then build and | ||||
| install WordNet using these commands: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| make | ||||
| make install | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Running WordNet | ||||
| =============== | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| In order to run WordNet, you must set your PATH variable to include | ||||
| the directory that contains the WordNet binraries. By default, WordNet | ||||
| is installed in `/usr/local/WordNet-3.0'.   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Several other environment variables may need to be set in order to | ||||
| run WordNet on your system: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| PATH - should include either `/usr/local/WordNet-3.0/bin' or the path | ||||
| you specified with the `--prefix=' option to `configure', unless you | ||||
| installed WordNet in a directory that is already in your path. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| WNHOME - if you did not install in the default location, you must set | ||||
| this environment variable to the value you specified on the `prefix=' | ||||
| option.  This tells the WordNet browser where to find the database files. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| LD_LIBRARY_PATH - may need to be set to the location of the Tcl/Tk | ||||
| libraries. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| TK_LIBRARY - on OS X, may need to be set to the directory that | ||||
| contains the `tk.tcl' file (usually a subidrectory of where the Tk | ||||
| library is installed). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The command `wnb' starts the WordNet browser application.  If any | ||||
| of the above variables is not set, or not set properly, an error will | ||||
| occur when you run `wnb'. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The command line interface is run with the `wn' command.  The `PATH' and | ||||
| `WNHOME' environment variables must also be set. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
							
								
								
									
										31
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/LICENSE
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										31
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/LICENSE
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,31 @@ | |||
| WordNet Release 3.0 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| This software and database is being provided to you, the LICENSEE, by   | ||||
| Princeton University under the following license.  By obtaining, using   | ||||
| and/or copying this software and database, you agree that you have   | ||||
| read, understood, and will comply with these terms and conditions.:   | ||||
|    | ||||
| Permission to use, copy, modify and distribute this software and   | ||||
| database and its documentation for any purpose and without fee or   | ||||
| royalty is hereby granted, provided that you agree to comply with   | ||||
| the following copyright notice and statements, including the disclaimer,   | ||||
| and that the same appear on ALL copies of the software, database and   | ||||
| documentation, including modifications that you make for internal   | ||||
| use or for distribution.   | ||||
|    | ||||
| WordNet 3.0 Copyright 2006 by Princeton University.  All rights reserved.   | ||||
|    | ||||
| THIS SOFTWARE AND DATABASE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND PRINCETON   | ||||
| UNIVERSITY MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR   | ||||
| IMPLIED.  BY WAY OF EXAMPLE, BUT NOT LIMITATION, PRINCETON   | ||||
| UNIVERSITY MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES OF MERCHANT-   | ||||
| ABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR THAT THE USE   | ||||
| OF THE LICENSED SOFTWARE, DATABASE OR DOCUMENTATION WILL NOT   | ||||
| INFRINGE ANY THIRD PARTY PATENTS, COPYRIGHTS, TRADEMARKS OR   | ||||
| OTHER RIGHTS.   | ||||
|    | ||||
| The name of Princeton University or Princeton may not be used in   | ||||
| advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software   | ||||
| and/or database.  Title to copyright in this software, database and   | ||||
| any associated documentation shall at all times remain with   | ||||
| Princeton University and LICENSEE agrees to preserve same.   | ||||
							
								
								
									
										2
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/Makefile.am
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										2
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/Makefile.am
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,2 @@ | |||
| EXTRA_DIST = README ChangeLog COPYING INSTALL AUTHORS LICENSE doc dict include | ||||
| SUBDIRS = doc dict include lib src | ||||
							
								
								
									
										569
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/Makefile.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										569
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/Makefile.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,569 @@ | |||
| # Makefile.in generated by automake 1.9 from Makefile.am.
 | ||||
| # @configure_input@
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
 | ||||
| # 2003, 2004  Free Software Foundation, Inc.
 | ||||
| # This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
 | ||||
| # gives unlimited permission to copy and/or distribute it,
 | ||||
| # with or without modifications, as long as this notice is preserved.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | ||||
| # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law; without
 | ||||
| # even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A
 | ||||
| # PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| @SET_MAKE@ | ||||
| srcdir = @srcdir@ | ||||
| top_srcdir = @top_srcdir@ | ||||
| VPATH = @srcdir@ | ||||
| pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| pkglibdir = $(libdir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| top_builddir = . | ||||
| am__cd = CDPATH="$${ZSH_VERSION+.}$(PATH_SEPARATOR)" && cd | ||||
| INSTALL = @INSTALL@ | ||||
| install_sh_DATA = $(install_sh) -c -m 644 | ||||
| install_sh_PROGRAM = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| install_sh_SCRIPT = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| INSTALL_HEADER = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| transform = $(program_transform_name) | ||||
| NORMAL_INSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_INSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_INSTALL = : | ||||
| NORMAL_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| subdir = . | ||||
| DIST_COMMON = README $(am__configure_deps) $(srcdir)/Makefile.am \
 | ||||
| 	$(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(srcdir)/config.h.in \
 | ||||
| 	$(top_srcdir)/configure AUTHORS COPYING ChangeLog INSTALL NEWS \
 | ||||
| 	compile depcomp install-sh missing | ||||
| ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4 | ||||
| am__aclocal_m4_deps = $(top_srcdir)/acinclude.m4 \
 | ||||
| 	$(top_srcdir)/configure.ac | ||||
| am__configure_deps = $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES) \
 | ||||
| 	$(ACLOCAL_M4) | ||||
| am__CONFIG_DISTCLEAN_FILES = config.status config.cache config.log \
 | ||||
|  configure.lineno configure.status.lineno | ||||
| mkinstalldirs = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| CONFIG_HEADER = config.h | ||||
| CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES = | ||||
| SOURCES = | ||||
| DIST_SOURCES = | ||||
| RECURSIVE_TARGETS = all-recursive check-recursive dvi-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	html-recursive info-recursive install-data-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	install-exec-recursive install-info-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	install-recursive installcheck-recursive installdirs-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	pdf-recursive ps-recursive uninstall-info-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-recursive | ||||
| ETAGS = etags | ||||
| CTAGS = ctags | ||||
| DIST_SUBDIRS = $(SUBDIRS) | ||||
| DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(DIST_SOURCES) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST) | ||||
| distdir = $(PACKAGE)-$(VERSION) | ||||
| top_distdir = $(distdir) | ||||
| am__remove_distdir = \
 | ||||
|   { test ! -d $(distdir) \
 | ||||
|     || { find $(distdir) -type d ! -perm -200 -exec chmod u+w {} ';' \
 | ||||
|          && rm -fr $(distdir); }; } | ||||
| DIST_ARCHIVES = $(distdir).tar.gz | ||||
| GZIP_ENV = --best | ||||
| distuninstallcheck_listfiles = find . -type f -print | ||||
| distcleancheck_listfiles = find . -type f -print | ||||
| ACLOCAL = @ACLOCAL@ | ||||
| AMDEP_FALSE = @AMDEP_FALSE@ | ||||
| AMDEP_TRUE = @AMDEP_TRUE@ | ||||
| AMTAR = @AMTAR@ | ||||
| AUTOCONF = @AUTOCONF@ | ||||
| AUTOHEADER = @AUTOHEADER@ | ||||
| AUTOMAKE = @AUTOMAKE@ | ||||
| AWK = @AWK@ | ||||
| CC = @CC@ | ||||
| CCDEPMODE = @CCDEPMODE@ | ||||
| CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@ | ||||
| CPP = @CPP@ | ||||
| CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@ | ||||
| CYGPATH_W = @CYGPATH_W@ | ||||
| DEFS = @DEFS@ | ||||
| DEPDIR = @DEPDIR@ | ||||
| ECHO_C = @ECHO_C@ | ||||
| ECHO_N = @ECHO_N@ | ||||
| ECHO_T = @ECHO_T@ | ||||
| EGREP = @EGREP@ | ||||
| EXEEXT = @EXEEXT@ | ||||
| INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@ | ||||
| INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@ | ||||
| INSTALL_SCRIPT = @INSTALL_SCRIPT@ | ||||
| INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM@ | ||||
| LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@ | ||||
| LIBOBJS = @LIBOBJS@ | ||||
| LIBS = @LIBS@ | ||||
| LTLIBOBJS = @LTLIBOBJS@ | ||||
| MAKEINFO = @MAKEINFO@ | ||||
| OBJEXT = @OBJEXT@ | ||||
| PACKAGE = @PACKAGE@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = @PACKAGE_BUGREPORT@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_NAME = @PACKAGE_NAME@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_STRING = @PACKAGE_STRING@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_TARNAME = @PACKAGE_TARNAME@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_VERSION = @PACKAGE_VERSION@ | ||||
| PATH_SEPARATOR = @PATH_SEPARATOR@ | ||||
| RANLIB = @RANLIB@ | ||||
| SET_MAKE = @SET_MAKE@ | ||||
| SHELL = @SHELL@ | ||||
| STRIP = @STRIP@ | ||||
| TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC = @TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC@ | ||||
| TCL_LIB_SPEC = @TCL_LIB_SPEC@ | ||||
| TK_LIBS = @TK_LIBS@ | ||||
| TK_LIB_SPEC = @TK_LIB_SPEC@ | ||||
| TK_PREFIX = @TK_PREFIX@ | ||||
| TK_XINCLUDES = @TK_XINCLUDES@ | ||||
| VERSION = @VERSION@ | ||||
| ac_ct_CC = @ac_ct_CC@ | ||||
| ac_ct_RANLIB = @ac_ct_RANLIB@ | ||||
| ac_ct_STRIP = @ac_ct_STRIP@ | ||||
| ac_prefix = @ac_prefix@ | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_FALSE = @am__fastdepCC_FALSE@ | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_TRUE = @am__fastdepCC_TRUE@ | ||||
| am__include = @am__include@ | ||||
| am__leading_dot = @am__leading_dot@ | ||||
| am__quote = @am__quote@ | ||||
| am__tar = @am__tar@ | ||||
| am__untar = @am__untar@ | ||||
| bindir = @bindir@ | ||||
| build_alias = @build_alias@ | ||||
| datadir = @datadir@ | ||||
| exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@ | ||||
| host_alias = @host_alias@ | ||||
| includedir = @includedir@ | ||||
| infodir = @infodir@ | ||||
| install_sh = @install_sh@ | ||||
| libdir = @libdir@ | ||||
| libexecdir = @libexecdir@ | ||||
| localstatedir = @localstatedir@ | ||||
| mandir = @mandir@ | ||||
| mkdir_p = @mkdir_p@ | ||||
| oldincludedir = @oldincludedir@ | ||||
| prefix = @prefix@ | ||||
| program_transform_name = @program_transform_name@ | ||||
| sbindir = @sbindir@ | ||||
| sharedstatedir = @sharedstatedir@ | ||||
| sysconfdir = @sysconfdir@ | ||||
| target_alias = @target_alias@ | ||||
| EXTRA_DIST = README ChangeLog COPYING INSTALL AUTHORS LICENSE doc dict include | ||||
| SUBDIRS = doc dict include lib src | ||||
| all: config.h | ||||
| 	$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) all-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SUFFIXES: | ||||
| am--refresh: | ||||
| 	@: | ||||
| $(srcdir)/Makefile.in:  $(srcdir)/Makefile.am  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	@for dep in $?; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case '$(am__configure_deps)' in \
 | ||||
| 	    *$$dep*) \
 | ||||
| 	      echo ' cd $(srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu '; \
 | ||||
| 	      cd $(srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  \
 | ||||
| 		&& exit 0; \
 | ||||
| 	      exit 1;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	echo ' cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  Makefile'; \
 | ||||
| 	cd $(top_srcdir) && \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  Makefile | ||||
| .PRECIOUS: Makefile | ||||
| Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status | ||||
| 	@case '$?' in \
 | ||||
| 	  *config.status*) \
 | ||||
| 	    echo ' $(SHELL) ./config.status'; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(SHELL) ./config.status;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) \
 | ||||
| 	    echo ' cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $@ $(am__depfiles_maybe)'; \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $@ $(am__depfiles_maybe);; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_builddir)/config.status: $(top_srcdir)/configure $(CONFIG_STATUS_DEPENDENCIES) | ||||
| 	$(SHELL) ./config.status --recheck | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_srcdir)/configure:  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(srcdir) && $(AUTOCONF) | ||||
| $(ACLOCAL_M4):  $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(srcdir) && $(ACLOCAL) $(ACLOCAL_AMFLAGS) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| config.h: stamp-h1 | ||||
| 	@if test ! -f $@; then \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f stamp-h1; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(MAKE) stamp-h1; \
 | ||||
| 	else :; fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| stamp-h1: $(srcdir)/config.h.in $(top_builddir)/config.status | ||||
| 	@rm -f stamp-h1 | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status config.h | ||||
| $(srcdir)/config.h.in:  $(am__configure_deps)  | ||||
| 	cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOHEADER) | ||||
| 	rm -f stamp-h1 | ||||
| 	touch $@ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-hdr: | ||||
| 	-rm -f config.h stamp-h1 | ||||
| uninstall-info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This directory's subdirectories are mostly independent; you can cd
 | ||||
| # into them and run `make' without going through this Makefile.
 | ||||
| # To change the values of `make' variables: instead of editing Makefiles,
 | ||||
| # (1) if the variable is set in `config.status', edit `config.status'
 | ||||
| #     (which will cause the Makefiles to be regenerated when you run `make');
 | ||||
| # (2) otherwise, pass the desired values on the `make' command line.
 | ||||
| $(RECURSIVE_TARGETS): | ||||
| 	@set fnord $$MAKEFLAGS; amf=$$2; \
 | ||||
| 	dot_seen=no; \
 | ||||
| 	target=`echo $@ | sed s/-recursive//`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  echo "Making $$target in $$subdir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dot_seen=yes; \
 | ||||
| 	    local_target="$$target-am"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    local_target="$$target"; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  (cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) $$local_target) \
 | ||||
| 	   || case "$$amf" in *=*) exit 1;; *k*) fail=yes;; *) exit 1;; esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	if test "$$dot_seen" = "no"; then \
 | ||||
| 	  $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) "$$target-am" || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	fi; test -z "$$fail" | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-recursive clean-recursive distclean-recursive \ | ||||
| maintainer-clean-recursive: | ||||
| 	@set fnord $$MAKEFLAGS; amf=$$2; \
 | ||||
| 	dot_seen=no; \
 | ||||
| 	case "$@" in \
 | ||||
| 	  distclean-* | maintainer-clean-*) list='$(DIST_SUBDIRS)' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) list='$(SUBDIRS)' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; \
 | ||||
| 	rev=''; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = "."; then :; else \
 | ||||
| 	    rev="$$subdir $$rev"; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	rev="$$rev ."; \
 | ||||
| 	target=`echo $@ | sed s/-recursive//`; \
 | ||||
| 	for subdir in $$rev; do \
 | ||||
| 	  echo "Making $$target in $$subdir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    local_target="$$target-am"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    local_target="$$target"; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  (cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) $$local_target) \
 | ||||
| 	   || case "$$amf" in *=*) exit 1;; *k*) fail=yes;; *) exit 1;; esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done && test -z "$$fail" | ||||
| tags-recursive: | ||||
| 	list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test "$$subdir" = . || (cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) tags); \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| ctags-recursive: | ||||
| 	list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test "$$subdir" = . || (cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) ctags); \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ID: $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES) $(LISP) $(TAGS_FILES) | ||||
| 	list='$(SOURCES) $(HEADERS) $(LISP) $(TAGS_FILES)'; \
 | ||||
| 	unique=`for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -f "$$i"; then echo $$i; else echo $(srcdir)/$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  done | \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AWK) '    { files[$$0] = 1; } \
 | ||||
| 	       END { for (i in files) print i; }'`; \
 | ||||
| 	mkid -fID $$unique | ||||
| tags: TAGS | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| TAGS: tags-recursive $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES) config.h.in $(TAGS_DEPENDENCIES) \ | ||||
| 		$(TAGS_FILES) $(LISP) | ||||
| 	tags=; \
 | ||||
| 	here=`pwd`; \
 | ||||
| 	if ($(ETAGS) --etags-include --version) >/dev/null 2>&1; then \
 | ||||
| 	  include_option=--etags-include; \
 | ||||
| 	  empty_fix=.; \
 | ||||
| 	else \
 | ||||
| 	  include_option=--include; \
 | ||||
| 	  empty_fix=; \
 | ||||
| 	fi; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = .; then :; else \
 | ||||
| 	    test ! -f $$subdir/TAGS || \
 | ||||
| 	      tags="$$tags $$include_option=$$here/$$subdir/TAGS"; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(SOURCES) $(HEADERS) config.h.in $(LISP) $(TAGS_FILES)'; \
 | ||||
| 	unique=`for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -f "$$i"; then echo $$i; else echo $(srcdir)/$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  done | \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AWK) '    { files[$$0] = 1; } \
 | ||||
| 	       END { for (i in files) print i; }'`; \
 | ||||
| 	if test -z "$(ETAGS_ARGS)$$tags$$unique"; then :; else \
 | ||||
| 	  test -n "$$unique" || unique=$$empty_fix; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(ETAGS) $(ETAGSFLAGS) $(AM_ETAGSFLAGS) $(ETAGS_ARGS) \
 | ||||
| 	    $$tags $$unique; \
 | ||||
| 	fi | ||||
| ctags: CTAGS | ||||
| CTAGS: ctags-recursive $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES) config.h.in $(TAGS_DEPENDENCIES) \ | ||||
| 		$(TAGS_FILES) $(LISP) | ||||
| 	tags=; \
 | ||||
| 	here=`pwd`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(SOURCES) $(HEADERS) config.h.in $(LISP) $(TAGS_FILES)'; \
 | ||||
| 	unique=`for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -f "$$i"; then echo $$i; else echo $(srcdir)/$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  done | \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AWK) '    { files[$$0] = 1; } \
 | ||||
| 	       END { for (i in files) print i; }'`; \
 | ||||
| 	test -z "$(CTAGS_ARGS)$$tags$$unique" \
 | ||||
| 	  || $(CTAGS) $(CTAGSFLAGS) $(AM_CTAGSFLAGS) $(CTAGS_ARGS) \
 | ||||
| 	     $$tags $$unique | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| GTAGS: | ||||
| 	here=`$(am__cd) $(top_builddir) && pwd` \
 | ||||
| 	  && cd $(top_srcdir) \
 | ||||
| 	  && gtags -i $(GTAGS_ARGS) $$here | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-tags: | ||||
| 	-rm -f TAGS ID GTAGS GRTAGS GSYMS GPATH tags | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distdir: $(DISTFILES) | ||||
| 	$(am__remove_distdir) | ||||
| 	mkdir $(distdir) | ||||
| 	@srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	topsrcdirstrip=`echo "$(top_srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(DISTFILES)'; for file in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case $$file in \
 | ||||
| 	    $(srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(top_srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$topsrcdirstrip/|$(top_builddir)/|"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $$file || test -d $$file; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  dir=`echo "$$file" | sed -e 's,/[^/]*$$,,'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$dir" != "$$file" && test "$$dir" != "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dir="/$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    dir=''; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -d $$d/$$file; then \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -d $(srcdir)/$$file && test $$d != $(srcdir); then \
 | ||||
| 	      cp -pR $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    fi; \
 | ||||
| 	    cp -pR $$d/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || cp -p $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| 	list='$(DIST_SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = .; then :; else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -d "$(distdir)/$$subdir" \
 | ||||
| 	    || $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)/$$subdir" \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    distdir=`$(am__cd) $(distdir) && pwd`; \
 | ||||
| 	    top_distdir=`$(am__cd) $(top_distdir) && pwd`; \
 | ||||
| 	    (cd $$subdir && \
 | ||||
| 	      $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) \
 | ||||
| 	        top_distdir="$$top_distdir" \
 | ||||
| 	        distdir="$$distdir/$$subdir" \
 | ||||
| 	        distdir) \
 | ||||
| 	      || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| 	-find $(distdir) -type d ! -perm -777 -exec chmod a+rwx {} \; -o \
 | ||||
| 	  ! -type d ! -perm -444 -links 1 -exec chmod a+r {} \; -o \
 | ||||
| 	  ! -type d ! -perm -400 -exec chmod a+r {} \; -o \
 | ||||
| 	  ! -type d ! -perm -444 -exec $(SHELL) $(install_sh) -c -m a+r {} {} \; \
 | ||||
| 	|| chmod -R a+r $(distdir) | ||||
| dist-gzip: distdir | ||||
| 	tardir=$(distdir) && $(am__tar) | GZIP=$(GZIP_ENV) gzip -c >$(distdir).tar.gz | ||||
| 	$(am__remove_distdir) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dist-bzip2: distdir | ||||
| 	tardir=$(distdir) && $(am__tar) | bzip2 -9 -c >$(distdir).tar.bz2 | ||||
| 	$(am__remove_distdir) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dist-tarZ: distdir | ||||
| 	tardir=$(distdir) && $(am__tar) | compress -c >$(distdir).tar.Z | ||||
| 	$(am__remove_distdir) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dist-shar: distdir | ||||
| 	shar $(distdir) | GZIP=$(GZIP_ENV) gzip -c >$(distdir).shar.gz | ||||
| 	$(am__remove_distdir) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dist-zip: distdir | ||||
| 	-rm -f $(distdir).zip | ||||
| 	zip -rq $(distdir).zip $(distdir) | ||||
| 	$(am__remove_distdir) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dist dist-all: distdir | ||||
| 	tardir=$(distdir) && $(am__tar) | GZIP=$(GZIP_ENV) gzip -c >$(distdir).tar.gz | ||||
| 	$(am__remove_distdir) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This target untars the dist file and tries a VPATH configuration.  Then
 | ||||
| # it guarantees that the distribution is self-contained by making another
 | ||||
| # tarfile.
 | ||||
| distcheck: dist | ||||
| 	case '$(DIST_ARCHIVES)' in \
 | ||||
| 	*.tar.gz*) \
 | ||||
| 	  GZIP=$(GZIP_ENV) gunzip -c $(distdir).tar.gz | $(am__untar) ;;\
 | ||||
| 	*.tar.bz2*) \
 | ||||
| 	  bunzip2 -c $(distdir).tar.bz2 | $(am__untar) ;;\
 | ||||
| 	*.tar.Z*) \
 | ||||
| 	  uncompress -c $(distdir).tar.Z | $(am__untar) ;;\
 | ||||
| 	*.shar.gz*) \
 | ||||
| 	  GZIP=$(GZIP_ENV) gunzip -c $(distdir).shar.gz | unshar ;;\
 | ||||
| 	*.zip*) \
 | ||||
| 	  unzip $(distdir).zip ;;\
 | ||||
| 	esac | ||||
| 	chmod -R a-w $(distdir); chmod a+w $(distdir) | ||||
| 	mkdir $(distdir)/_build | ||||
| 	mkdir $(distdir)/_inst | ||||
| 	chmod a-w $(distdir) | ||||
| 	dc_install_base=`$(am__cd) $(distdir)/_inst && pwd | sed -e 's,^[^:\\/]:[\\/],/,'` \
 | ||||
| 	  && dc_destdir="$${TMPDIR-/tmp}/am-dc-$$$$/" \
 | ||||
| 	  && cd $(distdir)/_build \
 | ||||
| 	  && ../configure --srcdir=.. --prefix="$$dc_install_base" \
 | ||||
| 	    $(DISTCHECK_CONFIGURE_FLAGS) \
 | ||||
| 	  && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) \
 | ||||
| 	  && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) dvi \
 | ||||
| 	  && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) check \
 | ||||
| 	  && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) install \
 | ||||
| 	  && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) installcheck \
 | ||||
| 	  && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) uninstall \
 | ||||
| 	  && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) distuninstallcheck_dir="$$dc_install_base" \
 | ||||
| 	        distuninstallcheck \
 | ||||
| 	  && chmod -R a-w "$$dc_install_base" \
 | ||||
| 	  && ({ \
 | ||||
| 	       (cd ../.. && umask 077 && mkdir "$$dc_destdir") \
 | ||||
| 	       && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) DESTDIR="$$dc_destdir" install \
 | ||||
| 	       && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) DESTDIR="$$dc_destdir" uninstall \
 | ||||
| 	       && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) DESTDIR="$$dc_destdir" \
 | ||||
| 	            distuninstallcheck_dir="$$dc_destdir" distuninstallcheck; \
 | ||||
| 	      } || { rm -rf "$$dc_destdir"; exit 1; }) \
 | ||||
| 	  && rm -rf "$$dc_destdir" \
 | ||||
| 	  && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) dist \
 | ||||
| 	  && rm -rf $(DIST_ARCHIVES) \
 | ||||
| 	  && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) distcleancheck | ||||
| 	$(am__remove_distdir) | ||||
| 	@(echo "$(distdir) archives ready for distribution: "; \
 | ||||
| 	  list='$(DIST_ARCHIVES)'; for i in $$list; do echo $$i; done) | \
 | ||||
| 	  sed -e '1{h;s/./=/g;p;x;}' -e '$${p;x;}' | ||||
| distuninstallcheck: | ||||
| 	@cd $(distuninstallcheck_dir) \
 | ||||
| 	&& test `$(distuninstallcheck_listfiles) | wc -l` -le 1 \
 | ||||
| 	   || { echo "ERROR: files left after uninstall:" ; \
 | ||||
| 	        if test -n "$(DESTDIR)"; then \
 | ||||
| 	          echo "  (check DESTDIR support)"; \
 | ||||
| 	        fi ; \
 | ||||
| 	        $(distuninstallcheck_listfiles) ; \
 | ||||
| 	        exit 1; } >&2 | ||||
| distcleancheck: distclean | ||||
| 	@if test '$(srcdir)' = . ; then \
 | ||||
| 	  echo "ERROR: distcleancheck can only run from a VPATH build" ; \
 | ||||
| 	  exit 1 ; \
 | ||||
| 	fi | ||||
| 	@test `$(distcleancheck_listfiles) | wc -l` -eq 0 \
 | ||||
| 	  || { echo "ERROR: files left in build directory after distclean:" ; \
 | ||||
| 	       $(distcleancheck_listfiles) ; \
 | ||||
| 	       exit 1; } >&2 | ||||
| check-am: all-am | ||||
| check: check-recursive | ||||
| all-am: Makefile config.h | ||||
| installdirs: installdirs-recursive | ||||
| installdirs-am: | ||||
| install: install-recursive | ||||
| install-exec: install-exec-recursive | ||||
| install-data: install-data-recursive | ||||
| uninstall: uninstall-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-am: all-am | ||||
| 	@$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) install-exec-am install-data-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck: installcheck-recursive | ||||
| install-strip: | ||||
| 	$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) INSTALL_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" \
 | ||||
| 	  install_sh_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" INSTALL_STRIP_FLAG=-s \
 | ||||
| 	  `test -z '$(STRIP)' || \
 | ||||
| 	    echo "INSTALL_PROGRAM_ENV=STRIPPROG='$(STRIP)'"` install | ||||
| mostlyclean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-generic: | ||||
| 	-test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean-generic: | ||||
| 	@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use" | ||||
| 	@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild." | ||||
| clean: clean-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-am: clean-generic mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean: distclean-recursive | ||||
| 	-rm -f $(am__CONFIG_DISTCLEAN_FILES) | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| distclean-am: clean-am distclean-generic distclean-hdr distclean-tags | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi: dvi-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| html: html-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info: info-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-data-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-exec-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-info: install-info-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-man: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-recursive | ||||
| 	-rm -f $(am__CONFIG_DISTCLEAN_FILES) | ||||
| 	-rm -rf $(top_srcdir)/autom4te.cache | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| maintainer-clean-am: distclean-am maintainer-clean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean: mostlyclean-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf: pdf-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps: ps-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-am: uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-info: uninstall-info-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .PHONY: $(RECURSIVE_TARGETS) CTAGS GTAGS all all-am am--refresh check \ | ||||
| 	check-am clean clean-generic clean-recursive ctags \
 | ||||
| 	ctags-recursive dist dist-all dist-bzip2 dist-gzip dist-shar \
 | ||||
| 	dist-tarZ dist-zip distcheck distclean distclean-generic \
 | ||||
| 	distclean-hdr distclean-recursive distclean-tags \
 | ||||
| 	distcleancheck distdir distuninstallcheck dvi dvi-am html \
 | ||||
| 	html-am info info-am install install-am install-data \
 | ||||
| 	install-data-am install-exec install-exec-am install-info \
 | ||||
| 	install-info-am install-man install-strip installcheck \
 | ||||
| 	installcheck-am installdirs installdirs-am maintainer-clean \
 | ||||
| 	maintainer-clean-generic maintainer-clean-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	mostlyclean mostlyclean-generic mostlyclean-recursive pdf \
 | ||||
| 	pdf-am ps ps-am tags tags-recursive uninstall uninstall-am \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
 | ||||
| # Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
 | ||||
| .NOEXPORT: | ||||
							
								
								
									
										0
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/NEWS
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										0
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/NEWS
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										101
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/README
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										101
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/README
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,101 @@ | |||
| 
 | ||||
| 		This is the README file for WordNet 3.0 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 1. About WordNet | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| WordNet was developed at Princeton University's Cognitive Science | ||||
| Laboratory under the direction of George Miller, James S. McDonnell | ||||
| Distinguished University Professor of Psychology, Emeritus. Over the | ||||
| years many linguists, lexicographers, students, and software engineers | ||||
| have contributed to the project. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| WordNet is an online lexical reference system.  Word forms in WordNet | ||||
| are represented in their familiar orthography; word meanings are | ||||
| represented by synonym sets (synsets) - lists of synonymous word forms | ||||
| that are interchangeable in some context.  Two kinds of relations are | ||||
| recognized: lexical and semantic.  Lexical relations hold between word | ||||
| forms; semantic relations hold between word meanings.   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| To learn more about WordNet, the book "WordNet: An Electronic Lexical | ||||
| Database," containing an updated version of "Five Papers on WordNet" | ||||
| and additional papers by WordNet users, is available from MIT Press: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     http://mitpress.mit.edu/book-home.tcl?isbn=026206197X | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 2. The WordNet Web Site | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| We maintain a Web site at: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| http://wordnet.princeton.edu | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Information about WordNet, access to our online interface, and the | ||||
| various WordNet packages that you can download are available from our | ||||
| web site.  All of the software documentation is available online, as | ||||
| well as a FAQ.  On this site we also have information about other | ||||
| applications that use WordNet. If you have an application that you | ||||
| would like included, please send e-mail to the above address. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 3. Contacting Us | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Ongoing deveopment work and WordNet related projects are done by a | ||||
| small group of researchers, lexicographers, and systems programmers. | ||||
| Since our resources are VERY limited, we request that you please | ||||
| confine correspondence to WordNet topics only.  Please check the | ||||
| documentation, FAQ, and other resources for the answer to your | ||||
| question or problem before contacting us. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| If you have trouble installing or downloading WordNet, have a bug to | ||||
| report, or any other problem, please refer to the online FAQ file | ||||
| first.  If you can heal thyself, please do so.  The FAQ will be | ||||
| updated over time.  And if you do find a previously unreported | ||||
| problem, please use our Bug Report Form: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| http://wordnet.princeton.edu/cgi-bin/bugsubmit.pl | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| When reporting a problem, please be as specific as possible, stating | ||||
| the computer platform you are using, which interface you are using, | ||||
| and the exact error.  The more details you can provide, the more | ||||
| likely it is that you will get an answer.  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| There is a WordNet user discussion group mailing list that we invite | ||||
| our users to join.  Users use this list to ask questions of one | ||||
| another, announce extensions to WordNet that they've developed, and | ||||
| other topics of general usefulness to the user community. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Information on joining the user discussion list, reporting bugs and other | ||||
| contact information is in found on our website at: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| http://wordnet.princeton.edu/contact | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 4. Current Release | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| WordNet Version 3.0 is the latest version available for download.  Two | ||||
| basic database packages are available - one for Windows and one for | ||||
| Unix platforms (including Mac OS X).  See the file ChangeLog (Unix) or | ||||
| CHANGES.txt (Windows) for a list of changes from previous versions. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| WordNet packages can either be downloaded from our web site via: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| http://wordnet.princeton.edu/obtain | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The Windows package is a self-extracting archive that installs itself | ||||
| when you double-click on it. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Beginning with Version 2.1, we changed the Unix package to a GNU Autotools | ||||
| package.  The WordNet browser makes use of the open source Tcl and Tk | ||||
| packages. Many systems come with either or both pre-installed.  If | ||||
| your system doesn't (some systems have Tcl installed, but not Tk) | ||||
| Tcl/Tk can be downloaded from: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| http://www.tcl.tk/  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Tcl and Tk must be installed BEFORE you compile WordNet. You must also | ||||
| have a C compiler before installing Tcl/Tk or WordNet.  WordNet has | ||||
| been built and tested with the GNU gcc compiler.  This is | ||||
| pre-installed on most Unix systems, and can be downloaded from: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| http://gcc.gnu.org/ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| See the file INSTALL for detailed WordNet installation instructions. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
							
								
								
									
										333
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/acinclude.m4
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										333
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/acinclude.m4
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,333 @@ | |||
| #------------------------------------------------------------------------ | ||||
| # SC_PATH_TCLCONFIG -- | ||||
| # | ||||
| #	Locate the tclConfig.sh file and perform a sanity check on | ||||
| #	the Tcl compile flags | ||||
| # | ||||
| # Arguments: | ||||
| #	none | ||||
| # | ||||
| # Results: | ||||
| # | ||||
| #	Adds the following arguments to configure: | ||||
| #		--with-tcl=... | ||||
| # | ||||
| #	Defines the following vars: | ||||
| #		TCL_BIN_DIR	Full path to the directory containing | ||||
| #				the tclConfig.sh file | ||||
| #------------------------------------------------------------------------ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| AC_DEFUN(SC_PATH_TCLCONFIG, [ | ||||
|     # | ||||
|     # Ok, lets find the tcl configuration | ||||
|     # First, look for one uninstalled. | ||||
|     # the alternative search directory is invoked by --with-tcl | ||||
|     # | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     if test x"${no_tcl}" = x ; then | ||||
| 	# we reset no_tcl in case something fails here | ||||
| 	no_tcl=true | ||||
| 	AC_ARG_WITH(tcl, [  --with-tcl              directory containing tcl configuration (tclConfig.sh)], with_tclconfig=${withval}) | ||||
| 	AC_MSG_CHECKING([for Tcl configuration]) | ||||
| 	AC_CACHE_VAL(ac_cv_c_tclconfig,[ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 	    # First check to see if --with-tcl was specified. | ||||
| 	    if test x"${with_tclconfig}" != x ; then | ||||
| 		if test -f "${with_tclconfig}/tclConfig.sh" ; then | ||||
| 		    ac_cv_c_tclconfig=`(cd ${with_tclconfig}; pwd)` | ||||
| 		else | ||||
| 		    AC_MSG_ERROR([${with_tclconfig} directory doesn't contain tclConfig.sh]) | ||||
| 		fi | ||||
| 	    fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 	    # then check for a private Tcl installation | ||||
| 	    if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then | ||||
| 		for i in \ | ||||
| 			../tcl \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			../../tcl \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			../../../tcl \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../../../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../../../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../../../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` ; do | ||||
| 		    if test -f "$i/unix/tclConfig.sh" ; then | ||||
| 			ac_cv_c_tclconfig=`(cd $i/unix; pwd)` | ||||
| 			break | ||||
| 		    fi | ||||
| 		done | ||||
| 	    fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 	    # check in a few common install locations | ||||
| 	    if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then | ||||
| 		for i in `ls -d ${libdir} 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -d /usr/local/lib 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -d /usr/contrib/lib 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -d /usr/lib 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -d /usr/lib64 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			; do | ||||
| 		    if test -f "$i/tclConfig.sh" ; then | ||||
| 			ac_cv_c_tclconfig=`(cd $i; pwd)` | ||||
| 			break | ||||
| 		    fi | ||||
| 		done | ||||
| 	    fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 	    # check in a few other private locations | ||||
| 	    if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then | ||||
| 		for i in \ | ||||
| 			${srcdir}/../tcl \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` ; do | ||||
| 		    if test -f "$i/unix/tclConfig.sh" ; then | ||||
| 		    ac_cv_c_tclconfig=`(cd $i/unix; pwd)` | ||||
| 		    break | ||||
| 		fi | ||||
| 		done | ||||
| 	    fi | ||||
| 	]) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 	if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then | ||||
| 	    TCL_BIN_DIR="# no Tcl configs found" | ||||
| 	    AC_MSG_WARN(Can't find Tcl configuration definitions) | ||||
| 	    exit 0 | ||||
| 	else | ||||
| 	    no_tcl= | ||||
| 	    TCL_BIN_DIR=${ac_cv_c_tclconfig} | ||||
| 	    AC_MSG_RESULT(found $TCL_BIN_DIR/tclConfig.sh) | ||||
| 	fi | ||||
|     fi | ||||
| ]) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| #------------------------------------------------------------------------ | ||||
| # SC_PATH_TKCONFIG -- | ||||
| # | ||||
| #	Locate the tkConfig.sh file | ||||
| # | ||||
| # Arguments: | ||||
| #	none | ||||
| # | ||||
| # Results: | ||||
| # | ||||
| #	Adds the following arguments to configure: | ||||
| #		--with-tk=... | ||||
| # | ||||
| #	Defines the following vars: | ||||
| #		TK_BIN_DIR	Full path to the directory containing | ||||
| #				the tkConfig.sh file | ||||
| #------------------------------------------------------------------------ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| AC_DEFUN(SC_PATH_TKCONFIG, [ | ||||
|     # | ||||
|     # Ok, lets find the tk configuration | ||||
|     # First, look for one uninstalled. | ||||
|     # the alternative search directory is invoked by --with-tk | ||||
|     # | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     if test x"${no_tk}" = x ; then | ||||
| 	# we reset no_tk in case something fails here | ||||
| 	no_tk=true | ||||
| 	AC_ARG_WITH(tk, [  --with-tk               directory containing tk configuration (tkConfig.sh)], with_tkconfig=${withval}) | ||||
| 	AC_MSG_CHECKING([for Tk configuration]) | ||||
| 	AC_CACHE_VAL(ac_cv_c_tkconfig,[ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 	    # First check to see if --with-tkconfig was specified. | ||||
| 	    if test x"${with_tkconfig}" != x ; then | ||||
| 		if test -f "${with_tkconfig}/tkConfig.sh" ; then | ||||
| 		    ac_cv_c_tkconfig=`(cd ${with_tkconfig}; pwd)` | ||||
| 		else | ||||
| 		    AC_MSG_ERROR([${with_tkconfig} directory doesn't contain tkConfig.sh]) | ||||
| 		fi | ||||
| 	    fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 	    # then check for a private Tk library | ||||
| 	    if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then | ||||
| 		for i in \ | ||||
| 			../tk \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			../../tk \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			../../../tk \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../../../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../../../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ../../../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` ; do | ||||
| 		    if test -f "$i/unix/tkConfig.sh" ; then | ||||
| 			ac_cv_c_tkconfig=`(cd $i/unix; pwd)` | ||||
| 			break | ||||
| 		    fi | ||||
| 		done | ||||
| 	    fi | ||||
| 	    # check in a few common install locations | ||||
| 	    if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then | ||||
| 		for i in `ls -d ${libdir} 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -d /usr/local/lib 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -d /usr/contrib/lib 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -d /usr/lib 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -d /usr/lib64 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			; do | ||||
| 		    if test -f "$i/tkConfig.sh" ; then | ||||
| 			ac_cv_c_tkconfig=`(cd $i; pwd)` | ||||
| 			break | ||||
| 		    fi | ||||
| 		done | ||||
| 	    fi | ||||
| 	    # check in a few other private locations | ||||
| 	    if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then | ||||
| 		for i in \ | ||||
| 			${srcdir}/../tk \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ | ||||
| 			`ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` ; do | ||||
| 		    if test -f "$i/unix/tkConfig.sh" ; then | ||||
| 			ac_cv_c_tkconfig=`(cd $i/unix; pwd)` | ||||
| 			break | ||||
| 		    fi | ||||
| 		done | ||||
| 	    fi | ||||
| 	]) | ||||
| 	if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then | ||||
| 	    TK_BIN_DIR="# no Tk configs found" | ||||
| 	    AC_MSG_WARN(Can't find Tk configuration definitions) | ||||
| 	    exit 0 | ||||
| 	else | ||||
| 	    no_tk= | ||||
| 	    TK_BIN_DIR=${ac_cv_c_tkconfig} | ||||
| 	    AC_MSG_RESULT(found $TK_BIN_DIR/tkConfig.sh) | ||||
| 	fi | ||||
|     fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ]) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| #------------------------------------------------------------------------ | ||||
| # SC_LOAD_TCLCONFIG -- | ||||
| # | ||||
| #	Load the tclConfig.sh file | ||||
| # | ||||
| # Arguments: | ||||
| #	 | ||||
| #	Requires the following vars to be set: | ||||
| #		TCL_BIN_DIR | ||||
| # | ||||
| # Results: | ||||
| # | ||||
| #	Subst the following vars: | ||||
| #		TCL_BIN_DIR | ||||
| #		TCL_SRC_DIR | ||||
| #		TCL_LIB_FILE | ||||
| # | ||||
| #------------------------------------------------------------------------ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| AC_DEFUN(SC_LOAD_TCLCONFIG, [ | ||||
|     AC_MSG_CHECKING([for existence of $TCL_BIN_DIR/tclConfig.sh]) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     if test -f "$TCL_BIN_DIR/tclConfig.sh" ; then | ||||
|         AC_MSG_RESULT([loading]) | ||||
| 	. $TCL_BIN_DIR/tclConfig.sh | ||||
|     else | ||||
|         AC_MSG_RESULT([file not found]) | ||||
|     fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     # | ||||
|     # If the TCL_BIN_DIR is the build directory (not the install directory), | ||||
|     # then set the common variable name to the value of the build variables. | ||||
|     # For example, the variable TCL_LIB_SPEC will be set to the value | ||||
|     # of TCL_BUILD_LIB_SPEC. An extension should make use of TCL_LIB_SPEC | ||||
|     # instead of TCL_BUILD_LIB_SPEC since it will work with both an | ||||
|     # installed and uninstalled version of Tcl. | ||||
|     # | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     if test -f $TCL_BIN_DIR/Makefile ; then | ||||
|         TCL_LIB_SPEC=${TCL_BUILD_LIB_SPEC} | ||||
|         TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC=${TCL_BUILD_STUB_LIB_SPEC} | ||||
|         TCL_STUB_LIB_PATH=${TCL_BUILD_STUB_LIB_PATH} | ||||
|     fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     # | ||||
|     # eval is required to do the TCL_DBGX substitution | ||||
|     # | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     eval "TCL_LIB_FILE=\"${TCL_LIB_FILE}\"" | ||||
|     eval "TCL_LIB_FLAG=\"${TCL_LIB_FLAG}\"" | ||||
|     eval "TCL_LIB_SPEC=\"${TCL_LIB_SPEC}\"" | ||||
|     eval "TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC=\"${TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC}\"" | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     eval "TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE=\"${TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE}\"" | ||||
|     eval "TCL_STUB_LIB_FLAG=\"${TCL_STUB_LIB_FLAG}\"" | ||||
|     eval "TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC=\"${TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC}\"" | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| #    AC_SUBST(TCL_VERSION) | ||||
| #    AC_SUBST(TCL_BIN_DIR) | ||||
| #    AC_SUBST(TCL_SRC_DIR) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| #    AC_SUBST(TCL_LIB_FILE) | ||||
| #    AC_SUBST(TCL_LIB_FLAG) | ||||
|     AC_SUBST(TCL_LIB_SPEC) | ||||
|     AC_SUBST(TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| #    AC_SUBST(TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE) | ||||
| #    AC_SUBST(TCL_STUB_LIB_FLAG) | ||||
| #    AC_SUBST(TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC) | ||||
| ]) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| #------------------------------------------------------------------------ | ||||
| # SC_LOAD_TKCONFIG -- | ||||
| # | ||||
| #	Load the tkConfig.sh file | ||||
| # | ||||
| # Arguments: | ||||
| #	 | ||||
| #	Requires the following vars to be set: | ||||
| #		TK_BIN_DIR | ||||
| # | ||||
| # Results: | ||||
| # | ||||
| #	Sets the following vars that should be in tkConfig.sh: | ||||
| #		TK_BIN_DIR | ||||
| #------------------------------------------------------------------------ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| AC_DEFUN(SC_LOAD_TKCONFIG, [ | ||||
|     AC_MSG_CHECKING([for existence of $TK_BIN_DIR/tkConfig.sh]) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     if test -f "$TK_BIN_DIR/tkConfig.sh" ; then | ||||
|         AC_MSG_RESULT([loading]) | ||||
| 	. $TK_BIN_DIR/tkConfig.sh | ||||
|     else | ||||
|         AC_MSG_RESULT([could not find $TK_BIN_DIR/tkConfig.sh]) | ||||
|     fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     AC_SUBST(TK_LIB_SPEC) | ||||
|     AC_SUBST(TK_LIBS) | ||||
|     AC_SUBST(TK_XINCLUDES) | ||||
|     AC_SUBST(TK_PREFIX) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| #    AC_SUBST(TK_VERSION) | ||||
| #    AC_SUBST(TK_BIN_DIR) | ||||
| #    AC_SUBST(TK_SRC_DIR) | ||||
| #    AC_SUBST(TK_LIB_FILE) | ||||
| ]) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dnl From Bruno Haible. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| AC_DEFUN([AC_LANGINFO_CODESET], | ||||
| [ | ||||
|   AC_CACHE_CHECK([for nl_langinfo and CODESET], am_cv_langinfo_codeset, | ||||
|     [AC_TRY_LINK([#include <langinfo.h>], | ||||
|       [char* cs = nl_langinfo(CODESET);], | ||||
|       am_cv_langinfo_codeset=yes, | ||||
|       am_cv_langinfo_codeset=no) | ||||
|     ]) | ||||
|   if test $am_cv_langinfo_codeset = yes; then | ||||
|     AC_DEFINE(HAVE_LANGINFO_CODESET, 1, | ||||
|       [Define if you have <langinfo.h> and nl_langinfo(CODESET).]) | ||||
|   fi | ||||
| ]) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
							
								
								
									
										1021
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/aclocal.m4
									
									
									
									
										vendored
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										1021
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/aclocal.m4
									
									
									
									
										vendored
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										136
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/compile
									
									
									
									
									
										Executable file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										136
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/compile
									
									
									
									
									
										Executable file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,136 @@ | |||
| #! /bin/sh | ||||
| # Wrapper for compilers which do not understand `-c -o'. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| scriptversion=2003-11-09.00 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | ||||
| # Written by Tom Tromey <tromey@cygnus.com>. | ||||
| # | ||||
| # This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify | ||||
| # it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by | ||||
| # the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) | ||||
| # any later version. | ||||
| # | ||||
| # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, | ||||
| # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of | ||||
| # MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the | ||||
| # GNU General Public License for more details. | ||||
| # | ||||
| # You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | ||||
| # along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software | ||||
| # Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you | ||||
| # distribute this file as part of a program that contains a | ||||
| # configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under | ||||
| # the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This file is maintained in Automake, please report | ||||
| # bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org> or send patches to | ||||
| # <automake-patches@gnu.org>. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| case $1 in | ||||
|   '') | ||||
|      echo "$0: No command.  Try \`$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2 | ||||
|      exit 1; | ||||
|      ;; | ||||
|   -h | --h*) | ||||
|     cat <<\EOF | ||||
| Usage: compile [--help] [--version] PROGRAM [ARGS] | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Wrapper for compilers which do not understand `-c -o'. | ||||
| Remove `-o dest.o' from ARGS, run PROGRAM with the remaining | ||||
| arguments, and rename the output as expected. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| If you are trying to build a whole package this is not the | ||||
| right script to run: please start by reading the file `INSTALL'. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Report bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org>. | ||||
| EOF | ||||
|     exit 0 | ||||
|     ;; | ||||
|   -v | --v*) | ||||
|     echo "compile $scriptversion" | ||||
|     exit 0 | ||||
|     ;; | ||||
| esac | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| prog=$1 | ||||
| shift | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ofile= | ||||
| cfile= | ||||
| args= | ||||
| while test $# -gt 0; do | ||||
|   case "$1" in | ||||
|     -o) | ||||
|       # configure might choose to run compile as `compile cc -o foo foo.c'. | ||||
|       # So we do something ugly here. | ||||
|       ofile=$2 | ||||
|       shift | ||||
|       case "$ofile" in | ||||
| 	*.o | *.obj) | ||||
| 	  ;; | ||||
| 	*) | ||||
| 	  args="$args -o $ofile" | ||||
| 	  ofile= | ||||
| 	  ;; | ||||
|       esac | ||||
|        ;; | ||||
|     *.c) | ||||
|       cfile=$1 | ||||
|       args="$args $1" | ||||
|       ;; | ||||
|     *) | ||||
|       args="$args $1" | ||||
|       ;; | ||||
|   esac | ||||
|   shift | ||||
| done | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| if test -z "$ofile" || test -z "$cfile"; then | ||||
|   # If no `-o' option was seen then we might have been invoked from a | ||||
|   # pattern rule where we don't need one.  That is ok -- this is a | ||||
|   # normal compilation that the losing compiler can handle.  If no | ||||
|   # `.c' file was seen then we are probably linking.  That is also | ||||
|   # ok. | ||||
|   exec "$prog" $args | ||||
| fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Name of file we expect compiler to create. | ||||
| cofile=`echo $cfile | sed -e 's|^.*/||' -e 's/\.c$/.o/'` | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Create the lock directory. | ||||
| # Note: use `[/.-]' here to ensure that we don't use the same name | ||||
| # that we are using for the .o file.  Also, base the name on the expected | ||||
| # object file name, since that is what matters with a parallel build. | ||||
| lockdir=`echo $cofile | sed -e 's|[/.-]|_|g'`.d | ||||
| while true; do | ||||
|   if mkdir $lockdir > /dev/null 2>&1; then | ||||
|     break | ||||
|   fi | ||||
|   sleep 1 | ||||
| done | ||||
| # FIXME: race condition here if user kills between mkdir and trap. | ||||
| trap "rmdir $lockdir; exit 1" 1 2 15 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Run the compile. | ||||
| "$prog" $args | ||||
| status=$? | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| if test -f "$cofile"; then | ||||
|   mv "$cofile" "$ofile" | ||||
| fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| rmdir $lockdir | ||||
| exit $status | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Local Variables: | ||||
| # mode: shell-script | ||||
| # sh-indentation: 2 | ||||
| # eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) | ||||
| # time-stamp-start: "scriptversion=" | ||||
| # time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" | ||||
| # time-stamp-end: "$" | ||||
| # End: | ||||
							
								
								
									
										86
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/config.h.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										86
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/config.h.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,86 @@ | |||
| /* config.h.in.  Generated from configure.ac by autoheader.  */ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Default installation prefix. */ | ||||
| #undef DEFAULTPATH | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the <inttypes.h> header file. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_INTTYPES_H | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define if you have <langinfo.h> and nl_langinfo(CODESET). */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_LANGINFO_CODESET | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the <locale.h> header file. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_LOCALE_H | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if your system has a GNU libc compatible `malloc' function, and
 | ||||
|    to 0 otherwise. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_MALLOC | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the <malloc.h> header file. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_MALLOC_H | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the <memory.h> header file. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_MEMORY_H | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the <stdint.h> header file. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_STDINT_H | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the <stdlib.h> header file. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_STDLIB_H | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the `strchr' function. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_STRCHR | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the `strdup' function. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_STRDUP | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the <strings.h> header file. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_STRINGS_H | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the <string.h> header file. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_STRING_H | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the `strrchr' function. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_STRRCHR | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the `strstr' function. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_STRSTR | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the `strtol' function. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_STRTOL | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/stat.h> header file. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_SYS_STAT_H | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/types.h> header file. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_SYS_TYPES_H | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the <unistd.h> header file. */ | ||||
| #undef HAVE_UNISTD_H | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Name of package */ | ||||
| #undef PACKAGE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to the address where bug reports for this package should be sent. */ | ||||
| #undef PACKAGE_BUGREPORT | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to the full name of this package. */ | ||||
| #undef PACKAGE_NAME | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to the full name and version of this package. */ | ||||
| #undef PACKAGE_STRING | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to the one symbol short name of this package. */ | ||||
| #undef PACKAGE_TARNAME | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to the version of this package. */ | ||||
| #undef PACKAGE_VERSION | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to 1 if you have the ANSI C header files. */ | ||||
| #undef STDC_HEADERS | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Version number of package */ | ||||
| #undef VERSION | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| /* Define to rpl_malloc if the replacement function should be used. */ | ||||
| #undef malloc | ||||
							
								
								
									
										5755
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/configure
									
									
									
									
										vendored
									
									
										Executable file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										5755
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/configure
									
									
									
									
										vendored
									
									
										Executable file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										74
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/configure.ac
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										74
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/configure.ac
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,74 @@ | |||
| #                                               -*- Autoconf -*- | ||||
| # Process this file with autoconf to produce a configure script. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| AC_PREREQ(2.59) | ||||
| AC_INIT(WordNet, 3.0, [wordnet@princeton.edu], wordnet) | ||||
| AC_CONFIG_SRCDIR([config.h.in]) | ||||
| AC_CONFIG_HEADER([config.h]) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Checks for programs. | ||||
| AC_PROG_CC | ||||
| AC_PROG_RANLIB | ||||
| AC_PROG_INSTALL | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Checks for header files. | ||||
| AC_HEADER_STDC | ||||
| AC_CHECK_HEADERS([locale.h malloc.h stdlib.h string.h]) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Checks for typedefs, structures, and compiler characteristics. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Checks for library functions. | ||||
| AC_FUNC_MALLOC | ||||
| AC_CHECK_FUNCS([strchr strdup strrchr strstr strtol]) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Set HAVE_LANGINFO_CODESET if nl_langinfo is found | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| AC_LANGINFO_CODESET | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| AM_INIT_AUTOMAKE(WordNet, 3.0) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| SC_PATH_TCLCONFIG | ||||
| SC_PATH_TKCONFIG | ||||
| SC_LOAD_TCLCONFIG | ||||
| SC_LOAD_TKCONFIG | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Set default installation prefix. | ||||
| AC_PREFIX_DEFAULT([/usr/local/WordNet-3.0]) | ||||
| ac_prefix=$prefix | ||||
| if test "x$ac_prefix" = "xNONE"; then | ||||
|     ac_prefix=$ac_default_prefix | ||||
| fi | ||||
| AC_SUBST(ac_prefix) | ||||
| AH_TEMPLATE([DEFAULTPATH],[The default search path for WordNet data files]) | ||||
| AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(DEFAULTPATH, ["$ac_prefix/dict"], [Default installation prefix.]) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| #AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(DEFAULTPATH,"${prefix}/dict") | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This doesn't do anything | ||||
| AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS([default]) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| AC_CONFIG_FILES(Makefile dict/Makefile doc/Makefile doc/html/Makefile doc/man/Makefile doc/pdf/Makefile doc/ps/Makefile include/Makefile include/tk/Makefile | ||||
| src/Makefile lib/Makefile lib/wnres/Makefile) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| AC_OUTPUT | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| AC_MSG_RESULT( | ||||
| [ | ||||
| WordNet is now configured | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   Installation directory:               ${prefix} | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   To build and install WordNet: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     make | ||||
|     make install | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   To run, environment variables should be set as follows: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     PATH - include ${bindir} | ||||
|     WNHOME - if not using default installation location, set to ${prefix} | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     See INSTALL file for details and additional environment variables | ||||
|     which may need to be set on your system. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ]) | ||||
							
								
								
									
										522
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/depcomp
									
									
									
									
									
										Executable file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										522
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/depcomp
									
									
									
									
									
										Executable file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,522 @@ | |||
| #! /bin/sh | ||||
| # depcomp - compile a program generating dependencies as side-effects | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| scriptversion=2004-05-31.23 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify | ||||
| # it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by | ||||
| # the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) | ||||
| # any later version. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, | ||||
| # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of | ||||
| # MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the | ||||
| # GNU General Public License for more details. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | ||||
| # along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software | ||||
| # Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA | ||||
| # 02111-1307, USA. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you | ||||
| # distribute this file as part of a program that contains a | ||||
| # configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under | ||||
| # the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Originally written by Alexandre Oliva <oliva@dcc.unicamp.br>. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| case $1 in | ||||
|   '') | ||||
|      echo "$0: No command.  Try \`$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2 | ||||
|      exit 1; | ||||
|      ;; | ||||
|   -h | --h*) | ||||
|     cat <<\EOF | ||||
| Usage: depcomp [--help] [--version] PROGRAM [ARGS] | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Run PROGRAMS ARGS to compile a file, generating dependencies | ||||
| as side-effects. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Environment variables: | ||||
|   depmode     Dependency tracking mode. | ||||
|   source      Source file read by `PROGRAMS ARGS'. | ||||
|   object      Object file output by `PROGRAMS ARGS'. | ||||
|   DEPDIR      directory where to store dependencies. | ||||
|   depfile     Dependency file to output. | ||||
|   tmpdepfile  Temporary file to use when outputing dependencies. | ||||
|   libtool     Whether libtool is used (yes/no). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Report bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org>. | ||||
| EOF | ||||
|     exit 0 | ||||
|     ;; | ||||
|   -v | --v*) | ||||
|     echo "depcomp $scriptversion" | ||||
|     exit 0 | ||||
|     ;; | ||||
| esac | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| if test -z "$depmode" || test -z "$source" || test -z "$object"; then | ||||
|   echo "depcomp: Variables source, object and depmode must be set" 1>&2 | ||||
|   exit 1 | ||||
| fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Dependencies for sub/bar.o or sub/bar.obj go into sub/.deps/bar.Po. | ||||
| depfile=${depfile-`echo "$object" | | ||||
|   sed 's|[^\\/]*$|'${DEPDIR-.deps}'/&|;s|\.\([^.]*\)$|.P\1|;s|Pobj$|Po|'`} | ||||
| tmpdepfile=${tmpdepfile-`echo "$depfile" | sed 's/\.\([^.]*\)$/.T\1/'`} | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Some modes work just like other modes, but use different flags.  We | ||||
| # parameterize here, but still list the modes in the big case below, | ||||
| # to make depend.m4 easier to write.  Note that we *cannot* use a case | ||||
| # here, because this file can only contain one case statement. | ||||
| if test "$depmode" = hp; then | ||||
|   # HP compiler uses -M and no extra arg. | ||||
|   gccflag=-M | ||||
|   depmode=gcc | ||||
| fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| if test "$depmode" = dashXmstdout; then | ||||
|    # This is just like dashmstdout with a different argument. | ||||
|    dashmflag=-xM | ||||
|    depmode=dashmstdout | ||||
| fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| case "$depmode" in | ||||
| gcc3) | ||||
| ## gcc 3 implements dependency tracking that does exactly what | ||||
| ## we want.  Yay!  Note: for some reason libtool 1.4 doesn't like | ||||
| ## it if -MD -MP comes after the -MF stuff.  Hmm. | ||||
|   "$@" -MT "$object" -MD -MP -MF "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   stat=$? | ||||
|   if test $stat -eq 0; then : | ||||
|   else | ||||
|     rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|     exit $stat | ||||
|   fi | ||||
|   mv "$tmpdepfile" "$depfile" | ||||
|   ;; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| gcc) | ||||
| ## There are various ways to get dependency output from gcc.  Here's | ||||
| ## why we pick this rather obscure method: | ||||
| ## - Don't want to use -MD because we'd like the dependencies to end | ||||
| ##   up in a subdir.  Having to rename by hand is ugly. | ||||
| ##   (We might end up doing this anyway to support other compilers.) | ||||
| ## - The DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT environment variable makes gcc act like | ||||
| ##   -MM, not -M (despite what the docs say). | ||||
| ## - Using -M directly means running the compiler twice (even worse | ||||
| ##   than renaming). | ||||
|   if test -z "$gccflag"; then | ||||
|     gccflag=-MD, | ||||
|   fi | ||||
|   "$@" -Wp,"$gccflag$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   stat=$? | ||||
|   if test $stat -eq 0; then : | ||||
|   else | ||||
|     rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|     exit $stat | ||||
|   fi | ||||
|   rm -f "$depfile" | ||||
|   echo "$object : \\" > "$depfile" | ||||
|   alpha=ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZabcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz | ||||
| ## The second -e expression handles DOS-style file names with drive letters. | ||||
|   sed -e 's/^[^:]*: / /' \ | ||||
|       -e 's/^['$alpha']:\/[^:]*: / /' < "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile" | ||||
| ## This next piece of magic avoids the `deleted header file' problem. | ||||
| ## The problem is that when a header file which appears in a .P file | ||||
| ## is deleted, the dependency causes make to die (because there is | ||||
| ## typically no way to rebuild the header).  We avoid this by adding | ||||
| ## dummy dependencies for each header file.  Too bad gcc doesn't do | ||||
| ## this for us directly. | ||||
|   tr ' ' ' | ||||
| ' < "$tmpdepfile" | | ||||
| ## Some versions of gcc put a space before the `:'.  On the theory | ||||
| ## that the space means something, we add a space to the output as | ||||
| ## well. | ||||
| ## Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process this invocation | ||||
| ## correctly.  Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround. | ||||
|     sed -e 's/^\\$//' -e '/^$/d' -e '/:$/d' | sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile" | ||||
|   rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   ;; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| hp) | ||||
|   # This case exists only to let depend.m4 do its work.  It works by | ||||
|   # looking at the text of this script.  This case will never be run, | ||||
|   # since it is checked for above. | ||||
|   exit 1 | ||||
|   ;; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| sgi) | ||||
|   if test "$libtool" = yes; then | ||||
|     "$@" "-Wp,-MDupdate,$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   else | ||||
|     "$@" -MDupdate "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   fi | ||||
|   stat=$? | ||||
|   if test $stat -eq 0; then : | ||||
|   else | ||||
|     rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|     exit $stat | ||||
|   fi | ||||
|   rm -f "$depfile" | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then  # yes, the sourcefile depend on other files | ||||
|     echo "$object : \\" > "$depfile" | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     # Clip off the initial element (the dependent).  Don't try to be | ||||
|     # clever and replace this with sed code, as IRIX sed won't handle | ||||
|     # lines with more than a fixed number of characters (4096 in | ||||
|     # IRIX 6.2 sed, 8192 in IRIX 6.5).  We also remove comment lines; | ||||
|     # the IRIX cc adds comments like `#:fec' to the end of the | ||||
|     # dependency line. | ||||
|     tr ' ' ' | ||||
| ' < "$tmpdepfile" \ | ||||
|     | sed -e 's/^.*\.o://' -e 's/#.*$//' -e '/^$/ d' | \ | ||||
|     tr ' | ||||
| ' ' ' >> $depfile | ||||
|     echo >> $depfile | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|     # The second pass generates a dummy entry for each header file. | ||||
|     tr ' ' ' | ||||
| ' < "$tmpdepfile" \ | ||||
|    | sed -e 's/^.*\.o://' -e 's/#.*$//' -e '/^$/ d' -e 's/$/:/' \ | ||||
|    >> $depfile | ||||
|   else | ||||
|     # The sourcefile does not contain any dependencies, so just | ||||
|     # store a dummy comment line, to avoid errors with the Makefile | ||||
|     # "include basename.Plo" scheme. | ||||
|     echo "#dummy" > "$depfile" | ||||
|   fi | ||||
|   rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   ;; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| aix) | ||||
|   # The C for AIX Compiler uses -M and outputs the dependencies | ||||
|   # in a .u file.  In older versions, this file always lives in the | ||||
|   # current directory.  Also, the AIX compiler puts `$object:' at the | ||||
|   # start of each line; $object doesn't have directory information. | ||||
|   # Version 6 uses the directory in both cases. | ||||
|   stripped=`echo "$object" | sed 's/\(.*\)\..*$/\1/'` | ||||
|   tmpdepfile="$stripped.u" | ||||
|   if test "$libtool" = yes; then | ||||
|     "$@" -Wc,-M | ||||
|   else | ||||
|     "$@" -M | ||||
|   fi | ||||
|   stat=$? | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then : | ||||
|   else | ||||
|     stripped=`echo "$stripped" | sed 's,^.*/,,'` | ||||
|     tmpdepfile="$stripped.u" | ||||
|   fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   if test $stat -eq 0; then : | ||||
|   else | ||||
|     rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|     exit $stat | ||||
|   fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then | ||||
|     outname="$stripped.o" | ||||
|     # Each line is of the form `foo.o: dependent.h'. | ||||
|     # Do two passes, one to just change these to | ||||
|     # `$object: dependent.h' and one to simply `dependent.h:'. | ||||
|     sed -e "s,^$outname:,$object :," < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile" | ||||
|     sed -e "s,^$outname: \(.*\)$,\1:," < "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile" | ||||
|   else | ||||
|     # The sourcefile does not contain any dependencies, so just | ||||
|     # store a dummy comment line, to avoid errors with the Makefile | ||||
|     # "include basename.Plo" scheme. | ||||
|     echo "#dummy" > "$depfile" | ||||
|   fi | ||||
|   rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   ;; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| icc) | ||||
|   # Intel's C compiler understands `-MD -MF file'.  However on | ||||
|   #    icc -MD -MF foo.d -c -o sub/foo.o sub/foo.c | ||||
|   # ICC 7.0 will fill foo.d with something like | ||||
|   #    foo.o: sub/foo.c | ||||
|   #    foo.o: sub/foo.h | ||||
|   # which is wrong.  We want: | ||||
|   #    sub/foo.o: sub/foo.c | ||||
|   #    sub/foo.o: sub/foo.h | ||||
|   #    sub/foo.c: | ||||
|   #    sub/foo.h: | ||||
|   # ICC 7.1 will output | ||||
|   #    foo.o: sub/foo.c sub/foo.h | ||||
|   # and will wrap long lines using \ : | ||||
|   #    foo.o: sub/foo.c ... \ | ||||
|   #     sub/foo.h ... \ | ||||
|   #     ... | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   "$@" -MD -MF "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   stat=$? | ||||
|   if test $stat -eq 0; then : | ||||
|   else | ||||
|     rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|     exit $stat | ||||
|   fi | ||||
|   rm -f "$depfile" | ||||
|   # Each line is of the form `foo.o: dependent.h', | ||||
|   # or `foo.o: dep1.h dep2.h \', or ` dep3.h dep4.h \'. | ||||
|   # Do two passes, one to just change these to | ||||
|   # `$object: dependent.h' and one to simply `dependent.h:'. | ||||
|   sed "s,^[^:]*:,$object :," < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile" | ||||
|   # Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process this invocation | ||||
|   # correctly.  Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround. | ||||
|   sed 's,^[^:]*: \(.*\)$,\1,;s/^\\$//;/^$/d;/:$/d' < "$tmpdepfile" | | ||||
|     sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile" | ||||
|   rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   ;; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| tru64) | ||||
|    # The Tru64 compiler uses -MD to generate dependencies as a side | ||||
|    # effect.  `cc -MD -o foo.o ...' puts the dependencies into `foo.o.d'. | ||||
|    # At least on Alpha/Redhat 6.1, Compaq CCC V6.2-504 seems to put | ||||
|    # dependencies in `foo.d' instead, so we check for that too. | ||||
|    # Subdirectories are respected. | ||||
|    dir=`echo "$object" | sed -e 's|/[^/]*$|/|'` | ||||
|    test "x$dir" = "x$object" && dir= | ||||
|    base=`echo "$object" | sed -e 's|^.*/||' -e 's/\.o$//' -e 's/\.lo$//'` | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    if test "$libtool" = yes; then | ||||
|       # Dependencies are output in .lo.d with libtool 1.4. | ||||
|       # With libtool 1.5 they are output both in $dir.libs/$base.o.d | ||||
|       # and in $dir.libs/$base.o.d and $dir$base.o.d.  We process the | ||||
|       # latter, because the former will be cleaned when $dir.libs is | ||||
|       # erased. | ||||
|       tmpdepfile1="$dir.libs/$base.lo.d" | ||||
|       tmpdepfile2="$dir$base.o.d" | ||||
|       tmpdepfile3="$dir.libs/$base.d" | ||||
|       "$@" -Wc,-MD | ||||
|    else | ||||
|       tmpdepfile1="$dir$base.o.d" | ||||
|       tmpdepfile2="$dir$base.d" | ||||
|       tmpdepfile3="$dir$base.d" | ||||
|       "$@" -MD | ||||
|    fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    stat=$? | ||||
|    if test $stat -eq 0; then : | ||||
|    else | ||||
|       rm -f "$tmpdepfile1" "$tmpdepfile2" "$tmpdepfile3" | ||||
|       exit $stat | ||||
|    fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|    if test -f "$tmpdepfile1"; then | ||||
|       tmpdepfile="$tmpdepfile1" | ||||
|    elif test -f "$tmpdepfile2"; then | ||||
|       tmpdepfile="$tmpdepfile2" | ||||
|    else | ||||
|       tmpdepfile="$tmpdepfile3" | ||||
|    fi | ||||
|    if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then | ||||
|       sed -e "s,^.*\.[a-z]*:,$object:," < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile" | ||||
|       # That's a tab and a space in the []. | ||||
|       sed -e 's,^.*\.[a-z]*:[	 ]*,,' -e 's,$,:,' < "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile" | ||||
|    else | ||||
|       echo "#dummy" > "$depfile" | ||||
|    fi | ||||
|    rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|    ;; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| #nosideeffect) | ||||
|   # This comment above is used by automake to tell side-effect | ||||
|   # dependency tracking mechanisms from slower ones. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dashmstdout) | ||||
|   # Important note: in order to support this mode, a compiler *must* | ||||
|   # always write the preprocessed file to stdout, regardless of -o. | ||||
|   "$@" || exit $? | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   # Remove the call to Libtool. | ||||
|   if test "$libtool" = yes; then | ||||
|     while test $1 != '--mode=compile'; do | ||||
|       shift | ||||
|     done | ||||
|     shift | ||||
|   fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   # Remove `-o $object'. | ||||
|   IFS=" " | ||||
|   for arg | ||||
|   do | ||||
|     case $arg in | ||||
|     -o) | ||||
|       shift | ||||
|       ;; | ||||
|     $object) | ||||
|       shift | ||||
|       ;; | ||||
|     *) | ||||
|       set fnord "$@" "$arg" | ||||
|       shift # fnord | ||||
|       shift # $arg | ||||
|       ;; | ||||
|     esac | ||||
|   done | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   test -z "$dashmflag" && dashmflag=-M | ||||
|   # Require at least two characters before searching for `:' | ||||
|   # in the target name.  This is to cope with DOS-style filenames: | ||||
|   # a dependency such as `c:/foo/bar' could be seen as target `c' otherwise. | ||||
|   "$@" $dashmflag | | ||||
|     sed 's:^[  ]*[^: ][^:][^:]*\:[    ]*:'"$object"'\: :' > "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   rm -f "$depfile" | ||||
|   cat < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile" | ||||
|   tr ' ' ' | ||||
| ' < "$tmpdepfile" | \ | ||||
| ## Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process this invocation | ||||
| ## correctly.  Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround. | ||||
|     sed -e 's/^\\$//' -e '/^$/d' -e '/:$/d' | sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile" | ||||
|   rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   ;; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dashXmstdout) | ||||
|   # This case only exists to satisfy depend.m4.  It is never actually | ||||
|   # run, as this mode is specially recognized in the preamble. | ||||
|   exit 1 | ||||
|   ;; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| makedepend) | ||||
|   "$@" || exit $? | ||||
|   # Remove any Libtool call | ||||
|   if test "$libtool" = yes; then | ||||
|     while test $1 != '--mode=compile'; do | ||||
|       shift | ||||
|     done | ||||
|     shift | ||||
|   fi | ||||
|   # X makedepend | ||||
|   shift | ||||
|   cleared=no | ||||
|   for arg in "$@"; do | ||||
|     case $cleared in | ||||
|     no) | ||||
|       set ""; shift | ||||
|       cleared=yes ;; | ||||
|     esac | ||||
|     case "$arg" in | ||||
|     -D*|-I*) | ||||
|       set fnord "$@" "$arg"; shift ;; | ||||
|     # Strip any option that makedepend may not understand.  Remove | ||||
|     # the object too, otherwise makedepend will parse it as a source file. | ||||
|     -*|$object) | ||||
|       ;; | ||||
|     *) | ||||
|       set fnord "$@" "$arg"; shift ;; | ||||
|     esac | ||||
|   done | ||||
|   obj_suffix="`echo $object | sed 's/^.*\././'`" | ||||
|   touch "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   ${MAKEDEPEND-makedepend} -o"$obj_suffix" -f"$tmpdepfile" "$@" | ||||
|   rm -f "$depfile" | ||||
|   cat < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile" | ||||
|   sed '1,2d' "$tmpdepfile" | tr ' ' ' | ||||
| ' | \ | ||||
| ## Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process this invocation | ||||
| ## correctly.  Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround. | ||||
|     sed -e 's/^\\$//' -e '/^$/d' -e '/:$/d' | sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile" | ||||
|   rm -f "$tmpdepfile" "$tmpdepfile".bak | ||||
|   ;; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| cpp) | ||||
|   # Important note: in order to support this mode, a compiler *must* | ||||
|   # always write the preprocessed file to stdout. | ||||
|   "$@" || exit $? | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   # Remove the call to Libtool. | ||||
|   if test "$libtool" = yes; then | ||||
|     while test $1 != '--mode=compile'; do | ||||
|       shift | ||||
|     done | ||||
|     shift | ||||
|   fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   # Remove `-o $object'. | ||||
|   IFS=" " | ||||
|   for arg | ||||
|   do | ||||
|     case $arg in | ||||
|     -o) | ||||
|       shift | ||||
|       ;; | ||||
|     $object) | ||||
|       shift | ||||
|       ;; | ||||
|     *) | ||||
|       set fnord "$@" "$arg" | ||||
|       shift # fnord | ||||
|       shift # $arg | ||||
|       ;; | ||||
|     esac | ||||
|   done | ||||
| 
 | ||||
|   "$@" -E | | ||||
|     sed -n '/^# [0-9][0-9]* "\([^"]*\)".*/ s:: \1 \\:p' | | ||||
|     sed '$ s: \\$::' > "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   rm -f "$depfile" | ||||
|   echo "$object : \\" > "$depfile" | ||||
|   cat < "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile" | ||||
|   sed < "$tmpdepfile" '/^$/d;s/^ //;s/ \\$//;s/$/ :/' >> "$depfile" | ||||
|   rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   ;; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| msvisualcpp) | ||||
|   # Important note: in order to support this mode, a compiler *must* | ||||
|   # always write the preprocessed file to stdout, regardless of -o, | ||||
|   # because we must use -o when running libtool. | ||||
|   "$@" || exit $? | ||||
|   IFS=" " | ||||
|   for arg | ||||
|   do | ||||
|     case "$arg" in | ||||
|     "-Gm"|"/Gm"|"-Gi"|"/Gi"|"-ZI"|"/ZI") | ||||
| 	set fnord "$@" | ||||
| 	shift | ||||
| 	shift | ||||
| 	;; | ||||
|     *) | ||||
| 	set fnord "$@" "$arg" | ||||
| 	shift | ||||
| 	shift | ||||
| 	;; | ||||
|     esac | ||||
|   done | ||||
|   "$@" -E | | ||||
|   sed -n '/^#line [0-9][0-9]* "\([^"]*\)"/ s::echo "`cygpath -u \\"\1\\"`":p' | sort | uniq > "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   rm -f "$depfile" | ||||
|   echo "$object : \\" > "$depfile" | ||||
|   . "$tmpdepfile" | sed 's% %\\ %g' | sed -n '/^\(.*\)$/ s::	\1 \\:p' >> "$depfile" | ||||
|   echo "	" >> "$depfile" | ||||
|   . "$tmpdepfile" | sed 's% %\\ %g' | sed -n '/^\(.*\)$/ s::\1\::p' >> "$depfile" | ||||
|   rm -f "$tmpdepfile" | ||||
|   ;; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| none) | ||||
|   exec "$@" | ||||
|   ;; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| *) | ||||
|   echo "Unknown depmode $depmode" 1>&2 | ||||
|   exit 1 | ||||
|   ;; | ||||
| esac | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| exit 0 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Local Variables: | ||||
| # mode: shell-script | ||||
| # sh-indentation: 2 | ||||
| # eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) | ||||
| # time-stamp-start: "scriptversion=" | ||||
| # time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" | ||||
| # time-stamp-end: "$" | ||||
| # End: | ||||
							
								
								
									
										314
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/Makefile
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										314
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/Makefile
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,314 @@ | |||
| # Makefile.in generated by automake 1.9 from Makefile.am.
 | ||||
| # dict/Makefile.  Generated from Makefile.in by configure.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
 | ||||
| # 2003, 2004  Free Software Foundation, Inc.
 | ||||
| # This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
 | ||||
| # gives unlimited permission to copy and/or distribute it,
 | ||||
| # with or without modifications, as long as this notice is preserved.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | ||||
| # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law; without
 | ||||
| # even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A
 | ||||
| # PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| srcdir = . | ||||
| top_srcdir = .. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/WordNet | ||||
| pkglibdir = $(libdir)/WordNet | ||||
| pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/WordNet | ||||
| top_builddir = .. | ||||
| am__cd = CDPATH="$${ZSH_VERSION+.}$(PATH_SEPARATOR)" && cd | ||||
| INSTALL = /usr/csl/bin/install -c | ||||
| install_sh_DATA = $(install_sh) -c -m 644 | ||||
| install_sh_PROGRAM = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| install_sh_SCRIPT = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| INSTALL_HEADER = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| transform = $(program_transform_name) | ||||
| NORMAL_INSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_INSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_INSTALL = : | ||||
| NORMAL_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| subdir = dict | ||||
| DIST_COMMON = $(srcdir)/Makefile.am $(srcdir)/Makefile.in | ||||
| ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4 | ||||
| am__aclocal_m4_deps = $(top_srcdir)/acinclude.m4 \
 | ||||
| 	$(top_srcdir)/configure.ac | ||||
| am__configure_deps = $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES) \
 | ||||
| 	$(ACLOCAL_M4) | ||||
| mkinstalldirs = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| CONFIG_HEADER = $(top_builddir)/config.h | ||||
| CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES = | ||||
| SOURCES = | ||||
| DIST_SOURCES = | ||||
| am__vpath_adj_setup = srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; | ||||
| am__vpath_adj = case $$p in \
 | ||||
|     $(srcdir)/*) f=`echo "$$p" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
|     *) f=$$p;; \
 | ||||
|   esac; | ||||
| am__strip_dir = `echo $$p | sed -e 's|^.*/||'`; | ||||
| am__installdirs = "$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)" | ||||
| dictDATA_INSTALL = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| DATA = $(dict_DATA) | ||||
| DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(DIST_SOURCES) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST) | ||||
| ACLOCAL = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run aclocal-1.9 | ||||
| AMDEP_FALSE = # | ||||
| AMDEP_TRUE =  | ||||
| AMTAR = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run tar | ||||
| AUTOCONF = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run autoconf | ||||
| AUTOHEADER = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run autoheader | ||||
| AUTOMAKE = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run automake-1.9 | ||||
| AWK = nawk | ||||
| CC = gcc | ||||
| CCDEPMODE = depmode=gcc3 | ||||
| CFLAGS = -g -O2 | ||||
| CPP = gcc -E | ||||
| CPPFLAGS =  | ||||
| CYGPATH_W = echo | ||||
| DEFS = -DHAVE_CONFIG_H | ||||
| DEPDIR = .deps | ||||
| ECHO_C =  | ||||
| ECHO_N = -n | ||||
| ECHO_T =  | ||||
| EGREP = egrep | ||||
| EXEEXT =  | ||||
| INSTALL_DATA = ${INSTALL} -m 644 | ||||
| INSTALL_PROGRAM = ${INSTALL} | ||||
| INSTALL_SCRIPT = ${INSTALL} | ||||
| INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM = ${SHELL} $(install_sh) -c -s | ||||
| LDFLAGS =  | ||||
| LIBOBJS =  | ||||
| LIBS =  | ||||
| LTLIBOBJS =  | ||||
| MAKEINFO = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run makeinfo | ||||
| OBJEXT = o | ||||
| PACKAGE = WordNet | ||||
| PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = wordnet@princeton.edu | ||||
| PACKAGE_NAME = WordNet | ||||
| PACKAGE_STRING = WordNet 3.0 | ||||
| PACKAGE_TARNAME = wordnet | ||||
| PACKAGE_VERSION = 3.0 | ||||
| PATH_SEPARATOR = : | ||||
| RANLIB = ranlib | ||||
| SET_MAKE =  | ||||
| SHELL = /bin/bash | ||||
| STRIP =  | ||||
| TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC = -I/usr/csl/include | ||||
| TCL_LIB_SPEC = -L/usr/csl/lib -ltcl8.4 | ||||
| TK_LIBS = -L/usr/openwin/lib -lX11 -ldl  -lpthread -lsocket -lnsl -lm | ||||
| TK_LIB_SPEC = -L/usr/csl/lib -ltk8.4 | ||||
| TK_PREFIX = /usr/csl | ||||
| TK_XINCLUDES = -I/usr/openwin/include | ||||
| VERSION = 3.0 | ||||
| ac_ct_CC = gcc | ||||
| ac_ct_RANLIB = ranlib | ||||
| ac_ct_STRIP =  | ||||
| ac_prefix = /usr/local/WordNet-3.0 | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_FALSE = # | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_TRUE =  | ||||
| am__include = include | ||||
| am__leading_dot = . | ||||
| am__quote =  | ||||
| am__tar = ${AMTAR} chof - "$$tardir" | ||||
| am__untar = ${AMTAR} xf - | ||||
| bindir = ${exec_prefix}/bin | ||||
| build_alias =  | ||||
| datadir = ${prefix}/share | ||||
| exec_prefix = ${prefix} | ||||
| host_alias =  | ||||
| includedir = ${prefix}/include | ||||
| infodir = ${prefix}/info | ||||
| install_sh = /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/install-sh | ||||
| libdir = ${exec_prefix}/lib | ||||
| libexecdir = ${exec_prefix}/libexec | ||||
| localstatedir = ${prefix}/var | ||||
| mandir = ${prefix}/man | ||||
| mkdir_p = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| oldincludedir = /usr/include | ||||
| prefix = /usr/local/WordNet-3.0 | ||||
| program_transform_name = s,x,x, | ||||
| sbindir = ${exec_prefix}/sbin | ||||
| sharedstatedir = ${prefix}/com | ||||
| sysconfdir = ${prefix}/etc | ||||
| target_alias =  | ||||
| dictdir = $(prefix)/dict | ||||
| dict_DATA = adj.exc adv.exc cntlist cntlist.rev data.adj data.adv data.noun data.verb frames.vrb index.adj index.adv index.noun index.sense index.verb log.grind.3.0 noun.exc sentidx.vrb sents.vrb verb.Framestext verb.exc lexnames | ||||
| all: all-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SUFFIXES: | ||||
| $(srcdir)/Makefile.in:  $(srcdir)/Makefile.am  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	@for dep in $?; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case '$(am__configure_deps)' in \
 | ||||
| 	    *$$dep*) \
 | ||||
| 	      cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh \
 | ||||
| 		&& exit 0; \
 | ||||
| 	      exit 1;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	echo ' cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  dict/Makefile'; \
 | ||||
| 	cd $(top_srcdir) && \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  dict/Makefile | ||||
| .PRECIOUS: Makefile | ||||
| Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status | ||||
| 	@case '$?' in \
 | ||||
| 	  *config.status*) \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) \
 | ||||
| 	    echo ' cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe)'; \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe);; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_builddir)/config.status: $(top_srcdir)/configure $(CONFIG_STATUS_DEPENDENCIES) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_srcdir)/configure:  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| $(ACLOCAL_M4):  $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| uninstall-info-am: | ||||
| install-dictDATA: $(dict_DATA) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(dictdir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(dict_DATA)'; for p in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f "$$p"; then d=; else d="$(srcdir)/"; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  f=$(am__strip_dir) \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(dictDATA_INSTALL) '$$d$$p' '$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)/$$f'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(dictDATA_INSTALL) "$$d$$p" "$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)/$$f"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-dictDATA: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(dict_DATA)'; for p in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  f=$(am__strip_dir) \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)/$$f'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)/$$f"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| tags: TAGS | ||||
| TAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ctags: CTAGS | ||||
| CTAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distdir: $(DISTFILES) | ||||
| 	@srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	topsrcdirstrip=`echo "$(top_srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(DISTFILES)'; for file in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case $$file in \
 | ||||
| 	    $(srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(top_srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$topsrcdirstrip/|$(top_builddir)/|"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $$file || test -d $$file; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  dir=`echo "$$file" | sed -e 's,/[^/]*$$,,'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$dir" != "$$file" && test "$$dir" != "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dir="/$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    dir=''; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -d $$d/$$file; then \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -d $(srcdir)/$$file && test $$d != $(srcdir); then \
 | ||||
| 	      cp -pR $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    fi; \
 | ||||
| 	    cp -pR $$d/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || cp -p $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| check-am: all-am | ||||
| check: check-am | ||||
| all-am: Makefile $(DATA) | ||||
| installdirs: | ||||
| 	for dir in "$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)"; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test -z "$$dir" || $(mkdir_p) "$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install: install-am | ||||
| install-exec: install-exec-am | ||||
| install-data: install-data-am | ||||
| uninstall: uninstall-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-am: all-am | ||||
| 	@$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) install-exec-am install-data-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck: installcheck-am | ||||
| install-strip: | ||||
| 	$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) INSTALL_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" \
 | ||||
| 	  install_sh_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" INSTALL_STRIP_FLAG=-s \
 | ||||
| 	  `test -z '$(STRIP)' || \
 | ||||
| 	    echo "INSTALL_PROGRAM_ENV=STRIPPROG='$(STRIP)'"` install | ||||
| mostlyclean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-generic: | ||||
| 	-test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean-generic: | ||||
| 	@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use" | ||||
| 	@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild." | ||||
| clean: clean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-am: clean-generic mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean: distclean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| distclean-am: clean-am distclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi: dvi-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| html: html-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info: info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-data-am: install-dictDATA | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-exec-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-info: install-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-man: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| maintainer-clean-am: distclean-am maintainer-clean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean: mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf: pdf-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps: ps-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-am: uninstall-dictDATA uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .PHONY: all all-am check check-am clean clean-generic distclean \ | ||||
| 	distclean-generic distdir dvi dvi-am html html-am info info-am \
 | ||||
| 	install install-am install-data install-data-am \
 | ||||
| 	install-dictDATA install-exec install-exec-am install-info \
 | ||||
| 	install-info-am install-man install-strip installcheck \
 | ||||
| 	installcheck-am installdirs maintainer-clean \
 | ||||
| 	maintainer-clean-generic mostlyclean mostlyclean-generic pdf \
 | ||||
| 	pdf-am ps ps-am uninstall uninstall-am uninstall-dictDATA \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
 | ||||
| # Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
 | ||||
| .NOEXPORT: | ||||
							
								
								
									
										2
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/Makefile.am
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										2
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/Makefile.am
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,2 @@ | |||
| dictdir = $(prefix)/dict | ||||
| dict_DATA = adj.exc adv.exc cntlist cntlist.rev data.adj data.adv data.noun data.verb frames.vrb index.adj index.adv index.noun index.sense index.verb log.grind.3.0 noun.exc sentidx.vrb sents.vrb verb.Framestext verb.exc lexnames | ||||
							
								
								
									
										314
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/Makefile.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										314
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/Makefile.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,314 @@ | |||
| # Makefile.in generated by automake 1.9 from Makefile.am.
 | ||||
| # @configure_input@
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
 | ||||
| # 2003, 2004  Free Software Foundation, Inc.
 | ||||
| # This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
 | ||||
| # gives unlimited permission to copy and/or distribute it,
 | ||||
| # with or without modifications, as long as this notice is preserved.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | ||||
| # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law; without
 | ||||
| # even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A
 | ||||
| # PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| @SET_MAKE@ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| srcdir = @srcdir@ | ||||
| top_srcdir = @top_srcdir@ | ||||
| VPATH = @srcdir@ | ||||
| pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| pkglibdir = $(libdir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| top_builddir = .. | ||||
| am__cd = CDPATH="$${ZSH_VERSION+.}$(PATH_SEPARATOR)" && cd | ||||
| INSTALL = @INSTALL@ | ||||
| install_sh_DATA = $(install_sh) -c -m 644 | ||||
| install_sh_PROGRAM = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| install_sh_SCRIPT = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| INSTALL_HEADER = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| transform = $(program_transform_name) | ||||
| NORMAL_INSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_INSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_INSTALL = : | ||||
| NORMAL_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| subdir = dict | ||||
| DIST_COMMON = $(srcdir)/Makefile.am $(srcdir)/Makefile.in | ||||
| ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4 | ||||
| am__aclocal_m4_deps = $(top_srcdir)/acinclude.m4 \
 | ||||
| 	$(top_srcdir)/configure.ac | ||||
| am__configure_deps = $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES) \
 | ||||
| 	$(ACLOCAL_M4) | ||||
| mkinstalldirs = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| CONFIG_HEADER = $(top_builddir)/config.h | ||||
| CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES = | ||||
| SOURCES = | ||||
| DIST_SOURCES = | ||||
| am__vpath_adj_setup = srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; | ||||
| am__vpath_adj = case $$p in \
 | ||||
|     $(srcdir)/*) f=`echo "$$p" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
|     *) f=$$p;; \
 | ||||
|   esac; | ||||
| am__strip_dir = `echo $$p | sed -e 's|^.*/||'`; | ||||
| am__installdirs = "$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)" | ||||
| dictDATA_INSTALL = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| DATA = $(dict_DATA) | ||||
| DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(DIST_SOURCES) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST) | ||||
| ACLOCAL = @ACLOCAL@ | ||||
| AMDEP_FALSE = @AMDEP_FALSE@ | ||||
| AMDEP_TRUE = @AMDEP_TRUE@ | ||||
| AMTAR = @AMTAR@ | ||||
| AUTOCONF = @AUTOCONF@ | ||||
| AUTOHEADER = @AUTOHEADER@ | ||||
| AUTOMAKE = @AUTOMAKE@ | ||||
| AWK = @AWK@ | ||||
| CC = @CC@ | ||||
| CCDEPMODE = @CCDEPMODE@ | ||||
| CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@ | ||||
| CPP = @CPP@ | ||||
| CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@ | ||||
| CYGPATH_W = @CYGPATH_W@ | ||||
| DEFS = @DEFS@ | ||||
| DEPDIR = @DEPDIR@ | ||||
| ECHO_C = @ECHO_C@ | ||||
| ECHO_N = @ECHO_N@ | ||||
| ECHO_T = @ECHO_T@ | ||||
| EGREP = @EGREP@ | ||||
| EXEEXT = @EXEEXT@ | ||||
| INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@ | ||||
| INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@ | ||||
| INSTALL_SCRIPT = @INSTALL_SCRIPT@ | ||||
| INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM@ | ||||
| LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@ | ||||
| LIBOBJS = @LIBOBJS@ | ||||
| LIBS = @LIBS@ | ||||
| LTLIBOBJS = @LTLIBOBJS@ | ||||
| MAKEINFO = @MAKEINFO@ | ||||
| OBJEXT = @OBJEXT@ | ||||
| PACKAGE = @PACKAGE@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = @PACKAGE_BUGREPORT@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_NAME = @PACKAGE_NAME@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_STRING = @PACKAGE_STRING@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_TARNAME = @PACKAGE_TARNAME@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_VERSION = @PACKAGE_VERSION@ | ||||
| PATH_SEPARATOR = @PATH_SEPARATOR@ | ||||
| RANLIB = @RANLIB@ | ||||
| SET_MAKE = @SET_MAKE@ | ||||
| SHELL = @SHELL@ | ||||
| STRIP = @STRIP@ | ||||
| TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC = @TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC@ | ||||
| TCL_LIB_SPEC = @TCL_LIB_SPEC@ | ||||
| TK_LIBS = @TK_LIBS@ | ||||
| TK_LIB_SPEC = @TK_LIB_SPEC@ | ||||
| TK_PREFIX = @TK_PREFIX@ | ||||
| TK_XINCLUDES = @TK_XINCLUDES@ | ||||
| VERSION = @VERSION@ | ||||
| ac_ct_CC = @ac_ct_CC@ | ||||
| ac_ct_RANLIB = @ac_ct_RANLIB@ | ||||
| ac_ct_STRIP = @ac_ct_STRIP@ | ||||
| ac_prefix = @ac_prefix@ | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_FALSE = @am__fastdepCC_FALSE@ | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_TRUE = @am__fastdepCC_TRUE@ | ||||
| am__include = @am__include@ | ||||
| am__leading_dot = @am__leading_dot@ | ||||
| am__quote = @am__quote@ | ||||
| am__tar = @am__tar@ | ||||
| am__untar = @am__untar@ | ||||
| bindir = @bindir@ | ||||
| build_alias = @build_alias@ | ||||
| datadir = @datadir@ | ||||
| exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@ | ||||
| host_alias = @host_alias@ | ||||
| includedir = @includedir@ | ||||
| infodir = @infodir@ | ||||
| install_sh = @install_sh@ | ||||
| libdir = @libdir@ | ||||
| libexecdir = @libexecdir@ | ||||
| localstatedir = @localstatedir@ | ||||
| mandir = @mandir@ | ||||
| mkdir_p = @mkdir_p@ | ||||
| oldincludedir = @oldincludedir@ | ||||
| prefix = @prefix@ | ||||
| program_transform_name = @program_transform_name@ | ||||
| sbindir = @sbindir@ | ||||
| sharedstatedir = @sharedstatedir@ | ||||
| sysconfdir = @sysconfdir@ | ||||
| target_alias = @target_alias@ | ||||
| dictdir = $(prefix)/dict | ||||
| dict_DATA = adj.exc adv.exc cntlist cntlist.rev data.adj data.adv data.noun data.verb frames.vrb index.adj index.adv index.noun index.sense index.verb log.grind.3.0 noun.exc sentidx.vrb sents.vrb verb.Framestext verb.exc lexnames | ||||
| all: all-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SUFFIXES: | ||||
| $(srcdir)/Makefile.in:  $(srcdir)/Makefile.am  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	@for dep in $?; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case '$(am__configure_deps)' in \
 | ||||
| 	    *$$dep*) \
 | ||||
| 	      cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh \
 | ||||
| 		&& exit 0; \
 | ||||
| 	      exit 1;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	echo ' cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  dict/Makefile'; \
 | ||||
| 	cd $(top_srcdir) && \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  dict/Makefile | ||||
| .PRECIOUS: Makefile | ||||
| Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status | ||||
| 	@case '$?' in \
 | ||||
| 	  *config.status*) \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) \
 | ||||
| 	    echo ' cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe)'; \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe);; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_builddir)/config.status: $(top_srcdir)/configure $(CONFIG_STATUS_DEPENDENCIES) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_srcdir)/configure:  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| $(ACLOCAL_M4):  $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| uninstall-info-am: | ||||
| install-dictDATA: $(dict_DATA) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(dictdir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(dict_DATA)'; for p in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f "$$p"; then d=; else d="$(srcdir)/"; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  f=$(am__strip_dir) \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(dictDATA_INSTALL) '$$d$$p' '$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)/$$f'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(dictDATA_INSTALL) "$$d$$p" "$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)/$$f"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-dictDATA: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(dict_DATA)'; for p in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  f=$(am__strip_dir) \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)/$$f'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)/$$f"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| tags: TAGS | ||||
| TAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ctags: CTAGS | ||||
| CTAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distdir: $(DISTFILES) | ||||
| 	@srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	topsrcdirstrip=`echo "$(top_srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(DISTFILES)'; for file in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case $$file in \
 | ||||
| 	    $(srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(top_srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$topsrcdirstrip/|$(top_builddir)/|"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $$file || test -d $$file; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  dir=`echo "$$file" | sed -e 's,/[^/]*$$,,'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$dir" != "$$file" && test "$$dir" != "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dir="/$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    dir=''; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -d $$d/$$file; then \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -d $(srcdir)/$$file && test $$d != $(srcdir); then \
 | ||||
| 	      cp -pR $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    fi; \
 | ||||
| 	    cp -pR $$d/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || cp -p $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| check-am: all-am | ||||
| check: check-am | ||||
| all-am: Makefile $(DATA) | ||||
| installdirs: | ||||
| 	for dir in "$(DESTDIR)$(dictdir)"; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test -z "$$dir" || $(mkdir_p) "$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install: install-am | ||||
| install-exec: install-exec-am | ||||
| install-data: install-data-am | ||||
| uninstall: uninstall-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-am: all-am | ||||
| 	@$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) install-exec-am install-data-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck: installcheck-am | ||||
| install-strip: | ||||
| 	$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) INSTALL_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" \
 | ||||
| 	  install_sh_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" INSTALL_STRIP_FLAG=-s \
 | ||||
| 	  `test -z '$(STRIP)' || \
 | ||||
| 	    echo "INSTALL_PROGRAM_ENV=STRIPPROG='$(STRIP)'"` install | ||||
| mostlyclean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-generic: | ||||
| 	-test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean-generic: | ||||
| 	@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use" | ||||
| 	@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild." | ||||
| clean: clean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-am: clean-generic mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean: distclean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| distclean-am: clean-am distclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi: dvi-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| html: html-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info: info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-data-am: install-dictDATA | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-exec-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-info: install-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-man: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| maintainer-clean-am: distclean-am maintainer-clean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean: mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf: pdf-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps: ps-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-am: uninstall-dictDATA uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .PHONY: all all-am check check-am clean clean-generic distclean \ | ||||
| 	distclean-generic distdir dvi dvi-am html html-am info info-am \
 | ||||
| 	install install-am install-data install-data-am \
 | ||||
| 	install-dictDATA install-exec install-exec-am install-info \
 | ||||
| 	install-info-am install-man install-strip installcheck \
 | ||||
| 	installcheck-am installdirs maintainer-clean \
 | ||||
| 	maintainer-clean-generic mostlyclean mostlyclean-generic pdf \
 | ||||
| 	pdf-am ps ps-am uninstall uninstall-am uninstall-dictDATA \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
 | ||||
| # Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
 | ||||
| .NOEXPORT: | ||||
							
								
								
									
										1490
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/adj.exc
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										1490
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/adj.exc
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										7
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/adv.exc
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										7
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/adv.exc
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,7 @@ | |||
| best well | ||||
| better well | ||||
| deeper deeply | ||||
| farther far | ||||
| further far | ||||
| harder hard | ||||
| hardest hard | ||||
							
								
								
									
										37387
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/cntlist
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										37387
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/cntlist
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										37387
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/cntlist.rev
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										37387
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/cntlist.rev
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										18185
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/data.adj
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										18185
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/data.adj
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										3650
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/data.adv
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										3650
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/data.adv
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										82144
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/data.noun
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										82144
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/data.noun
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because one or more lines are too long
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										13796
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/data.verb
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										13796
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/data.verb
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because one or more lines are too long
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										35
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/frames.vrb
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										35
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/frames.vrb
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,35 @@ | |||
| 1  Something ----s | ||||
| 2  Somebody ----s | ||||
| 3  It is ----ing | ||||
| 4  Something is ----ing PP | ||||
| 5  Something ----s something Adjective/Noun | ||||
| 6  Something ----s Adjective/Noun | ||||
| 7  Somebody ----s Adjective | ||||
| 8  Somebody ----s something | ||||
| 9  Somebody ----s somebody | ||||
| 10 Something ----s somebody | ||||
| 11 Something ----s something | ||||
| 12 Something ----s to somebody | ||||
| 13 Somebody ----s on something | ||||
| 14 Somebody ----s somebody something | ||||
| 15 Somebody ----s something to somebody | ||||
| 16 Somebody ----s something from somebody | ||||
| 17 Somebody ----s somebody with something | ||||
| 18 Somebody ----s somebody of something | ||||
| 19 Somebody ----s something on somebody | ||||
| 20 Somebody ----s somebody PP | ||||
| 21 Somebody ----s something PP | ||||
| 22 Somebody ----s PP | ||||
| 23 Somebody's (body part) ----s | ||||
| 24 Somebody ----s somebody to INFINITIVE | ||||
| 25 Somebody ----s somebody INFINITIVE | ||||
| 26 Somebody ----s that CLAUSE | ||||
| 27 Somebody ----s to somebody | ||||
| 28 Somebody ----s to INFINITIVE | ||||
| 29 Somebody ----s whether INFINITIVE | ||||
| 30 Somebody ----s somebody into V-ing something | ||||
| 31 Somebody ----s something with something | ||||
| 32 Somebody ----s INFINITIVE | ||||
| 33 Somebody ----s VERB-ing | ||||
| 34 It ----s that CLAUSE | ||||
| 35 Something ----s INFINITIVE | ||||
							
								
								
									
										21508
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/index.adj
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										21508
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/index.adj
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										4510
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/index.adv
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										4510
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/index.adv
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										117827
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/index.noun
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										117827
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/index.noun
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										206941
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/index.sense
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										206941
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/index.sense
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										11558
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/index.verb
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										11558
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/index.verb
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										45
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/lexnames
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										45
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/lexnames
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,45 @@ | |||
| 00	adj.all	3 | ||||
| 01	adj.pert	3  | ||||
| 02	adv.all	4 | ||||
| 03	noun.Tops	1   | ||||
| 04	noun.act	1 | ||||
| 05	noun.animal	1 | ||||
| 06	noun.artifact	1 | ||||
| 07	noun.attribute	1 | ||||
| 08	noun.body	1 | ||||
| 09	noun.cognition	1 | ||||
| 10	noun.communication	1 | ||||
| 11	noun.event	1 | ||||
| 12	noun.feeling	1 | ||||
| 13	noun.food	1 | ||||
| 14	noun.group	1 | ||||
| 15	noun.location	1 | ||||
| 16	noun.motive	1 | ||||
| 17	noun.object	1 | ||||
| 18	noun.person	1 | ||||
| 19	noun.phenomenon	1 | ||||
| 20	noun.plant	1 | ||||
| 21	noun.possession	1 | ||||
| 22	noun.process	1 | ||||
| 23	noun.quantity	1 | ||||
| 24	noun.relation	1 | ||||
| 25	noun.shape	1 | ||||
| 26	noun.state	1 | ||||
| 27	noun.substance	1 | ||||
| 28	noun.time	1 | ||||
| 29	verb.body	2 | ||||
| 30	verb.change	2 | ||||
| 31	verb.cognition	2 | ||||
| 32	verb.communication	2 | ||||
| 33	verb.competition	2 | ||||
| 34	verb.consumption	2 | ||||
| 35	verb.contact	2 | ||||
| 36	verb.creation	2 | ||||
| 37	verb.emotion	2 | ||||
| 38	verb.motion	2 | ||||
| 39	verb.perception	2 | ||||
| 40	verb.possession	2 | ||||
| 41	verb.social	2 | ||||
| 42	verb.stative	2 | ||||
| 43	verb.weather	2 | ||||
| 44	adj.ppl	3 | ||||
							
								
								
									
										89
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/log.grind.3.0
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										89
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/log.grind.3.0
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,89 @@ | |||
| Processing adj.all... | ||||
| Processing adj.pert... | ||||
| Processing adv.all... | ||||
| Processing noun.Tops... | ||||
| noun.Tops, line 7: warning: No hypernyms in synset | ||||
| Processing noun.act... | ||||
| Processing noun.animal... | ||||
| Processing noun.artifact... | ||||
| Processing noun.attribute... | ||||
| Processing noun.body... | ||||
| Processing noun.cognition... | ||||
| Processing noun.communication... | ||||
| Processing noun.event... | ||||
| Processing noun.feeling... | ||||
| Processing noun.food... | ||||
| Processing noun.group... | ||||
| Processing noun.location... | ||||
| Processing noun.motive... | ||||
| Processing noun.object... | ||||
| Processing noun.person... | ||||
| Processing noun.phenomenon... | ||||
| Processing noun.plant... | ||||
| Processing noun.possession... | ||||
| Processing noun.process... | ||||
| Processing noun.quantity... | ||||
| Processing noun.relation... | ||||
| Processing noun.shape... | ||||
| Processing noun.state... | ||||
| Processing noun.substance... | ||||
| Processing noun.time... | ||||
| Processing verb.body... | ||||
| Processing verb.change... | ||||
| Processing verb.cognition... | ||||
| Processing verb.communication... | ||||
| Processing verb.competition... | ||||
| Processing verb.consumption... | ||||
| Processing verb.contact... | ||||
| Processing verb.creation... | ||||
| Processing verb.emotion... | ||||
| Processing verb.motion... | ||||
| Processing verb.perception... | ||||
| Processing verb.possession... | ||||
| Processing verb.social... | ||||
| Processing verb.stative... | ||||
| Processing verb.weather... | ||||
| Processing adj.ppl... | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| *** Statistics for ground files: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 82115 noun synsets | ||||
| 13767 verb synsets | ||||
| 3812 adj synsets | ||||
| 3621 adv synsets | ||||
| 3651 pertainym synsets | ||||
| 10693 adjective satellite synsets | ||||
| 117659 synsets in total (including satellite and pertainym synsets) | ||||
| 82115 noun synsets have definitional glosses | ||||
| 13767 verb synsets have definitional glosses | ||||
| 3812 adj synsets have definitional glosses | ||||
| 3621 adv synsets have definitional glosses | ||||
| 3651 pertainym synsets have definitional glosses | ||||
| 10693 adjective satellite synsets have definitional glosses | ||||
| 117659 definitional glosses in total (including adjective satellite synsets) | ||||
| 225000 pointers in total | ||||
| 206978 synonyms in synsets | ||||
| 147306 unique word phrases | ||||
| 83118 word phrases of length 1 | ||||
| 54533 word phrases of length 2 | ||||
| 7766 word phrases of length 3 | ||||
| 1454 word phrases of length 4 | ||||
| 298 word phrases of length 5 | ||||
| 80 word phrases of length 6 | ||||
| 28 word phrases of length 7 | ||||
| 20 word phrases of length 8 | ||||
| 9 word phrases of length 9 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Resolving pointers... | ||||
| Done resolving pointers... | ||||
| Getting sense counts... | ||||
| Done with sense counts... | ||||
| Figuring out byte offsets... | ||||
| Dumping data files... | ||||
| Done dumping data files... | ||||
| Cannot open file: cntlist | ||||
| Cannot order senses | ||||
| Dumping index files... | ||||
| Done dumping index files... | ||||
| Dumping sense index... | ||||
| Done dumping sense index... | ||||
							
								
								
									
										2054
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/noun.exc
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										2054
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/noun.exc
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										3421
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/sentidx.vrb
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										3421
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/sentidx.vrb
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										170
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/sents.vrb
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										170
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/sents.vrb
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,170 @@ | |||
| 1 The children %s to the playground | ||||
| 10 The cars %s down the avenue | ||||
| 100 These glasses %s easily | ||||
| 101 These fabrics %s easily | ||||
| 102 They %s their earnings this year | ||||
| 103 Their earnings %s this year | ||||
| 104 The water %ss  | ||||
| 105 They %s the water  | ||||
| 106 The animals %s | ||||
| 107 They %s a long time | ||||
| 108 The car %ss the tree  | ||||
| 109 John will %s angry | ||||
| 11 They %s the car down the avenue | ||||
| 110 They %s in the city | ||||
| 111 They won't %s the story  | ||||
| 112 They %s that there was a traffic accident  | ||||
| 113 They %s whether there was a traffic accident | ||||
| 114 They %s her vice president | ||||
| 115 Did he %s his major works over a short period of time? | ||||
| 116 The chefs %s the vegetables | ||||
| 117 They %s the cape  | ||||
| 118 The food does %s good  | ||||
| 119 The music does %s good  | ||||
| 12 They %s the glass tubes | ||||
| 120 The cool air does %s good | ||||
| 121 This food does %s well  | ||||
| 122 It was %sing all day long  | ||||
| 123 They %s him to write the letter | ||||
| 124 They %s him into writing the letter | ||||
| 125 They %s him from writing the letter | ||||
| 126 The bad news will %s him | ||||
| 127 The good news will %s her | ||||
| 128 The chef wants to %s the eggs  | ||||
| 129 Sam wants to %s with Sue  | ||||
| 13 The glass tubes %s | ||||
| 130 The fighter managed to %s his opponent | ||||
| 131 These cars won't %s  | ||||
| 132 The branches %s from the trees | ||||
| 133 The stock market is going to %s  | ||||
| 134 The moon will soon %s  | ||||
| 135 The business is going to %s  | ||||
| 136 The airplane is sure to %s  | ||||
| 137 They %s to move  | ||||
| 138 They %s moving  | ||||
| 139 Sam and Sue %s the movie  | ||||
| 14 Sam and Sue %s | ||||
| 140 They want to %s the prisoners  | ||||
| 141 They want to %s the doors | ||||
| 142 The doors %s  | ||||
| 143 Did he %s his foot?  | ||||
| 144 Did his feet %s? | ||||
| 145 They will %s the duet | ||||
| 146 They %s their hair  | ||||
| 147 They %s the trees | ||||
| 148 They %s him of all his money | ||||
| 149 Lights %s on the horizon | ||||
| 15 Sam cannot %s Sue  | ||||
| 150 The horizon is %sing with lights | ||||
| 151 The crowds %s in the streets | ||||
| 152 The streets %s with crowds | ||||
| 153 Cars %s in the streets  | ||||
| 154 The streets %s with cars  | ||||
| 155 You can hear animals %s in the meadows | ||||
| 156 The meadows %s with animals  | ||||
| 157 The birds %s in the woods  | ||||
| 158 The woods %s with many kinds of birds  | ||||
| 159 The performance is likely to %s Sue | ||||
| 16 The ropes %s | ||||
| 160 Sam and Sue %s over the results of the experiment | ||||
| 161 In the summer they like to go out and %s | ||||
| 162 The children %s in the rocking chair | ||||
| 163 There %s some children in the rocking chair | ||||
| 164 Some big birds %s in the tree | ||||
| 165 There %s some big birds in the tree | ||||
| 166 The men %s the area for animals  | ||||
| 167 The men %s for animals in the area | ||||
| 168 The customs agents %s the bags for drugs  | ||||
| 169 They %s him as chairman  | ||||
| 17 The strong winds %s the rope | ||||
| 170 They %s him "Bobby" | ||||
| 18 They %s the sheets | ||||
| 19 The sheets didn't %s | ||||
| 2 The banks %s the check | ||||
| 20 The horses %s across the field | ||||
| 21 They %s the bags on the table | ||||
| 22 The men %s the horses across the field | ||||
| 23 Our properties %s at this point | ||||
| 24 His fields %s mine at this point | ||||
| 25 They %s the hill | ||||
| 26 They %s up the hill | ||||
| 27 They %s the river | ||||
| 28 They %s down the river  | ||||
| 29 They %s the countryside | ||||
| 3 The checks %s  | ||||
| 30 They %s in the countryside | ||||
| 31 These men %s across the river | ||||
| 32 These men %s the river | ||||
| 33 They %s the food to the people | ||||
| 34 They %s the people the food | ||||
| 35 They %s more bread | ||||
| 36 They %s the object in the water | ||||
| 37 The men %s the bookshelves | ||||
| 38 They %s the money in the closet | ||||
| 39 The lights %s from the ceiling | ||||
| 4 The children %s the ball | ||||
| 40 They %s the lights from the ceiling | ||||
| 41 They %s their rifles on the cabinet | ||||
| 42 The chairs %s in the corner | ||||
| 43 The men %s the chairs | ||||
| 44 The women %s water into the bowl | ||||
| 45 Water and oil %s into the bowl | ||||
| 46 They %s the wire around the stick | ||||
| 47 The wires %s around the stick | ||||
| 48 They %s the bread with melted butter | ||||
| 49 They %s the cart with boxes  | ||||
| 5 The balls %s  | ||||
| 50 They %s the books into the box | ||||
| 51 They %s sugar over the cake | ||||
| 52 They %s the cake with sugar | ||||
| 53 They %s the fruit with a chemical | ||||
| 54 They %s a chemical into the fruit | ||||
| 55 They %s the field with rye | ||||
| 56 They %s rye in the field | ||||
| 57 They %s notices on the doors | ||||
| 58 They %s the doors with notices | ||||
| 59 They %s money on their grandchild | ||||
| 6 The girls %s the wooden sticks | ||||
| 60 They %s their grandchild with money | ||||
| 61 They %s coins on the image  | ||||
| 62 They %s the image with coins  | ||||
| 63 They %s butter on the bread | ||||
| 64 They %s the lake with fish | ||||
| 65 The children %s the paper with grease  | ||||
| 66 The children %s grease onto the paper | ||||
| 67 They %s papers over the floor | ||||
| 68 They %s the floor with papers | ||||
| 69 They %s the money  | ||||
| 7 The wooden sticks %s  | ||||
| 70 They %s the newspapers | ||||
| 71 They %s the goods | ||||
| 72 The men %s the boat  | ||||
| 73 They %s the animals | ||||
| 74 The books %s the box  | ||||
| 75 They %s the halls with holly | ||||
| 76 Holly flowers %s the halls | ||||
| 77 The wind storms %s the area with dust and dirt | ||||
| 78 Dust and dirt %s the area | ||||
| 79 The swollen rivers %s the area with water | ||||
| 8 The coins %s  | ||||
| 80 The waters %s the area | ||||
| 81 They %s the cloth with water and alcohol | ||||
| 82 Water and alcohol %s the cloth | ||||
| 83 They %s the snow from the path | ||||
| 84 They %s the path of the snow | ||||
| 85 They %s the water from the sink | ||||
| 86 They %s the sink of water | ||||
| 87 They %s the parcel to their parents | ||||
| 88 They %s them the parcel | ||||
| 89 They %s cars to the tourists | ||||
| 9 They %s the coin  | ||||
| 90 They %s the tourists their cars | ||||
| 91 They %s the money to them  | ||||
| 92 They %s them the money | ||||
| 93 They %s them the information | ||||
| 94 They %s the information to them | ||||
| 95 The parents %s a French poem to the children | ||||
| 96 The parents %s the children a French poem  | ||||
| 97 They %s  | ||||
| 98 They %s themselves | ||||
| 99 These balls %s easily | ||||
							
								
								
									
										35
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/verb.Framestext
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										35
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/verb.Framestext
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,35 @@ | |||
| 1  Something ----s | ||||
| 2  Somebody ----s | ||||
| 3  It is ----ing | ||||
| 4  Something is ----ing PP | ||||
| 5  Something ----s something Adjective/Noun | ||||
| 6  Something ----s Adjective/Noun | ||||
| 7  Somebody ----s Adjective | ||||
| 8  Somebody ----s something | ||||
| 9  Somebody ----s somebody | ||||
| 10 Something ----s somebody | ||||
| 11 Something ----s something | ||||
| 12 Something ----s to somebody | ||||
| 13 Somebody ----s on something | ||||
| 14 Somebody ----s somebody something | ||||
| 15 Somebody ----s something to somebody | ||||
| 16 Somebody ----s something from somebody | ||||
| 17 Somebody ----s somebody with something | ||||
| 18 Somebody ----s somebody of something | ||||
| 19 Somebody ----s something on somebody | ||||
| 20 Somebody ----s somebody PP | ||||
| 21 Somebody ----s something PP | ||||
| 22 Somebody ----s PP | ||||
| 23 Somebody's (body part) ----s | ||||
| 24 Somebody ----s somebody to INFINITIVE | ||||
| 25 Somebody ----s somebody INFINITIVE | ||||
| 26 Somebody ----s that CLAUSE | ||||
| 27 Somebody ----s to somebody | ||||
| 28 Somebody ----s to INFINITIVE | ||||
| 29 Somebody ----s whether INFINITIVE | ||||
| 30 Somebody ----s somebody into V-ing something | ||||
| 31 Somebody ----s something with something | ||||
| 32 Somebody ----s INFINITIVE | ||||
| 33 Somebody ----s VERB-ing | ||||
| 34 It ----s that CLAUSE | ||||
| 35 Something ----s INFINITIVE | ||||
							
								
								
									
										2401
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/verb.exc
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										2401
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/dict/verb.exc
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
										
											
												File diff suppressed because it is too large
												Load Diff
											
										
									
								
							
							
								
								
									
										426
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/Makefile
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										426
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/Makefile
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,426 @@ | |||
| # Makefile.in generated by automake 1.9 from Makefile.am.
 | ||||
| # doc/Makefile.  Generated from Makefile.in by configure.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
 | ||||
| # 2003, 2004  Free Software Foundation, Inc.
 | ||||
| # This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
 | ||||
| # gives unlimited permission to copy and/or distribute it,
 | ||||
| # with or without modifications, as long as this notice is preserved.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | ||||
| # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law; without
 | ||||
| # even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A
 | ||||
| # PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| srcdir = . | ||||
| top_srcdir = .. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/WordNet | ||||
| pkglibdir = $(libdir)/WordNet | ||||
| pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/WordNet | ||||
| top_builddir = .. | ||||
| am__cd = CDPATH="$${ZSH_VERSION+.}$(PATH_SEPARATOR)" && cd | ||||
| INSTALL = /usr/csl/bin/install -c | ||||
| install_sh_DATA = $(install_sh) -c -m 644 | ||||
| install_sh_PROGRAM = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| install_sh_SCRIPT = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| INSTALL_HEADER = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| transform = $(program_transform_name) | ||||
| NORMAL_INSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_INSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_INSTALL = : | ||||
| NORMAL_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| subdir = doc | ||||
| DIST_COMMON = $(srcdir)/Makefile.am $(srcdir)/Makefile.in | ||||
| ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4 | ||||
| am__aclocal_m4_deps = $(top_srcdir)/acinclude.m4 \
 | ||||
| 	$(top_srcdir)/configure.ac | ||||
| am__configure_deps = $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES) \
 | ||||
| 	$(ACLOCAL_M4) | ||||
| mkinstalldirs = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| CONFIG_HEADER = $(top_builddir)/config.h | ||||
| CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES = | ||||
| SOURCES = | ||||
| DIST_SOURCES = | ||||
| RECURSIVE_TARGETS = all-recursive check-recursive dvi-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	html-recursive info-recursive install-data-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	install-exec-recursive install-info-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	install-recursive installcheck-recursive installdirs-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	pdf-recursive ps-recursive uninstall-info-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-recursive | ||||
| ETAGS = etags | ||||
| CTAGS = ctags | ||||
| DIST_SUBDIRS = $(SUBDIRS) | ||||
| DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(DIST_SOURCES) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST) | ||||
| ACLOCAL = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run aclocal-1.9 | ||||
| AMDEP_FALSE = # | ||||
| AMDEP_TRUE =  | ||||
| AMTAR = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run tar | ||||
| AUTOCONF = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run autoconf | ||||
| AUTOHEADER = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run autoheader | ||||
| AUTOMAKE = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run automake-1.9 | ||||
| AWK = nawk | ||||
| CC = gcc | ||||
| CCDEPMODE = depmode=gcc3 | ||||
| CFLAGS = -g -O2 | ||||
| CPP = gcc -E | ||||
| CPPFLAGS =  | ||||
| CYGPATH_W = echo | ||||
| DEFS = -DHAVE_CONFIG_H | ||||
| DEPDIR = .deps | ||||
| ECHO_C =  | ||||
| ECHO_N = -n | ||||
| ECHO_T =  | ||||
| EGREP = egrep | ||||
| EXEEXT =  | ||||
| INSTALL_DATA = ${INSTALL} -m 644 | ||||
| INSTALL_PROGRAM = ${INSTALL} | ||||
| INSTALL_SCRIPT = ${INSTALL} | ||||
| INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM = ${SHELL} $(install_sh) -c -s | ||||
| LDFLAGS =  | ||||
| LIBOBJS =  | ||||
| LIBS =  | ||||
| LTLIBOBJS =  | ||||
| MAKEINFO = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run makeinfo | ||||
| OBJEXT = o | ||||
| PACKAGE = WordNet | ||||
| PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = wordnet@princeton.edu | ||||
| PACKAGE_NAME = WordNet | ||||
| PACKAGE_STRING = WordNet 3.0 | ||||
| PACKAGE_TARNAME = wordnet | ||||
| PACKAGE_VERSION = 3.0 | ||||
| PATH_SEPARATOR = : | ||||
| RANLIB = ranlib | ||||
| SET_MAKE =  | ||||
| SHELL = /bin/bash | ||||
| STRIP =  | ||||
| TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC = -I/usr/csl/include | ||||
| TCL_LIB_SPEC = -L/usr/csl/lib -ltcl8.4 | ||||
| TK_LIBS = -L/usr/openwin/lib -lX11 -ldl  -lpthread -lsocket -lnsl -lm | ||||
| TK_LIB_SPEC = -L/usr/csl/lib -ltk8.4 | ||||
| TK_PREFIX = /usr/csl | ||||
| TK_XINCLUDES = -I/usr/openwin/include | ||||
| VERSION = 3.0 | ||||
| ac_ct_CC = gcc | ||||
| ac_ct_RANLIB = ranlib | ||||
| ac_ct_STRIP =  | ||||
| ac_prefix = /usr/local/WordNet-3.0 | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_FALSE = # | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_TRUE =  | ||||
| am__include = include | ||||
| am__leading_dot = . | ||||
| am__quote =  | ||||
| am__tar = ${AMTAR} chof - "$$tardir" | ||||
| am__untar = ${AMTAR} xf - | ||||
| bindir = ${exec_prefix}/bin | ||||
| build_alias =  | ||||
| datadir = ${prefix}/share | ||||
| exec_prefix = ${prefix} | ||||
| host_alias =  | ||||
| includedir = ${prefix}/include | ||||
| infodir = ${prefix}/info | ||||
| install_sh = /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/install-sh | ||||
| libdir = ${exec_prefix}/lib | ||||
| libexecdir = ${exec_prefix}/libexec | ||||
| localstatedir = ${prefix}/var | ||||
| mandir = ${prefix}/man | ||||
| mkdir_p = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| oldincludedir = /usr/include | ||||
| prefix = /usr/local/WordNet-3.0 | ||||
| program_transform_name = s,x,x, | ||||
| sbindir = ${exec_prefix}/sbin | ||||
| sharedstatedir = ${prefix}/com | ||||
| sysconfdir = ${prefix}/etc | ||||
| target_alias =  | ||||
| SUBDIRS = html man pdf ps | ||||
| all: all-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SUFFIXES: | ||||
| $(srcdir)/Makefile.in:  $(srcdir)/Makefile.am  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	@for dep in $?; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case '$(am__configure_deps)' in \
 | ||||
| 	    *$$dep*) \
 | ||||
| 	      cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh \
 | ||||
| 		&& exit 0; \
 | ||||
| 	      exit 1;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	echo ' cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/Makefile'; \
 | ||||
| 	cd $(top_srcdir) && \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/Makefile | ||||
| .PRECIOUS: Makefile | ||||
| Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status | ||||
| 	@case '$?' in \
 | ||||
| 	  *config.status*) \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) \
 | ||||
| 	    echo ' cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe)'; \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe);; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_builddir)/config.status: $(top_srcdir)/configure $(CONFIG_STATUS_DEPENDENCIES) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_srcdir)/configure:  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| $(ACLOCAL_M4):  $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| uninstall-info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This directory's subdirectories are mostly independent; you can cd
 | ||||
| # into them and run `make' without going through this Makefile.
 | ||||
| # To change the values of `make' variables: instead of editing Makefiles,
 | ||||
| # (1) if the variable is set in `config.status', edit `config.status'
 | ||||
| #     (which will cause the Makefiles to be regenerated when you run `make');
 | ||||
| # (2) otherwise, pass the desired values on the `make' command line.
 | ||||
| $(RECURSIVE_TARGETS): | ||||
| 	@set fnord $$MAKEFLAGS; amf=$$2; \
 | ||||
| 	dot_seen=no; \
 | ||||
| 	target=`echo $@ | sed s/-recursive//`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  echo "Making $$target in $$subdir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dot_seen=yes; \
 | ||||
| 	    local_target="$$target-am"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    local_target="$$target"; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  (cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) $$local_target) \
 | ||||
| 	   || case "$$amf" in *=*) exit 1;; *k*) fail=yes;; *) exit 1;; esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	if test "$$dot_seen" = "no"; then \
 | ||||
| 	  $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) "$$target-am" || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	fi; test -z "$$fail" | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-recursive clean-recursive distclean-recursive \ | ||||
| maintainer-clean-recursive: | ||||
| 	@set fnord $$MAKEFLAGS; amf=$$2; \
 | ||||
| 	dot_seen=no; \
 | ||||
| 	case "$@" in \
 | ||||
| 	  distclean-* | maintainer-clean-*) list='$(DIST_SUBDIRS)' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) list='$(SUBDIRS)' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; \
 | ||||
| 	rev=''; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = "."; then :; else \
 | ||||
| 	    rev="$$subdir $$rev"; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	rev="$$rev ."; \
 | ||||
| 	target=`echo $@ | sed s/-recursive//`; \
 | ||||
| 	for subdir in $$rev; do \
 | ||||
| 	  echo "Making $$target in $$subdir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    local_target="$$target-am"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    local_target="$$target"; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  (cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) $$local_target) \
 | ||||
| 	   || case "$$amf" in *=*) exit 1;; *k*) fail=yes;; *) exit 1;; esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done && test -z "$$fail" | ||||
| tags-recursive: | ||||
| 	list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test "$$subdir" = . || (cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) tags); \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| ctags-recursive: | ||||
| 	list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test "$$subdir" = . || (cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) ctags); \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ID: $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES) $(LISP) $(TAGS_FILES) | ||||
| 	list='$(SOURCES) $(HEADERS) $(LISP) $(TAGS_FILES)'; \
 | ||||
| 	unique=`for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -f "$$i"; then echo $$i; else echo $(srcdir)/$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  done | \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AWK) '    { files[$$0] = 1; } \
 | ||||
| 	       END { for (i in files) print i; }'`; \
 | ||||
| 	mkid -fID $$unique | ||||
| tags: TAGS | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| TAGS: tags-recursive $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)  $(TAGS_DEPENDENCIES) \ | ||||
| 		$(TAGS_FILES) $(LISP) | ||||
| 	tags=; \
 | ||||
| 	here=`pwd`; \
 | ||||
| 	if ($(ETAGS) --etags-include --version) >/dev/null 2>&1; then \
 | ||||
| 	  include_option=--etags-include; \
 | ||||
| 	  empty_fix=.; \
 | ||||
| 	else \
 | ||||
| 	  include_option=--include; \
 | ||||
| 	  empty_fix=; \
 | ||||
| 	fi; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = .; then :; else \
 | ||||
| 	    test ! -f $$subdir/TAGS || \
 | ||||
| 	      tags="$$tags $$include_option=$$here/$$subdir/TAGS"; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(SOURCES) $(HEADERS)  $(LISP) $(TAGS_FILES)'; \
 | ||||
| 	unique=`for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -f "$$i"; then echo $$i; else echo $(srcdir)/$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  done | \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AWK) '    { files[$$0] = 1; } \
 | ||||
| 	       END { for (i in files) print i; }'`; \
 | ||||
| 	if test -z "$(ETAGS_ARGS)$$tags$$unique"; then :; else \
 | ||||
| 	  test -n "$$unique" || unique=$$empty_fix; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(ETAGS) $(ETAGSFLAGS) $(AM_ETAGSFLAGS) $(ETAGS_ARGS) \
 | ||||
| 	    $$tags $$unique; \
 | ||||
| 	fi | ||||
| ctags: CTAGS | ||||
| CTAGS: ctags-recursive $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)  $(TAGS_DEPENDENCIES) \ | ||||
| 		$(TAGS_FILES) $(LISP) | ||||
| 	tags=; \
 | ||||
| 	here=`pwd`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(SOURCES) $(HEADERS)  $(LISP) $(TAGS_FILES)'; \
 | ||||
| 	unique=`for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -f "$$i"; then echo $$i; else echo $(srcdir)/$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  done | \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AWK) '    { files[$$0] = 1; } \
 | ||||
| 	       END { for (i in files) print i; }'`; \
 | ||||
| 	test -z "$(CTAGS_ARGS)$$tags$$unique" \
 | ||||
| 	  || $(CTAGS) $(CTAGSFLAGS) $(AM_CTAGSFLAGS) $(CTAGS_ARGS) \
 | ||||
| 	     $$tags $$unique | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| GTAGS: | ||||
| 	here=`$(am__cd) $(top_builddir) && pwd` \
 | ||||
| 	  && cd $(top_srcdir) \
 | ||||
| 	  && gtags -i $(GTAGS_ARGS) $$here | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-tags: | ||||
| 	-rm -f TAGS ID GTAGS GRTAGS GSYMS GPATH tags | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distdir: $(DISTFILES) | ||||
| 	@srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	topsrcdirstrip=`echo "$(top_srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(DISTFILES)'; for file in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case $$file in \
 | ||||
| 	    $(srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(top_srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$topsrcdirstrip/|$(top_builddir)/|"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $$file || test -d $$file; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  dir=`echo "$$file" | sed -e 's,/[^/]*$$,,'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$dir" != "$$file" && test "$$dir" != "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dir="/$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    dir=''; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -d $$d/$$file; then \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -d $(srcdir)/$$file && test $$d != $(srcdir); then \
 | ||||
| 	      cp -pR $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    fi; \
 | ||||
| 	    cp -pR $$d/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || cp -p $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| 	list='$(DIST_SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = .; then :; else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -d "$(distdir)/$$subdir" \
 | ||||
| 	    || $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)/$$subdir" \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    distdir=`$(am__cd) $(distdir) && pwd`; \
 | ||||
| 	    top_distdir=`$(am__cd) $(top_distdir) && pwd`; \
 | ||||
| 	    (cd $$subdir && \
 | ||||
| 	      $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) \
 | ||||
| 	        top_distdir="$$top_distdir" \
 | ||||
| 	        distdir="$$distdir/$$subdir" \
 | ||||
| 	        distdir) \
 | ||||
| 	      || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| check-am: all-am | ||||
| check: check-recursive | ||||
| all-am: Makefile | ||||
| installdirs: installdirs-recursive | ||||
| installdirs-am: | ||||
| install: install-recursive | ||||
| install-exec: install-exec-recursive | ||||
| install-data: install-data-recursive | ||||
| uninstall: uninstall-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-am: all-am | ||||
| 	@$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) install-exec-am install-data-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck: installcheck-recursive | ||||
| install-strip: | ||||
| 	$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) INSTALL_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" \
 | ||||
| 	  install_sh_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" INSTALL_STRIP_FLAG=-s \
 | ||||
| 	  `test -z '$(STRIP)' || \
 | ||||
| 	    echo "INSTALL_PROGRAM_ENV=STRIPPROG='$(STRIP)'"` install | ||||
| mostlyclean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-generic: | ||||
| 	-test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean-generic: | ||||
| 	@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use" | ||||
| 	@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild." | ||||
| clean: clean-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-am: clean-generic mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean: distclean-recursive | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| distclean-am: clean-am distclean-generic distclean-tags | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi: dvi-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| html: html-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info: info-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-data-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-exec-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-info: install-info-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-man: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-recursive | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| maintainer-clean-am: distclean-am maintainer-clean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean: mostlyclean-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf: pdf-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps: ps-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-am: uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-info: uninstall-info-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .PHONY: $(RECURSIVE_TARGETS) CTAGS GTAGS all all-am check check-am \ | ||||
| 	clean clean-generic clean-recursive ctags ctags-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	distclean distclean-generic distclean-recursive distclean-tags \
 | ||||
| 	distdir dvi dvi-am html html-am info info-am install \
 | ||||
| 	install-am install-data install-data-am install-exec \
 | ||||
| 	install-exec-am install-info install-info-am install-man \
 | ||||
| 	install-strip installcheck installcheck-am installdirs \
 | ||||
| 	installdirs-am maintainer-clean maintainer-clean-generic \
 | ||||
| 	maintainer-clean-recursive mostlyclean mostlyclean-generic \
 | ||||
| 	mostlyclean-recursive pdf pdf-am ps ps-am tags tags-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall uninstall-am uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
 | ||||
| # Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
 | ||||
| .NOEXPORT: | ||||
							
								
								
									
										1
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/Makefile.am
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										1
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/Makefile.am
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1 @@ | |||
| SUBDIRS = html man pdf ps | ||||
							
								
								
									
										426
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/Makefile.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										426
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/Makefile.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,426 @@ | |||
| # Makefile.in generated by automake 1.9 from Makefile.am.
 | ||||
| # @configure_input@
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
 | ||||
| # 2003, 2004  Free Software Foundation, Inc.
 | ||||
| # This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
 | ||||
| # gives unlimited permission to copy and/or distribute it,
 | ||||
| # with or without modifications, as long as this notice is preserved.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | ||||
| # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law; without
 | ||||
| # even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A
 | ||||
| # PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| @SET_MAKE@ | ||||
| srcdir = @srcdir@ | ||||
| top_srcdir = @top_srcdir@ | ||||
| VPATH = @srcdir@ | ||||
| pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| pkglibdir = $(libdir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| top_builddir = .. | ||||
| am__cd = CDPATH="$${ZSH_VERSION+.}$(PATH_SEPARATOR)" && cd | ||||
| INSTALL = @INSTALL@ | ||||
| install_sh_DATA = $(install_sh) -c -m 644 | ||||
| install_sh_PROGRAM = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| install_sh_SCRIPT = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| INSTALL_HEADER = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| transform = $(program_transform_name) | ||||
| NORMAL_INSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_INSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_INSTALL = : | ||||
| NORMAL_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| subdir = doc | ||||
| DIST_COMMON = $(srcdir)/Makefile.am $(srcdir)/Makefile.in | ||||
| ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4 | ||||
| am__aclocal_m4_deps = $(top_srcdir)/acinclude.m4 \
 | ||||
| 	$(top_srcdir)/configure.ac | ||||
| am__configure_deps = $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES) \
 | ||||
| 	$(ACLOCAL_M4) | ||||
| mkinstalldirs = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| CONFIG_HEADER = $(top_builddir)/config.h | ||||
| CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES = | ||||
| SOURCES = | ||||
| DIST_SOURCES = | ||||
| RECURSIVE_TARGETS = all-recursive check-recursive dvi-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	html-recursive info-recursive install-data-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	install-exec-recursive install-info-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	install-recursive installcheck-recursive installdirs-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	pdf-recursive ps-recursive uninstall-info-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-recursive | ||||
| ETAGS = etags | ||||
| CTAGS = ctags | ||||
| DIST_SUBDIRS = $(SUBDIRS) | ||||
| DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(DIST_SOURCES) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST) | ||||
| ACLOCAL = @ACLOCAL@ | ||||
| AMDEP_FALSE = @AMDEP_FALSE@ | ||||
| AMDEP_TRUE = @AMDEP_TRUE@ | ||||
| AMTAR = @AMTAR@ | ||||
| AUTOCONF = @AUTOCONF@ | ||||
| AUTOHEADER = @AUTOHEADER@ | ||||
| AUTOMAKE = @AUTOMAKE@ | ||||
| AWK = @AWK@ | ||||
| CC = @CC@ | ||||
| CCDEPMODE = @CCDEPMODE@ | ||||
| CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@ | ||||
| CPP = @CPP@ | ||||
| CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@ | ||||
| CYGPATH_W = @CYGPATH_W@ | ||||
| DEFS = @DEFS@ | ||||
| DEPDIR = @DEPDIR@ | ||||
| ECHO_C = @ECHO_C@ | ||||
| ECHO_N = @ECHO_N@ | ||||
| ECHO_T = @ECHO_T@ | ||||
| EGREP = @EGREP@ | ||||
| EXEEXT = @EXEEXT@ | ||||
| INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@ | ||||
| INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@ | ||||
| INSTALL_SCRIPT = @INSTALL_SCRIPT@ | ||||
| INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM@ | ||||
| LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@ | ||||
| LIBOBJS = @LIBOBJS@ | ||||
| LIBS = @LIBS@ | ||||
| LTLIBOBJS = @LTLIBOBJS@ | ||||
| MAKEINFO = @MAKEINFO@ | ||||
| OBJEXT = @OBJEXT@ | ||||
| PACKAGE = @PACKAGE@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = @PACKAGE_BUGREPORT@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_NAME = @PACKAGE_NAME@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_STRING = @PACKAGE_STRING@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_TARNAME = @PACKAGE_TARNAME@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_VERSION = @PACKAGE_VERSION@ | ||||
| PATH_SEPARATOR = @PATH_SEPARATOR@ | ||||
| RANLIB = @RANLIB@ | ||||
| SET_MAKE = @SET_MAKE@ | ||||
| SHELL = @SHELL@ | ||||
| STRIP = @STRIP@ | ||||
| TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC = @TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC@ | ||||
| TCL_LIB_SPEC = @TCL_LIB_SPEC@ | ||||
| TK_LIBS = @TK_LIBS@ | ||||
| TK_LIB_SPEC = @TK_LIB_SPEC@ | ||||
| TK_PREFIX = @TK_PREFIX@ | ||||
| TK_XINCLUDES = @TK_XINCLUDES@ | ||||
| VERSION = @VERSION@ | ||||
| ac_ct_CC = @ac_ct_CC@ | ||||
| ac_ct_RANLIB = @ac_ct_RANLIB@ | ||||
| ac_ct_STRIP = @ac_ct_STRIP@ | ||||
| ac_prefix = @ac_prefix@ | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_FALSE = @am__fastdepCC_FALSE@ | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_TRUE = @am__fastdepCC_TRUE@ | ||||
| am__include = @am__include@ | ||||
| am__leading_dot = @am__leading_dot@ | ||||
| am__quote = @am__quote@ | ||||
| am__tar = @am__tar@ | ||||
| am__untar = @am__untar@ | ||||
| bindir = @bindir@ | ||||
| build_alias = @build_alias@ | ||||
| datadir = @datadir@ | ||||
| exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@ | ||||
| host_alias = @host_alias@ | ||||
| includedir = @includedir@ | ||||
| infodir = @infodir@ | ||||
| install_sh = @install_sh@ | ||||
| libdir = @libdir@ | ||||
| libexecdir = @libexecdir@ | ||||
| localstatedir = @localstatedir@ | ||||
| mandir = @mandir@ | ||||
| mkdir_p = @mkdir_p@ | ||||
| oldincludedir = @oldincludedir@ | ||||
| prefix = @prefix@ | ||||
| program_transform_name = @program_transform_name@ | ||||
| sbindir = @sbindir@ | ||||
| sharedstatedir = @sharedstatedir@ | ||||
| sysconfdir = @sysconfdir@ | ||||
| target_alias = @target_alias@ | ||||
| SUBDIRS = html man pdf ps | ||||
| all: all-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SUFFIXES: | ||||
| $(srcdir)/Makefile.in:  $(srcdir)/Makefile.am  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	@for dep in $?; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case '$(am__configure_deps)' in \
 | ||||
| 	    *$$dep*) \
 | ||||
| 	      cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh \
 | ||||
| 		&& exit 0; \
 | ||||
| 	      exit 1;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	echo ' cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/Makefile'; \
 | ||||
| 	cd $(top_srcdir) && \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/Makefile | ||||
| .PRECIOUS: Makefile | ||||
| Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status | ||||
| 	@case '$?' in \
 | ||||
| 	  *config.status*) \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) \
 | ||||
| 	    echo ' cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe)'; \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe);; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_builddir)/config.status: $(top_srcdir)/configure $(CONFIG_STATUS_DEPENDENCIES) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_srcdir)/configure:  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| $(ACLOCAL_M4):  $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| uninstall-info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This directory's subdirectories are mostly independent; you can cd
 | ||||
| # into them and run `make' without going through this Makefile.
 | ||||
| # To change the values of `make' variables: instead of editing Makefiles,
 | ||||
| # (1) if the variable is set in `config.status', edit `config.status'
 | ||||
| #     (which will cause the Makefiles to be regenerated when you run `make');
 | ||||
| # (2) otherwise, pass the desired values on the `make' command line.
 | ||||
| $(RECURSIVE_TARGETS): | ||||
| 	@set fnord $$MAKEFLAGS; amf=$$2; \
 | ||||
| 	dot_seen=no; \
 | ||||
| 	target=`echo $@ | sed s/-recursive//`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  echo "Making $$target in $$subdir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dot_seen=yes; \
 | ||||
| 	    local_target="$$target-am"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    local_target="$$target"; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  (cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) $$local_target) \
 | ||||
| 	   || case "$$amf" in *=*) exit 1;; *k*) fail=yes;; *) exit 1;; esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	if test "$$dot_seen" = "no"; then \
 | ||||
| 	  $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) "$$target-am" || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	fi; test -z "$$fail" | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-recursive clean-recursive distclean-recursive \ | ||||
| maintainer-clean-recursive: | ||||
| 	@set fnord $$MAKEFLAGS; amf=$$2; \
 | ||||
| 	dot_seen=no; \
 | ||||
| 	case "$@" in \
 | ||||
| 	  distclean-* | maintainer-clean-*) list='$(DIST_SUBDIRS)' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) list='$(SUBDIRS)' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; \
 | ||||
| 	rev=''; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = "."; then :; else \
 | ||||
| 	    rev="$$subdir $$rev"; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	rev="$$rev ."; \
 | ||||
| 	target=`echo $@ | sed s/-recursive//`; \
 | ||||
| 	for subdir in $$rev; do \
 | ||||
| 	  echo "Making $$target in $$subdir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    local_target="$$target-am"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    local_target="$$target"; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  (cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) $$local_target) \
 | ||||
| 	   || case "$$amf" in *=*) exit 1;; *k*) fail=yes;; *) exit 1;; esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done && test -z "$$fail" | ||||
| tags-recursive: | ||||
| 	list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test "$$subdir" = . || (cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) tags); \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| ctags-recursive: | ||||
| 	list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test "$$subdir" = . || (cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) ctags); \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ID: $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES) $(LISP) $(TAGS_FILES) | ||||
| 	list='$(SOURCES) $(HEADERS) $(LISP) $(TAGS_FILES)'; \
 | ||||
| 	unique=`for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -f "$$i"; then echo $$i; else echo $(srcdir)/$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  done | \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AWK) '    { files[$$0] = 1; } \
 | ||||
| 	       END { for (i in files) print i; }'`; \
 | ||||
| 	mkid -fID $$unique | ||||
| tags: TAGS | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| TAGS: tags-recursive $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)  $(TAGS_DEPENDENCIES) \ | ||||
| 		$(TAGS_FILES) $(LISP) | ||||
| 	tags=; \
 | ||||
| 	here=`pwd`; \
 | ||||
| 	if ($(ETAGS) --etags-include --version) >/dev/null 2>&1; then \
 | ||||
| 	  include_option=--etags-include; \
 | ||||
| 	  empty_fix=.; \
 | ||||
| 	else \
 | ||||
| 	  include_option=--include; \
 | ||||
| 	  empty_fix=; \
 | ||||
| 	fi; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = .; then :; else \
 | ||||
| 	    test ! -f $$subdir/TAGS || \
 | ||||
| 	      tags="$$tags $$include_option=$$here/$$subdir/TAGS"; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(SOURCES) $(HEADERS)  $(LISP) $(TAGS_FILES)'; \
 | ||||
| 	unique=`for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -f "$$i"; then echo $$i; else echo $(srcdir)/$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  done | \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AWK) '    { files[$$0] = 1; } \
 | ||||
| 	       END { for (i in files) print i; }'`; \
 | ||||
| 	if test -z "$(ETAGS_ARGS)$$tags$$unique"; then :; else \
 | ||||
| 	  test -n "$$unique" || unique=$$empty_fix; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(ETAGS) $(ETAGSFLAGS) $(AM_ETAGSFLAGS) $(ETAGS_ARGS) \
 | ||||
| 	    $$tags $$unique; \
 | ||||
| 	fi | ||||
| ctags: CTAGS | ||||
| CTAGS: ctags-recursive $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)  $(TAGS_DEPENDENCIES) \ | ||||
| 		$(TAGS_FILES) $(LISP) | ||||
| 	tags=; \
 | ||||
| 	here=`pwd`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(SOURCES) $(HEADERS)  $(LISP) $(TAGS_FILES)'; \
 | ||||
| 	unique=`for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -f "$$i"; then echo $$i; else echo $(srcdir)/$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  done | \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AWK) '    { files[$$0] = 1; } \
 | ||||
| 	       END { for (i in files) print i; }'`; \
 | ||||
| 	test -z "$(CTAGS_ARGS)$$tags$$unique" \
 | ||||
| 	  || $(CTAGS) $(CTAGSFLAGS) $(AM_CTAGSFLAGS) $(CTAGS_ARGS) \
 | ||||
| 	     $$tags $$unique | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| GTAGS: | ||||
| 	here=`$(am__cd) $(top_builddir) && pwd` \
 | ||||
| 	  && cd $(top_srcdir) \
 | ||||
| 	  && gtags -i $(GTAGS_ARGS) $$here | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-tags: | ||||
| 	-rm -f TAGS ID GTAGS GRTAGS GSYMS GPATH tags | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distdir: $(DISTFILES) | ||||
| 	@srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	topsrcdirstrip=`echo "$(top_srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(DISTFILES)'; for file in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case $$file in \
 | ||||
| 	    $(srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(top_srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$topsrcdirstrip/|$(top_builddir)/|"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $$file || test -d $$file; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  dir=`echo "$$file" | sed -e 's,/[^/]*$$,,'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$dir" != "$$file" && test "$$dir" != "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dir="/$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    dir=''; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -d $$d/$$file; then \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -d $(srcdir)/$$file && test $$d != $(srcdir); then \
 | ||||
| 	      cp -pR $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    fi; \
 | ||||
| 	    cp -pR $$d/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || cp -p $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| 	list='$(DIST_SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$subdir" = .; then :; else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -d "$(distdir)/$$subdir" \
 | ||||
| 	    || $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)/$$subdir" \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    distdir=`$(am__cd) $(distdir) && pwd`; \
 | ||||
| 	    top_distdir=`$(am__cd) $(top_distdir) && pwd`; \
 | ||||
| 	    (cd $$subdir && \
 | ||||
| 	      $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) \
 | ||||
| 	        top_distdir="$$top_distdir" \
 | ||||
| 	        distdir="$$distdir/$$subdir" \
 | ||||
| 	        distdir) \
 | ||||
| 	      || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| check-am: all-am | ||||
| check: check-recursive | ||||
| all-am: Makefile | ||||
| installdirs: installdirs-recursive | ||||
| installdirs-am: | ||||
| install: install-recursive | ||||
| install-exec: install-exec-recursive | ||||
| install-data: install-data-recursive | ||||
| uninstall: uninstall-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-am: all-am | ||||
| 	@$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) install-exec-am install-data-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck: installcheck-recursive | ||||
| install-strip: | ||||
| 	$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) INSTALL_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" \
 | ||||
| 	  install_sh_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" INSTALL_STRIP_FLAG=-s \
 | ||||
| 	  `test -z '$(STRIP)' || \
 | ||||
| 	    echo "INSTALL_PROGRAM_ENV=STRIPPROG='$(STRIP)'"` install | ||||
| mostlyclean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-generic: | ||||
| 	-test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean-generic: | ||||
| 	@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use" | ||||
| 	@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild." | ||||
| clean: clean-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-am: clean-generic mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean: distclean-recursive | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| distclean-am: clean-am distclean-generic distclean-tags | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi: dvi-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| html: html-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info: info-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-data-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-exec-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-info: install-info-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-man: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-recursive | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| maintainer-clean-am: distclean-am maintainer-clean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean: mostlyclean-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf: pdf-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps: ps-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-am: uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-info: uninstall-info-recursive | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .PHONY: $(RECURSIVE_TARGETS) CTAGS GTAGS all all-am check check-am \ | ||||
| 	clean clean-generic clean-recursive ctags ctags-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	distclean distclean-generic distclean-recursive distclean-tags \
 | ||||
| 	distdir dvi dvi-am html html-am info info-am install \
 | ||||
| 	install-am install-data install-data-am install-exec \
 | ||||
| 	install-exec-am install-info install-info-am install-man \
 | ||||
| 	install-strip installcheck installcheck-am installdirs \
 | ||||
| 	installdirs-am maintainer-clean maintainer-clean-generic \
 | ||||
| 	maintainer-clean-recursive mostlyclean mostlyclean-generic \
 | ||||
| 	mostlyclean-recursive pdf pdf-am ps ps-am tags tags-recursive \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall uninstall-am uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
 | ||||
| # Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
 | ||||
| .NOEXPORT: | ||||
							
								
								
									
										313
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/Makefile
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										313
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/Makefile
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,313 @@ | |||
| # Makefile.in generated by automake 1.9 from Makefile.am.
 | ||||
| # doc/html/Makefile.  Generated from Makefile.in by configure.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
 | ||||
| # 2003, 2004  Free Software Foundation, Inc.
 | ||||
| # This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
 | ||||
| # gives unlimited permission to copy and/or distribute it,
 | ||||
| # with or without modifications, as long as this notice is preserved.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | ||||
| # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law; without
 | ||||
| # even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A
 | ||||
| # PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| srcdir = . | ||||
| top_srcdir = ../.. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/WordNet | ||||
| pkglibdir = $(libdir)/WordNet | ||||
| pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/WordNet | ||||
| top_builddir = ../.. | ||||
| am__cd = CDPATH="$${ZSH_VERSION+.}$(PATH_SEPARATOR)" && cd | ||||
| INSTALL = /usr/csl/bin/install -c | ||||
| install_sh_DATA = $(install_sh) -c -m 644 | ||||
| install_sh_PROGRAM = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| install_sh_SCRIPT = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| INSTALL_HEADER = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| transform = $(program_transform_name) | ||||
| NORMAL_INSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_INSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_INSTALL = : | ||||
| NORMAL_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| subdir = doc/html | ||||
| DIST_COMMON = $(srcdir)/Makefile.am $(srcdir)/Makefile.in | ||||
| ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4 | ||||
| am__aclocal_m4_deps = $(top_srcdir)/acinclude.m4 \
 | ||||
| 	$(top_srcdir)/configure.ac | ||||
| am__configure_deps = $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES) \
 | ||||
| 	$(ACLOCAL_M4) | ||||
| mkinstalldirs = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| CONFIG_HEADER = $(top_builddir)/config.h | ||||
| CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES = | ||||
| SOURCES = | ||||
| DIST_SOURCES = | ||||
| am__vpath_adj_setup = srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; | ||||
| am__vpath_adj = case $$p in \
 | ||||
|     $(srcdir)/*) f=`echo "$$p" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
|     *) f=$$p;; \
 | ||||
|   esac; | ||||
| am__strip_dir = `echo $$p | sed -e 's|^.*/||'`; | ||||
| am__installdirs = "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)" | ||||
| htmlDATA_INSTALL = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| DATA = $(html_DATA) | ||||
| DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(DIST_SOURCES) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST) | ||||
| ACLOCAL = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run aclocal-1.9 | ||||
| AMDEP_FALSE = # | ||||
| AMDEP_TRUE =  | ||||
| AMTAR = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run tar | ||||
| AUTOCONF = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run autoconf | ||||
| AUTOHEADER = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run autoheader | ||||
| AUTOMAKE = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run automake-1.9 | ||||
| AWK = nawk | ||||
| CC = gcc | ||||
| CCDEPMODE = depmode=gcc3 | ||||
| CFLAGS = -g -O2 | ||||
| CPP = gcc -E | ||||
| CPPFLAGS =  | ||||
| CYGPATH_W = echo | ||||
| DEFS = -DHAVE_CONFIG_H | ||||
| DEPDIR = .deps | ||||
| ECHO_C =  | ||||
| ECHO_N = -n | ||||
| ECHO_T =  | ||||
| EGREP = egrep | ||||
| EXEEXT =  | ||||
| INSTALL_DATA = ${INSTALL} -m 644 | ||||
| INSTALL_PROGRAM = ${INSTALL} | ||||
| INSTALL_SCRIPT = ${INSTALL} | ||||
| INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM = ${SHELL} $(install_sh) -c -s | ||||
| LDFLAGS =  | ||||
| LIBOBJS =  | ||||
| LIBS =  | ||||
| LTLIBOBJS =  | ||||
| MAKEINFO = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run makeinfo | ||||
| OBJEXT = o | ||||
| PACKAGE = WordNet | ||||
| PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = wordnet@princeton.edu | ||||
| PACKAGE_NAME = WordNet | ||||
| PACKAGE_STRING = WordNet 3.0 | ||||
| PACKAGE_TARNAME = wordnet | ||||
| PACKAGE_VERSION = 3.0 | ||||
| PATH_SEPARATOR = : | ||||
| RANLIB = ranlib | ||||
| SET_MAKE =  | ||||
| SHELL = /bin/bash | ||||
| STRIP =  | ||||
| TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC = -I/usr/csl/include | ||||
| TCL_LIB_SPEC = -L/usr/csl/lib -ltcl8.4 | ||||
| TK_LIBS = -L/usr/openwin/lib -lX11 -ldl  -lpthread -lsocket -lnsl -lm | ||||
| TK_LIB_SPEC = -L/usr/csl/lib -ltk8.4 | ||||
| TK_PREFIX = /usr/csl | ||||
| TK_XINCLUDES = -I/usr/openwin/include | ||||
| VERSION = 3.0 | ||||
| ac_ct_CC = gcc | ||||
| ac_ct_RANLIB = ranlib | ||||
| ac_ct_STRIP =  | ||||
| ac_prefix = /usr/local/WordNet-3.0 | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_FALSE = # | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_TRUE =  | ||||
| am__include = include | ||||
| am__leading_dot = . | ||||
| am__quote =  | ||||
| am__tar = ${AMTAR} chof - "$$tardir" | ||||
| am__untar = ${AMTAR} xf - | ||||
| bindir = ${exec_prefix}/bin | ||||
| build_alias =  | ||||
| datadir = ${prefix}/share | ||||
| exec_prefix = ${prefix} | ||||
| host_alias =  | ||||
| includedir = ${prefix}/include | ||||
| infodir = ${prefix}/info | ||||
| install_sh = /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/install-sh | ||||
| libdir = ${exec_prefix}/lib | ||||
| libexecdir = ${exec_prefix}/libexec | ||||
| localstatedir = ${prefix}/var | ||||
| mandir = ${prefix}/man | ||||
| mkdir_p = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| oldincludedir = /usr/include | ||||
| prefix = /usr/local/WordNet-3.0 | ||||
| program_transform_name = s,x,x, | ||||
| sbindir = ${exec_prefix}/sbin | ||||
| sharedstatedir = ${prefix}/com | ||||
| sysconfdir = ${prefix}/etc | ||||
| target_alias =  | ||||
| htmldir = $(prefix)/doc/html | ||||
| html_DATA = binsrch.3WN.html cntlist.5WN.html grind.1WN.html lexnames.5WN.html morph.3WN.html morphy.7WN.html senseidx.5WN.html uniqbeg.7WN.html wn.1WN.html wnb.1WN.html wndb.5WN.html wngloss.7WN.html wngroups.7WN.html wninput.5WN.html wnintro.1WN.html wnintro.3WN.html wnintro.5WN.html wnintro.7WN.html wnlicens.7WN.html wnpkgs.7WN.html wnsearch.3WN.html wnstats.7WN.html wnutil.3WN.html | ||||
| all: all-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SUFFIXES: | ||||
| $(srcdir)/Makefile.in:  $(srcdir)/Makefile.am  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	@for dep in $?; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case '$(am__configure_deps)' in \
 | ||||
| 	    *$$dep*) \
 | ||||
| 	      cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh \
 | ||||
| 		&& exit 0; \
 | ||||
| 	      exit 1;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	echo ' cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/html/Makefile'; \
 | ||||
| 	cd $(top_srcdir) && \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/html/Makefile | ||||
| .PRECIOUS: Makefile | ||||
| Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status | ||||
| 	@case '$?' in \
 | ||||
| 	  *config.status*) \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) \
 | ||||
| 	    echo ' cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe)'; \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe);; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_builddir)/config.status: $(top_srcdir)/configure $(CONFIG_STATUS_DEPENDENCIES) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_srcdir)/configure:  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| $(ACLOCAL_M4):  $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| uninstall-info-am: | ||||
| install-htmlDATA: $(html_DATA) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(htmldir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(html_DATA)'; for p in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f "$$p"; then d=; else d="$(srcdir)/"; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  f=$(am__strip_dir) \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(htmlDATA_INSTALL) '$$d$$p' '$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(htmlDATA_INSTALL) "$$d$$p" "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-htmlDATA: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(html_DATA)'; for p in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  f=$(am__strip_dir) \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| tags: TAGS | ||||
| TAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ctags: CTAGS | ||||
| CTAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distdir: $(DISTFILES) | ||||
| 	@srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	topsrcdirstrip=`echo "$(top_srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(DISTFILES)'; for file in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case $$file in \
 | ||||
| 	    $(srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(top_srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$topsrcdirstrip/|$(top_builddir)/|"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $$file || test -d $$file; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  dir=`echo "$$file" | sed -e 's,/[^/]*$$,,'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$dir" != "$$file" && test "$$dir" != "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dir="/$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    dir=''; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -d $$d/$$file; then \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -d $(srcdir)/$$file && test $$d != $(srcdir); then \
 | ||||
| 	      cp -pR $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    fi; \
 | ||||
| 	    cp -pR $$d/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || cp -p $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| check-am: all-am | ||||
| check: check-am | ||||
| all-am: Makefile $(DATA) | ||||
| installdirs: | ||||
| 	for dir in "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)"; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test -z "$$dir" || $(mkdir_p) "$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install: install-am | ||||
| install-exec: install-exec-am | ||||
| install-data: install-data-am | ||||
| uninstall: uninstall-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-am: all-am | ||||
| 	@$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) install-exec-am install-data-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck: installcheck-am | ||||
| install-strip: | ||||
| 	$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) INSTALL_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" \
 | ||||
| 	  install_sh_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" INSTALL_STRIP_FLAG=-s \
 | ||||
| 	  `test -z '$(STRIP)' || \
 | ||||
| 	    echo "INSTALL_PROGRAM_ENV=STRIPPROG='$(STRIP)'"` install | ||||
| mostlyclean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-generic: | ||||
| 	-test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean-generic: | ||||
| 	@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use" | ||||
| 	@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild." | ||||
| clean: clean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-am: clean-generic mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean: distclean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| distclean-am: clean-am distclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi: dvi-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| html: html-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info: info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-data-am: install-htmlDATA | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-exec-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-info: install-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-man: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| maintainer-clean-am: distclean-am maintainer-clean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean: mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf: pdf-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps: ps-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-am: uninstall-htmlDATA uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .PHONY: all all-am check check-am clean clean-generic distclean \ | ||||
| 	distclean-generic distdir dvi dvi-am html html-am info info-am \
 | ||||
| 	install install-am install-data install-data-am install-exec \
 | ||||
| 	install-exec-am install-htmlDATA install-info install-info-am \
 | ||||
| 	install-man install-strip installcheck installcheck-am \
 | ||||
| 	installdirs maintainer-clean maintainer-clean-generic \
 | ||||
| 	mostlyclean mostlyclean-generic pdf pdf-am ps ps-am uninstall \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-am uninstall-htmlDATA uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
 | ||||
| # Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
 | ||||
| .NOEXPORT: | ||||
							
								
								
									
										2
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/Makefile.am
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										2
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/Makefile.am
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,2 @@ | |||
| htmldir = $(prefix)/doc/html | ||||
| html_DATA = binsrch.3WN.html cntlist.5WN.html grind.1WN.html lexnames.5WN.html morph.3WN.html morphy.7WN.html senseidx.5WN.html uniqbeg.7WN.html wn.1WN.html wnb.1WN.html wndb.5WN.html wngloss.7WN.html wngroups.7WN.html wninput.5WN.html wnintro.1WN.html wnintro.3WN.html wnintro.5WN.html wnintro.7WN.html wnlicens.7WN.html wnpkgs.7WN.html wnsearch.3WN.html wnstats.7WN.html wnutil.3WN.html | ||||
							
								
								
									
										313
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/Makefile.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										313
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/Makefile.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,313 @@ | |||
| # Makefile.in generated by automake 1.9 from Makefile.am.
 | ||||
| # @configure_input@
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
 | ||||
| # 2003, 2004  Free Software Foundation, Inc.
 | ||||
| # This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
 | ||||
| # gives unlimited permission to copy and/or distribute it,
 | ||||
| # with or without modifications, as long as this notice is preserved.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | ||||
| # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law; without
 | ||||
| # even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A
 | ||||
| # PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| @SET_MAKE@ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| srcdir = @srcdir@ | ||||
| top_srcdir = @top_srcdir@ | ||||
| VPATH = @srcdir@ | ||||
| pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| pkglibdir = $(libdir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| top_builddir = ../.. | ||||
| am__cd = CDPATH="$${ZSH_VERSION+.}$(PATH_SEPARATOR)" && cd | ||||
| INSTALL = @INSTALL@ | ||||
| install_sh_DATA = $(install_sh) -c -m 644 | ||||
| install_sh_PROGRAM = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| install_sh_SCRIPT = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| INSTALL_HEADER = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| transform = $(program_transform_name) | ||||
| NORMAL_INSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_INSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_INSTALL = : | ||||
| NORMAL_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| subdir = doc/html | ||||
| DIST_COMMON = $(srcdir)/Makefile.am $(srcdir)/Makefile.in | ||||
| ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4 | ||||
| am__aclocal_m4_deps = $(top_srcdir)/acinclude.m4 \
 | ||||
| 	$(top_srcdir)/configure.ac | ||||
| am__configure_deps = $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES) \
 | ||||
| 	$(ACLOCAL_M4) | ||||
| mkinstalldirs = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| CONFIG_HEADER = $(top_builddir)/config.h | ||||
| CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES = | ||||
| SOURCES = | ||||
| DIST_SOURCES = | ||||
| am__vpath_adj_setup = srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; | ||||
| am__vpath_adj = case $$p in \
 | ||||
|     $(srcdir)/*) f=`echo "$$p" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
|     *) f=$$p;; \
 | ||||
|   esac; | ||||
| am__strip_dir = `echo $$p | sed -e 's|^.*/||'`; | ||||
| am__installdirs = "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)" | ||||
| htmlDATA_INSTALL = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| DATA = $(html_DATA) | ||||
| DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(DIST_SOURCES) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST) | ||||
| ACLOCAL = @ACLOCAL@ | ||||
| AMDEP_FALSE = @AMDEP_FALSE@ | ||||
| AMDEP_TRUE = @AMDEP_TRUE@ | ||||
| AMTAR = @AMTAR@ | ||||
| AUTOCONF = @AUTOCONF@ | ||||
| AUTOHEADER = @AUTOHEADER@ | ||||
| AUTOMAKE = @AUTOMAKE@ | ||||
| AWK = @AWK@ | ||||
| CC = @CC@ | ||||
| CCDEPMODE = @CCDEPMODE@ | ||||
| CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@ | ||||
| CPP = @CPP@ | ||||
| CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@ | ||||
| CYGPATH_W = @CYGPATH_W@ | ||||
| DEFS = @DEFS@ | ||||
| DEPDIR = @DEPDIR@ | ||||
| ECHO_C = @ECHO_C@ | ||||
| ECHO_N = @ECHO_N@ | ||||
| ECHO_T = @ECHO_T@ | ||||
| EGREP = @EGREP@ | ||||
| EXEEXT = @EXEEXT@ | ||||
| INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@ | ||||
| INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@ | ||||
| INSTALL_SCRIPT = @INSTALL_SCRIPT@ | ||||
| INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM@ | ||||
| LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@ | ||||
| LIBOBJS = @LIBOBJS@ | ||||
| LIBS = @LIBS@ | ||||
| LTLIBOBJS = @LTLIBOBJS@ | ||||
| MAKEINFO = @MAKEINFO@ | ||||
| OBJEXT = @OBJEXT@ | ||||
| PACKAGE = @PACKAGE@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = @PACKAGE_BUGREPORT@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_NAME = @PACKAGE_NAME@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_STRING = @PACKAGE_STRING@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_TARNAME = @PACKAGE_TARNAME@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_VERSION = @PACKAGE_VERSION@ | ||||
| PATH_SEPARATOR = @PATH_SEPARATOR@ | ||||
| RANLIB = @RANLIB@ | ||||
| SET_MAKE = @SET_MAKE@ | ||||
| SHELL = @SHELL@ | ||||
| STRIP = @STRIP@ | ||||
| TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC = @TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC@ | ||||
| TCL_LIB_SPEC = @TCL_LIB_SPEC@ | ||||
| TK_LIBS = @TK_LIBS@ | ||||
| TK_LIB_SPEC = @TK_LIB_SPEC@ | ||||
| TK_PREFIX = @TK_PREFIX@ | ||||
| TK_XINCLUDES = @TK_XINCLUDES@ | ||||
| VERSION = @VERSION@ | ||||
| ac_ct_CC = @ac_ct_CC@ | ||||
| ac_ct_RANLIB = @ac_ct_RANLIB@ | ||||
| ac_ct_STRIP = @ac_ct_STRIP@ | ||||
| ac_prefix = @ac_prefix@ | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_FALSE = @am__fastdepCC_FALSE@ | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_TRUE = @am__fastdepCC_TRUE@ | ||||
| am__include = @am__include@ | ||||
| am__leading_dot = @am__leading_dot@ | ||||
| am__quote = @am__quote@ | ||||
| am__tar = @am__tar@ | ||||
| am__untar = @am__untar@ | ||||
| bindir = @bindir@ | ||||
| build_alias = @build_alias@ | ||||
| datadir = @datadir@ | ||||
| exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@ | ||||
| host_alias = @host_alias@ | ||||
| includedir = @includedir@ | ||||
| infodir = @infodir@ | ||||
| install_sh = @install_sh@ | ||||
| libdir = @libdir@ | ||||
| libexecdir = @libexecdir@ | ||||
| localstatedir = @localstatedir@ | ||||
| mandir = @mandir@ | ||||
| mkdir_p = @mkdir_p@ | ||||
| oldincludedir = @oldincludedir@ | ||||
| prefix = @prefix@ | ||||
| program_transform_name = @program_transform_name@ | ||||
| sbindir = @sbindir@ | ||||
| sharedstatedir = @sharedstatedir@ | ||||
| sysconfdir = @sysconfdir@ | ||||
| target_alias = @target_alias@ | ||||
| htmldir = $(prefix)/doc/html | ||||
| html_DATA = binsrch.3WN.html cntlist.5WN.html grind.1WN.html lexnames.5WN.html morph.3WN.html morphy.7WN.html senseidx.5WN.html uniqbeg.7WN.html wn.1WN.html wnb.1WN.html wndb.5WN.html wngloss.7WN.html wngroups.7WN.html wninput.5WN.html wnintro.1WN.html wnintro.3WN.html wnintro.5WN.html wnintro.7WN.html wnlicens.7WN.html wnpkgs.7WN.html wnsearch.3WN.html wnstats.7WN.html wnutil.3WN.html | ||||
| all: all-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SUFFIXES: | ||||
| $(srcdir)/Makefile.in:  $(srcdir)/Makefile.am  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	@for dep in $?; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case '$(am__configure_deps)' in \
 | ||||
| 	    *$$dep*) \
 | ||||
| 	      cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh \
 | ||||
| 		&& exit 0; \
 | ||||
| 	      exit 1;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	echo ' cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/html/Makefile'; \
 | ||||
| 	cd $(top_srcdir) && \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/html/Makefile | ||||
| .PRECIOUS: Makefile | ||||
| Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status | ||||
| 	@case '$?' in \
 | ||||
| 	  *config.status*) \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) \
 | ||||
| 	    echo ' cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe)'; \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe);; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_builddir)/config.status: $(top_srcdir)/configure $(CONFIG_STATUS_DEPENDENCIES) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_srcdir)/configure:  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| $(ACLOCAL_M4):  $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| uninstall-info-am: | ||||
| install-htmlDATA: $(html_DATA) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(htmldir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(html_DATA)'; for p in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f "$$p"; then d=; else d="$(srcdir)/"; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  f=$(am__strip_dir) \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(htmlDATA_INSTALL) '$$d$$p' '$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(htmlDATA_INSTALL) "$$d$$p" "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-htmlDATA: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(html_DATA)'; for p in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  f=$(am__strip_dir) \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| tags: TAGS | ||||
| TAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ctags: CTAGS | ||||
| CTAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distdir: $(DISTFILES) | ||||
| 	@srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	topsrcdirstrip=`echo "$(top_srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(DISTFILES)'; for file in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case $$file in \
 | ||||
| 	    $(srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(top_srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$topsrcdirstrip/|$(top_builddir)/|"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $$file || test -d $$file; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  dir=`echo "$$file" | sed -e 's,/[^/]*$$,,'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$dir" != "$$file" && test "$$dir" != "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dir="/$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    dir=''; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -d $$d/$$file; then \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -d $(srcdir)/$$file && test $$d != $(srcdir); then \
 | ||||
| 	      cp -pR $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    fi; \
 | ||||
| 	    cp -pR $$d/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || cp -p $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| check-am: all-am | ||||
| check: check-am | ||||
| all-am: Makefile $(DATA) | ||||
| installdirs: | ||||
| 	for dir in "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)"; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test -z "$$dir" || $(mkdir_p) "$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install: install-am | ||||
| install-exec: install-exec-am | ||||
| install-data: install-data-am | ||||
| uninstall: uninstall-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-am: all-am | ||||
| 	@$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) install-exec-am install-data-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck: installcheck-am | ||||
| install-strip: | ||||
| 	$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) INSTALL_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" \
 | ||||
| 	  install_sh_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" INSTALL_STRIP_FLAG=-s \
 | ||||
| 	  `test -z '$(STRIP)' || \
 | ||||
| 	    echo "INSTALL_PROGRAM_ENV=STRIPPROG='$(STRIP)'"` install | ||||
| mostlyclean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-generic: | ||||
| 	-test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean-generic: | ||||
| 	@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use" | ||||
| 	@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild." | ||||
| clean: clean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-am: clean-generic mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean: distclean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| distclean-am: clean-am distclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi: dvi-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| html: html-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info: info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-data-am: install-htmlDATA | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-exec-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-info: install-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-man: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| maintainer-clean-am: distclean-am maintainer-clean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean: mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf: pdf-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps: ps-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-am: uninstall-htmlDATA uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .PHONY: all all-am check check-am clean clean-generic distclean \ | ||||
| 	distclean-generic distdir dvi dvi-am html html-am info info-am \
 | ||||
| 	install install-am install-data install-data-am install-exec \
 | ||||
| 	install-exec-am install-htmlDATA install-info install-info-am \
 | ||||
| 	install-man install-strip installcheck installcheck-am \
 | ||||
| 	installdirs maintainer-clean maintainer-clean-generic \
 | ||||
| 	mostlyclean mostlyclean-generic pdf pdf-am ps ps-am uninstall \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-am uninstall-htmlDATA uninstall-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
 | ||||
| # Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
 | ||||
| .NOEXPORT: | ||||
							
								
								
									
										78
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/binsrch.3WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										78
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/binsrch.3WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,78 @@ | |||
| <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>BINSRCH(3WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| bin_search, copyfile, replace_line, insert_line   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">SYNOPSIS </A></H2> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| <B>char *bin_search(char  | ||||
| *key, FILE *fp); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>void copyfile(FILE *fromfp, FILE *tofp); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>char *replace_line(char  | ||||
| *new_line, char *key, FILE *fp); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>char *insert_line(char *new_line, char  | ||||
| *key, FILE *fp); </B>   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| The WordNet library contains several general  | ||||
| purpose functions for performing a binary search and modifying sorted  | ||||
| files. <P> | ||||
| <B>bin_search()</B> is the primary binary search algorithm to search for  | ||||
| <I>key </I> as the first item on a line in the file pointed to by <I>fp </I>.  The delimiter  | ||||
| between the key and the rest of the fields on the line, if any, must be  | ||||
| a space.  A pointer to a static variable containing the entire line is  | ||||
| returned. <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   is returned if a match is not found. <P> | ||||
| The remaining functions  | ||||
| are not used by WordNet, and are only briefly described. <P> | ||||
| <B>copyfile()</B> copies  | ||||
| the contents of one file to another. <P> | ||||
| <B>replace_line()</B> replaces a line in  | ||||
| a file having searchkey <I>key </I> with the contents of <I>new_line </I>. It returns  | ||||
| the original line or <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   in case of error. <P> | ||||
| <B>insert_line()</B> finds the proper  | ||||
| place to insert the contents of <I>new_line </I>, having searchkey <I>key </I> in the  | ||||
| sorted file pointed to by <I>fp </I>. It returns <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   if a line with this searchkey  | ||||
| is already in the file.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">NOTES </A></H2> | ||||
| The maximum length of <I>key </I> is 1024. <P> | ||||
|  The  | ||||
| maximum line length in a file is 25K. <P> | ||||
|  If there are no additional fields  | ||||
| after the search key, the key must be followed by at least one space before  | ||||
| the newline character.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnintro.3WN.html">wnintro</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="morph.3WN.html">morph</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnsearch.3WN.html">wnsearch</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnutil.3WN.html">wnutil</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.5WN.html">wnintro</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| .   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">WARNINGS </A></H2> | ||||
| <B>binsearch() </B> returns a pointer to  | ||||
| a static character buffer. The returned string should be copied by the  | ||||
| caller if the results need to be saved, as a subsequent call will replace  | ||||
| the contents of the static buffer. <P> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">SYNOPSIS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">WARNINGS</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										125
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/cntlist.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										125
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/cntlist.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,125 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>CNTLIST(5WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| cntlist - file listing number of times each tagged sense occurs  | ||||
| in a semantic concordance, sorted most to least frequently tagged <P> | ||||
|  cntlist.rev  | ||||
| - file listing number of times each tagged sense occurs in a semantic concordance,  | ||||
| sorted by sense key   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| A cntlist file for a semantic concordance  | ||||
| lists the number of times each semantically tagged sense occurs in the  | ||||
| concordance and its sense number in the WordNet database.  Each line in  | ||||
| the file corresponds to a sense in the WordNet database to which at least  | ||||
| one semantic tag points.  Only senses that are tagged in a concordance  | ||||
| are in the concordance's cntlist file. <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">WordNet Database <I>cntlist </I> File  | ||||
| </A></H3> | ||||
| In the WordNet database, words are assigned sense numbers based on frequency  | ||||
| of use in semantically tagged corpora.  The cntlist file used by <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)<B></B></A> | ||||
|   | ||||
| to build the WordNet database and assign the sense numbers is a union  | ||||
| of the cntlist files from the various semantic concordances that were  | ||||
| formerly released by Princeton University.  This combined cntlist file  | ||||
| is provided with the WordNet package and is found in the <B>WNSEARCHDIR </B>  | ||||
| directory. <P> | ||||
|  The <I>cntlist.rev </I> file is used at run-time by the WordNet library  | ||||
| code and browser interfaces to print in the output display the number  | ||||
| of times each sense has been tagged.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">File Format </A></H3> | ||||
| Each line in a cntlist  | ||||
| file contains information for one sense.  The file is ordered from most  | ||||
| to least frequently tagged sense.  The fields are separated by one space,  | ||||
| and each line is terminated with a newline character.  Senses having the  | ||||
| same <I>tag_cnt </I> value are listed in reverse alphabetical order of the <I>lemma  | ||||
| </I> field of the <I>sense_key </I>. <P> | ||||
|  Each line in <B>cntlist </B> is of the form: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><I>tag_cnt  sense_key  sense_number  | ||||
| </I>  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  where <I>tag_cnt </I> is the decimal number of times the sense is tagged in  | ||||
| the corresponding semantic concordance.  <I>sense_key </I> is a WordNet sense  | ||||
| encoding and <I>sense_number </I> is a WordNet sense number as described in <P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| The <I>cntlist.rev </I> file contains the same fields described above, in the  | ||||
| following order: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><I>sense_key  sense_number  tag_cnt </I>  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">NOTES </A></H2> | ||||
| Princeton  | ||||
| no longer maintains or releases the Semantic Concordance files.  The <I>cntlist  | ||||
| </I> file used to order the senses in WordNet 3.0 was generated from the Semantic  | ||||
| Concordance files at the point that they were last updated in 2001.  In  | ||||
| general, the order of senses presented usually reflects what the user  | ||||
| would expect, however sense ordering is now less reliable than in prior  | ||||
| releases and should not be construed as an accurate indicator of frequency  | ||||
| of use.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNHOME</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  | ||||
|  Default is <B>/usr/local/WordNet-3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNSEARCHDIR</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Directory in which the  | ||||
| WordNet database has been installed.   Default is <B>WNHOME/dict </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">REGISTRY  | ||||
| (WINDOWS) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\WordNet\3.0\WNHome</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for  | ||||
| WordNet.  Default is <B>C:\Program Files\WordNet\3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>HKEY_CURRENT_USER\SOFTWARE\WordNet\3.0\wnres</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>User's default browser options. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect7" HREF="#toc7">FILES </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>cntlist, cntlist.rev</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>file of combined  | ||||
| semantic concordance <B>cntlist </B> files.  Used to assign sense numbers in WordNet  | ||||
| database </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect8" HREF="#toc8">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.5WN.html">wnintro</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="senseidx.5WN.html">senseidx</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">WordNet Database cntlist  File</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">File Format</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">REGISTRY (WINDOWS)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc7" HREF="#sect7">FILES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc8" HREF="#sect8">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										195
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/grind.1WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										195
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/grind.1WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,195 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>GRIND(1) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| grind - process WordNet lexicographer files   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">SYNOPSIS </A></H2> | ||||
| <B>grind </B> [ <B>-v  | ||||
| </B> ] [ <B>-s </B> ] [ <B>-L </B><I>logfile </I> ] [ <B>-a </B> ] [ <B>-d </B> ] [ <B>-i </B> ] [ <B>-o </B> ] [ <B>-n </B> ] <I>filename </I>  | ||||
| [ <I>filename </I>... ]   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| <B>grind() </B> processes WordNet lexicographer files,  | ||||
| producing database files suitable for use with the WordNet search and  | ||||
| interface code and other applications.  The syntactic and structural integrity  | ||||
| of the input files is verified.  Warnings and errors are reported via <B>stderr  | ||||
| </B> and a run-time log is produced on <B>stdout </B>.  A database is generated only  | ||||
| if there are no errors.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">Input Files </A></H3> | ||||
| Input files correspond to the syntactic  | ||||
| categories implemented in WordNet - <B>noun</B>, <B></B> <B>verb</B>, <B></B> <B>adjective</B> and <B></B> <B>adverb</B>.  | ||||
| Each input lexicographer file consists of a list of synonym sets (<I>synsets  | ||||
| </I>) for one part of speech.  Although the basic synset syntax is the same  | ||||
| for all of the parts of speech, some parts of the syntax only apply to  | ||||
| a particular part of speech.  See <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)<B></B></A> | ||||
|  for a description of the  | ||||
| input file format. <P> | ||||
|  Each <I>filename </I> specified is of the form: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote>  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  where  | ||||
| <I>pathname </I> is optional and <I>pos </I> is either <B>noun</B>, <B></B> <B>verb</B>, <B></B> <B>adj</B> or <B></B> <B>adv</B>. <I>suffix  | ||||
| </I> may be used to separate groups of synsets into different files, for example  | ||||
| <B>noun.animal </B> and <B>noun.plant </B>.  One or more input files, in any combination  | ||||
| of syntactic categories, may be specified.  See <B><A HREF="lexnames.5WN.html">lexnames</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a list  | ||||
| of the lexicographer files used to build the complete WordNet database.  | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">Output Files </A></H3> | ||||
| <B>grind() </B> produces the following output files: <P> | ||||
|   <TABLE BORDER=0> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Filename  | ||||
| </B></TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>Description  </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>index.<I>pos </I></B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Index file for each syntactic category </TD>  | ||||
| </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>data.<I>pos </I></B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Data file for each syntactic category </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>index.sense </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Sense  | ||||
| index </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  </TABLE> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  See  <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)<B></B></A> | ||||
|  for a description of the database file formats.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  Each time <B>grind() </B> is run, any existing database files are overwritten  | ||||
| with the database files generated from the specified input files.  If no  | ||||
| input files from a syntactic category are specified, the corresponding  | ||||
| database files are not overwritten.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">Sense Numbers </A></H3> | ||||
| Senses are generally  | ||||
| ordered from most to least frequently used, with the most common sense  | ||||
| numbered <B>1 </B>.  Frequency of use is determined by the number of times a sense  | ||||
| is tagged in the various semantic concordance texts.  Senses that are not  | ||||
| semantically tagged follow the ordered senses in an arbitrary order.    | ||||
| Note that this ordering is only an estimate based on usage in a small  | ||||
| corpus. <P> | ||||
|  The <I>tagsense_cnt </I> field for each entry in the <B>index.<I>pos </I></B> files  | ||||
| indicates how many of the senses in the list have been tagged. <P> | ||||
|  The <B>cntlist  | ||||
| </B> file provided with the database lists the number of times each sense  | ||||
| is tagged in the semantic concordances. <B>grind() </B> uses the data from <B>cntlist  | ||||
| </B> to order the senses of each word.  When the <B>index </B>.<I>pos </I> files are generated,  | ||||
| the <I>synset_offset </I>s are output in sense number order, with sense 1 first  | ||||
| in the list.  Senses with the same number of semantic tags are assigned  | ||||
| unique but consecutive sense numbers.  The WordNet <FONT SIZE=-1><B>OVERVIEW </B></FONT> | ||||
|   search displays  | ||||
| all senses of the specified word, in all syntactic categories, and indicates  | ||||
| which of the senses are represented in the semantically tagged texts.   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">OPTIONS </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-v</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Verify integrity of input without generating database. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-s</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Suppress  | ||||
| generation of warning messages.  Usually <B>grind </B> is run with this option  | ||||
| until all syntactic and structural errors are corrected since the warning  | ||||
| messages may make it difficult to spot error messages. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-L</B><I>logfile</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Write  | ||||
| all messages to <I>logfile </I> instead of <B>stderr </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-a</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Generate statistical report  | ||||
| on input files processed. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-d</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Generate distribution of senses by string  | ||||
| length report on input files processed.  </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-i</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Generate sense index file. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-o</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Order senses using <B>cntlist </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-n</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Generate nominalization (derivational  | ||||
| morphology) links in database. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>filename</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Input file of the form described  | ||||
| in  <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Input </B></FONT> | ||||
|   </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect7" HREF="#toc7">FILES </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B><I>pos </I>.*</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>lexicographer files to use to build database  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>cntlist</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>file of combined semantic concordance <B>cntlist </B> files.  Used to  | ||||
| assign sense numbers in WordNet database </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect8" HREF="#toc8">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="cntlist.5WN.html">cntlist</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="lexnames.5WN.html">lexnames</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="senseidx.5WN.html">senseidx</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="uniqbeg.7WN.html">uniqbeg</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wngloss.7WN.html">wngloss</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| .   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect9" HREF="#toc9">DIAGNOSTICS  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| Exit status is normally 0. Exit status is -1 if non-specific error occurs.  | ||||
| If syntactic or structural errors exist, exit status is number of errors  | ||||
| detected.  | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>usage: grind [-v] [-s] [-Llogfile] [-a ] [-d] [-i] [-o] [-n] filename  | ||||
| [filename...]</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Invalid options were specified on the command line. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>No input  | ||||
| files processed.</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>None of the filenames specified were of the appropriate  | ||||
| form. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B><I>n </I> syntactic errors found.</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Syntax errors were found while parsing  | ||||
| the input files. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B><I>n </I> structural errors found.</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Pointer errors were found  | ||||
| that could not be automatically corrected. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect10" HREF="#toc10">BUGS </A></H2> | ||||
| Please report bugs to  | ||||
| <B>wordnet@princeton.edu </B>. <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">SYNOPSIS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">Input Files</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">Output Files</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">Sense Numbers</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">OPTIONS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc7" HREF="#sect7">FILES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc8" HREF="#sect8">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc9" HREF="#sect9">DIAGNOSTICS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc10" HREF="#sect10">BUGS</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										195
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/lexnames.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										195
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/lexnames.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,195 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>LEXNAMES(5WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| List of WordNet lexicographer file names and numbers   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| During WordNet development synsets are organized into forty-five lexicographer  | ||||
| files based on syntactic category and logical groupings. <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
|  processes  | ||||
| these files and produces a database suitable for use with the WordNet  | ||||
| library, interface code, and other applications.  The format of the lexicographer  | ||||
| files is described in <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
|  A file number corresponds to each  | ||||
| lexicographer file.  File numbers are encoded in several parts of the WordNet  | ||||
| system as an efficient way to indicate a lexicographer file name.  The  | ||||
| file <B>lexnames </B> lists the mapping between file names and numbers, and can  | ||||
| be used by programs or end users to correlate the two.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">File Format </A></H3> | ||||
| Each  | ||||
| line in <B>lexnames </B> contains 3 tab separated fields, and is terminated with  | ||||
| a newline character.  The first field is the two digit decimal integer  | ||||
| file number.  (The first file in the list is numbered <B>00 </B>.)  The second  | ||||
| field is the name of the lexicographer file that is represented by that  | ||||
| number, and the third field is an integer that indicates the syntactic  | ||||
| category of the synsets contained in the file. This is simply a shortcut  | ||||
| for programs and scripts, since the syntactic category is also part of  | ||||
| the lexicographer file's name.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">Syntactic Category </A></H3> | ||||
| The syntactic category  | ||||
| field is encoded as follows: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><B>1 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> NOUN <BR> | ||||
|  <B>2 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> VERB <BR> | ||||
|  <B>3 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADJECTIVE <BR> | ||||
|  <B>4 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADVERB <BR> | ||||
|   | ||||
|  </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">Lexicographer Files </A></H3> | ||||
| The names of the lexicographer files and their corresponding  | ||||
| file numbers are listed below along with a brief description each file's  | ||||
| contents.  <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote> <TABLE BORDER=0> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>File Number </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>Name </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>Contents </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>00 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>adj.all </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>all adjective  | ||||
| clusters </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>01 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>adj.pert </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>relational adjectives (pertainyms) </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>02 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>adv.all  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>all adverbs </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>03 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.Tops </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>unique beginner for nouns </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>04 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.act  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting acts or actions  </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>05 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.animal </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting animals  | ||||
| </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>06 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.artifact </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting man-made objects </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>07 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.attribute  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting attributes of people and objects   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>08 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.body </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns  | ||||
| denoting body parts   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>09 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.cognition </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting cognitive processes  | ||||
| and contents </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>10 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.communication </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting communicative processes  | ||||
| and contents   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>11 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.event </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting natural events   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>12  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.feeling </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting feelings and emotions   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>13 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.food </TD>  | ||||
| <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting foods and drinks   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>14 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.group </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting groupings  | ||||
| of people or objects   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>15 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.location </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting spatial position  | ||||
|  </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>16 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.motive </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting goals   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>17 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.object </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting  | ||||
| natural objects (not man-made)   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>18 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.person   </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting people  | ||||
| </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>19 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.phenomenon </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting natural phenomena   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>20 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.plant  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting plants  </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>21 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.possession </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting possession  | ||||
| and transfer of possession   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>22 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.process </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting natural  | ||||
| processes   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>23 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.quantity </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting quantities and units of  | ||||
| measure   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>24 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.relation </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting relations between people  | ||||
| or things or ideas   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>25 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.shape </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting two and three dimensional  | ||||
| shapes   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>26 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.state </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting stable states of affairs   </TD>  | ||||
| </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>27 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.substance </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns denoting substances   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>28 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun.time </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>nouns  | ||||
| denoting time and temporal relations   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>29 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.body </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of grooming,  | ||||
| dressing and bodily care   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>30 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.change </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of size, temperature  | ||||
| change, intensifying, etc.   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>31 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.cognition </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of thinking, judging,  | ||||
| analyzing, doubting   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>32 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.communication </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of telling, asking,  | ||||
| ordering, singing   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>33 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.competition </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of fighting, athletic  | ||||
| activities   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>34 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.consumption </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of eating and drinking   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>35 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.contact </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of touching, hitting, tying, digging   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>36 </TD>  | ||||
| <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.creation </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of sewing, baking, painting, performing   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>37 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.emotion  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of feeling   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>38 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.motion </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of walking, flying, swimming  | ||||
|   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>39 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.perception </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of seeing, hearing, feeling  </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>40 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.possession  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of buying, selling, owning   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>41 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.social </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of political  | ||||
| and social activities and events   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>42 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.stative </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of being,  | ||||
| having, spatial relations   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>43 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb.weather </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verbs of raining, snowing,  | ||||
| thawing, thundering   </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>44 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>adj.ppl </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>participial adjectives </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  </TABLE> | ||||
|  </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">NOTES  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| The lexicographer files are not included in the WordNet database package.  | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNHOME</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  Default  | ||||
| is <B>/usr/local/WordNet-3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNSEARCHDIR</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Directory in which the WordNet database  | ||||
| has been installed.   Default is <B>WNHOME/dict </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect7" HREF="#toc7">REGISTRY (WINDOWS) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\WordNet\3.0\WNHome</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  Default is <B>C:\Program Files\WordNet\3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect8" HREF="#toc8">FILES  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>lexnames</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>list of lexicographer file names and numbers </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect9" HREF="#toc9">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnintro.5WN.html">wnintro</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">File Format</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">Syntactic Category</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">Lexicographer Files</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc7" HREF="#sect7">REGISTRY (WINDOWS)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc8" HREF="#sect8">FILES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc9" HREF="#sect9">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										109
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/morph.3WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										109
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/morph.3WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,109 @@ | |||
| <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>MORPH(3WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| morphinit, re_morphinit, morphstr, morphword   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">SYNOPSIS </A></H2> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| <B>#include  | ||||
| "wn.h" </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>int morphinit(void); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>int re_morphinit(void); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>char *morphstr(char  | ||||
| *origstr, int pos); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>char *morphword(char *word, int pos); </B>   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">DESCRIPTION  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| The WordNet morphological processor, Morphy, is accessed through these  | ||||
| functions: <P> | ||||
| <B>morphinit()</B> is used to open the exception list files.  It returns  | ||||
| <B>0 </B> if successful, <B>-1 </B> otherwise.  The exception list files must be opened  | ||||
| before <B>morphstr() </B> or <B>morphword()</B> are called. <P> | ||||
| <B>re_morphinit()</B> is used to  | ||||
| close the exception list files and reopen them, and is used exclusively  | ||||
| for WordNet development.  Return codes are as described above. <P> | ||||
| <B>morphstr()</B>  | ||||
| is the basic user interface to Morphy.  It tries to find the base form  | ||||
| (lemma) of the word or collocation <I>origstr </I> in the specified <I>pos </I>.  The  | ||||
| first call (with <I>origstr </I> specified) returns a pointer to the first base  | ||||
| form found.  Subsequent calls requesting base forms of the same string  | ||||
| must be made with the first argument of <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL. </B></FONT> | ||||
|   When no more base forms  | ||||
| for <I>origstr </I> can be found, <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   is returned.  Note that <B>morphstr() </B> returns  | ||||
| a pointer to a static character buffer.  A subsequent call to <B>morphstr()  | ||||
| </B> with a new string (instead of <B>NULL </B>) will overwrite the string pointed  | ||||
| to by a previous call.  Users should copy the returned string into a local  | ||||
| buffer, or use the C library function <B>strdup </B> to duplicate the returned  | ||||
| string into a <I>malloc'd </I> buffer. <P> | ||||
| <B>morphword()</B> tries to find the base form  | ||||
| of <I>word </I> in the specified <I>pos </I>. This function is called by <B>morphstr()</B> for  | ||||
| each individual word in a collocation. Note that <B>morphword() </B> returns a  | ||||
| pointer to a static character buffer.  A subsequent call to <B>morphword()  | ||||
| </B>  will overwrite the string pointed to by a previous call.  Users should  | ||||
| copy the returned string into a local buffer, or use the C library function  | ||||
| <B>strdup </B> to duplicate the returned string into a <I>malloc'd </I> buffer.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">NOTES  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| <B>morphinit()</B> is called by  <B>wninit() </B> and is not intended to be called directly  | ||||
| by an application. Applications wishing to use WordNet and/or the morphological  | ||||
| functions must call <B>wninit() </B> at the start of the program.  See <B><A HREF="wnutil.3WN.html">wnutil</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
|   | ||||
| for more information. <P> | ||||
|  <I>origstr </I> may be either a word or a collocation formed  | ||||
| by joining individual words with underscore characters (<B>_ </B>). <P> | ||||
|  Usually only  | ||||
| <B>morphstr() </B> is called from applications, as it works on both words and  | ||||
| collocations. <P> | ||||
|  <I>pos </I> must be one of the following: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><B>1 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> NOUN <BR> | ||||
|  <B>2 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> VERB <BR> | ||||
|  <B>3 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADJECTIVE  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|  <B>4 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADVERB <BR> | ||||
|  <B>5 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADJECTIVE_SATELLITE <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  If  <FONT SIZE=-1><B>ADJECTIVE_SATELLITE </B></FONT> | ||||
|   is passed,  | ||||
| it is treated by <B>morphstr() </B> as <FONT SIZE=-1><B>ADJECTIVE. </B></FONT> | ||||
|     | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnintro.3WN.html">wnintro</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnsearch.3WN.html">wnsearch</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="morphy.7WN.html">morphy</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">WARNINGS </A></H2> | ||||
| Passing an invalid part of speech will  | ||||
| result in a core dump. <P> | ||||
|  The WordNet database files must be open to use  | ||||
| <B>morphstr() </B> or <B>morphword().  <P> | ||||
|   </B> | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">BUGS </A></H2> | ||||
| Morphy will allow non-words to be converted  | ||||
| to words, if they follow one of the rules described above.  For example,  | ||||
| it will happily convert <B>plantes </B> to <B>plants </B>. <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">SYNOPSIS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">WARNINGS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">BUGS</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										221
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/morphy.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										221
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/morphy.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,221 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>MORPHY(7WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| morphy - discussion of WordNet's morphological processing   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| Although only base forms of words are usually stored in WordNet, searches  | ||||
| may be done on inflected forms.  A set of morphology functions, Morphy,  | ||||
| is applied to the search string to generate a form that is present in  | ||||
| WordNet. <P> | ||||
|  Morphology in WordNet uses two types of processes to try to convert  | ||||
| the string passed into one that can be found in the WordNet database. There  | ||||
| are lists of inflectional endings, based on syntactic category, that can  | ||||
| be detached from individual words in an attempt to find a form of the  | ||||
| word that is in WordNet.  There are also exception list files, one for  | ||||
| each syntactic category, in which a search for an inflected form is done.  | ||||
|  Morphy tries to use these two processes in an intelligent manner to translate  | ||||
| the string passed to the base form found in WordNet.  Morphy first checks  | ||||
| for exceptions, then uses the rules of detachment.  The Morphy functions  | ||||
| are not independent from WordNet. After each transformation, WordNet is  | ||||
| searched for the resulting string in the syntactic category specified.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  The Morphy functions are passed a string and a syntactic category.  A  | ||||
| string is either a single word or a collocation.  Since some words, such  | ||||
| as <B>axes </B> can have more than one base form (<B>axe </B> and <B>axis </B>), Morphy works  | ||||
| in the following manner.  The first time that Morphy is called with a specific  | ||||
| string, it returns a base form. For each subsequent call to Morphy made  | ||||
| with a  <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   string argument, Morphy returns another base form.  Whenever  | ||||
| Morphy cannot perform a transformation, whether on the first call for  | ||||
| a word or subsequent calls, <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   is returned.  A transformation to a  | ||||
| valid English string will return  <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   if the base form of the string  | ||||
| is not in WordNet. <P> | ||||
|  The morphological functions are found in the WordNet  | ||||
| library.  See <B><A HREF="morph.3WN.html">morph</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
|  for information on using these functions.     | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">Rules  | ||||
| of Detachment </A></H3> | ||||
| The following table shows the rules of detachment used by  | ||||
| Morphy.  If a word ends with one of the suffixes, it is stripped from the  | ||||
| word and the corresponding ending is added.  Then WordNet is searched for  | ||||
| the resulting string.  No rules are applicable to adverbs. <P> | ||||
|   <TABLE BORDER=0> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>POS </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Suffix  | ||||
| </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Ending </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>NOUN </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"s" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>NOUN </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"ses" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"s" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>NOUN </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"xes" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"x" </TD>  | ||||
| </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>NOUN </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"zes" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"z" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>NOUN </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"ches" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"ch" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>NOUN </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"shes" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"sh" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>NOUN  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"men" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"man" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>NOUN </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"ies" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"y" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>VERB </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"s" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>VERB </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"ies" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"y"  | ||||
| </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>VERB </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"es" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"e" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>VERB </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"es" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>VERB </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"ed" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"e" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>VERB </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"ed"  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>VERB </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"ing" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"e" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>VERB </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"ing" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ADJ </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"er" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ADJ </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"est"  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ADJ </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"er" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"e" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ADJ </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"est" </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>"e" </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  </TABLE> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">Exception Lists </A></H3> | ||||
| There is one  | ||||
| exception list file for each syntactic category.  The exception lists contain  | ||||
| the morphological transformations for strings that are not regular and  | ||||
| therefore cannot be processed in an algorithmic manner.  Each line of an  | ||||
| exception list contains an inflected form of a word or collocation, followed  | ||||
| by one or more base forms.  The list is kept in alphabetical order and  | ||||
| a binary search is used to find words in these lists.  See <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for  | ||||
| information on the format of the exception list files.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">Single Words </A></H3> | ||||
| In  | ||||
| general, single words are relatively easy to process.  Morphy first looks  | ||||
| for the word in the exception list.  If it is found the first base form  | ||||
| is returned.  Subsequent calls with a <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   argument return additional  | ||||
| base forms, if present.  A <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   is returned when there are no more base  | ||||
| forms of the word. <P> | ||||
|  If the word is not found in the exception list corresponding  | ||||
| to the syntactic category, an algorithmic process using the rules of detachment  | ||||
| looks for a matching suffix.  If a matching suffix is found, a corresponding  | ||||
| ending is applied (sometimes this ending is a <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   string, so in effect  | ||||
| the suffix is removed from the word), and WordNet is consulted to see  | ||||
| if the resulting word is found in the desired part of speech.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">Collocations  | ||||
| </A></H3> | ||||
| As opposed to single words, collocations can be quite difficult to transform  | ||||
| into a base form that is present in WordNet.  In general, only base forms  | ||||
| of words, even those comprising collocations, are stored in WordNet, such  | ||||
| as <B>attorney general </B>.  Transforming the collocation <B>attorneys general </B>  | ||||
| is then simply a matter of finding the base forms of the individual words  | ||||
| comprising the collocation. This usually works for nouns, therefore non-conforming  | ||||
| nouns, such as <B>customs duty </B> are presently entered in the noun exception  | ||||
| list. <P> | ||||
|  Verb collocations that contain prepositions, such as <B>ask for it  | ||||
| </B>, are more difficult.  As with single words, the exception list is searched  | ||||
| first.  If the collocation is not found, special code in Morphy determines  | ||||
| whether a verb collocation includes a preposition. If it does, a function  | ||||
| is called to try to find the base form in the following manner.  It is  | ||||
| assumed that the first word in the collocation is a verb and that the  | ||||
| last word is a noun.  The algorithm then builds a search string with the  | ||||
| base forms of the verb and noun, leaving the remainder of the collocation  | ||||
| (usually just the preposition, but more words may be involved) in the  | ||||
| middle.  For example, passed <B>asking for it </B>, the database search would  | ||||
| be performed with <B>ask for it </B>, which is found in WordNet, and therefore  | ||||
| returned from Morphy.  If a verb collocation does not contain a preposition,  | ||||
| then the base form of each word in the collocation is found and WordNet  | ||||
| is searched for the resulting string.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">Hyphenation </A></H3> | ||||
| Hyphenation also presents  | ||||
| special difficulties when searching WordNet. It is often a subjective decision  | ||||
| as to whether a word is hyphenated, joined as one word, or is a collocation  | ||||
| of several words, and which of the various forms are entered into WordNet.  | ||||
|  When Morphy breaks a string into "words", it looks for both spaces and  | ||||
| hyphens as delimiters.  It also looks for periods in strings and removes  | ||||
| them if an exact match is not found.  A search for an abbreviation like  | ||||
| <B>oct. </B> return the synset for <B>{ October, Oct } </B>.  Not every pattern of hyphenated  | ||||
| and collocated string is searched for properly, so it may be advantageous  | ||||
| to specify several search strings if the results of a search attempt seem  | ||||
| incomplete.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect7" HREF="#toc7">Special Processing for nouns ending with 'ful' </A></H3> | ||||
| Morphy contains  | ||||
| code that searches for nouns ending with <B>ful </B> and performs a transformation  | ||||
| on the substring preceeding it.  It then appends 'ful' back onto the resulting  | ||||
| string and returns it. For example, if passed the nouns <B>boxesful </B>, it will  | ||||
| return <B>boxful </B>.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect8" HREF="#toc8">BUGS </A></H2> | ||||
| Since many noun collocations contains prepositions,  | ||||
| such as <B>line of products </B>, an algorithm similar to that used for verbs  | ||||
| should be written for nouns.  In the present scheme, if Morphy is passed  | ||||
| <B>lines of products </B>, the search string becomes <B>line of product </B>, which  | ||||
| is not in WordNet <P> | ||||
|  Morphy will allow non-words to be converted to words,  | ||||
| if they follow one of the rules described above.  For example, it will  | ||||
| happily convert <B>plantes </B> to <B>plants </B>.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect9" HREF="#toc9">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNHOME</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  Default is <B>/usr/local/WordNet-3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNSEARCHDIR</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Directory in which the WordNet database has been installed.   Default  | ||||
| is <B>WNHOME/dict </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect10" HREF="#toc10">REGISTRY (WINDOWS) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\WordNet\3.0\WNHome</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  Default is <B>C:\Program Files\WordNet\3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect11" HREF="#toc11">FILES  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B><I>pos </I>.exc</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>morphology exception lists </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect12" HREF="#toc12">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wn.1WN.html">wn</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnb.1WN.html">wnb</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="binsrch.3WN.html">binsrch</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="morph.3WN.html">morph</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wninput.7WN.html">wninput</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">Rules of Detachment</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">Exception Lists</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">Single Words</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">Collocations</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">Hyphenation</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc7" HREF="#sect7">Special Processing for nouns ending with 'ful'</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc8" HREF="#sect8">BUGS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc9" HREF="#sect9">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc10" HREF="#sect10">REGISTRY (WINDOWS)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc11" HREF="#sect11">FILES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc12" HREF="#sect12">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										318
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/prologdb.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										318
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/prologdb.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,318 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>PROLOGDB(5WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| wn_pl - description of Prolog database files   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| The files  | ||||
| <B>wn_ </B><I>* </I><B>.pl </B> contain the WordNet database in a prolog-readable format.  A prolog  | ||||
| interface to WordNet is not implemented. <P> | ||||
|  The prolog database is very large  | ||||
| and may take many minutes to load into the Prolog workspace.  A separate  | ||||
| file has been created for each WordNet relation giving the user the ability  | ||||
| to load only those parts of the database that they are interested. <P> | ||||
|  See  | ||||
| <B>FILES </B>, below, for a list of the database files and <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  and <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)<B></B></A> | ||||
|   | ||||
| for detailed descriptions of the various WordNet relations (referred to  | ||||
| as <I>operators </I> in this manual page).   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">File Format </A></H3> | ||||
| Each prolog database file  | ||||
| contains information corresponding to the synsets and word senses contained  | ||||
| in the WordNet database.  In the prolog version of the database, the <I>synset_id  | ||||
| </I>s (defined below) are used as unique synset identifiers. <P> | ||||
|  Each line of  | ||||
| a file contains an operator that corresponds to a WordNet relation.  All  | ||||
| lines with the same <I>operator </I> value are stored in the file <B>wn_ </B><I>operator  | ||||
| </I><B>.pl </B>. <P> | ||||
|  The general format of a line in a prolog database file is as follows:  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><I>operator<B>(<I>field1<B>,<I>  ...  <B>,<I>fieldn<B>). </B></I></B></I></B></I></B></I> <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  Each line contains the name of the  | ||||
| operator, followed by a left parenthesis, a comma-separated list of fields,  | ||||
| a right parenthesis, and a period.  Note there are no spaces, and each  | ||||
| line is terminated with a newline character.    | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">Operators </A></H3> | ||||
| Each WordNet relation  | ||||
| is represented in a separate file by <I>operator </I> name.  Some operators are  | ||||
| reflexive (i.e. the "reverse" relation is implicit).  So, for example, if  | ||||
| <B>x </B> is a hypernym of <B>y </B>, <B>y </B> is necessarily a hyponym of <B>x </B>.  In the prolog  | ||||
| database, reflected pointers are usually implied for semantic relations.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  Semantic relations are represented by a pair of <I>synset_id </I>s, in which  | ||||
| the first <I>synset_id </I> is generally the source of the relation and the second  | ||||
| is the target.  If two pairs <I>synset_id </I><B>, </B><I>w_num </I> are present, the operator  | ||||
| represents a lexical relation between word forms. <P> | ||||
|  <B>s(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>w_num<B>,'<I>word<B>',<I>ss_type<B>,<I>sense_number<B>,<I>tag_count<B>).  | ||||
| </B></I></B></I></B></I></B></I></B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>A <B>s </B> operator is present for every word sense in WordNet.  In <B>wn_s.pl  | ||||
| </B>, <I>w_num </I> specifies the word number for <I>word </I> in the synset.  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>g(<I>synset_id<B>,'(<I>gloss<B>)').  | ||||
| </B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>g </B> operator specifies the gloss for a synset.    </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>hyp(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>synset_id<B>).  | ||||
| </B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>hyp </B> operator specifies that the second synset is a hypernym of  | ||||
| the first synset.  This relation holds for nouns and verbs.  The reflexive  | ||||
| operator, hyponym, implies that the first synset is a hyponym of the second  | ||||
| synset.  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>ent(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>synset_id<B>). </B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>ent </B> operator specifies that the  | ||||
| second synset is an entailment of first synset.  This relation only holds  | ||||
| for verbs.  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>sim(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>synset_id<B>). </B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>sim </B> operator specifies that  | ||||
| the second synset is similar in meaning to the first synset.  This means  | ||||
| that the second synset is a satellite the first synset, which is the cluster  | ||||
| head.  This relation only holds for adjective synsets contained in adjective  | ||||
| clusters.  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>mm(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>synset_id<B>). </B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>mm </B> operator specifies that the  | ||||
| second synset is a member meronym of the first synset.  This relation only  | ||||
| holds for nouns.  The reflexive operator, member holonym, can be implied.  | ||||
|  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>ms(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>synset_id<B>). </B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>ms </B> operator specifies that the second  | ||||
| synset is a substance meronym of the first synset.  This relation only  | ||||
| holds for nouns.  The reflexive operator, substance holonym, can be implied.  | ||||
|  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>mp(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>synset_id<B>). </B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>mp </B> operator specifies that the second  | ||||
| synset is a part meronym of the first synset.  This relation only holds  | ||||
| for nouns.  The reflexive operator, part holonym, can be implied.  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>cs(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>synset_id<B>).  | ||||
| </B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>cs </B> operator specifies that the second synset is a cause of the  | ||||
| first synset.  This relation only holds for verbs.  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>vgp(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>synset_id<B>).  | ||||
| </B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>vgp </B> operator specifies verb synsets that are similar in meaning  | ||||
| and should be grouped together when displayed in response to a grouped  | ||||
| synset search.  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>at(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>synset_id<B>). </B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>at </B> operator defines the  | ||||
| attribute relation between noun and adjective synset pairs in which the  | ||||
| adjective is a value of the noun. For each pair, both relations are listed  | ||||
| (ie. each <I>synset_id </I> is both a source and target).  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>ant(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>w_num<B>,<I>synset_id<B>,<I>w_num<B>).  | ||||
| </B></I></B></I></B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>ant </B> operator specifies antonymous <I>word </I>s.  This is a lexical relation  | ||||
| that holds for all syntactic categories.  For each antonymous pair, both  | ||||
| relations are listed (ie. each <I>synset_id,w_num </I> pair is both a source and  | ||||
| target word.)  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>sa(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>w_num<B>,<I>synset_id<B>,<I>w_num<B>). </B></I></B></I></B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>sa </B> operator  | ||||
| specifies that additional information about the first word can be obtained  | ||||
| by seeing the second word.  This operator is only defined for verbs and  | ||||
| adjectives.  There is no reflexive relation (ie. it cannot be inferred that  | ||||
| the additional information about the second word can be obtained from  | ||||
| the first word).  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>ppl(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>w_num<B>,<I>synset_id<B>,<I>w_num<B>). </B></I></B></I></B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>ppl </B> operator  | ||||
| specifies that the adjective first word is a participle of the verb second  | ||||
| word.  The reflexive operator can be implied.   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>per(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>w_num<B>,<I>synset_id<B>,<I>w_num<B>).  | ||||
| </B></I></B></I></B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>per </B> operator specifies two different relations based on the parts  | ||||
| of speech involved.  If the first word is in an adjective synset, that  | ||||
| word pertains to either the noun or adjective second word.  If the first  | ||||
| word is in an adverb synset, that word is derived from the adjective second  | ||||
| word.  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>fr(<I>synset_id<B>,<I>f_num<B>,<I>w_num<B>). </B></I></B></I></B></I></B><BR> | ||||
|   <blockquote>The <B>fr </B> operator specifies a generic  | ||||
| sentence frame for one or all words in a synset.  The operator is defined  | ||||
| only for verbs.  </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">Field Definitions </A></H3> | ||||
| A <I>synset_id </I> is a nine byte field in  | ||||
| which the first byte defines the syntactic category of the synset and  | ||||
| the remaining eight bytes are a <I>synset_offset </I>, as defined in  <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| indicating the byte offset in the <B>data. </B><I>pos </I> file that corresponds to the  | ||||
| syntactic category. <P> | ||||
|  The syntactic category is encoded as:   <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><B>1 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> NOUN <BR> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <B>2 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> VERB <BR> | ||||
|  <B>3 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADJECTIVE <BR> | ||||
|  <B>4 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADVERB <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <I>w_num </I>, if present, indicates which word  | ||||
| in the synset is being referred to.  Word numbers are assigned to the <I>word  | ||||
| </I> fields in a synset, from left to right, beginning with 1.  When used to  | ||||
| represent lexical WordNet relations <I>w_num </I> may be 0, indicating that the  | ||||
| relation holds for all words in the synset indicated by the preceding  | ||||
| <I>synset_id </I>.  See <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a discussion of semantic and lexical  | ||||
| relations. <P> | ||||
|  <I>ss_type </I> is a one character code indicating the synset type:  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><B>n </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> NOUN <BR> | ||||
|  <B>v </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> VERB <BR> | ||||
|  <B>a </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADJECTIVE <BR> | ||||
|  <B>s </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADJECTIVE SATELLITE <BR> | ||||
|  <B>r </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADVERB <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <I>sense_number  | ||||
| </I> specifies the sense number of the word, within the part of speech encoded  | ||||
| in the <I>synset_id </I>, in the WordNet database. <P> | ||||
|  <I>word </I> is the ASCII text of  | ||||
| the word as entered in the synset by the lexicographer, with spaces replaced  | ||||
| by underscore characters (<B>_ </B>).  The text of the word is case sensitive.  | ||||
|  An adjective <I>word </I> is immediately followed by a syntactic marker if one  | ||||
| was specified in the lexicographer file.  A syntactic marker is appended,  | ||||
| in parentheses, onto <I>word </I> without any intervening spaces.  See <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|   | ||||
| for a list of the syntactic markers for adjectives. <P> | ||||
|  Each synset has a  | ||||
| <I>gloss </I> that may contain a definition, one or more example sentences, or  | ||||
| both.  Note that glosses are enclosed in single forward quotes and parentheses:  <B>'(<I>gloss<B>)'  | ||||
| </B></I></B>. <P> | ||||
|  <I>f_num </I> specifies the generic sentence frame number for word <I>w_num </I> in  | ||||
| the synset indicated by <I>synset_id </I>.  Note that when <I>w_num </I> is <B>0 </B>, the frame  | ||||
| number applies to all words in the synset.  If non-zero, the frame applies  | ||||
| to that word in the synset. <P> | ||||
|  In WordNet, sense numbers are assigned as  | ||||
| described in  <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| . <I>tag_count </I> is the number of times the sense was  | ||||
| tagged in the Semantic Concordances, and <B>0 </B> if it was not instantiated.  | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">NOTES </A></H2> | ||||
| Since single forward quotes are used to enclose character strings,  | ||||
| single quote characters found in <I>word </I> and <I>gloss </I> fields are represented  | ||||
| as two adjacent single quote characters. <P> | ||||
|  The load time can be greatly  | ||||
| reduced by creating "object language" versions of the files, an option  | ||||
| that is supported by some implementations, such as Quintus Prolog.    | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">ENVIRONMENT  | ||||
| VARIABLES (UNIX) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNHOME</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  Default is <B>/usr/local/WordNet-3.0  | ||||
| </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect7" HREF="#toc7">REGISTRY (WINDOWS) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\WordNet\3.0\WNHome</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory  | ||||
| for WordNet.  Default is <B>C:\Program Files\WordNet\3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect8" HREF="#toc8">FILES </A></H2> | ||||
| All files are  | ||||
| in <B>WNHOME/prolog </B> on Unix platforms and <B>WNHome\prolog </B> on Windows platforms  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_s.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>synset pointers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_g.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>gloss pointers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_hyp.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>hypernym pointers  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_ent.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>entailment pointers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_sim.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>similar pointers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_mm.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>member  | ||||
| meronym pointers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_ms.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>substance meronym pointers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_mp.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>part meronym  | ||||
| pointers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_cs.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>cause pointers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_vgp.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>grouped verb pointers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_at.pl</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>attribute pointers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_ant.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>antonym pointers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_sa.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>see also pointers  | ||||
|  </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_ppl.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>participle pointers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_per.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>pertainym pointers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn_fr.pl</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>frame  | ||||
| pointers </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect9" HREF="#toc9">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wngroups.7WN.html">wngroups</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnpkgs.7WN.html">wnpkgs</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| .  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">File Format</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">Operators</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">Field Definitions</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc7" HREF="#sect7">REGISTRY (WINDOWS)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc8" HREF="#sect8">FILES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc9" HREF="#sect9">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										184
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/senseidx.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										184
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/senseidx.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,184 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>SENSEIDX(5WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| index.sense, sense.idx - WordNet's sense index   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| The WordNet  | ||||
| sense index provides an alternate method for accessing synsets and word  | ||||
| senses in the WordNet database.  It is useful to applications that retrieve  | ||||
| synsets or other information related to a specific sense in WordNet, rather  | ||||
| than all the senses of a word or collocation.  It can also be used with  | ||||
| tools like <B>grep </B> and Perl to find all senses of a word in one or more  | ||||
| parts of speech.  A specific WordNet sense, encoded as a <I>sense_key </I>, can  | ||||
| be used as an index into this file to obtain its WordNet sense number,  | ||||
| the database byte offset of the synset containing the sense, and the number  | ||||
| of times it has been tagged in the semantic concordance texts. <P> | ||||
|  Concatenating  | ||||
| the <I>lemma </I> and <I>lex_sense </I> fields of a semantically tagged word (represented  | ||||
| in a <B><wf  </B>... <B>> </B> attribute/value pair) in a semantic concordance file, using  | ||||
| <B>% </B> as the concatenation character, creates the <I>sense_key </I> for that sense,  | ||||
| which can in turn be used to search the sense index file. <P> | ||||
|  A <I>sense_key  | ||||
| </I> is the best way to represent a sense in semantic tagging or other systems  | ||||
| that refer to WordNet senses. <I>sense_key </I>s are independent of WordNet sense  | ||||
| numbers and <I>synset_offset </I>s, which vary between versions of the database.  | ||||
| Using the sense index and a <I>sense_key </I>, the corresponding synset (via  | ||||
| the <I>synset_offset </I>) and WordNet sense number can easily be obtained.  A  | ||||
| mapping from noun <I>sense_key </I>s in WordNet 1.6 to corresponding 2.0 <I>sense_key  | ||||
| </I>s is provided with version 2.0, and is described in <B><A HREF="sensemap.5WN.html">sensemap</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
|  See  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a thorough discussion of the WordNet database files.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">File  | ||||
| Format </A></H3> | ||||
| The sense index file lists all of the senses in the WordNet database  | ||||
| with each line representing one sense.  The file is in alphabetical order,  | ||||
| fields are separated by one space, and each line is terminated with a  | ||||
| newline character. <P> | ||||
|  Each line is of the form: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><I>sense_key  synset_offset  sense_number  tag_cnt  | ||||
| </I>  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <I>sense_key </I> is an encoding of the word sense.  Programs can construct  | ||||
| a sense key in this format and use it as a binary search key into the  | ||||
| sense index file.   The format of a <I>sense_key </I> is described below. <P> | ||||
|  <I>synset_offset  | ||||
| </I> is the byte offset that the synset containing the sense is found at in  | ||||
| the database "data" file corresponding to the part of speech encoded in  | ||||
| the <I>sense_key </I>.  <I>synset_offset </I> is an 8 digit, zero-filled decimal integer,  | ||||
| and can be used with <B><A HREF="fseek.3.html">fseek</B>(3)</A> | ||||
|  to read a synset from the data file.  When  | ||||
| passed to the WordNet library function <B>read_synset() </B> along with the syntactic  | ||||
| category, a data structure containing the parsed synset is returned. <P> | ||||
|  <I>sense_number  | ||||
| </I> is a decimal integer indicating the sense number of the word, within  | ||||
| the part of speech encoded in <I>sense_key </I>, in the WordNet database.  See  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for information about how sense numbers are assigned. <P> | ||||
|  <I>tag_cnt  | ||||
| </I> represents the decimal number of times the sense is tagged in various  | ||||
| semantic concordance texts.  A <I>tag_cnt </I> of <B>0 </B> indicates that the sense  | ||||
| has not been semantically tagged.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">Sense Key Encoding </A></H3> | ||||
| A <I>sense_key </I> is represented  | ||||
| as: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><I>lemma </I><B>% </B><I>lex_sense </I>  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  where <I>lex_sense </I> is encoded as: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><I>ss_type<B>:<I>lex_filenum<B>:<I>lex_id<B>:<I>head_word<B>:<I>head_id  | ||||
| </I></B></I></B></I></B></I></B></I>  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <I>lemma </I> is the ASCII text of the word or collocation as found in the  | ||||
| WordNet database index file corresponding to <I>pos </I>. <I>lemma </I> is in lower case,  | ||||
| and collocations are formed by joining individual words with an underscore  | ||||
| (<B>_ </B>) character. <P> | ||||
|  <I>ss_type </I> is a one digit decimal integer representing the  | ||||
| synset type for the sense.  See <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Synset Type </B></FONT> | ||||
|   below for a listing of the  | ||||
| numbers corresponding to each synset type. <P> | ||||
|  <I>lex_filenum </I> is a two digit  | ||||
| decimal integer representing the name of the lexicographer file containing  | ||||
| the synset for the sense. See <B><A HREF="lexnames.5WN.html">lexnames</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for the list of lexicographer  | ||||
| file names and their corresponding numbers. <P> | ||||
|  <I>lex_id </I> is a two digit decimal  | ||||
| integer that, when appended onto <I>lemma </I>, uniquely identifies a sense within  | ||||
| a lexicographer file. <I>lex_id </I> numbers usually start with <B>00 </B>, and are incremented  | ||||
| as additional senses of the word are added to the same file, although  | ||||
| there is no requirement that the numbers be consecutive or begin with  | ||||
| <B>00 </B>.  Note that a value of <B>00 </B> is the default, and therefore is not present  | ||||
| in lexicographer files.  Only non-default <I>lex_id </I> values must be explicitly  | ||||
| assigned in lexicographer files.  See <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for information on the  | ||||
| format of lexicographer files. <P> | ||||
|  <I>head_word </I> is only present if the sense  | ||||
| is in an adjective satellite synset.  It is the lemma of the first word  | ||||
| of the satellite's head synset. <P> | ||||
|  <I>head_id </I> is a two digit decimal integer  | ||||
| that, when appended onto <I>head_word </I>, uniquely identifies the sense of  | ||||
| <I>head_word </I> within a lexicographer file, as described for <I>lex_id </I>.  There  | ||||
| is a value in this field only if <I>head_word </I> is present.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">Synset Type </A></H3> | ||||
| The  | ||||
| synset type is encoded as follows: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><B>1 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> NOUN <BR> | ||||
|  <B>2 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> VERB <BR> | ||||
|  <B>3 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADJECTIVE <BR> | ||||
|  <B>4 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADVERB  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|  <B>5 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADJECTIVE SATELLITE <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">NOTES </A></H2> | ||||
| For non-satellite senses the <I>head_word  | ||||
| </I> and <I>head_id </I> fields have no values, however the field separator character  | ||||
| (<B>: </B>) is present.    | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNHOME</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory  | ||||
| for WordNet.  Default is <B>/usr/local/WordNet-3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNSEARCHDIR</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Directory in  | ||||
| which the WordNet database has been installed.   Default is <B>WNHOME/dict  | ||||
| </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect7" HREF="#toc7">REGISTRY (WINDOWS) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\WordNet\3.0\WNHome</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory  | ||||
| for WordNet.  Default is <B>C:\Program Files\WordNet\3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect8" HREF="#toc8">FILES </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>index.sense</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>sense  | ||||
| index </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect9" HREF="#toc9">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="binsrch.3WN.html">binsrch</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnsearch.3WN.html">wnsearch</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="lexnames.5WN.html">lexnames</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.5WN.html">wnintro</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="sensemap.5WN.html">sensemap</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">File Format</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">Sense Key Encoding</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">Synset Type</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc7" HREF="#sect7">REGISTRY (WINDOWS)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc8" HREF="#sect8">FILES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc9" HREF="#sect9">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										53
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/uniqbeg.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										53
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/uniqbeg.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,53 @@ | |||
| <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>UNIQBEG(7WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| uniqbeg - unique beginners for noun hierarchies   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| All  | ||||
| of the WordNet noun synsets are organized into hierarchies, headed by  | ||||
| the unique beginner synset for <B>entity </B> in the file <B>noun.Tops </B>.  <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote>{ entity  | ||||
| (that which is perceived or known or inferred to have its own  <BR> | ||||
|  distinct  | ||||
| existence (living or nonliving)) } <BR> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">NOTES </A></H2> | ||||
| The lexicographer files are  | ||||
| not included in the WordNet database package.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">FILES </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>noun.Tops</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>unique beginners  | ||||
| for nouns </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.7WN.html">wnintro</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wngloss.7WN.html">wngloss</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| .  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">FILES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										388
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wn.1WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										388
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wn.1WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,388 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WN(1WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| wn - command line interface to WordNet lexical database     | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">SYNOPSIS  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| <B>wn </B> [ <I>searchstr </I> ] [ <B>-h </B>] [ <B>-g </B> ] [ <B>-a </B> ] [ <B>-l </B> ] [ <B>-o </B> ] [ <B>-s </B> ] [ <B>-n<I># </I></B> ] [  | ||||
| <I>search_option </I>... ]   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| <B>wn() </B> provides a command line interface  | ||||
| to the WordNet database, allowing synsets and relations to be displayed  | ||||
| as formatted text.  For each word, different searches are provided, based  | ||||
| on syntactic category and pointer types.  Although only base forms of words  | ||||
| are usually stored in WordNet, users may search for inflected forms.  A  | ||||
| morphological process is applied to the search string to generate a form  | ||||
| that is present in WordNet. <P> | ||||
|  The command line interface is often useful  | ||||
| when writing scripts to extract information from the WordNet database.  | ||||
|  Post-processing of the output with various scripting tools can reformat  | ||||
| the results as desired.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">OPTIONS </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-h</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Print help text before search results.  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-g</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display textual glosses associated with synsets. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-a</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display lexicographer  | ||||
| file information. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-o</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display synset offset of each synset. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-s</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display each  | ||||
| word's sense numbers in synsets. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-l</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display the WordNet copyright notice,  | ||||
| version number, and license. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-n<I># </I></B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Perform search on sense number <I># </I> only.  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-over </B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display overview of all senses of <I>searchstr </I> in all syntactic categories.  | ||||
|  </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">Search Options </A></H3> | ||||
| Note that the last letter of <I>search_option </I> generally  | ||||
| denotes the part of speech that the search applies to: <B>n </B> for nouns, <B>v  | ||||
| </B> for verbs, <B>a </B> for adjectives, and <B>r </B> for adverbs.  Multiple searches may  | ||||
| be done for <I>searchstr </I> with a single command by specifying all the appropriate  | ||||
| search options. <P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-syns </B>(<I>n </I> | <I>v </I> | <I>a </I> | <I>r </I>)   </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display synonyms and immediate  | ||||
| hypernyms of synsets containing <I>searchstr </I>. Synsets are ordered by estimated  | ||||
| frequency of use.  For adjectives, if <I>searchstr </I> is in a head synset, the  | ||||
| cluster's satellite synsets are displayed in place of hypernyms.  If <I>searchstr  | ||||
| </I> is in a satellite synset, its head synset is also displayed. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-simsv </B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display  | ||||
| verb synonyms and immediate hypernyms of synsets containing <I>searchstr  | ||||
| </I>.  Synsets are grouped by similarity of meaning. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-ants </B>(<I>n </I> | <I>v </I> | <I>a </I> | <I>r </I>)   | ||||
| </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display synsets containing antonyms of <I>searchstr </I>. For adjectives, if <I>searchstr  | ||||
| </I> is in a head synset, <I>searchstr </I> has a direct antonym. The head synset  | ||||
| for the direct antonym is displayed along with the direct antonym's satellite  | ||||
| synsets.  If <I>searchstr </I> is in a satellite synset, <I>searchstr </I> has an indirect  | ||||
| antonym via the head synset, which is displayed. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-faml </B>(<I>n </I> | <I>v </I> | <I>a </I> | <I>r </I>)  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display familiarity and polysemy information for <I>searchstr </I>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-hype </B>(<I>n </I>  | ||||
| | <I>v </I>)  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Recursively display hypernym (superordinate) tree for <I>searchstr  | ||||
| </I> (<I>searchstr </I> <I>IS A KIND OF _____ </I> relation). </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-hypo </B>(<I>n </I> | <I>v </I>)  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display immediate  | ||||
| hyponyms (subordinates) for <I>searchstr </I> (<I>_____ IS A KIND OF </I> <I>searchstr  | ||||
| </I> relation). </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-tree </B>(<I>n </I> | <I>v </I>)  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display hyponym (subordinate) tree for <I>searchstr  | ||||
| </I>.  This is a recursive search that finds the hyponyms of each hyponym. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-coor  | ||||
| </B>(<I>n </I> | <I>v </I>)  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display the coordinates (sisters) of <I>searchstr </I>.  This search  | ||||
| prints the immediate hypernym for each synset that contains <I>searchstr  | ||||
| </I> and the hypernym's immediate hyponyms. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-deri </B>(<I>n </I> | <I>v </I>)  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display derivational  | ||||
| morphology links between noun and verb forms. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-domn </B>(<I>n </I> | <I>v </I> | <I>a </I> | <I>r </I>)  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display  | ||||
| domain that <I>searchstr </I> has been classified in. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-domt </B>(<I>n </I> | <I>v </I> | <I>a </I> | <I>r </I>)  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display  | ||||
| all terms classified as members of the <I>searchstr </I>'s domain. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-subsn</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display  | ||||
| substance meronyms of <I>searchstr </I> (<I>HAS SUBSTANCE </I> relation). </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-partn</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display  | ||||
| part meronyms of <I>searchstr </I> (<I>HAS PART </I> relation). </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-membn</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display member  | ||||
| meronyms of <I>searchstr </I> (<I>HAS MEMBER </I> relation). </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-meron</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display all meronyms  | ||||
| of <I>searchstr </I> (<I>HAS PART, HAS MEMBER, HAS SUBSTANCE </I> relations). </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-hmern</B>   | ||||
| </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display meronyms for <I>searchstr </I> tree.  This is a recursive search that  | ||||
| prints all the meronyms of <I>searchstr </I> and all of its hypernyms. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-sprtn</B>   | ||||
| </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display <I>part of </I> holonyms of <I>searchstr </I> (<I>PART OF </I> relation). </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-smemn</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display  | ||||
| <I>member of </I> holonyms of <I>searchstr </I> (<I>MEMBER OF </I> relation). </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-ssubn</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display  | ||||
| <I>substance of </I> holonyms of <I>searchstr </I> (<I>SUBSTANCE OF </I> relation). </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-holon</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display  | ||||
| all holonyms of <I>searchstr </I> (<I>PART OF, MEMBER OF, SUBSTANCE OF </I> relations).  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-hholn</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display holonyms for <I>searchstr </I> tree.  This is a recursive search  | ||||
| that prints all the holonyms of <I>searchstr </I> and all of each holonym's holonyms.  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-entav</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display entailment relations of <I>searchstr </I>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-framv</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display applicable  | ||||
| verb sentence frames for <I>searchstr </I>.  </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-causv</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display <I>cause to </I> relations  | ||||
| of <I>searchstr </I>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B> -pert </B>(<I>a </I> | <I>r </I>)  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display pertainyms of <I>searchstr </I>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B> -attr </B>(<I>n  | ||||
| </I> | <I>a </I>)  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display adjective values for noun attribute, or noun attributes  | ||||
| of adjective values. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>-grep </B>(<I>n </I> | <I>v </I> | <I>a </I> | <I>r </I>)  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>List compound words containing  | ||||
| <I>searchstr </I> as a substring. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">SEARCH RESULTS </A></H2> | ||||
| The results of a search are  | ||||
| written to the standard output.  For each search, the output consists a  | ||||
| one line description of the search, followed by the search results. <P> | ||||
|  All  | ||||
| searches other than <B>-over </B> list all senses matching the search results  | ||||
| in the following general format.  Items enclosed in italicized square brackets  | ||||
| (<I>[ ... ] </I>) may not be present. <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote>One line listing the number of senses matching  | ||||
| the search request. <P> | ||||
|  Each sense matching the search requested displayed  | ||||
| as follows: <P> | ||||
|  <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> <B>Sense <I>n </I></B> <BR> | ||||
|  <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> <I>[<B>{<I>synset_offset<B>}<I>] [<B><<I>lex_filename<B>><I>]  word1[<B>#<I>sense_number][,  word2...]  | ||||
| </I></B></I></B></I></B></I></B></I></B></I> <BR> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
|  Where <I>n </I> is the sense number of the search word, <I>synset_offset </I> is  | ||||
| the byte offset of the synset in the <B>data.<I>pos </I></B> file corresponding to the  | ||||
| syntactic category, <I>lex_filename </I> is the name of the lexicographer file  | ||||
| that the synset comes from, <I>word1 </I> is the first word in the synset (note  | ||||
| that this is not necessarily the search word) and <I>sense_number </I> is the  | ||||
| WordNet sense number assigned to the preceding word. <I>synset_offset, lex_filename  | ||||
| </I>, and <I>sense_number </I> are generated when the <B>-o, -a, </B> and <B>-s </B> options, respectively,  | ||||
| are specified. <P> | ||||
|  The synsets matching the search requested are printed below  | ||||
| each sense's synset output described above.  Each line of output is preceded  | ||||
| by a marker (usually <B>=> </B>), then a synset, formatted as described above.  | ||||
|  If a search traverses more one level of the tree, then successive lines  | ||||
| are indented by spaces corresponding to its level in the hierarchy.  When  | ||||
| the <B>-g </B> option is specified, synset glosses are displayed in parentheses  | ||||
| at the end of each synset.  Each synset is printed on one line. <P> | ||||
|  Senses  | ||||
| are generally ordered from most to least frequently used, with the most  | ||||
| common sense numbered <B>1 </B>.  Frequency of use is determined by the number  | ||||
| of times a sense is tagged in the various semantic concordance texts.   | ||||
| Senses that are not semantically tagged follow the ordered senses.  Note  | ||||
| that this ordering is only an estimate based on usage in a small corpus.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  Verb senses can be grouped by similarity of meaning, rather than ordered  | ||||
| by frequency of use.  The <B>-simsv </B> search prints all senses that are close  | ||||
| in meaning together, with a line of dashes indicating the end of a group.  | ||||
|  See <B><A HREF="wngroups.7WN.html">wngroups</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a discussion of how senses are grouped. <P> | ||||
|  The <B>-over  | ||||
| </B> search displays an overview of all the senses of the search word in all  | ||||
| syntactic categories.  The results of this search are similar to the <B>-syns  | ||||
| </B> search, however no additional (ex. hypernym) synsets are displayed, and  | ||||
| synset glosses are always printed.  The senses are grouped by syntactic  | ||||
| category, and each synset is annotated as described above with <I>synset_offset  | ||||
| </I>, <I>lex_filename </I>, and <I>sense_number </I> as dictated by the <B>-o, -a, </B> and <B>-s </B> options.  | ||||
|  The overview search also indicates how many of the senses in each syntactic  | ||||
| category are represented in the tagged texts.  This is a way for the user  | ||||
| to determine whether a sense's sense number is based on semantic tagging  | ||||
| data, or was arbitrarily assigned.   For each sense that has appeared in  | ||||
| such texts, the number of semantic tags to that sense are indicated in  | ||||
| parentheses after the sense number. <P> | ||||
|  If a search cannot be performed on  | ||||
| some senses of <I>searchstr </I>, the search results are headed by a string of  | ||||
| the form: <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> X of Y senses of <I>searchstr </I> <BR> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
|  The output of the <B>-deri </B> search  | ||||
| shows word forms that are morphologically related to <B>searchstr </B>. Each word  | ||||
| form pointed to from <I>searchstr </I> is displayed, preceded by <B>RELATED TO-> </B>  | ||||
| and the syntactic category of the link, followed, on the next line, by  | ||||
| its synset.  Printed after the word form is <B># </B><I>n </I> where <I>n </I> indicates the  | ||||
| WordNet sense number of the term pointed to. <P> | ||||
|  The <B>-domn </B> and <B>-domt </B> searches  | ||||
| show the domain that a synset has been classified in and, conversely,  | ||||
| all of the terms that have been assigned to a specific domain.  A domain  | ||||
| is either a <B>TOPIC, </B> <B>REGION </B> or <B>USAGE, </B> as reflected in the specific pointer  | ||||
| character stored in the database, and displayed in the output.  A <B>-domn  | ||||
| </B> search on a term shows the domain, if any, that each synset containing  | ||||
| <I>searchstr </I> has been classified in.  The output display shows the domain  | ||||
| type (<B>TOPIC, </B> <B>REGION </B> or <B>USAGE </B>), followed by the syntactic category of  | ||||
| the domain synset and the terms in the synset.  Each term is followed by  | ||||
| <B># </B><I>n </I> where <I>n </I> indicates the WordNet sense number of the term.  The converse  | ||||
| search, <B>-domt </B>, shows all of the synsets that have been placed into the  | ||||
| domain <I>searchstr </I>, with analogous markers.  <P> | ||||
|  When <B>-framv </B> is specified,  | ||||
| sample illustrative sentences and generic sentence frames are displayed.  | ||||
|  If a sample sentence is found, the base form of <I>search </I> is substituted  | ||||
| into the sentence, and it is printed below the synset, preceded with the  | ||||
| <B>EX: </B> marker.  When no sample sentences are found, the generic sentence  | ||||
| frames are displayed.  Sentence frames that are acceptable for all words  | ||||
| in a synset are preceded by the marker <B>*> </B>.  If a frame is acceptable for  | ||||
| the search word only, it is preceded by the marker <B>=> </B>. <P> | ||||
|  Search results  | ||||
| for adjectives are slightly different from those for other parts of speech.  | ||||
|  When an adjective is printed, its direct antonym, if it has one, is also  | ||||
| printed in parentheses.  When <I>searchstr </I> is in a head synset, all of the  | ||||
| head synset's satellites are also displayed.  The position of an adjective  | ||||
| in relation to the noun may be restricted to the <I>prenominal </I>, <I>postnominal  | ||||
| </I> or <I>predicative </I> position.  Where present, these restrictions are noted  | ||||
| in parentheses. <P> | ||||
|  When an adjective is a participle of a verb, the output  | ||||
| indicates the verb and displays its synset. <P> | ||||
|  When an adverb is derived  | ||||
| from an adjective, the specific adjectival sense on which it is based  | ||||
| is indicated. <P> | ||||
|  The morphological transformations performed by the search  | ||||
| code may result in more than one word to search for.  WordNet automatically  | ||||
| performs the requested search on all of the strings and returns the results  | ||||
| grouped by word.  For example, the verb <B>saw </B> is both the present tense  | ||||
| of <B>saw </B> and the past tense of <B>see </B>.  When passed <I>searchstr </I> <B>saw </B>, WordNet  | ||||
| performs the desired search first on <B>saw </B> and next on <B>see </B>, returning  | ||||
| the list of <B>saw </B> senses and search results, followed by those for <B>see  | ||||
| </B>.  </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">EXIT STATUS </A></H2> | ||||
| <B>wn() </B> normally exits with the number of senses displayed.  | ||||
|  If <I>searchword </I> is not found in WordNet, it exits with <B>0 </B>. <P> | ||||
|  If the WordNet  | ||||
| database cannot be opened, an error messages is displayed and <B>wn() </B> exits  | ||||
| with <B>-1 </B>.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect7" HREF="#toc7">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNHOME</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  | ||||
|  Default is <B>/usr/local/WordNet-3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNSEARCHDIR</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Directory in which the  | ||||
| WordNet database has been installed.   Default is <B>WNHOME/dict </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect8" HREF="#toc8">REGISTRY  | ||||
| (WINDOWS) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\WordNet\3.0\WNHome</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for  | ||||
| WordNet.  Default is <B>C:\Program Files\WordNet\3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect9" HREF="#toc9">FILES </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>index.<I>pos </I></B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>database  | ||||
| index files </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>data.<I>pos </I></B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>database data files </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>*.vrb</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>files of sentences illustrating  | ||||
| the use of verbs </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B><I>pos </I>.exc</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>morphology exception lists </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect10" HREF="#toc10">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnintro.1WN.html">wnintro</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnb.1WN.html">wnb</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.3WN.html">wnintro</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="lexnames.5WN.html">lexnames</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="senseidx.5WN.html">senseidx</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| ,<B></B> <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="morphy.7WN.html">morphy</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wngloss.7WN.html">wngloss</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wngroups.7WN.html">wngroups</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| .   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect11" HREF="#toc11">BUGS </A></H2> | ||||
| Please report bugs to wordnet@princeton.edu.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">SYNOPSIS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">OPTIONS</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">Search Options</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">SEARCH RESULTS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">EXIT STATUS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc7" HREF="#sect7">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc8" HREF="#sect8">REGISTRY (WINDOWS)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc9" HREF="#sect9">FILES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc10" HREF="#sect10">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc11" HREF="#sect11">BUGS</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										524
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnb.1WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										524
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnb.1WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,524 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNB(1WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| wnb - WordNet window-based browser interface    | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">SYNOPSIS </A></H2> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| <B>wnb </B>   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">DESCRIPTION  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| <B>wnb() </B> provides a window-based interface for browsing the WordNet database,  | ||||
| allowing synsets and relations to be displayed as formatted text.  For  | ||||
| each search word, different searches are available based on syntactic  | ||||
| category and information available in the database.   <P> | ||||
|  <B>wnb </B> is written  | ||||
| in Tcl/Tk, which is available for Unix and Windows platforms.  This allows  | ||||
| the same code to work on all supported WordNet platforms without modification.  | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">WNB WINDOWS </A></H2> | ||||
| <B>wnb() </B> was developed with the philosophy that only those  | ||||
| searches and buttons that are applicable at the current time are displayed.  | ||||
|  As a result, the appearance of the interface changes as it is used.  Use  | ||||
| the standard windowing system mouse functions to open and close the WordNet  | ||||
| Browser Window, move the window, and change its size. <P> | ||||
|  The WordNet Browser  | ||||
| Window contains the following areas, from top to bottom:  | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Menubar  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A menubar  | ||||
| runs along the top of the browser window with pulldown menus and button  | ||||
| entitled <B>File </B>, <B>History </B>, <B>Options </B>, and <B>Help </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Search Word Entry   </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Below  | ||||
| the Menubar is a line for entering the search word.  A search word can  | ||||
| be a single word, hyphenated string, or a collocation.  Case is ignored.  | ||||
|  Although only uninflected forms of words are usually stored in WordNet,  | ||||
| users may search for inflected forms.  WordNet's morphological processor  | ||||
| finds the base form automatically. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Search Selection  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Below the Search Word  | ||||
| Entry line is an area for selecting the search type and senses to search.  | ||||
|  Until a search word is entered this area is blank.  After a search word  | ||||
| is entered, buttons appear corresponding to each syntactic category (<B>Noun  | ||||
| </B>, <B>Verb </B>, <B>Adjective </B>, <B>Adverb </B>) in which the search string is defined in  | ||||
| WordNet.   </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  At the right edge of the Search Selection line is a box for  | ||||
| entering sense numbers.  When this box is empty, search results for all  | ||||
| senses of the search word that match the search type are displayed.  The  | ||||
| search may be restricted to one or more specific senses by entering a  | ||||
| comma or space separated list of sense numbers in the <B>Senses </B> box.  These  | ||||
| sense numbers remain in effect until either the user changes or deletes  | ||||
| them, or a new search word is entered.  | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Results Window  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Most of the browser  | ||||
| window consists of a large text buffer for displaying the results of WordNet  | ||||
| searches.  Horizontal and vertical scroll bars are present for scrolling  | ||||
| through the output. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Status Line   </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A status line is at the bottom of the  | ||||
| browser window. When search results are displayed in the Results Window,  | ||||
| this status line reflects the type of search selected.  When there is no  | ||||
| search word entered, your are prompted to <B>"Enter search word and press  | ||||
| return." </B>  If the search word entered is not in WordNet, the message <B>"Sorry,  | ||||
| no matches found." </B> is displayed. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">SEARCHING THE DATABASE </A></H2> | ||||
| The WordNet browser  | ||||
| navigates through WordNet in two steps.  First a search word is entered  | ||||
| and an overview of all the senses of the word in all syntactic categories  | ||||
| is displayed in the Results Window.   The senses are grouped by syntactic  | ||||
| category, and each synset is annotated as described above with <I>synset_offset  | ||||
| </I>, <I>lex_filename </I>, and <I>sense_number </I> as dictated by the advanced search  | ||||
| options set. The overview search also indicates how many of the senses  | ||||
| in each syntactic category are represented in the tagged texts.  This is  | ||||
| a way for the user to determine whether a sense's sense number is based  | ||||
| on semantic tagging data, or was arbitrarily assigned.  For each sense  | ||||
| that has appeared in such texts, the number of semantic tags to that sense  | ||||
| are indicated in parentheses after the sense number. <P> | ||||
|  Then, within a syntactic  | ||||
| category, a specific search is selected.  The desired search is performed  | ||||
| and the search results are displayed in the Results Window.  Additional  | ||||
| searches on the same word can be performed, or a new search word can be  | ||||
| entered. <P> | ||||
|  To enter a search word, click the mouse in the horizontal box  | ||||
| labeled <B>Search Word </B>, type a single word, hyphenated string, or collocation  | ||||
| and press <FONT SIZE=-1><B>RETURN. </B></FONT> | ||||
|   <P> | ||||
|  <B>wnb() </B> responds by making a set of Part of Speech  | ||||
| buttons appear in the Search Selection line.  Each button corresponds to  | ||||
| a syntactic category in which the search string is defined in WordNet.  | ||||
|  At the same time, an Overview of the synsets for all senses of the search  | ||||
| word is displayed in the Results Window.  The Overview includes the gloss  | ||||
| for each synset and also indicates which of the senses have appeared in  | ||||
| the semantically tagged texts.  For each sense that has appeared in such  | ||||
| texts, the number of semantic tags to that sense are indicated in parentheses  | ||||
| after the sense number. <P> | ||||
|  The pulldown menus in the Search Selection line  | ||||
| list all of the WordNet searches that can be performed for the search  | ||||
| word in that part of speech.  To select a search, highlight it by dragging  | ||||
| the mouse to it, and release the mouse while it is highlighted.  Drag the  | ||||
| mouse outside of the pulldown list and release to hide the menu without  | ||||
| making a selection.  Dragging the mouse across the Part of Speech buttons  | ||||
| displays the available searches for each syntactic category. <P> | ||||
|  To restrict  | ||||
| a search to one or more senses within a syntactic category, enter a comma  | ||||
| or space separated list of sense numbers in the <B>Senses </B> box before selecting  | ||||
| a search. <P> | ||||
|  After a search is selected, <B>wnb() </B> performs the search on the  | ||||
| WordNet database and displays the formatted results in the Results Window.  | ||||
|  Whenever search results are displayed, a button entitled <B>Redisplay Overview  | ||||
| </B> is present at the right edge of the Search Word Entry line.  Clicking  | ||||
| on this button redisplays the Overview of all synsets for the search word  | ||||
| in the Results Window.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">Changing the Search Word </A></H3> | ||||
| A new search word can  | ||||
| be entered at any time by moving to the Search Word Entry box, if necessary  | ||||
| highlighting it by clicking, erasing the old string, typing a new one  | ||||
| and pressing <FONT SIZE=-1><B>RETURN. </B></FONT> | ||||
|   The <B>Senses </B> box is cleared if necessary, the Part  | ||||
| of Speech buttons applicable to the new search word appear, and the Overview  | ||||
| for the new search word is displayed.   <P> | ||||
|  The middle mouse button can also  | ||||
| be used to select a new search word by placing the mouse over any word  | ||||
| in the Results Window and clicking.  The selected word will replace the  | ||||
| text in the Search Word Entry box, and the overview for that word will  | ||||
| automatically be displayed. <P> | ||||
|  To select a new search string collocation  | ||||
| from text in the Results Window, highlight the text with the mouse and  | ||||
| press <FONT SIZE=-1><B>CONTROL-S. </B></FONT> | ||||
|   <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">Interrupting a Search </A></H3> | ||||
| When a search is in progress  | ||||
| the message <B>"Searching...(press escape to abort)" </B> is displayed in the Status  | ||||
| Line.  Note that most searches return very quickly, so this message isn't  | ||||
| noticeable.  As indicated, pressing the <FONT SIZE=-1><B>ESCAPE </B></FONT> | ||||
|   key will interrupt the  | ||||
| search.  The results of the search obtained before the time the search  | ||||
| was interrupted are displayed in the Results Window.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect7" HREF="#toc7">MENUS </A></H2> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect8" HREF="#toc8">File Menu  | ||||
| </A></H3> | ||||
|  <blockquote> | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Find keywords by substring </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display a popup window for specifying a search  | ||||
| of WordNet for words or collocations that contain a specific substring.  | ||||
|  If a search word is currently entered in the <B>Search Word </B> box, it is  | ||||
| used as the substring to search for by default.  The Substring Search Window  | ||||
| contains a box for entering a substring, a pulldown menu to its right  | ||||
| for specifying the part of speech to search, a large area for displaying  | ||||
| the search results, and action buttons at the bottom entitled <B>Search </B>,  | ||||
| <B>Save </B>, <B>Print </B> <B>Dismiss </B>.  </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  Once a substring is entered and a part of speech  | ||||
| selected, clicking on the <B>Search </B> button causes a search to be done for  | ||||
| all words and collocations in WordNet, in that syntactic category, that  | ||||
| contain the substring according to the following criteria: <P> | ||||
|  1. The substring  | ||||
| can appear at the beginning or end of a word, hyphenated string o collocation.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  2. The substring can appear in the middle of a hyphenated string or collocation,  | ||||
| but only delimited on both sides by spaces or hyphens. <P> | ||||
|  The search results  | ||||
| are displayed in the large buffer.  Clicking on an item from the search  | ||||
| results list causes <B>wnb() </B> to automatically enter that word in the <B>Search  | ||||
| Word </B> box of the WordNet Browser Window and perform the Overview search.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  Clicking the <B>Save </B> button generates a popup dialog for specifying a filename  | ||||
| to save the substring search results to.  Clicking the <B>Print </B> button generates  | ||||
| a popup dialog in which a print command can be specified. <P> | ||||
|  Selecting <B>Dismiss  | ||||
| </B> closes the Substring Search Window.  | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Save current display </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display a popup  | ||||
| dialog for specifying a filename to save the current Results Window contents  | ||||
| to. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Print current display </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display a popup dialog in which to specify a  | ||||
| print command to which the current Results Window contents can be piped.  | ||||
| Note - this option does not exist in the Windows version. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Clear current  | ||||
| display </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Clear the <B>Search Word </B> and <B>Senses </B> boxes, and Results Window. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Exit  | ||||
| </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Does what you would expect. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|  </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect9" HREF="#toc9">History </A></H3> | ||||
| This pulldown menu contains a list  | ||||
| of the last searches performed. Selecting an item from this list performs  | ||||
| that search again.  The maximum number of searches stored in the list can  | ||||
| be adjusted from the <B>Options </B> menu.  The default is 10.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect10" HREF="#toc10">Options </A></H3> | ||||
|  <blockquote> | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Show help  | ||||
| with each search </DT> | ||||
| <DD>When this checkbox is selected search results are preceded  | ||||
| by some explanatory text about the type of search selected. This is off  | ||||
| by default. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Show descriptive gloss </DT> | ||||
| <DD>When this checkbox is selected, synset  | ||||
| glosses are displayed in all search results.  This is set by default.  Note  | ||||
| that glosses are always displayed in the Overview. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Wrap Lines </DT> | ||||
| <DD>When this  | ||||
| checkbox is selected, lines in the Results Window that are wider than  | ||||
| the window are automatically wrapped.  This is set by default.  If not selected,  | ||||
| a horizontal scroll bar is present if any lines are longer than the width  | ||||
| of the window. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Set advanced search options... </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Selecting this item displays  | ||||
| a popup window for setting the following search options:  <B>Lexical file  | ||||
| information; Synset location in database file; Sense number </B>.  Choices  | ||||
| for each are: </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> <B>Don't show </B> (default) <BR> | ||||
|  <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> <B>Show with searches </B> <BR> | ||||
|  <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> <B>Show with searches  | ||||
| and overview </B> <BR> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
|  When lexical file information is shown, the name of the  | ||||
| lexicographer file is printed before each synset, enclosed in angle brackets  | ||||
| (<B><  <I>...<B>  > </B></I></B>).  When both lexical file information and synset location information  | ||||
| are displayed, the synset location information appears first.  If within  | ||||
| one lexicographer file more than one sense of a word is entered, an integer  | ||||
| <I>lex_id </I> is appended onto all but one of the word's instances to uniquely  | ||||
| identify it.  In each synset, each word having a non-zero <I>lex_id </I> is printed  | ||||
| with the <I>lex_id </I> value printed immediately following the word.  If both  | ||||
| lexicographer information and sense numbers are displayed, <I>lex_id </I>s, if  | ||||
| present, precede sense numbers. <P> | ||||
|  When synset location is shown, the byte  | ||||
| offset of the synset in the database "data" file corresponding to the  | ||||
| syntactic category of the synset is printed before each synset, enclosed  | ||||
| in curly braces (<B>{  <I>...<B>  } </B></I></B>).  When both lexical file information and synset  | ||||
| location information are displayed, the synset location information appears  | ||||
| first. <P> | ||||
|  When sense numbers are shown, the sense number of each word in  | ||||
| each synset is printed immediately after the word, and is preceded by  | ||||
| a number sign (<B># </B>).  | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Set maximum history length... </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display a popup dialog in  | ||||
| which the maximum number of previous searches to be kept on the History  | ||||
| list can be set. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Set font...            </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display a popup window for setting  | ||||
| the font (typeface) and font size to use for the Results Window.  Choices  | ||||
| for typeface are: <B>Courier </B>, <B>Helvetica </B>, and <B>Times </B> (default).  Font size  | ||||
| can be <B>small </B>, <B>medium </B> (default), or <B>large </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Save current options as default  | ||||
| </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Save the currently set options.  Next time the browser is started, these  | ||||
| options will be used as the user defaults. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|  </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect11" HREF="#toc11">Help </A></H3> | ||||
|  <blockquote> | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Help on using the WordNet  | ||||
| browser </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display this manual page. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Help on WordNet terminology </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display the  | ||||
|  <B><A HREF="wngloss.7WN.html">wngloss</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
|  manual page. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>Display the WordNet license </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Display the WordNet  | ||||
| copyright notice and license agreement. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT>About the WordNet browser </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Information  | ||||
| about this application. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|  </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect12" HREF="#toc12">SHORCUTS </A></H2> | ||||
| Clicking on any word in the Results  | ||||
| Window while holding down the  <FONT SIZE=-1><B>SHIFT </B></FONT> | ||||
|   key on the keyboard causes the  | ||||
| browser to replace <B>Search Word </B> with the word and display its Overview  | ||||
| and available searches. Clicking on any word in the Results Window with  | ||||
| the middle mouse button does the same thing. <P> | ||||
|  Pressing the <FONT SIZE=-1><B>CONTROL-S </B></FONT> | ||||
|   keys  | ||||
| causes the browser to do as above on the text that is currently highlighted.  | ||||
|  Under Unix, this will work even if the highlighted text is in another  | ||||
| window.  This works on hyphenated strings and collocations, as well as  | ||||
| individual words. <P> | ||||
|  Pressing the <FONT SIZE=-1><B>CONTROL-G </B></FONT> | ||||
|   keys displays the Substring  | ||||
| Search Window. <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect13" HREF="#toc13">SEARCH RESULTS </A></H2> | ||||
| The results of a search of the WordNet  | ||||
| database are displayed in the Results Window.  Horizontal and vertical  | ||||
| scroll bars are present for scrolling through the search results. <P> | ||||
|  All  | ||||
| searches other than the Overview list all senses matching the search results  | ||||
| in the following general format.  Items enclosed in italicized square brackets  | ||||
| (<I>[ ... ] </I>) may not be present. <P> | ||||
|  If a search cannot be performed on some senses  | ||||
| of <I>searchstr </I>, the search results are headed by a string of the form:  | ||||
| <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> X of Y senses of <I>searchstr </I> <BR> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote>One line listing the number of senses matching  | ||||
| the search selected. <P> | ||||
|  Each sense matching the search selected displayed  | ||||
| as follows: <P> | ||||
|  <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> <B>Sense <I>n </I></B> <BR> | ||||
|  <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> <I>[<B>{<I>synset_offset<B>}<I>] [<B><<I>lex_filename<B>><I>]  word1[<B>#<I>sense_number][,  word2...]  | ||||
| </I></B></I></B></I></B></I></B></I></B></I> <BR> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
|  Where <I>n </I> is the sense number of the search word, <I>synset_offset </I> is  | ||||
| the byte offset of the synset in the <B>data.<I>pos </I></B> file corresponding to the  | ||||
| syntactic category, <I>lex_filename </I> is the name of the lexicographer file  | ||||
| that the synset comes from, <I>word1 </I> is the first word in the synset (note  | ||||
| that this is not necessarily the search word) and <I>sense_number </I> is the  | ||||
| WordNet sense number assigned to the preceding word. <I>synset_offset </I>, <I>lex_filename  | ||||
| </I>, and <I>sense_number </I> are generated if the appropriate Options are specified.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  The synsets matching the search selected are printed below each sense's  | ||||
| synset output described above.  Each line of output is preceded by a marker  | ||||
| (usually <B>=> </B>), then a synset, formatted as described above.  If a search  | ||||
| traverses more one level of the tree, then successive lines are indented  | ||||
| by spaces corresponding to its level in the hierarchy.  Glosses are displayed  | ||||
| in parentheses at the end of each synset if the appropriate Option is  | ||||
| set.  Each synset is printed on one line. <P> | ||||
|  Senses are ordered from most  | ||||
| to least frequently used, with the most common sense numbered <B>1 </B>.  Frequency  | ||||
| of use is determined by the number of times a sense is tagged in the various  | ||||
| semantic concordance texts.  Senses that are not semantically tagged follow  | ||||
| the ordered senses. Note that this ordering is only an estimate based on  | ||||
| usage in a small corpus. <P> | ||||
|  Verb senses can be grouped by similarity of meaning,  | ||||
| rather than ordered by frequency of use.  When the <B>"Synonyms, grouped by  | ||||
| similarity" </B> search is selected, senses that are close in meaning are  | ||||
| printed together, with a line of dashes indicating the end of a group.  | ||||
|  See <B><A HREF="wngroups.7WN.html">wngroups</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a discussion how senses are grouped. <P> | ||||
|  The output  | ||||
| of the <B>"Derivationally Related Forms" </B>  search shows word forms that are  | ||||
| morphologically related to <B>searchstr </B>. Each word form pointed to from <I>searchstr  | ||||
| </I> is displayed, preceded by <B>RELATED TO-> </B> and the syntactic category of the  | ||||
| link, followed, on the next line, by its synset.  Printed after the word  | ||||
| form is <B># </B><I>n </I> where <I>n </I> indicates the WordNet sense number of the term pointed  | ||||
| to. <P> | ||||
|  The <B>"Domain" </B> and <B>"Domain Terms" </B> searches show the domain that a  | ||||
| synset has been classified in and, conversely, all of the terms that have  | ||||
| been assigned to a specific domain.  A domain is either a <B>TOPIC, </B> <B>REGION  | ||||
| </B> or <B>USAGE, </B> as reflected in the specific pointer character stored in the  | ||||
| database, and displayed in the output.  A <B>Domain </B> search on a term shows  | ||||
| the domain, if any, that each synset containing <I>searchstr </I> has been classified  | ||||
| in.  The output display shows the domain type (<B>TOPIC, </B> <B>REGION </B> or <B>USAGE  | ||||
| </B>), followed by the syntactic category of the domain synset and the terms  | ||||
| in the synset.  Each term is followed by <B># </B><I>n </I> where <I>n </I> indicates the WordNet  | ||||
| sense number of the term.  The converse search, <B>Domain Terms </B>, shows all  | ||||
| of the synsets that have been placed into the domain <I>searchstr </I>, with  | ||||
| analogous markers.  <P> | ||||
|  When the <B>"Sentence Frames" </B> search is specified, sample  | ||||
| illustrative sentences and generic sentence frames are displayed.  If a  | ||||
| sample sentence is found, the base form of the search word is substituted  | ||||
| into the sentence, and it is printed below the synset, preceded with the  | ||||
| <B>EX: </B> marker.  When no sample sentences are found, the generic sentence  | ||||
| frames are displayed.  Sentence frames that are acceptable for all words  | ||||
| in a synset are preceded by the marker <B>*> </B>.  If a frame is acceptable for  | ||||
| the search word only, it is preceded by the marker <B>=> </B>. <P> | ||||
|  Search results  | ||||
| for adjectives are slightly different from those for other parts of speech.  | ||||
|  When an adjective is printed, its direct antonym, if it has one, is also  | ||||
| printed in parentheses.  When the search word is in a head synset, all  | ||||
| of the head synset's satellites are also displayed.  The position of an  | ||||
| adjective in relation to the noun may be restricted to the <I>prenominal  | ||||
| </I>, <I>postnominal </I> or <I>predicative </I> position.  Where present, these restrictions  | ||||
| are noted in parentheses. <P> | ||||
|  When an adjective is a participle of a verb,  | ||||
| the output indicates the verb and displays its synset. <P> | ||||
|  When an adverb  | ||||
| is derived from an adjective, the specific adjectival sense on which it  | ||||
| is based is indicated. <P> | ||||
|  The morphological transformations performed by  | ||||
| the search code may result in more than one word to search for.  <B>wnb()  | ||||
| </B> automatically performs the requested search on all of the strings and  | ||||
| returns the results grouped by word.  For example, the verb <B>saw </B> is both  | ||||
| the present tense of <B>saw </B> and the past tense of <B>see </B>.  When there is more  | ||||
| than one word to search for, search results are grouped by word.  </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect14" HREF="#toc14">DIAGNOSTICS  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| If the WordNet database files cannot be opened, error messages are displayed.  | ||||
|  This is usually corrected by setting the environment variables described  | ||||
| below to the proper location of the WordNet database for your installation.  | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect15" HREF="#toc15">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNHOME</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  Default  | ||||
| is <B>/usr/local/WordNet-3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNSEARCHDIR</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Directory in which the WordNet database  | ||||
| has been installed.   Default is <B>WNHOME/dict </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect16" HREF="#toc16">REGISTRY (WINDOWS) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\WordNet\3.0\WNHome</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  Default is <B>C:\Program Files\WordNet\3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>HKEY_CURRENT_USER\SOFTWARE\WordNet\3.0\wnres</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>User's default browser options. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect17" HREF="#toc17">FILES </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>index.<I>pos </I></B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>database index files  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>data.<I>pos </I></B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>database data files </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>*.vrb</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>files of sentences illustrating the  | ||||
| use of verbs </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B><I>pos </I>.exc</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>morphology exception lists </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect18" HREF="#toc18">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnintro.1WN.html">wnintro</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wn.1WN.html">wn</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.3WN.html">wnintro</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="lexnames.5WN.html">lexnames</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="senseidx.5WN.html">senseidx</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| ,<B></B> <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="morphy.7WN.html">morphy</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| ,<B></B> <B><A HREF="wngloss.7WN.html">wngloss</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wngroups.7WN.html">wngroups</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| .   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect19" HREF="#toc19">BUGS </A></H2> | ||||
| Please reports bugs to  | ||||
| wordnet@princeton.edu. <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">SYNOPSIS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">WNB WINDOWS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">SEARCHING THE DATABASE</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">Changing the Search Word</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">Interrupting a Search</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc7" HREF="#sect7">MENUS</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc8" HREF="#sect8">File Menu</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc9" HREF="#sect9">History</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc10" HREF="#sect10">Options</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc11" HREF="#sect11">Help</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc12" HREF="#sect12">SHORCUTS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc13" HREF="#sect13">SEARCH RESULTS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc14" HREF="#sect14">DIAGNOSTICS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc15" HREF="#sect15">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc16" HREF="#sect16">REGISTRY (WINDOWS)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc17" HREF="#sect17">FILES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc18" HREF="#sect18">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc19" HREF="#sect19">BUGS</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										398
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wndb.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										398
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wndb.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,398 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNDB(5WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| index.noun, data.noun, index.verb, data.verb, index.adj, data.adj, index.adv,  | ||||
| data.adv - WordNet database files <P> | ||||
| noun.exc, verb.exc. adj.exc adv.exc - morphology  | ||||
| exception lists <P> | ||||
| sentidx.vrb, sents.vrb - files used by search code to display  | ||||
| sentences illustrating the use of some specific verbs   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| For  | ||||
| each syntactic category, two files are needed to represent the contents  | ||||
| of the WordNet database - <B>index. </B><I>pos </I> and <B>data. </B><I>pos </I>, where <I>pos </I> is <B>noun  | ||||
| </B>, <B>verb </B>, <B>adj </B> and <B>adv </B>.  The other auxiliary files are used by the WordNet  | ||||
| library's searching functions and are needed to run the various WordNet  | ||||
| browsers. <P> | ||||
|  Each index file is an alphabetized list of all the words found  | ||||
| in WordNet in the corresponding part of speech.  On each line, following  | ||||
| the word, is a list of byte offsets (<I>synset_offset </I>s) in the corresponding  | ||||
| data file, one for each synset containing the word. Words in the index  | ||||
| file are in lower case only, regardless of how they were entered in the  | ||||
| lexicographer files.  This folds various orthographic representations of  | ||||
| the word into one line enabling database searches to be case insensitive.  | ||||
|  See <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a detailed description of the lexicographer files  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  A data file for a syntactic category contains information corresponding  | ||||
| to the synsets that were specified in the lexicographer files, with relational  | ||||
| pointers resolved to <I>synset_offset </I>s. Each line corresponds to a synset.  | ||||
|  Pointers are followed and hierarchies traversed by moving from one synset  | ||||
| to another via the <I>synset_offset </I>s.   <P> | ||||
|  The exception list files, <I>pos </I><B>.exc  | ||||
| </B>, are used to help the morphological processor find base forms from irregular  | ||||
| inflections. <P> | ||||
|  The files <B>sentidx.vrb </B> and <B>sents.vrb </B> contain sentences illustrating  | ||||
| the use of specific senses of some verbs.  These files are used by the  | ||||
| searching software in response to a request for verb sentence frames.   | ||||
| Generic sentence frames are displayed when an illustrative sentence is  | ||||
| not present. <P> | ||||
|  The various database files are in ASCII formats that are  | ||||
| easily read by both humans and machines.  All fields, unless otherwise  | ||||
| noted, are separated by one space character, and all lines are terminated  | ||||
| by a newline character.  Fields enclosed in italicized square brackets  | ||||
| may not be present. <P> | ||||
|  See  <B><A HREF="wngloss.7WN.html">wngloss</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a glossary of WordNet terminology  | ||||
| and a discussion of the database's content and logical organization.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">Index  | ||||
| File Format </A></H3> | ||||
| Each index file begins with several lines containing a copyright  | ||||
| notice, version number and license agreement.  These lines all begin with  | ||||
| two spaces and the line number so they do not interfere with the binary  | ||||
| search algorithm that is used to look up entries in the index files.  All  | ||||
| other lines are in the following format.  In the field descriptions, <B>number  | ||||
| </B> always refers to a decimal integer unless otherwise defined. <P> | ||||
|  <I>lemma  pos  synset_cnt  p_cnt  [ptr_symbol...]  sense_cnt  tagsense_cnt  | ||||
|   synset_offset  [synset_offset...] </I> <BR> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>lemma</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>lower case ASCII text of word  | ||||
| or collocation.  Collocations are formed by joining individual words with  | ||||
| an underscore (<B>_ </B>) character. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>pos</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Syntactic category: <B>n </B> for noun files,  | ||||
|  <B>v </B> for verb files, <B>a </B> for adjective files, <B>r </B> for adverb files. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
| All remaining  | ||||
| fields are with respect to senses of <I>lemma </I> in <I>pos </I>. <P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>synset_cnt</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Number  | ||||
| of synsets that <I>lemma </I> is in.  This is the number of senses of the word  | ||||
| in WordNet. See  <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Sense Numbers </B></FONT> | ||||
|  below for a discussion of how sense numbers  | ||||
| are assigned and the order of <I>synset_offset </I>s in the index files. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>p_cnt</I>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Number of different pointers that <I>lemma </I> has in all synsets containing  | ||||
| it. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>ptr_symbol</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A space separated list of <I>p_cnt </I> different types of pointers  | ||||
| that <I>lemma </I> has in all synsets containing it. See <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a list  | ||||
| of <I>pointer_symbol </I>s.  If all senses of <I>lemma </I> have no pointers, this field  | ||||
| is omitted and <I>p_cnt </I> is <B>0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>sense_cnt</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Same as <I>sense_cnt </I> above.  This  | ||||
| is redundant, but the field was preserved for compatibility reasons. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>tagsense_cnt</I>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Number of senses of <I>lemma </I> that are ranked according to their frequency  | ||||
| of occurrence in semantic concordance texts. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>synset_offset</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Byte offset  | ||||
| in <B>data.<I>pos </I></B> file of a synset containing <I>lemma </I>.  Each <I>synset_offset </I> in  | ||||
| the list corresponds to a different sense of <I>lemma </I> in WordNet.  <I>synset_offset  | ||||
| </I> is an 8 digit, zero-filled decimal integer that can be used with <B><A HREF="fseek.3.html">fseek</B>(3)</A> | ||||
|   | ||||
| to read a synset from the data file.  When passed to <B><A HREF="read_synset.3WN.html">read_synset</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
|  along  | ||||
| with the syntactic category, a data structure containing the parsed synset  | ||||
| is returned. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">Data File Format </A></H3> | ||||
| Each data file begins with several lines  | ||||
| containing a copyright notice, version number and license agreement.  These  | ||||
| lines all begin with two spaces and the line number.  All other lines are  | ||||
| in the following format.  Integer fields are of fixed length, and are zero-filled.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <I>synset_offset  lex_filenum  ss_type  w_cnt  word  lex_id  [word  lex_id...]  p_cnt  [ptr...]  [frames...]  <B>|  | ||||
| </B></I><I>  gloss </I> <BR> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>synset_offset</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Current byte offset in the file represented  | ||||
| as an 8 digit decimal integer.  </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>lex_filenum</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Two digit decimal integer  | ||||
| corresponding to the lexicographer file name containing the synset.  See  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="lexnames.5WN.html">lexnames</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for the list of filenames and their corresponding numbers.  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>ss_type</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>One character code indicating the synset type:  </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><B>n </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> NOUN <BR> | ||||
|  <B>v </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> VERB  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|  <B>a </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADJECTIVE <BR> | ||||
|  <B>s </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADJECTIVE SATELLITE <BR> | ||||
|  <B>r </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADVERB <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>w_cnt</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Two digit hexadecimal  | ||||
| integer indicating the number of words in the synset. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>word</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>ASCII form  | ||||
| of a word as entered in the synset by the lexicographer, with spaces replaced  | ||||
| by underscore characters (<B>_ </B>).  The text of the word is case sensitive,  | ||||
| in contrast to its form in the corresponding <B>index. </B><I>pos </I> file, that contains  | ||||
| only lower-case forms.  In <B>data.adj </B>, a <I>word </I> is followed by a syntactic  | ||||
| marker if one was specified in the lexicographer file.  A syntactic marker  | ||||
| is appended, in parentheses, onto <I>word </I> without any intervening spaces.  | ||||
|  See <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a list of the syntactic markers for adjectives. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>lex_id</I>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>One digit hexadecimal integer that, when appended onto <I>lemma </I>, uniquely  | ||||
| identifies a sense within a lexicographer file.  <I>lex_id </I> numbers usually  | ||||
| start with <B>0 </B>, and are incremented as additional senses of the word are  | ||||
| added to the same file, although there is no requirement that the numbers  | ||||
| be consecutive or begin with <B>0 </B>. Note that a value of <B>0 </B> is the default,  | ||||
| and therefore is not present in lexicographer files.  </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>p_cnt</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Three digit  | ||||
| decimal integer indicating the number of pointers from this synset to  | ||||
| other synsets.  If <I>p_cnt </I> is <B>000 </B> the synset has no pointers. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>ptr</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A pointer  | ||||
| from this synset to another.  <I>ptr </I> is of the form: </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <I>pointer_symbol  synset_offset  pos  source/target  | ||||
| </I> <BR> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
|  where <I>synset_offset </I> is the byte offset of the target synset in the  | ||||
| data file corresponding to <I>pos </I>. <P> | ||||
|  The <I>source/target </I> field distinguishes  | ||||
| lexical and semantic pointers.  It is a four byte field, containing two  | ||||
| two-digit hexadecimal integers.  The first two digits indicates the word  | ||||
| number in the current (source) synset, the last two digits indicate the  | ||||
| word number in the target synset.  A value of <B>0000 </B> means that <I>pointer_symbol  | ||||
| </I> represents a semantic relation between the current (source) synset and  | ||||
| the target synset indicated by <I>synset_offset </I>. <P> | ||||
|  A lexical relation between  | ||||
| two words in different synsets is represented by non-zero values in the  | ||||
| source and target word numbers. The first and last two bytes of this field  | ||||
| indicate the word numbers in the source and target synsets, respectively,  | ||||
| between which the relation holds.  Word numbers are assigned to the <I>word  | ||||
| </I> fields in a synset, from left to right, beginning with <B>1 </B>. <P> | ||||
|  See  <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|   | ||||
| for a list of <I>pointer_symbol </I>s, and semantic and lexical pointer classifications.  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>frames</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>In <B>data.verb </B> only, a list of numbers corresponding to the generic  | ||||
| verb sentence frames for <I>word </I>s in the synset.   <I>frames </I> is of the form:  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <I>f_cnt   </I> <B>+ </B> <I>  f_num  w_num  [ </I> <B>+ </B> <I>  f_num  w_num...] </I> <BR> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
|  where <I>f_cnt </I> a two  | ||||
| digit decimal integer indicating the number of generic frames listed,  | ||||
| <I>f_num </I> is a two digit decimal integer frame number, and <I>w_num </I> is a two  | ||||
| digit hexadecimal integer indicating the word in the synset that the frame  | ||||
| applies to.  As with pointers, if this number is <B>00 </B>, <I>f_num </I> applies to  | ||||
| all <I>word </I>s in the synset.  If non-zero, it is applicable only to the word  | ||||
| indicated.  Word numbers are assigned as described for pointers. Each <I>f_num  w_num  | ||||
| </I> pair is preceded by a <B>+ </B>. See <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for the text of the generic  | ||||
| sentence frames.  | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><I>gloss</I>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Each synset contains a gloss.  A <I>gloss </I> is represented  | ||||
| as a vertical bar (<B>| </B>), followed by a text string that continues until  | ||||
| the end of the line.  The gloss may contain a definition, one or more example  | ||||
| sentences, or both. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">Sense Numbers </A></H3> | ||||
| Senses in WordNet are generally ordered  | ||||
| from most to least frequently used, with the most common sense numbered  | ||||
| <B>1 </B>.  Frequency of use is determined by the number of times a sense is tagged  | ||||
| in the various semantic concordance texts.  Senses that are not semantically  | ||||
| tagged follow the ordered senses.  The <I>tagsense_cnt </I> field for each entry  | ||||
| in the <B>index.<I>pos </I></B> files indicates how many of the senses in the list have  | ||||
| been tagged. <P> | ||||
|  The  <B><A HREF="cntlist.5WN.html">cntlist</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  file provided with the database lists the  | ||||
| number of times each sense is tagged in the semantic concordances.  The  | ||||
| data from <B>cntlist </B> is used by <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
|  to order the senses of each word.  | ||||
|  When the <B>index </B>.<I>pos </I> files are generated, the <I>synset_offset </I>s are output  | ||||
| in sense number order, with sense 1 first in the list.  Senses with the  | ||||
| same number of semantic tags are assigned unique but consecutive sense  | ||||
| numbers.  The WordNet  <FONT SIZE=-1><B>OVERVIEW </B></FONT> | ||||
|   search displays all senses of the specified  | ||||
| word, in all syntactic categories, and indicates which of the senses are  | ||||
| represented in the semantically tagged texts.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">Exception List File Format  | ||||
| </A></H3> | ||||
| Exception lists are alphabetized lists of inflected forms of words and  | ||||
| their base forms.  The first field of each line is an inflected form, followed  | ||||
| by a space separated list of one or more base forms of the word.  There  | ||||
| is one exception list file for each syntactic category. <P> | ||||
|  Note that the  | ||||
| noun and verb exception lists were automatically generated from a machine-readable  | ||||
| dictionary, and contain many words that are not in WordNet.  Also, for  | ||||
| many of the inflected forms, base forms could be easily derived using  | ||||
| the standard rules of detachment programmed into Morphy (See <B><A HREF="morph.7WN.html">morph</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| ).  | ||||
| These anomalies are allowed to remain in the exception list files, as  | ||||
| they do no harm. <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">Verb Example Sentences </A></H3> | ||||
| For some verb senses, example  | ||||
| sentences illustrating the use of the verb sense can be displayed.  Each  | ||||
| line of the file <B>sentidx.vrb </B> contains a <I>sense_key </I> followed by a space  | ||||
| and a comma separated list of example sentence template numbers, in decimal.  | ||||
|  The file <B>sents.vrb </B> lists all of the example sentence templates.  Each  | ||||
| line begins with the template number followed by a space.  The rest of  | ||||
| the line is the text of a template example sentence, with <B>%s </B> used as  | ||||
| a placeholder in the text for the verb.  Both files are sorted alphabetically  | ||||
| so that the <I>sense_key </I> and template sentence number can be used as indices,  | ||||
| via <B><A HREF="binsrch.3WN.html">binsrch</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| ,<B></B> into the appropriate file. <P> | ||||
|  When a request for  <FONT SIZE=-1><B>FRAMES  | ||||
| </B></FONT> | ||||
|   is made, the WordNet search code looks for the sense in <B>sentidx.vrb </B>.  | ||||
|  If found, the sentence template(s) listed is retrieved from <B>sents.vrb  | ||||
| </B>, and the <B>%s </B> is replaced with the verb.  If the sense is not found, the  | ||||
| applicable generic sentence frame(s) listed in <I>frames </I> is displayed.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect7" HREF="#toc7">NOTES  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| Information in the <B>data.<I>pos </I></B> and <B>index.<I>pos </I></B> files represents all of the  | ||||
| word senses and synsets in the WordNet database. The <I>word </I>, <I>lex_id </I>, and  | ||||
| <I>lex_filenum </I> fields together uniquely identify each word sense in WordNet.  | ||||
|  These can be encoded in a <I>sense_key </I> as described in <B><A HREF="senseidx.5WN.html">senseidx</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| . Each  | ||||
| synset in the database can be uniquely identified by combining the <I>synset_offset  | ||||
| </I> for the synset with a code for the syntactic category (since it is possible  | ||||
| for synsets in different <B>data.<I>pos </I></B> files to have the same <I>synset_offset  | ||||
| </I>). <P> | ||||
|  The WordNet system provide both command line and window-based browser  | ||||
| interfaces to the database.  Both interfaces utilize a common library of  | ||||
| search and morphology code.  The source code for the library and interfaces  | ||||
| is included in the WordNet package.  See <B><A HREF="wnintro.3WN.html">wnintro</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
|  for an overview of  | ||||
| the WordNet source code.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect8" HREF="#toc8">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNHOME</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory  | ||||
| for WordNet.  Default is <B>/usr/local/WordNet-3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNSEARCHDIR</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Directory in  | ||||
| which the WordNet database has been installed.   Default is <B>WNHOME/dict  | ||||
| </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect9" HREF="#toc9">REGISTRY (WINDOWS) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\WordNet\3.0\WNHome</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory  | ||||
| for WordNet.  Default is <B>C:\Program Files\WordNet\3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect10" HREF="#toc10">FILES </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>index.<I>pos </I></B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>database  | ||||
| index files </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>data.<I>pos </I></B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>database data files </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>*.vrb</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>files of sentences illustrating  | ||||
| the use of verbs </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B><I>pos </I>.exc</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>morphology exception lists </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect11" HREF="#toc11">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wn.1WN.html">wn</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnb.1WN.html">wnb</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.3WN.html">wnintro</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="binsrch.3WN.html">binsrch</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.5WN.html">wnintro</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="cntlist.5WN.html">cntlist</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="lexnames.5WN.html">lexnames</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="senseidx.5WN.html">senseidx</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="morphy.7WN.html">morphy</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wngloss.7WN.html">wngloss</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wngroups.7WN.html">wngroups</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnstats.7WN.html">wnstats</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">Index File Format</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">Data File Format</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">Sense Numbers</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">Exception List File Format</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">Verb Example Sentences</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc7" HREF="#sect7">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc8" HREF="#sect8">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc9" HREF="#sect9">REGISTRY (WINDOWS)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc10" HREF="#sect10">FILES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc11" HREF="#sect11">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										325
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wngloss.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										325
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wngloss.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,325 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNGLOSS(7WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| wngloss - glossary of terms used in WordNet system   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| The <I>WordNet Reference Manual </I> consists of Unix-style manual pages divided  | ||||
| into sections as follows: <P> | ||||
|   <TABLE BORDER=0> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Section </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Description </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>1 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>WordNet User  | ||||
| Commands </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>3 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>WordNet Library Functions </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>5 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>WordNet File Formats </TD> </TR> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>7 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Miscellaneous Information about WordNet </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  </TABLE> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">System Description </A></H3> | ||||
| The  | ||||
| WordNet system consists of lexicographer files, code to convert these  | ||||
| files into a database, and search routines and interfaces that display  | ||||
| information from the database.  The lexicographer files organize nouns,  | ||||
| verbs, adjectives and adverbs into groups of synonyms, and describe relations  | ||||
| between synonym groups. <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
|  converts the lexicographer files into  | ||||
| a database that encodes the relations between the synonym groups.  The  | ||||
| different interfaces to the WordNet database utilize a common library  | ||||
| of search routines to display these relations.  Note that the lexicographer  | ||||
| files and  <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
|  program are not generally distributed.   <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">Database  | ||||
| Organization </A></H3> | ||||
| Information in WordNet is organized around logical groupings  | ||||
| called synsets.  Each synset consists of a list of synonymous words or  | ||||
| collocations (eg. <B>"fountain pen" </B>, <B>"take in" </B>), and pointers that describe  | ||||
| the relations between this synset and other synsets.  A word or collocation  | ||||
| may appear in more than one synset, and in more than one part of speech.  | ||||
|  The words in a synset are grouped such that they are interchangeable  | ||||
| in some context. <P> | ||||
|  Two kinds of relations are represented by pointers: lexical  | ||||
| and semantic.  Lexical relations hold between semantically related  word  | ||||
| forms; semantic relations hold between word meanings.  These relations  | ||||
| include (but are not limited to) hypernymy/hyponymy (superordinate/subordinate),  | ||||
|  antonymy, entailment, and meronymy/holonymy. <P> | ||||
|  Nouns and verbs are organized  | ||||
| into hierarchies based on the hypernymy/hyponymy relation between synsets.  | ||||
|  Additional pointers are be used to indicate other relations.   <P> | ||||
|  Adjectives  | ||||
| are arranged in clusters containing head synsets and satellite synsets.  | ||||
|  Each cluster is organized around antonymous pairs (and occasionally antonymous  | ||||
| triplets).  The antonymous pairs (or triplets) are indicated in the head  | ||||
| synsets of a cluster.  Most head synsets have one or more satellite synsets,  | ||||
| each of which represents a concept that is similar in meaning to the concept  | ||||
| represented by the head synset.  One way to think of the adjective cluster  | ||||
| organization is to visualize a wheel, with a head synset as the hub and  | ||||
| satellite synsets as the spokes.  Two or more wheels are logically connected  | ||||
| via antonymy, which can be thought of as an axle between the wheels. <P> | ||||
|  Pertainyms  | ||||
| are relational adjectives and do not follow the structure just described.  | ||||
|  Pertainyms do not have antonyms; the synset for a pertainym most often  | ||||
| contains only one word or collocation and a lexical pointer to the noun  | ||||
| that the adjective is "pertaining to".  Participial adjectives have lexical  | ||||
| pointers to the verbs that they are derived from. <P> | ||||
|  Adverbs are often derived  | ||||
| from adjectives, and sometimes have antonyms; therefore the synset for  | ||||
| an adverb usually contains a lexical pointer to the adjective from which  | ||||
| it is derived. <P> | ||||
|  See <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a detailed description of the database  | ||||
| files and how the data are represented.    | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">GLOSSARY OF TERMS </A></H2> | ||||
| Many terms  | ||||
| used in the <I>WordNet Reference Manual </I> are unique to the WordNet system.  | ||||
|  Other general terms have specific meanings when used in the WordNet documentation.  | ||||
|  Definitions for many of these terms are given to help with the interpretation  | ||||
| and understanding of the reference manual, and in the use of the WordNet  | ||||
| system. <P> | ||||
|  In following definitions <B>word </B> is used in place of <B>word or collocation  | ||||
| </B>.  | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>adjective cluster</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A group of adjective synsets that are organized around  | ||||
| antonymous pairs or triplets.  An adjective cluster contains two or more  | ||||
| <B>head synsets </B> which represent antonymous concepts. Each head synset has  | ||||
| one or more <B>satellite synsets </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>attribute</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A noun for which adjectives  | ||||
| express values. The noun <B>weight </B> is an attribute, for which the adjectives  | ||||
|  <B>light </B> and <B>heavy </B> express values.  </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>base form</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>The base form of a word  | ||||
| or collocation is the form to which inflections are added. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>basic synset</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Syntactically, same as <B>synset </B>.  Term is used in  <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)<B></B></A> | ||||
|  to help  | ||||
| explain differences in entering synsets in lexicographer files. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>collocation</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A collocation in WordNet is a string of two or more words, connected  | ||||
| by spaces or hyphens.  Examples are: <B>man-eating shark </B>, <B>blue-collar </B>, <B>depend on  | ||||
| </B>, <B>line of products </B>.  In the database files spaces are represented as underscore  | ||||
| (<B>_ </B>) characters. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>coordinate</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Coordinate terms are nouns or verbs that have  | ||||
| the same <B>hypernym </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>cross-cluster pointer</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A <B>semantic pointer </B> from one  | ||||
| adjective cluster to another. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>derivationally related forms</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Terms in different  | ||||
| syntactic categories that have the same root form and are semantically  | ||||
| related.  </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>direct antonyms</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A pair of words between which there is an associative  | ||||
| bond resulting from their frequent co-occurrence.  In <B>adjective clusters  | ||||
| </B>, direct antonyms appears only in <B>head synsets </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>domain</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A topical classification  | ||||
| to which a synset has been linked with a CATEGORY, REGION or USAGE pointer.  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>domain term</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A synset belonging to a topical class.  A domain term is further  | ||||
| identified as being a CATEGORY_TERM, REGION_TERM or USAGE_TERM. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>entailment</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A verb <B>X </B> entails <B>Y </B> if <B>X </B> cannot be done unless <B>Y </B> is,  or has been,  | ||||
| done. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>exception list</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Morphological transformations for words that are  | ||||
| not regular and therefore cannot be processed in an algorithmic manner.  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>group</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Verb senses that similar in meaning and have been manually grouped  | ||||
| together. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>gloss</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Each synset contains <B>gloss </B> consisting of a definition  | ||||
| and optionally example sentences. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>head synset</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Synset in an adjective <B>cluster  | ||||
| </B> containing at least one word that has a <B>direct antonym </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>holonym</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>The  | ||||
| name of the whole of which the meronym names a part.  <B>Y </B>  is a holonym  | ||||
| of <B>X </B> if <B>X </B> is a part of <B>Y </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>hypernym</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>The generic term used to designate  | ||||
| a whole class of specific instances. <B>Y </B> is a hypernym of <B>X </B> if <B>X </B> is a  | ||||
| (kind of) <B>Y </B>.   </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>hyponym</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>The specific term used to designate a member of  | ||||
| a class.  <B>X </B> is a hyponym of  <B>Y </B> if <B>X </B> is a (kind of) <B>Y </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>indirect antonym</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>An adjective in a <B>satellite synset </B> that does not have a <B>direct antonym  | ||||
| </B> has an indirect antonyms via the direct antonym of the <B>head synset </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>instance</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A proper noun that refers to a particular, unique referent (as distinguished  | ||||
| from nouns that refer to classes).  This is a specific form of hyponym.  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>lemma</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Lower case ASCII text of word as found in the WordNet database  | ||||
| index files.  Usually the <B>base form </B> for a word or collocation. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>lexical  | ||||
| pointer</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A lexical pointer indicates a relation between words in synsets  | ||||
| (word forms). </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>lexicographer file</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Files containing the raw data for WordNet  | ||||
| synsets, edited by lexicographers, that are input to the <B>grind </B> program  | ||||
| to generate a WordNet database. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>lexicographer id (lex id)</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A decimal integer  | ||||
| that, when appended onto <B>lemma </B>, uniquely identifies a sense within a  | ||||
| lexicographer file.  </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>monosemous</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Having only one sense in a syntactic category.  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>meronym</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>The name of a constituent part of, the substance of, or a member  | ||||
| of something.  <B>X </B> is a meronym of <B>Y </B> if <B>X </B> is a part of <B>Y </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>part of speech</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>WordNet defines "part of speech" as either noun, verb, adjective, or  | ||||
| adverb.  Same as <B>syntactic category </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>participial adjective</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>An adjective  | ||||
| that is derived from a verb. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>pertainym</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A relational adjective.  Adjectives  | ||||
| that are pertainyms are usually defined by such phrases as "of or pertaining  | ||||
| to" and do not have antonyms.  A pertainym can point to a noun or another  | ||||
| pertainym. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>polysemous</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Having more than one sense in a syntactic category.  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>polysemy count</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Number of senses of a word in a syntactic category, in  | ||||
| WordNet. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>postnominal</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A postnominal adjective occurs only immediately following  | ||||
| the noun  that it modifies. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>predicative</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>An adjective that can be used  | ||||
| only in predicate positions.  If <B>X </B> is a predicate adjective, it can only  | ||||
| be used in such phrases as "it is <B>X </B>" and never prenominally. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>prenominal</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>An adjective that can occur only before the noun that it modifies: it  | ||||
| cannot be used predicatively. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>satellite synset</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Synset in an adjective  | ||||
| <B>cluster </B> representing a concept that is similar in meaning to the concept  | ||||
| represented by its <B>head synset </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>semantic concordance</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A textual corpus  | ||||
| (e.g. the Brown Corpus) and a lexicon (e.g. WordNet) so combined  that every  | ||||
| substantive word in the text is linked to its appropriate sense in the  | ||||
| lexicon via a <B>semantic tag </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>semantic tag</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A pointer from a word in a text  | ||||
| file to a specific sense of that word in the WordNet database.  A semantic  | ||||
| tag in a semantic concordance is represented by a <B>sense key </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>semantic  | ||||
| pointer</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A semantic pointer indicates a relation between synsets (concepts).  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>sense</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A meaning of a word in WordNet.  Each sense of a word is in a different  | ||||
| <B>synset </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>sense key</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Information necessary to find a sense in the WordNet  | ||||
| database.  A sense key combines a <B>lemma </B> field and codes for the synset  | ||||
| type, lexicographer id, lexicographer file number, and information about  | ||||
| a satellite's <B>head synset </B>, if required.  See <B><A HREF="senseidx.5WN.html">senseidx</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a description  | ||||
| of the format of a sense key. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>subordinate</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Same as <B>hyponym </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>superordinate</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Same as <B>hypernym </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>synset</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A synonym set; a set of words that are interchangeable  | ||||
| in some context without changing the truth value of the preposition in  | ||||
| which they are embedded. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>troponym</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A verb expressing a specific manner  | ||||
| elaboration of another verb. <B>X </B> is a troponym of <B>Y </B> if <B>to X </B> is <B>to Y </B> in  | ||||
| some manner. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>unique beginner</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>A noun synset with no <B>superordinate </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">System Description</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">Database Organization</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">GLOSSARY OF TERMS</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										80
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wngroups.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										80
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wngroups.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,80 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNGROUPS(7WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| wngroups - discussion of WordNet search code to group similar verb  | ||||
| senses   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| Some similar senses of verbs have been grouped by  | ||||
| the lexicographers. This grouping is done statically in the lexicographer  | ||||
| source files using the semantic <I>pointer_symbol </I> <B>$ </B>. Transitivity is used  | ||||
| to combine groups of overlapping senses into the largest sense groups  | ||||
| possible.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">NOTES </A></H2> | ||||
| Coverage of verb groups is incomplete.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES  | ||||
| (UNIX) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNHOME</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  Default is <B>/usr/local/WordNet-3.0  | ||||
| </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNSEARCHDIR</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Directory in which the WordNet database has been installed.  | ||||
|   Default is <B>WNHOME/dict </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">REGISTRY (WINDOWS) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\WordNet\3.0\WNHome</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  Default is <B>C:\Program Files\WordNet\3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">FILES  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>sentidx.vrb</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>verb sense keys and sentence frame numbers </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>sents.vrb</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>example  | ||||
| sentence frames </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wn.1WN.html">wn</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnb.1WN.html">wnb</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="senseidx.5WN.html">senseidx</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnsearch.3WN.html">wnsearch</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.7WN.html">wnintro</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">REGISTRY (WINDOWS)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">FILES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										491
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wninput.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										491
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wninput.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,491 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNINPUT(5WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| noun.<I>suffix </I>, verb.<I>suffix </I>, adj.<I>suffix </I>, adv.<I>suffix </I> - WordNet lexicographer  | ||||
| files that are input to  <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| WordNet's source files  | ||||
| are written by lexicographers.  They are the product of a detailed relational  | ||||
| analysis of lexical semantics: a variety of lexical and semantic relations  | ||||
| are used to represent the organization of lexical knowledge.  Two kinds  | ||||
| of building blocks are distinguished in the source files: word forms and  | ||||
| word meanings.  Word forms are represented in their familiar orthography;  | ||||
| word meanings are represented by synonym sets (<I>synset </I>s) - lists of synonymous  | ||||
| word forms that are interchangeable in some context.  Two kinds of relations  | ||||
| are recognized: lexical and semantic.  Lexical relations hold between word  | ||||
| forms; semantic relations hold between word meanings. <P> | ||||
|  Lexicographer files  | ||||
| correspond to the syntactic categories implemented in WordNet - noun, verb,  | ||||
| adjective and adverb.  All of the synsets in a lexicographer file are in  | ||||
| the same syntactic category.  Each synset consists of a list of synonymous  | ||||
| words or collocations (eg. <B>"fountain pen" </B>, <B>"take in" </B>), and pointers that  | ||||
| describe the relations between this synset and other synsets.  These relations  | ||||
| include (but are not limited to) hypernymy/hyponymy, antonymy, entailment,  | ||||
| and meronymy/holonymy.  A word or collocation may appear in more than one  | ||||
| synset, and in more than one part of speech.  Each use of a word in a synset  | ||||
| represents a sense of that word in the part of speech corresponding to  | ||||
| the synset. <P> | ||||
|  Adjectives may be organized into clusters containing head  | ||||
| synsets and satellite synsets.  Adverbs generally point to the adjectives  | ||||
| from which they are derived. <P> | ||||
|  See  <B><A HREF="wngloss.7WN.html">wngloss</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a glossary of WordNet  | ||||
| terminology and a discussion of the database's content and logical organization.  | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">Lexicographer File Names </A></H3> | ||||
| The names of the lexicographer files are of  | ||||
| the form: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><I>pos</I>.<I>suffix</I>  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  where <I>pos </I> is either <B>noun </B>, <B>verb </B>, <B>adj </B> or <B>adv  | ||||
| </B>.  <I>suffix </I> may be used to organize groups of synsets into different files,  | ||||
| for example <B>noun.animal </B> and <B>noun.plant </B>.  See <B><A HREF="lexnames.5WN.html">lexnames</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a list of  | ||||
| lexicographer file names that are used in building WordNet.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">Pointers </A></H3> | ||||
| Pointers  | ||||
| are used to represent the relations between the words in one synset and  | ||||
| another.  Semantic pointers represent relations between word meanings,  | ||||
| and therefore pertain to all of the words in the source and target synsets.  | ||||
|  Lexical pointers represent relations between word forms, and pertain  | ||||
| only to specific words in the source and target synsets.  The following  | ||||
| pointer types are usually used to indicate lexical relations: Antonym,  | ||||
| Pertainym, Participle, Also See, Derivationally Related.  The remaining  | ||||
| pointer types are generally used to represent semantic relations. <P> | ||||
|  A relation  | ||||
| from a source to a target synset is formed by specifying a word from the  | ||||
| target synset in the source synset, followed by the <I>pointer_symbol </I> indicating  | ||||
| the pointer type.  The location of a pointer within a synset defines it  | ||||
| as either lexical or semantic.   The <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Lexicographer File Format </B></FONT> | ||||
|   section  | ||||
| describes the syntax for entering a semantic pointer, and <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Word Syntax  | ||||
| </B></FONT> | ||||
|   describes the syntax for entering a lexical pointer. <P> | ||||
|  Although there  | ||||
| are many pointer types, only certain types of relations are permitted  | ||||
| between synsets of each syntactic category. <P> | ||||
|  The <I>pointer_symbol </I>s for nouns  | ||||
| are:  <blockquote><B>! </B> <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Antonym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>@ </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Hypernym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>@i </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Instance Hypernym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>  </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Hyponym <BR> | ||||
|  <B> i </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Instance  | ||||
| Hyponym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>#m </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Member holonym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>#s </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Substance holonym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>#p </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Part holonym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>%m  | ||||
| </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Member meronym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>%s </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Substance meronym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>%p </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Part meronym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>= </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Attribute <BR> | ||||
|  <B>+  | ||||
| </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Derivationally related form<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt>  <BR> | ||||
|  <B>;c </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Domain of synset - TOPIC <BR> | ||||
|  <B>-c </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Member of this  | ||||
| domain - TOPIC <BR> | ||||
|  <B>;r </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Domain of synset - REGION <BR> | ||||
|  <B>-r </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Member of this domain - REGION  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|  <B>;u </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Domain of synset - USAGE <BR> | ||||
|  <B>-u </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Member of this domain - USAGE <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  The <I>pointer_symbol  | ||||
| </I>s for verbs are:  <blockquote><B>! </B> <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Antonym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>@ </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Hypernym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>  </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Hyponym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>* </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Entailment <BR> | ||||
|  <B>> </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Cause  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|  <B>^ </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Also see <BR> | ||||
|  <B>$ </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Verb Group <BR> | ||||
|  <B>+ </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Derivationally related form<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt>  <BR> | ||||
|  <B>;c </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Domain of  | ||||
| synset - TOPIC <BR> | ||||
|  <B>;r </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Domain of synset - REGION <BR> | ||||
|  <B>;u </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Domain of synset - USAGE  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  The <I>pointer_symbol </I>s for adjectives are:  <blockquote><B>! </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Antonym <BR> | ||||
|  <B>& </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Similar to <BR> | ||||
|  <B><  | ||||
| </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Participle of verb <BR> | ||||
|  <B>\ </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Pertainym (pertains to noun) <BR> | ||||
|  <B>= </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Attribute <BR> | ||||
|  <B>^ </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Also  | ||||
| see <BR> | ||||
|  <B>;c </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Domain of synset - TOPIC <BR> | ||||
|  <B>;r </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Domain of synset - REGION <BR> | ||||
|  <B>;u </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Domain  | ||||
| of synset - USAGE <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  The <I>pointer_symbol </I>s for adverbs are:  <blockquote><B>! </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Antonym <BR> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <B>\ </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Derived from adjective <BR> | ||||
|  <B>;c </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Domain of synset - TOPIC <BR> | ||||
|  <B>;r </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Domain of synset  | ||||
| - REGION <BR> | ||||
|  <B>;u </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Domain of synset - USAGE <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  Many pointer types are reflexive,  | ||||
| meaning that if a synset contains a pointer to another synset, the other  | ||||
| synset should contain a corresponding reflexive pointer.   <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
|  automatically  | ||||
| inserts missing reflexive pointers for the following pointer types: <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <TABLE BORDER=0> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Pointer </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Reflect </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Antonym </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Antonym </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Hyponym </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Hypernym </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Hypernym  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Hyponym </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Instance Hyponym </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Instance Hypernym </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Instance Hypernym </TD>  | ||||
| <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Instance Hyponym </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Holonym </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Meronym </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Meronym </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Holonym </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Similar to  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Similar to </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Attribute </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Attribute </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Verb Group </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Verb Group </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Derivationally  | ||||
| Related </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Derivationally Related </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Domain of synset </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Member of Doman </TD>  | ||||
| </TR> | ||||
|  </TABLE> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">Verb Frames </A></H3> | ||||
| Each verb synset contains a list of generic sentence frames  | ||||
| illustrating the types of simple sentences in which the verbs in the synset  | ||||
| can be used.  For some verb senses, example sentences illustrating actual  | ||||
| uses of the verb are provided.  (See <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Verb Example Sentences </B></FONT> | ||||
|   in <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| .)  | ||||
| Whenever there is no example sentence, the generic sentence frames specified  | ||||
| by the lexicographer are used.  The generic sentence frames are entered  | ||||
| in a synset as a comma-separated list of integer frame numbers.  The following  | ||||
| list is the text of the generic frames, preceded by their frame numbers:  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote>1<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Something ----s <BR> | ||||
|  2<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s <BR> | ||||
|  3<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> It is ----ing <BR> | ||||
|  4<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Something is ----ing PP <BR> | ||||
|  5<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Something  | ||||
| ----s something Adjective/Noun <BR> | ||||
|  6<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Something ----s Adjective/Noun <BR> | ||||
|  7<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s Adjective  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|  8<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s something <BR> | ||||
|  9<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s somebody <BR> | ||||
|  10<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Something ----s somebody <BR> | ||||
|   | ||||
| 11<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Something ----s something <BR> | ||||
|  12<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Something ----s to somebody <BR> | ||||
|  13<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s on something  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|  14<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s somebody something <BR> | ||||
|  15<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s something to somebody <BR> | ||||
|   | ||||
| 16<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s something from somebody <BR> | ||||
|  17<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s somebody with something  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|  18<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s somebody of something <BR> | ||||
|  19<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s something on somebody  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|  20<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s somebody PP <BR> | ||||
|  21<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s something PP <BR> | ||||
|  22<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s PP  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|  23<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody's (body part) ----s <BR> | ||||
|  24<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s somebody to INFINITIVE <BR> | ||||
|  25<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody  | ||||
| ----s somebody INFINITIVE <BR> | ||||
|  26<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s that CLAUSE <BR> | ||||
|  27<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s to somebody  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|  28<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s to INFINITIVE <BR> | ||||
|  29<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s whether INFINITIVE <BR> | ||||
|  30<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody  | ||||
| ----s somebody into V-ing something <BR> | ||||
|  31<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s something with something  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|  32<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s INFINITIVE <BR> | ||||
|  33<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Somebody ----s VERB-ing <BR> | ||||
|  34<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> It ----s that CLAUSE <BR> | ||||
|  35<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> Something  | ||||
| ----s INFINITIVE <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">Lexicographer File Format </A></H3> | ||||
| Synsets are entered one per  | ||||
| line, and each line is terminated with a newline character.  A line containing  | ||||
| a synset may be as long as necessary, but no newlines can be entered within  | ||||
| a synset.  Within a synset, spaces or tabs may be used to separate entities.  | ||||
|  Items enclosed in italicized square brackets may not be present. <P> | ||||
|  The  | ||||
| general synset syntax is: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><B>{ </B> <I>  words  pointers   </I> <B>( </B> <I> gloss  </I> <B>)  } </B>  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  Synsets of this form are valid for all syntactic categories except  | ||||
| verb, and are referred to as basic synsets.  At least one <I>word </I> and a <I>gloss  | ||||
| </I> are required to form a valid synset.  Pointers entered following all the  | ||||
| <I>words </I> in a synset represent semantic relations between all the words  | ||||
| in the source and target synsets. <P> | ||||
|  For verbs, the basic synset syntax is  | ||||
| defined as follows: <P> | ||||
|    <blockquote><B>{ </B> <I>  words  pointers  frames   </I> <B>( </B>  <I>gloss  </I> <B>)  }  | ||||
| </B> <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  Adjective may be organized into clusters containing one or more head  | ||||
| synsets and optional satellite synsets.  Adjective clusters are of the  | ||||
| form: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><B>[ </B><BR> | ||||
|  <I>head synset </I><BR> | ||||
|  [satellite synsets] <BR> | ||||
|  [-] <BR> | ||||
|  [additional head/satellite  | ||||
| synsets] <BR> | ||||
|  <B>] </B> <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
|  Each adjective cluster is enclosed in square brackets,  | ||||
| and may have one or more parts.  Each part consists of a head synset and  | ||||
| optional satellite synsets that are conceptually similar to the head synset's  | ||||
| meaning.  Parts of a cluster are separated by one or more hyphens (<B>- </B>) on  | ||||
| a line by themselves, with the terminating square bracket following the  | ||||
| last synset.  Head and satellite synsets follow the syntax of basic synsets,  | ||||
| however a "Similar to" pointer must be specified in a head synset for  | ||||
| each of its satellite synsets.  Most adjective clusters contain two antonymous  | ||||
| parts.  See <B><A HREF="wngloss.7WN.html">wngloss</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a discussion of adjective clusters, and <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Special  | ||||
| Adjective Syntax </B></FONT> | ||||
|   for more information on adjective cluster syntax. <P> | ||||
|  Synsets  | ||||
| for relational adjectives (pertainyms) and participial adjectives do not  | ||||
| adhere to the cluster structure.  They use the basic synset syntax. <P> | ||||
|  Comments  | ||||
| can be entered in a lexicographer file by enclosing the text of the comment  | ||||
| in parentheses.  Note that comments <B>cannot </B> appear within a synset, as  | ||||
| parentheses within a synset have an entirely different meaning (see <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Gloss  | ||||
| Syntax </B></FONT> | ||||
|   ).  However, entire synsets (or adjective clusters) can be "commented  | ||||
| out" by enclosing them in parentheses.  This is often used by the lexicographers  | ||||
| to verify the syntax of files under development or to leave a note to  | ||||
| oneself while working on entries.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">Word Syntax </A></H3> | ||||
| A synset must have at least  | ||||
| one word, and the words of a synset must appear after the opening brace  | ||||
| and before any other synset constructs. A word may be entered in either  | ||||
| the simple word or word/pointer syntax. <P> | ||||
|  A simple word is of the form:  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><I>word[ </I> <B>( </B> <I>marker </I> <B>) </B> <I>][lex_id] </I> <B>, </B> <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <I>word </I> may be entered in any combination  | ||||
| of upper and lower case unless it is in an adjective cluster.  A collocation  | ||||
| is entered by joining the individual words with an underscore character  | ||||
| (<B>_ </B>). Numbers (integer or real) may be entered, either by themselves or  | ||||
| as part of a word string, by following the number with a double quote  | ||||
| (<B>" </B>). <P> | ||||
|  See  <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Special Adjective Syntax </B></FONT> | ||||
|   for a description of adjective clusters  | ||||
| and markers. <P> | ||||
|  <I>word </I> may be followed by an integer <I>lex_id </I> from <B>1 </B> to <B>15  | ||||
| </B>.  The <I>lex_id </I> is used to distinguish different senses of the same word  | ||||
| within a lexicographer file.  The lexicographer assigns <I>lex_id </I> values,  | ||||
| usually in ascending order, although there is no requirement that the  | ||||
| numbers be consecutive.  The default is <B>0 </B>, and does not have to be specified.  | ||||
|  A <I>lex_id </I> must be used on pointers if the desired sense has a non-zero  | ||||
| <I>lex_id </I> in its synset specification. <P> | ||||
|  Word/pointer syntax is of the form:  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><B>[   </B> <I>word[ </I> <B>( </B> <I>marker </I> <B>) </B> <I>][lex_id] </I> <B>, </B> <I>  pointers   </I> <B>] </B> <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  This syntax  | ||||
| is used when one or more pointers correspond only to the specific word  | ||||
| in the word/pointer set, rather than all the words in the synset, and  | ||||
| represents a lexical relation.  Note that a word/pointer set appears within  | ||||
| a synset, therefore the square brackets used to enclose it are treated  | ||||
| differently from those used to define an adjective cluster.  Only one word  | ||||
| can be specified in each word/pointer set, and any number of pointers  | ||||
| may be included.  A synset can have any number of word/pointer sets.  Each  | ||||
| is treated by <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)<B></B></A> | ||||
|  essentially as a <I>word </I>, so they all must appear  | ||||
| before any synset <I>pointers </I> representing semantic relations. <P> | ||||
|  For verbs,  | ||||
| the word/pointer syntax is extended in the following manner to allow the  | ||||
| user to specify generic sentence frames that, like pointers, correspond  | ||||
| only to a specific word, rather than all the words in the synset.  In this  | ||||
| case, <I>pointers </I> are optional. <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><B>[   </B> <I>word </I> <B>, </B>   <I>[pointers]  frames   </I> <B>]  | ||||
| </B> <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect7" HREF="#toc7">Pointer Syntax </A></H3> | ||||
| Pointers are optional in synsets.  If a pointer is specified  | ||||
| outside of a word/pointer set, the relation is applied to all of the words  | ||||
| in the synset, including any words specified using the word/pointer syntax.  | ||||
|  This indicates a semantic relation between the meanings of the words  | ||||
| in the synsets.  If specified within a word/pointer set, the relation corresponds  | ||||
| only to the word in the set and represents a lexical relation. <P> | ||||
|  A pointer  | ||||
| is of the form: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><I>[lex_filename </I><B>: </B> <I>]word[lex_id] </I><B>, </B><I>pointer_symbol </I> <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| or: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><I>[lex_filename </I><B>: </B> <I>]word[lex_id] </I><B>^ </B><I>word[lex_id] </I><B>, </B><I>pointer_symbol </I> <BR> | ||||
|   | ||||
|  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  For pointers, <I>word </I> indicates a word in another synset.  When the second  | ||||
| form of a pointer is used, the first <I>word </I> indicates a word in a head  | ||||
| synset, and the second is a word in a satellite of that cluster.  <I>word  | ||||
| </I> may be followed by a <I>lex_id </I> that is used to match the pointer to the  | ||||
| correct target synset.  The synset containing <I>word </I> may reside in another  | ||||
| lexicographer file.  In this case, <I>word </I> is preceded by <I>lex_filename </I> as  | ||||
| shown. <P> | ||||
|  See <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Pointers </B></FONT> | ||||
|   for a list of <I>pointer_symbol </I>s and their meanings.  | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect8" HREF="#toc8">Verb Frame List Syntax </A></H3> | ||||
| Frame numbers corresponding to generic sentence  | ||||
| frames must be entered in each verb synset.  If a frame list is specified  | ||||
| outside of a word/pointer set, the verb frames in the list apply to all  | ||||
| of the words in the synset, including any words specified using the word/pointer  | ||||
| syntax.  If specified within a word/pointer set, the verb frames in the  | ||||
| list correspond only to the word in the set. <P> | ||||
|  A frame number list is entered  | ||||
| as follows: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><B>frames: </B>  <I>f_num </I>[<B>, </B><I>f_num...] </I>  </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  Where <I>f_num </I> specifies a generic  | ||||
| frame number. See <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Verb Frames </B></FONT> | ||||
|   for a list of generic sentences and their  | ||||
| corresponding frame numbers.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect9" HREF="#toc9">Gloss Syntax </A></H3> | ||||
| A gloss is included in all synsets.  | ||||
|  The lexicographer may enter a text string of any length desired.  A gloss  | ||||
| is simply a string enclosed in parentheses with no embedded carriage returns.  | ||||
|  It provides a definition of what the synset represents and/or example  | ||||
| sentences.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect10" HREF="#toc10">Special Adjective Syntax </A></H3> | ||||
| The syntax for representing antonymous  | ||||
| adjective synsets requires several additional conditions. <P> | ||||
|  The first word  | ||||
| of a head synset <B>must </B> be entered in upper case, and can be thought of  | ||||
| as the head word of the head synset.  The <I>word </I> part of a pointer from  | ||||
| one head synset to another head synset within the same cluster (usually  | ||||
| an antonym) must also be entered in upper case.  Usually antonymous adjectives  | ||||
| are entered using the word/pointer syntax described in <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Word Syntax </B></FONT> | ||||
|   to  | ||||
| indicate a lexical relation.  There is no restriction on the number of  | ||||
| parts that a cluster may have, and some clusters have three parts, representing  | ||||
| antonymous triplets, such as <B>solid </B>, <B>liquid </B>, and <B>gas </B>. <P> | ||||
|  A cross-cluster  | ||||
| pointer may be specified, allowing a head or satellite synset to point  | ||||
| to a head synset in a different cluster.  A cross-cluster pointer is indicated  | ||||
| by entering the <I>word </I> part of the pointer in upper case. <P> | ||||
|  An adjective  | ||||
| may be annotated with a syntactic marker indicating a limitation on the  | ||||
| syntactic position the adjective may have in relation to noun that it  | ||||
| modifies.  If so marked, the marker appears between the word and its following  | ||||
| comma.  If a <I>lex_id </I> is specified, the marker immediately follows it.  The  | ||||
| syntactic markers are:  <blockquote><B>(p) </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> predicate position <BR> | ||||
|  <B>(a) </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> prenominal (attributive)  | ||||
| position <BR> | ||||
|  <B>(ip) </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> immediately postnominal position<tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> <tt> </tt>  <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect11" HREF="#toc11">EXAMPLES </A></H2> | ||||
| <I>(Note that  | ||||
| these are hypothetical examples not found in the WordNet lexicographer  | ||||
| files.) </I> <P> | ||||
|  Sample noun synsets:  <blockquote>{ canine, [ dog1, cat,! ] pooch, canid,@  | ||||
| } <BR> | ||||
|  { collie, dog1,@ (large multi-colored dog with pointy nose) } <BR> | ||||
|  { hound,  | ||||
| hunting_dog, pack,#m dog1,@ } <BR> | ||||
|  { dog, } <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  Sample verb synsets:  <blockquote>{ [ confuse,  | ||||
| clarify,! frames: 1 ] blur, obscure, frames: 8, 10 } <BR> | ||||
|  { [ clarify, confuse,!  | ||||
| ] make_clear, interpret,@ frames: 8 } <BR> | ||||
|  { interpret, construe, understand,@  | ||||
| frames: 8 } <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  Sample adjective clusters:  <blockquote>[ <BR> | ||||
|  { [ HOT, COLD,! ] lukewarm(a),  | ||||
| TEPID,^ (hot to the touch) } <BR> | ||||
|  { warm, } <BR> | ||||
|  - <BR> | ||||
|  { [ COLD, HOT,! ] frigid, (cold  | ||||
| to the touch) } <BR> | ||||
|  { freezing, } <BR> | ||||
|  ] <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  Sample adverb synsets:  <blockquote>{ [ basically,  | ||||
| adj.all:essential^basic,\ ] [ essentially, adj.all:basic^fundamental,\ ] ( by  | ||||
| one's very nature )} <BR> | ||||
|  { pointedly, adj.all:pungent^pointed,\ } <BR> | ||||
|  { [ badly,  | ||||
| adj.all:bad,\ well,! ] ill, ("He was badly prepared") } <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect12" HREF="#toc12">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnintro.5WN.html">wnintro</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="lexnames.5WN.html">lexnames</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="uniqbeg.7WN.html">uniqbeg</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wngloss.7WN.html">wngloss</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
| Fellbaum,  | ||||
| C. (1998), ed. <I>"WordNet: An Electronic Lexical Database" </I>. MIT Press, Cambridge,  | ||||
| MA. <P> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">Lexicographer File Names</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">Pointers</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">Verb Frames</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">Lexicographer File Format</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">Word Syntax</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc7" HREF="#sect7">Pointer Syntax</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc8" HREF="#sect8">Verb Frame List Syntax</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc9" HREF="#sect9">Gloss Syntax</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc10" HREF="#sect10">Special Adjective Syntax</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc11" HREF="#sect11">EXAMPLES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc12" HREF="#sect12">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										81
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnintro.1WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										81
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnintro.1WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,81 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNINTRO(1WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| wnintro - WordNet user commands   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">SYNOPSIS </A></H2> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| <B>wn </B> - command line interface  | ||||
| to WordNet database <P> | ||||
| <B>wnb </B> - window based WordNet browser   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| This  | ||||
| section of the <I>WordNet Reference Manual </I> contains manual pages that describe  | ||||
| commands available with the various WordNet system packages. <P> | ||||
|  The WordNet  | ||||
| interfaces  <B><A HREF="wn.1WN.html">wn</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
|  and <B><A HREF="wnb.1WN.html">wnb</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
|  allow the user to search the WordNet  | ||||
| database and display the information textually.     | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES  | ||||
| (UNIX) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNHOME</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  Default is <B>/usr/local/WordNet-3.0  | ||||
| </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNSEARCHDIR</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Directory in which the WordNet database has been installed.  | ||||
|   Default is <B>WNHOME/dict </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">REGISTRY (WINDOWS) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\WordNet\3.0\WNHome</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  Default is <B>C:\Program Files\WordNet\3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">SEE  | ||||
| ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wn.1WN.html">wn</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnb.1WN.html">wnb</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.3WN.html">wnintro</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.5WN.html">wnintro</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.7WN.html">wnintro</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| .  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| Fellbaum, C. (1998), ed. <I>"WordNet: An Electronic Lexical Database" </I>. MIT  | ||||
| Press, Cambridge, MA.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">AVAILABILITY </A></H2> | ||||
| WordNet has a World Wide Web site at  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="http://wordnet.princeton.edu">http://wordnet.princeton.edu</A> | ||||
|  </B>.  From this web site users can learn about  | ||||
| the WordNet project, run several different interfaces to the WordNet database,  | ||||
| and download various WordNet system packages and <I>"Five Papers on WordNet"  | ||||
| </I>. <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">SYNOPSIS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">REGISTRY (WINDOWS)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">AVAILABILITY</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										365
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnintro.3WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										365
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnintro.3WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,365 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNINTRO(3WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| wnintro - introduction to WordNet library functions   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| This section of the <I>WordNet Reference Manual </I> contains manual pages that  | ||||
| describe the WordNet library functions and API. <P> | ||||
|  Functions are organized  | ||||
| into the following categories:  <P> | ||||
|   <TABLE BORDER=0> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>Category </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>Manual Page </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>Object File  | ||||
| </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Database Search </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>wnsearch (3WN) </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>search.o </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Morphology </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>morph (3WN)  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>morph.o </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Misc. Utility </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>wnutil (3WN) </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>wnutil.o </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Binary Search </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>binsrch  | ||||
| (3WN) </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>binsrch.o </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  </TABLE> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  The WordNet library is used by all of the searching  | ||||
| interfaces provided with the various WordNet packages.  Additional programs  | ||||
| in the system, such as <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , also use functions in this library.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  The WordNet library is provided in both source and binary forms (on some  | ||||
| platforms) to allow users to build applications and tools to their own  | ||||
| specifications that utilize the WordNet database.  We do not provide programming  | ||||
| support or assistance. <P> | ||||
|  The code conforms to ANSI C standards.  Functions  | ||||
| are defined with function prototypes.  If you do not have a compiler that  | ||||
| accepts prototypes, you must edit the source code and remove the prototypes  | ||||
| before compiling.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">LIST OF WORDNET LIBRARY FUNCTIONS </A></H2> | ||||
| Not all library functions  | ||||
| are listed below. Missing are mainly functions that are called by documented  | ||||
| ones, or ones that were written for specific applications or tools used  | ||||
| during WordNet development.  Data structures are defined in <B>wn.h </B>. <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">Database  | ||||
| Searching Functions (search.o) </A></H3> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>findtheinfo </B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Primary search function for  | ||||
| WordNet database.  Returns formatted search results in text buffer.  Used  | ||||
| by WordNet interfaces to perform requested search. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>findtheinfo_ds</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Primary  | ||||
| search function for WordNet database.  Returns search results in linked  | ||||
| list data structure. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>is_defined</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Set bit for each search type that is valid  | ||||
| for the search word passed and return bit mask. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>in_wn</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Set bit for each  | ||||
| syntactic category that search word is in. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>index_lookup</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Find word in index  | ||||
| file and return parsed entry in data structure. Input word must be exact  | ||||
| match of string in database.  Called by <B>getindex() </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>getindex</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Find word  | ||||
| in index file, trying different techniques - replace hyphens with underscores,  | ||||
| replace underscores with hyphens, strip hyphens and underscores, strip  | ||||
| periods. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>read_synset</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Read synset from data file at byte offset passed  | ||||
| and return parsed entry in data structure.  Calls <B>parse_synset() </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>parse_synset</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Read synset at current byte offset in file and return parsed entry in  | ||||
| data structure. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>free_syns</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Free a synset linked list allocated by <B>findtheinfo_ds()  | ||||
| </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>free_synset</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Free a synset structure. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>free_index</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Free an index structure.  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>traceptrs_ds</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Recursive search algorithm to trace a pointer tree and return  | ||||
| results in linked list. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>do_trace</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Do requested search on synset passed  | ||||
| returning formatted output in buffer. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">Morphology Functions (morph.o) </A></H3> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>morphinit</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Open exception list files. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>re_morphinit</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Close exception list  | ||||
| files and reopen. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>morphstr</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Try to find base form (lemma) of word or collocation  | ||||
| in syntactic category passed.  Calls <B>morphword() </B> for each word in string  | ||||
| passed. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>morphword</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Try to find base form (lemma) of individual word in  | ||||
| syntactic category passed. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">Utility Functions (wnutil.o) </A></H3> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wninit</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Top level  | ||||
| function to open database files and morphology exception lists. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>re_wninit</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Top level function to close and reopen database files and morphology  | ||||
| exception lists. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>cntwords</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Count the number of underscore or space separated  | ||||
| words in a string. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>strtolower</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Convert string to lower case and remove  | ||||
| trailing adjective marker if found. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>ToLowerCase</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Convert string passed  | ||||
| to lower case. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>strsubst</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Replace all occurrences of <I>from </I> with <I>to </I> in <I>str  | ||||
| </I>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>getptrtype</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Return code for pointer type character passed. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>getpos</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Return  | ||||
| syntactic category code for string passed. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>getsstype</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Return synset type  | ||||
| code for string passed. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>FmtSynset</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Reconstruct synset string from synset  | ||||
| pointer. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>StrToPos</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Passed string for syntactic category, returns corresponding  | ||||
| integer value. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>GetSynsetForSense</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Return synset for sense key passed. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>GetDataOffset</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Find synset offset for sense. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>GetPolyCount</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Find polysemy count for sense  | ||||
| passed. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>GetWORD</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Return word part of sense key. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>GetPOS</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Return syntactic  | ||||
| category code for sense key passed. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNSnsToStr</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Generate sense key for  | ||||
| index entry passed. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>GetValidIndexPointer</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Search for string and/or base  | ||||
| form of word in database and return index structure for word if found.  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>GetWNSense</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Return sense number in database for sense key. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>GetSenseIndex</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Return parsed sense index entry for sense key passed. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>default_display_message</B>  | ||||
|  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Default function to use as value of <B>display_message </B>.  Simply returns  | ||||
| <B>-1 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">Binary Search Functions (binsrch.o) </A></H3> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>bin_search</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>General purpose binary  | ||||
| search function to search for key as first item on line in sorted file.  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>copyfile</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Copy contents from one file to another. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>replace_line</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Replace  | ||||
| a line in a sorted file.  </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>insert_line</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Insert a line into a sorted file.  | ||||
| </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect7" HREF="#toc7">HEADER FILE </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>wn.h</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>WordNet include file of constants, data structures,  | ||||
| external declarations for global variables initialized in <B>wnglobal.c </B>. Also  | ||||
| lists function prototypes for library API. It must be included to use any  | ||||
| WordNet library functions. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect8" HREF="#toc8">NOTES </A></H2> | ||||
| All library functions that access the  | ||||
| database files expect the files to be open.  The function <B><A HREF="wninit.3WN.html">wninit</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
|  must  | ||||
| be called before other database access functions such as <B><A HREF="findtheinfo.3WN.html">findtheinfo</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
|   | ||||
| or <B><A HREF="read_synset.3WN.html">read_synset</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| .<B></B> <P> | ||||
|  Inclusion of the header file <B>wn.h </B> is necessary. <P> | ||||
|  The  | ||||
| command line interface is a good example of a simple application that  | ||||
| uses several WordNet library functions.  <P> | ||||
|  Many of the library functions  | ||||
| are passed or return syntactic category or synset type information.  The  | ||||
| following table lists the possible categories as integer codes, synset  | ||||
| type constant names, syntactic category constant names, single characters  | ||||
| and character strings. <P> | ||||
|   <TABLE BORDER=0> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Integer </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Synset Type </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Syntactic Category </B>  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Char </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>String </B>  </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>1 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>NOUN </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>NOUN </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>n </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>noun </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>2 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>VERB </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>VERB </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>v </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>verb  | ||||
| </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>3 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ADJ </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ADJ </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>a </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>adj </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>4 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ADV </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ADV </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>r </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>adv </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>5 </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>SATELLITE </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ADJ </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>s  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><I>n/a </I> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  </TABLE> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect9" HREF="#toc9">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNHOME</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for WordNet.  | ||||
|  Default is <B>/usr/local/WordNet-3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>WNSEARCHDIR</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Directory in which the  | ||||
| WordNet database has been installed.   Default is <B>WNHOME/dict </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect10" HREF="#toc10">REGISTRY  | ||||
| (WINDOWS) </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\WordNet\3.0\WNHome</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>Base directory for  | ||||
| WordNet.  Default is <B>C:\Program Files\WordNet\3.0 </B>. </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect11" HREF="#toc11">FILES </A></H2> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DL> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>lib/libwn.a</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>WordNet  | ||||
| library (Unix) </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>lib\wn.lib</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>WordNet library (Windows) </DD> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <DT><B>include</B>  </DT> | ||||
| <DD>header files  | ||||
| for use with WordNet library </DD> | ||||
| </DL> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect12" HREF="#toc12">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnintro.1WN.html">wnintro</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="binsrch.3WN.html">binsrch</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="morph.3WN.html">morph</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnsearch.3WN.html">wnsearch</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnutil.3WN.html">wnutil</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.5WN.html">wnintro</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.7WN.html">wnintro</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
|  Fellbaum, C. (1998),  | ||||
| ed. <I>"WordNet: An Electronic Lexical Database" </I>. MIT Press, Cambridge, MA.  | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect13" HREF="#toc13">BUGS </A></H2> | ||||
| Please report bugs to <B>wordnet@princeton.edu </B>. <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">LIST OF WORDNET LIBRARY FUNCTIONS</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">Database Searching Functions (search.o)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">Morphology Functions (morph.o)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">Utility Functions (wnutil.o)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">Binary Search Functions (binsrch.o)</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc7" HREF="#sect7">HEADER FILE</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc8" HREF="#sect8">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc9" HREF="#sect9">ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc10" HREF="#sect10">REGISTRY (WINDOWS)</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc11" HREF="#sect11">FILES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc12" HREF="#sect12">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc13" HREF="#sect13">BUGS</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										71
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnintro.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										71
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnintro.5WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,71 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNINTRO(5WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| wnintro - introduction to descriptions of WordNet file formats   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">SYNOPSIS </A></H2> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| <B>cntlist </B> - format of <B>cntlist </B> and <B>cntlist.rev </B> files <P> | ||||
| <B>lexnames </B>  | ||||
| - list of lexicographer file names and numbers <P> | ||||
| <B>prologdb </B> - description of  | ||||
| Prolog database files <P> | ||||
| <B>senseidx </B> - format of sense index file <P> | ||||
| <B>sensemap </B>  | ||||
| - mapping from senses in WordNet 2.1 to corresponding 3.0 senses <P> | ||||
| <B>wndb </B> - format  | ||||
| of WordNet database files  <P> | ||||
| <B>wninput </B> - format of WordNet lexicographer files  | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| This section of the <I>WordNet Reference Manual </I> contains manual  | ||||
| pages that describe the formats of the various files included in different  | ||||
| WordNet 3.0 packages.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">NOMENCLATURE </A></H2> | ||||
| All files are in ASCII.  Fields are generally  | ||||
| separated by one space, unless otherwise noted, and each line is terminated  | ||||
| with a newline character.  In the file format descriptions, terms in <I>italics  | ||||
| </I> refer to field names.  Characters or strings in <B>boldface </B> represent an  | ||||
| actual character or string as it appears in the file. Items enclosed in  | ||||
| italicized square brackets (<I>[  ] </I>) may not be present. Since several files  | ||||
| contain fields that have the identical meaning, field names are consistently  | ||||
| defined.  For example, several WordNet files contain one or more <I>synset_offset  | ||||
| </I> fields.  In each case, the definition of <I>synset_offset </I> is identical.   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnintro.1WN.html">wnintro</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.3WN.html">wnintro</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="cntlist.5WN.html">cntlist</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="lexnames.5WN.html">lexnames</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="prologdb.5WN.html">prologdb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="senseidx.5WN.html">senseidx</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="sensemap.5WN.html">sensemap</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wninput.5WN.html">wninput</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.7WN.html">wnintro</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wngloss.7WN.html">wngloss</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| .  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| Fellbaum, C. (1998), ed. <I>"WordNet: An Electronic Lexical Database" </I>. MIT  | ||||
| Press, Cambridge, MA. <P> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">SYNOPSIS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">NOMENCLATURE</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										57
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnintro.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										57
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnintro.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,57 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNINTRO(7WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| wnintro - introduction to miscellaneous WordNet information   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">SYNOPSIS  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| <B>morphy </B> - discussion of WordNet's morphological processing <P> | ||||
| <B>uniqbeg </B> - unique  | ||||
| beginners for noun hierarchies <P> | ||||
| <B>wngloss </B> - glossary of terms used in WordNet  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| <B>wngroups </B> - discussion of WordNet search code to group similar senses <P> | ||||
| <B>wnlicens  | ||||
| </B> - text of WordNet license agreement <P> | ||||
| <B>wnpkgs </B> - information about WordNet  | ||||
| packages and distribution <P> | ||||
| <B>wnstats </B> - database statistics   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| This  | ||||
| section of the <I>WordNet Reference Manual </I> contains manual pages that describe  | ||||
| various topics related to WordNet and the semantic concordances, and a  | ||||
| glossary of terms.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnintro.1WN.html">wnintro</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.3WN.html">wnintro</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.5WN.html">wnintro</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="morphy.7WN.html">morphy</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="uniqbeg.7WN.html">uniqbeg</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wngroups.7WN.html">wngroups</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnlicens.7WN.html">wnlicens</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnpkgs.7WN.html">wnpkgs</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnstats.7WN.html">wnstats</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wngloss.7WN.html">wngloss</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
| Fellbaum, C. (1998), ed. <I>"WordNet: An Electronic  | ||||
| Lexical Database" </I>. MIT Press, Cambridge, MA. <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">SYNOPSIS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										45
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnlicens.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										45
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnlicens.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,45 @@ | |||
| <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNLICENS(7WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| wnlicens - text of WordNet license   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| WordNet Release 3.0  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  This software and database is being provided to you, the LICENSEE, by  | ||||
|   Princeton University under the following license.  By obtaining, using  | ||||
|   and/or copying this software and database, you agree that you have   | ||||
|  read, understood, and will comply with these terms and conditions.:    | ||||
|    Permission to use, copy, modify and distribute this software and    | ||||
| database and its documentation for any purpose and without fee or   royalty  | ||||
| is hereby granted, provided that you agree to comply with   the following  | ||||
| copyright notice and statements, including the disclaimer,   and that  | ||||
| the same appear on ALL copies of the software, database and   documentation,  | ||||
| including modifications that you make for internal   use or for distribution.  | ||||
|      WordNet 3.0 Copyright 2006 by Princeton University.  All rights reserved.  | ||||
|      THIS SOFTWARE AND DATABASE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND PRINCETON   UNIVERSITY  | ||||
| MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR   IMPLIED.  BY WAY OF  | ||||
| EXAMPLE, BUT NOT LIMITATION, PRINCETON   UNIVERSITY MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS  | ||||
| OR WARRANTIES OF MERCHANT-   ABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE  | ||||
| OR THAT THE USE   OF THE LICENSED SOFTWARE, DATABASE OR DOCUMENTATION  | ||||
| WILL NOT   INFRINGE ANY THIRD PARTY PATENTS, COPYRIGHTS, TRADEMARKS OR  | ||||
|   OTHER RIGHTS.      The name of Princeton University or Princeton may  | ||||
| not be used in   advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of  | ||||
| the software   and/or database.  Title to copyright in this software, database  | ||||
| and   any associated documentation shall at all times remain with   Princeton  | ||||
| University and LICENSEE agrees to preserve same.   <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										95
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnpkgs.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										95
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnpkgs.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,95 @@ | |||
|  <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNPKGS(7WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| wnpkgs - description of various WordNet system packages   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| WordNet 3.0 is distributed in several formats and in various packages. All  | ||||
| of the packages are available via anonymous FTP from <B>ftp.cogsci.princeton.edu  | ||||
| </B> and from the WordNet Web site at <B><A HREF="http://wordnet.princeton.edu">http://wordnet.princeton.edu</A> | ||||
|  </B>.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">Packages  | ||||
| Available Via FTP and WWW </A></H3> | ||||
| The following WordNet packages can be downloaded  | ||||
| using a web browser from <B>ftp://ftp.cogsci.princeton.edu/wordnet/3.0 </B>, or from  | ||||
| the Web site noted above.  Users can also FTP directly from <B>ftp.cogsci.princeton.edu  | ||||
| </B>, directory <B>wordnet/3.0 </B>. <P> | ||||
|   <TABLE BORDER=0> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Package </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Filename </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Platform </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Description  | ||||
| </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>   <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Database </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>WordNet-3.0.tar.gz </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Unix/OS X </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>WordNet 3.0 database, interfaces,  | ||||
| sense index, interface and library source code, documentation.  </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Database  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>WordNet-3.0.exe </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Windows </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>WordNet 3.0 database, interfaces, sense index,  | ||||
| interface and library source code, documentation.  </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Prolog Database </TD>  | ||||
| <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>WNprolog-3.0.tar.gz </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>All </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>WordNet 3.0 database files in Prolog-readable format,  | ||||
| documentation.  </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Sense Map </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>WNsnsmap-3.0.tar.gz </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>All </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Mapping of 2.1 to 3.0  | ||||
| senses, documentation.  </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  </TABLE> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">Database Package </A></H3> | ||||
| The database package is a  | ||||
| complete installation for WordNet 3.0 users. It includes the 3.0 database  | ||||
| files, source code for the WordNet browsers and library, and documentation.  | ||||
|  The other packages are not included - they must be downloaded and installed  | ||||
| separately. <P> | ||||
|  Note that with this version of WordNet for Unix platforms,  | ||||
| only source code is provided.  Users should carefully read the README and  | ||||
| INSTALL files for detailed information on compiling WordNet and dependencies.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">Prolog Database Package </A></H3> | ||||
| The WordNet 3.0 database files are available  | ||||
| in this package in a Prolog-readable format.  Documentation describing the  | ||||
| file format is included.  This package is only downloadable in compressed  | ||||
| tar file format, although once unpackaged it can be used from Windows  | ||||
| systems since the files are in ASCII.  Many Windows utilities, such as  | ||||
| WinZip, can deal with a compressed tar file.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">Sense Map Package </A></H3> | ||||
| To help  | ||||
| users automatically convert 2.1 noun and verb senses to their corresponding  | ||||
| 3.0 senses, we provide sense mapping information in this package.  This  | ||||
| package contains files to map polysemous and monosemous words, and documentation  | ||||
| that describes the format of these files.  As with the Prolog database,  | ||||
| this package is only downloadable in compressed tar format, but the files  | ||||
| are also in ASCII.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">NOTES </A></H2> | ||||
| The lexicographer files and <B><A HREF="grind.1WN.html">grind</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
|  program  | ||||
| are not generally distributed. <P> | ||||
|  All of the packages described above may  | ||||
| not be available at the time of release of the 3.0 database package.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect7" HREF="#toc7">SEE  | ||||
| ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnintro.1WN.html">wnintro</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.3WN.html">wnintro</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.5WN.html">wnintro</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.7WN.html">wnintro</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">Packages Available Via FTP and WWW</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">Database Package</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">Prolog Database Package</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">Sense Map Package</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc7" HREF="#sect7">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										338
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnsearch.3WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										338
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnsearch.3WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,338 @@ | |||
| <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNSEARCH(3WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| findtheinfo, findtheinfo_ds, is_defined, in_wn, index_lookup, parse_index,  | ||||
| getindex, read_synset, parse_synset, free_syns, free_synset, free_index,  | ||||
| traceptrs_ds, do_trace   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">SYNOPSIS </A></H2> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| <B>#include "wn.h" <P> | ||||
| <B>char *findtheinfo(char  | ||||
| *searchstr, int pos, int ptr_type, int sense_num); </B></B> <P> | ||||
| <B>SynsetPtr findtheinfo_ds(char  | ||||
| *searchstr, int pos, int ptr_type, int sense_num ); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>unsigned int is_defined(char  | ||||
| *searchstr, int pos); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>unsigned int in_wn(char *searchstr, int pos); </B>  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| <B>IndexPtr index_lookup(char *searchstr, int pos); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>IndexPtr parse_index(long  | ||||
| offset, int dabase, char *line); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>IndexPtr getindex(char *searchstr, int  | ||||
| pos); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>SynsetPtr read_synset(int pos, long synset_offset, char *searchstr);  | ||||
| </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>SynsetPtr parse_synset(FILE *fp, int pos, char *searchstr); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>void free_syns(SynsetPtr  | ||||
| synptr); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>void free_synset(SynsetPtr synptr); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>void free_index(IndexPtr  | ||||
| idx); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>SynsetPtr traceptrs_ds(SynsetPtr synptr, int ptr_type, int pos,  | ||||
| int depth); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>char *do_trace(SynsetPtr synptr, int ptr_type, int pos, int  | ||||
| depth); </B>   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| These functions are used for searching the WordNet  | ||||
| database.  They generally fall into several categories: functions for reading  | ||||
| and parsing index file entries; functions for reading and parsing synsets  | ||||
| in data files; functions for tracing pointers and hierarchies; functions  | ||||
| for freeing space occupied by data structures allocated with <B><A HREF="malloc.3.html">malloc</B>(3)</A> | ||||
| .  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  In the following function descriptions, <I>pos </I> is one of the following:  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote><B>1 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> NOUN <BR> | ||||
|  <B>2 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> VERB <BR> | ||||
|  <B>3 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADJECTIVE <BR> | ||||
|  <B>4 </B><tt> </tt> <tt> </tt> ADVERB <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>findtheinfo()</B> is the primary  | ||||
| search algorithm for use with database interface applications.  Search  | ||||
| results are automatically formatted, and a pointer to the text buffer  | ||||
| is returned.  All searches listed in  <B>WNHOME/include/wn.h</B> can be done by  | ||||
|  <B>findtheinfo()</B>. <B>findtheinfo_ds()</B> can be used to perform most of the searches,  | ||||
| with results returned in a linked list data structure.  This is for use  | ||||
| with applications that need to analyze the search results rather than  | ||||
| just display them. <P> | ||||
|  Both functions are passed the same arguments: <I>searchstr  | ||||
| </I> is the word or collocation to search for; <I>pos </I> indicates the syntactic  | ||||
| category to search in; <I>ptr_type </I> is one of the valid search types for  | ||||
| <I>searchstr </I> in <I>pos </I>.  (Available searches can be obtained by calling <B>is_defined()</B>  | ||||
| described below.)  <I>sense_num </I> should be <FONT SIZE=-1><B>ALLSENSES </B></FONT> | ||||
|   if the search is to  | ||||
| be done on all senses of <I>searchstr </I> in <I>pos </I>, or a positive integer indicating  | ||||
| which sense to search. <P> | ||||
|  <B>findtheinfo_ds() </B> returns a linked list data structures  | ||||
| representing synsets.  Senses are linked through the <I>nextss </I> field of a  | ||||
| <B>Synset </B> data structure.  For each sense, synsets that match the search  | ||||
| specified with <I>ptr_type </I> are linked through the <I>ptrlist </I> field.  See <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Synset  | ||||
| Navigation </B></FONT> | ||||
|   below, for detailed information on the linked lists returned.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>is_defined() </B> sets a bit for each search type that is valid for <I>searchstr  | ||||
| </I> in <I>pos </I>, and returns the resulting unsigned integer.  Each bit number  | ||||
| corresponds to a pointer type constant defined in <B>WNHOME/include/wn.h </B>.  | ||||
|  For example, if bit 2 is set, the <FONT SIZE=-1><B>HYPERPTR </B></FONT> | ||||
|   search is valid for <I>searchstr  | ||||
| </I>.  There are 29 possible searches. <P> | ||||
|  <B>in_wn() </B> is used to find the syntactic  | ||||
| categories in the WordNet database that contain one or more senses of  | ||||
| <I>searchstr </I>. If <I>pos </I> is <FONT SIZE=-1><B>ALL_POS, </B></FONT> | ||||
|   all syntactic categories are checked.  | ||||
|  Otherwise, only the part of speech passed is checked.  An unsigned integer  | ||||
| is returned with a bit set corresponding to each syntactic category containing  | ||||
| <I>searchstr </I>.  The bit number matches the number for the part of speech.   | ||||
| <B>0 </B> is returned if <I>searchstr </I> is not present in <I>pos </I>. <P> | ||||
|  <B>index_lookup() </B> finds  | ||||
| <I>searchstr </I> in the index file for <I>pos </I> and returns a pointer to the parsed  | ||||
| entry in an <B>Index </B> data structure.  <I>searchstr </I> must exactly match the form  | ||||
| of the word (lower case only, hyphens and underscores in the same places)  | ||||
| in the index file. <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   is returned if a match is not found. <P> | ||||
|  <B>parse_index()  | ||||
| </B> parses an entry from an index file and returns a pointer to the parsed  | ||||
| entry in an <B>Index </B> data structure. Passed the byte <I>offset </I> and syntactic  | ||||
| category, it reads the index entry at the desired location in the corresponding  | ||||
| file.  If passed <I>line </I>, <I>line </I> contains an index file entry and the database  | ||||
| index file is not consulted.  However, <I>offset </I> and <I>dbase </I> should still  | ||||
| be passed so the information can be stored in the <B>Index </B> structure. <P> | ||||
|  <B>getindex()  | ||||
| </B> is a "smart" search for <I>searchstr </I> in the index file corresponding to  | ||||
| <I>pos </I>.  It applies to <I>searchstr </I> an algorithm that replaces underscores  | ||||
| with hyphens, hyphens with underscores, removes hyphens and underscores,  | ||||
| and removes periods in an attempt to find a form of the string that is  | ||||
| an exact match for an entry in the index file corresponding to <I>pos </I>. <B>index_lookup()  | ||||
| </B> is called on each transformed string until a match is found or all the  | ||||
| different strings have been tried.  It returns a pointer to the parsed  | ||||
| <B>Index </B> data structure for <I>searchstr </I>, or <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   if a match is not found.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>read_synset() </B> is used to read a synset from a byte offset in a data  | ||||
| file.  It performs an <B><A HREF="fseek.3.html">fseek </B>(3)</A> | ||||
|  to <I>synset_offset </I> in the data file corresponding  | ||||
| to <I>pos </I>, and calls <B>parse_synset() </B> to read and parse the synset.  A pointer  | ||||
| to the <B>Synset </B> data structure containing the parsed synset is returned.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>parse_synset() </B> reads the synset at the current offset in the file indicated  | ||||
| by <I>fp </I>.  <I>pos </I> is the syntactic category, and <I>searchstr </I>, if not <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL, </B></FONT> | ||||
|   | ||||
|  indicates the word in the synset that the caller is interested in.  An  | ||||
| attempt is made to match <I>searchstr </I> to one of the words in the synset.  | ||||
|  If an exact match is found, the <I>whichword </I> field in the <B>Synset </B> structure  | ||||
| is set to that word's number in the synset (beginning to count from <B>1 </B>).  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>free_syns() </B> is used to free a linked list of <B>Synset </B> structures allocated  | ||||
| by <B>findtheinfo_ds() </B>.  <I>synptr </I> is a pointer to the list to free. <P> | ||||
|  <B>free_synset()  | ||||
| </B> frees the <B>Synset </B> structure pointed to by <I>synptr </I>. <P> | ||||
|  <B>free_index() </B> frees  | ||||
| the <B>Index </B> structure pointed to by <I>idx </I>. <P> | ||||
|  <B>traceptrs_ds() </B> is a recursive  | ||||
| search algorithm that traces pointers matching <I>ptr_type </I> starting with  | ||||
| the synset pointed to by <I>synptr </I>.  Setting <I>depth </I> to <B>1 </B> when <B>traceptrs_ds()  | ||||
| </B> is called indicates a recursive search; <B>0 </B> indicates a non-recursive call.  | ||||
|  <I>synptr </I> points to the data structure representing the synset to search  | ||||
| for a pointer of type <I>ptr_type </I>.  When a pointer type match is found, the  | ||||
| synset pointed to is read is linked onto the <I>nextss </I> chain.  Levels of  | ||||
| the tree generated by a recursive search are linked via the <I>ptrlist </I> field  | ||||
| structure until <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   is found, indicating the top (or bottom) of the  | ||||
| tree.  This function is usually called from <B>findtheinfo_ds() </B> for each  | ||||
| sense of the word.  See <FONT SIZE=-1><B>Synset Navigation </B></FONT> | ||||
|   below, for detailed information  | ||||
| on the linked lists returned. <P> | ||||
|  <B>do_trace() </B> performs the search indicated  | ||||
| by <I>ptr_type </I> on synset  synptr  in syntactic category <I>pos </I>.  <I>depth </I> is  | ||||
| defined as above.  <B>do_trace() </B> returns the search results formatted in  | ||||
| a text buffer.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">Synset Navigation </A></H3> | ||||
| Since the <B>Synset </B> structure is used to  | ||||
| represent the synsets for both word senses and pointers, the <I>ptrlist </I>  | ||||
| and <I>nextss </I> fields have different meanings depending on whether the structure  | ||||
| is a word sense or pointer.  This can make navigation through the lists  | ||||
| returned by <B>findtheinfo_ds() </B> confusing. <P> | ||||
|  Navigation through the returned  | ||||
| list involves the following: <P> | ||||
|  Following the <I>nextss </I> chain from the synset  | ||||
| returned moves through the various senses of <I>searchstr </I>. <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   indicates  | ||||
| that end of the chain of senses. <P> | ||||
|  Following the <I>ptrlist </I> chain from a <B>Synset  | ||||
| </B> structure representing a sense traces the hierarchy of the search results  | ||||
| for that sense.  Subsequent links in the <I>ptrlist </I> chain indicate the next  | ||||
| level (up or down, depending on the search) in the hierarchy. <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   indicates  | ||||
| the end of the chain of search result synsets. <P> | ||||
|  If a synset pointed to  | ||||
| by <I>ptrlist </I> has a value in the <I>nextss </I> field, it represents another pointer  | ||||
| of the same type at that level in the hierarchy.  For example, some noun  | ||||
| synsets have two hypernyms.  Following this <I>nextss </I> pointer, and then the  | ||||
| <I>ptrlist </I> chain from the <B>Synset </B> structure pointed to, traces another,  | ||||
| parallel, hierarchy, until the end is indicated by <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   on that <I>ptrlist  | ||||
| </I> chain.  So, a <B>synset </B> representing a pointer (versus a sense of <I>searchstr  | ||||
| </I>) having a non-NULL value in <I>nextss </I> has another chain of search results  | ||||
| linked through the <I>ptrlist </I> chain of the synset pointed to by <I>nextss </I>.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  If <I>searchstr </I> contains more than one base form in WordNet (as in the  | ||||
| noun <B>axes </B>, which has base forms <B>axe </B> and <B>axis </B>), synsets representing  | ||||
| the search results for each base form are linked through the <I>nextform  | ||||
| </I> pointer of the <B>Synset </B> structure.   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">WordNet Searches </A></H3> | ||||
| There is no extensive  | ||||
| description of what each search type is or the results returned.  Using  | ||||
| the WordNet interface, examining the source code, and reading <B><A HREF="wndb.5WN.html">wndb</B>(5WN)<B></B></A> | ||||
|   | ||||
| are the best ways to see what types of searches are available and the  | ||||
| data returned for each. <P> | ||||
|  Listed below are the valid searches that can be  | ||||
| passed as <I>ptr_type </I> to <B>findtheinfo() </B>.  Passing a negative value (when  | ||||
| applicable) causes a recursive, hierarchical search by setting <I>depth </I>  | ||||
| to <B>1 </B> when <B>traceptrs() </B> is called. <P> | ||||
|    <TABLE BORDER=0> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>ptr_type </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Value </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Pointer </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT><B>Search  | ||||
| </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Symbol </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ANTPTR </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>1 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>! </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Antonyms </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>HYPERPTR </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>2 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>@ </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Hypernyms  | ||||
| </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>HYPOPTR </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>3 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>  </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Hyponyms </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ENTAILPTR </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>4 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>* </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Entailment </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>SIMPTR </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>5  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>& </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Similar </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ISMEMBERPTR </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>6 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>#m </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Member meronym </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ISSTUFFPTR </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>7 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>#s  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Substance meronym </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ISPARTPTR </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>8 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>#p </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Part meronym </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>HASMEMBERPTR </TD>  | ||||
| <TD ALIGN=CENTER>9 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>%m </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Member holonym </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>HASSTUFFPTR </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>10 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>%s </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Substance holonym </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>HASPARTPTR  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>11 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>%p </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Part holonym </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>MERONYM </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>12 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>% </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>All meronyms </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>HOLONYM </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>13 </TD>  | ||||
| <TD ALIGN=CENTER># </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>All holonyms </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>CAUSETO </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>14 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Cause </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>PPLPTR </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>15 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>< </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Participle of  | ||||
| verb </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>SEEALSOPTR </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>16 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>^ </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Also see </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>PERTPTR </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>17 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>\ </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Pertains to noun  | ||||
| or derived from adjective </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>ATTRIBUTE </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>18 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>\= </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Attribute </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>VERBGROUP  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>19 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>$ </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Verb group </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>DERIVATION </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>20 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>+ </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Derivationally related form </TD>  | ||||
| </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>CLASSIFICATION </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>21 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>; </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Domain of synset </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>CLASS </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>22 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>- </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Member of this  | ||||
| domain </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>SYNS </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>23 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><I>n/a </I> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Find synonyms  </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>FREQ </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>24 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><I>n/a </I> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Polysemy </TD>  | ||||
| </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>FRAMES </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>25 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><I>n/a </I> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Verb example sentences and generic frames </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>COORDS  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>26 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><I>n/a </I> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Noun coordinates </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>RELATIVES </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>27 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><I>n/a </I> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Group related senses  | ||||
| </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>HMERONYM </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>28 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><I>n/a </I> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Hierarchical meronym search </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>HHOLONYM </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>29 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><I>n/a  | ||||
| </I> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Hierarchical holonym search </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>WNGREP </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>30 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><I>n/a </I> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Find keywords by substring  | ||||
| </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>OVERVIEW </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>31 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><I>n/a </I> </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Show all synsets for word </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>CLASSIF_CATEGORY </TD>  | ||||
| <TD ALIGN=CENTER>32 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>;c </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Show domain topic </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>CLASSIF_USAGE </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>33 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>;u </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Show domain usage  | ||||
| </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>CLASSIF_REGIONAL </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>34 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>;r </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Show domain region </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>CLASS_CATEGORY </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>35  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>-c </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Show domain terms for topic </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>CLASS_USAGE </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>36 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>-u </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Show domain terms  | ||||
| for usage </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>CLASS_REGIONAL </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>37 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>-r </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Show domain terms for region </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>INSTANCE  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>38 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>@i </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Instance of </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>INSTANCES </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER>39 </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER> i </TD> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Show instances </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  </TABLE> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>findtheinfo_ds()  | ||||
| </B> cannot perform the following searches: <P> | ||||
|   <blockquote>SEEALSOPTR <BR> | ||||
|  PERTPTR <BR> | ||||
|  VERBGROUP  | ||||
| <BR> | ||||
|  FREQ <BR> | ||||
|  FRAMES <BR> | ||||
|  RELATIVES <BR> | ||||
|  WNGREP <BR> | ||||
|  OVERVIEW <BR> | ||||
|   </blockquote> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">NOTES </A></H2> | ||||
| Applications that  | ||||
| use WordNet and/or the morphological functions must call <B>wninit() </B> at  | ||||
| the start of the program.  See <B><A HREF="wnutil.3WN.html">wnutil</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
|  for more information. <P> | ||||
|  In all  | ||||
| function calls, <I>searchstr </I> may be either a word or a collocation formed  | ||||
| by joining individual words with underscore characters (<B>_ </B>). <P> | ||||
|  The <B>SearchResults  | ||||
| </B> structure defines fields in the <I>wnresults </I> global variable that are set  | ||||
| by the various search functions.  This is a way to get additional information,  | ||||
| such as the number of senses the word has, from the search functions. The  | ||||
| <I>searchds </I> field is set by <B>findtheinfo_ds() </B>. <P> | ||||
|  The <I>pos </I> passed to <B>traceptrs_ds()  | ||||
| </B> is not used. <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect6" HREF="#toc6">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wn.1WN.html">wn</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnb.1WN.html">wnb</B>(1WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.3WN.html">wnintro</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="binsrch.3WN.html">binsrch</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="malloc.3.html">malloc</B>(3)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="morph.3WN.html">morph</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnutil.3WN.html">wnutil</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.5WN.html">wnintro</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| .   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect7" HREF="#toc7">WARNINGS </A></H2> | ||||
| <B>parse_synset()  | ||||
| </B> must find an exact match between the <I>searchstr </I> passed and a word in  | ||||
| the synset to set <I>whichword </I>.  No attempt is made to translate hyphens  | ||||
| and underscores, as is done in <B>getindex() </B>. <P> | ||||
|  The WordNet database and exception  | ||||
| list files must be opened with <B>wninit </B> prior to using any of the searching  | ||||
| functions. <P> | ||||
|  A large search may cause <B>findtheinfo() </B> to run out of buffer  | ||||
| space.  The maximum buffer size is determined by computer platform. If the  | ||||
| buffer size is exceeded the following message is printed in the output  | ||||
| buffer: <B>"Search too large.  Narrow search and try again..." </B>. <P> | ||||
|  Passing an invalid  | ||||
| <I>pos </I> will probably result in a core dump. <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">SYNOPSIS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">Synset Navigation</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">WordNet Searches</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc6" HREF="#sect6">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc7" HREF="#sect7">WARNINGS</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										80
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnstats.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										80
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnstats.7WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,80 @@ | |||
| <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNSTATS(7WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| wnstats - WordNet 3.0 database statistics   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">DESCRIPTION </A></H2> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">Number of  | ||||
| words, synsets, and senses </A></H3> | ||||
|  <TABLE BORDER=0> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>POS </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Unique </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Synsets </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Total </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Strings  | ||||
| </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Word-Sense Pairs </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Noun </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>117798 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>82115 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>146312 </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Verb </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>11529 </TD>  | ||||
| <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>13767 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>25047 </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Adjective </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>21479 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>18156 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>30002 </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Adverb </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>4481 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>3621 </TD>  | ||||
| <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>5580 </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Totals </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>155287 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>117659 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>206941 </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  </TABLE> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H3><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">Polysemy information </A></H3> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   <TABLE BORDER=0> | ||||
|  <TR>  | ||||
| <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>POS </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Monosemous </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Polysemous </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Polysemous </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Words and Senses </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Words  | ||||
| </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Senses </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Noun </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>101863 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>15935 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>44449 </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Verb </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>6277 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>5252 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>18770 </TD>  | ||||
| </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Adjective </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>16503 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>4976 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>14399 </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Adverb </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>3748 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>733 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>1832 </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Totals  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>128391 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>26896 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>79450 </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  </TABLE> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|   <TABLE BORDER=0> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>POS </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Average Polysemy </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Average Polysemy  | ||||
| </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=CENTER> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Including Monosemous Words </B> </TD> <TD ALIGN=CENTER><B>Excluding Monosemous Words </B> </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR>  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Noun  | ||||
| </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>1.24 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>2.79 </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Verb </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>2.17 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>3.57 </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Adjective </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>1.40 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>2.71 </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  <TR> <TD ALIGN=LEFT>Adverb </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>1.25 </TD> <TD ALIGN=RIGHT>2.50  | ||||
| </TD> </TR> | ||||
|  </TABLE> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">NOTES </A></H2> | ||||
| Statistics for all types of adjectives and adjective satellites  | ||||
| are combined.   <P> | ||||
|  The total of all unique noun, verb, adjective, and adverb  | ||||
| strings is actually 147278. However, many strings are unique within a syntactic  | ||||
| category, but are in more than one syntactic category.  The figures in  | ||||
| the table represent the unique strings in each syntactic category. <P> | ||||
|  <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">Number of words, synsets, and senses</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">Polysemy information</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										154
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnutil.3WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										154
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/html/wnutil.3WN.html
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,154 @@ | |||
| <!-- manual page source format generated by PolyglotMan v3.0.3a12, --> | ||||
| <!-- available via anonymous ftp from ftp.cs.berkeley.edu:/ucb/people/phelps/tcltk/rman.tar.Z --> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HTML> | ||||
| <HEAD> | ||||
| <TITLE>WNUTIL(3WN) manual page</TITLE> | ||||
| </HEAD> | ||||
| <BODY> | ||||
| <A HREF="#toc">Table of Contents</A><P> | ||||
|   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect0" HREF="#toc0">NAME </A></H2> | ||||
| wninit, re_wninit, cntwords, strtolower, ToLowerCase, strsubst,  | ||||
| getptrtype, getpos, getsstype, StrToPos, GetSynsetForSense, GetDataOffset,  | ||||
| GetPolyCount, WNSnsToStr, GetValidIndexPointer, GetWNSense, GetSenseIndex,  | ||||
| default_display_message   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect1" HREF="#toc1">SYNOPSIS </A></H2> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| <B>#include "wn.h" </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>int wninit(void); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>int  | ||||
| re_wninit(void); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>int cntwords(char *str, char separator); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>char *strtolower(char  | ||||
| *str); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>char *ToLowerCase(char *str); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>char *strsubst(char *str, char  | ||||
| from, char to); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>int getptrtype(char *ptr_symbol); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>int getpos(char *ss_type);  | ||||
| </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>int getsstype(char *ss_type); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>int StrToPos(char pos); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>SynsetPtr GetSynsetForSense(char  | ||||
| *sense_key); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>long GetDataOffset(char *sense_key); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>int GetPolyCount(char  | ||||
| *sense_key); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>char *WNSnsToStr(IndexPtr idx, int sense_num); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>IndexPtr  | ||||
| GetValidIndexPointer(char *str, int pos); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>int GetWNSense(char *lemma,  | ||||
| *lex_sense); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>SnsIndexPtr GetSenseIndex(char *sense_key); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>int GetTagcnt(IndexPtr  | ||||
| idx, int sense); </B> <P> | ||||
| <B>int default_display_message(char *msg); </B>   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect2" HREF="#toc2">DESCRIPTION  | ||||
| </A></H2> | ||||
| <P> | ||||
| The WordNet library contains many utility functions used by the interface  | ||||
| code, other library functions, and various applications and tools.  Only  | ||||
| those of importance to the WordNet search code, or which are generally  | ||||
| useful are described here. <P> | ||||
|  <B>wninit()</B> opens the files necessary for using  | ||||
| WordNet with the WordNet library functions.  The database files are opened,  | ||||
| and  <B>morphinit()</B> is called to open the exception list files.  Returns <B>0  | ||||
| </B> if successful, <B>-1 </B> otherwise.  The database and exception list files must  | ||||
| be open before the WordNet search and morphology functions are used.  If  | ||||
| the database is successfully opened, the global variable <B>OpenDB </B> is set  | ||||
| to <B>1 </B>.  Note that it is possible for the database files to be opened (<B>OpenDB  | ||||
| == 1 </B>), but not the exception list files. <P> | ||||
|  <B>re_wninit()</B> is used to close  | ||||
| the database files and reopen them, and is used exclusively for WordNet  | ||||
| development. <B>re_morphinit() </B> is called to close and reopen the exception  | ||||
| list files.  Return codes are as described above. <P> | ||||
|  <B>cntwords()</B> counts the  | ||||
| number of underscore or space separated words in <I>str </I>. A hyphen is passed  | ||||
| in <I>separator </I> if is is to be considered a word delimiter.  Otherwise <I>separator  | ||||
| </I> can be any other character, or an underscore if another character is  | ||||
| not desired. <P> | ||||
|  <B>strtolower()</B> converts <I>str </I> to lower case and removes a trailing  | ||||
| adjective marker, if present.  <I>str </I> is actually modified by this function,  | ||||
| and a pointer to the modified string is returned. <P> | ||||
|  <B>ToLowerCase()</B> converts  | ||||
| <I>str </I> to lower case as above, without removing an adjective marker. <P> | ||||
|  <B>strsubst()</B>  | ||||
| replaces all occurrences of <I>from </I> with <I>to </I> in <I>str </I> and returns resulting  | ||||
| string. <P> | ||||
|  <B>getptrtype()</B> returns the integer <I>ptr_type </I> corresponding to the  | ||||
| pointer character passed in <I>ptr_symbol </I>.  See <B><A HREF="wnsearch.3WN.html">wnsearch</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
|  for a table  | ||||
| of pointer symbols and types. <P> | ||||
|  <B>getpos()</B> returns the integer constant corresponding  | ||||
| to the synset type passed. <I>ss_type </I> may be one of the following: <B>n, v,  | ||||
| a, r, s </B>.  If <B>s </B> is passed, <FONT SIZE=-1><B>ADJ </B></FONT> | ||||
|   is returned.  Exits with <B>-1 </B> if <I>ss_type  | ||||
| </I> is invalid. <P> | ||||
|  <B>getsstype()</B> works like <B>getpos() </B>, but returns <FONT SIZE=-1><B>SATELLITE </B></FONT> | ||||
|   | ||||
|  if <I>ss_type </I> is <B>s </B>. <P> | ||||
|  <B>StrToPos()</B> returns the integer constant corresponding  | ||||
| to the syntactic category passed in <I>pos </I>.  <I>string </I> must be one of the following:  | ||||
| <B>noun, verb, adj, adv </B>.  <B>-1 </B> is returned if <I>pos </I> is invalid. <P> | ||||
|  <B>GetSynsetForSense()</B>  | ||||
| returns the synset that contains the word sense <I>sense_key </I> and <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|    | ||||
| in case of error. <P> | ||||
|  <B>GetDataOffset()</B> returns the synset offset for synset  | ||||
| that contains the word sense <I>sense_key </I>, and <B>0 </B> if <I>sense_key </I> is not in  | ||||
| sense index file.  <P> | ||||
|  <B>GetPolyCount()</B> returns the polysemy count (number of  | ||||
| senses in WordNet) for <I>lemma </I> encoded in <I>sense_key </I> and <B>0 </B> if word is  | ||||
| not found.  <P> | ||||
|  <B>WNSnsToStr()</B> returns sense key encoding for <I>sense_num </I> entry  | ||||
| in <I>idx </I>. <P> | ||||
|  <B>GetValidIndexPointer()</B> returns the Index structure for <I>word </I>  | ||||
| in <I>pos </I>.  Calls <B><A HREF="morphstr.3WN.html">morphstr</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
|  to find a valid base form if <I>word </I> is inflected.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>GetWNSense()</B> returns the WordNet sense number for the sense key encoding  | ||||
| represented by <I>lemma </I> and <I>lex_sense </I>. <P> | ||||
|  <B>GetSenseIndex()</B> returns parsed sense  | ||||
| index entry for <I>sense_key </I> and  <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   if <I>sense_key </I> is not in sense index.  | ||||
| <P> | ||||
|  <B>GetTagcnt()</B> returns the number of times the sense passed has been tagged  | ||||
| according to the <I>cntlist </I> file. <P> | ||||
|  <B>default_display_message()</B> simply returns  | ||||
| <B>-1 </B>.  This is the default value for the global variable <B>display_message  | ||||
| </B>, that points to a function to call to display an error message.  In general,  | ||||
| applications (including the WordNet interfaces) define an application  | ||||
| specific function and set <B>display_message </B> to point to it.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect3" HREF="#toc3">NOTES </A></H2> | ||||
| <B>include/wn.h  | ||||
| </B> lists all the pointer and search types and their corresponding constant  | ||||
| values.  There is no description of what each search type is or the results  | ||||
| returned. Using the WordNet interface is the best way to see what types  | ||||
| of searches are available, and the data returned for each.   | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect4" HREF="#toc4">SEE ALSO </A></H2> | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnintro.3WN.html">wnintro</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| ,  | ||||
| <B><A HREF="wnsearch.3WN.html">wnsearch</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="morph.3WN.html">morph</B>(3WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.5WN.html">wnintro</B>(5WN)</A> | ||||
| , <B><A HREF="wnintro.7WN.html">wnintro</B>(7WN)</A> | ||||
| . <P> | ||||
|    | ||||
| <H2><A NAME="sect5" HREF="#toc5">WARNINGS </A></H2> | ||||
| Error  | ||||
| checking on passed arguments is not rigorous.  Passing  <FONT SIZE=-1><B>NULL </B></FONT> | ||||
|   pointers  | ||||
| or invalid values will often cause an application to die. <P> | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| <HR><P> | ||||
| <A NAME="toc"><B>Table of Contents</B></A><P> | ||||
| <UL> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc0" HREF="#sect0">NAME</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc1" HREF="#sect1">SYNOPSIS</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc2" HREF="#sect2">DESCRIPTION</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc3" HREF="#sect3">NOTES</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc4" HREF="#sect4">SEE ALSO</A></LI> | ||||
| <LI><A NAME="toc5" HREF="#sect5">WARNINGS</A></LI> | ||||
| </UL> | ||||
| </BODY></HTML> | ||||
							
								
								
									
										478
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/Makefile
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										478
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/Makefile
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,478 @@ | |||
| # Makefile.in generated by automake 1.9 from Makefile.am.
 | ||||
| # doc/man/Makefile.  Generated from Makefile.in by configure.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
 | ||||
| # 2003, 2004  Free Software Foundation, Inc.
 | ||||
| # This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
 | ||||
| # gives unlimited permission to copy and/or distribute it,
 | ||||
| # with or without modifications, as long as this notice is preserved.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | ||||
| # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law; without
 | ||||
| # even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A
 | ||||
| # PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| srcdir = . | ||||
| top_srcdir = ../.. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/WordNet | ||||
| pkglibdir = $(libdir)/WordNet | ||||
| pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/WordNet | ||||
| top_builddir = ../.. | ||||
| am__cd = CDPATH="$${ZSH_VERSION+.}$(PATH_SEPARATOR)" && cd | ||||
| INSTALL = /usr/csl/bin/install -c | ||||
| install_sh_DATA = $(install_sh) -c -m 644 | ||||
| install_sh_PROGRAM = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| install_sh_SCRIPT = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| INSTALL_HEADER = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| transform = $(program_transform_name) | ||||
| NORMAL_INSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_INSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_INSTALL = : | ||||
| NORMAL_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| subdir = doc/man | ||||
| DIST_COMMON = $(srcdir)/Makefile.am $(srcdir)/Makefile.in | ||||
| ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4 | ||||
| am__aclocal_m4_deps = $(top_srcdir)/acinclude.m4 \
 | ||||
| 	$(top_srcdir)/configure.ac | ||||
| am__configure_deps = $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES) \
 | ||||
| 	$(ACLOCAL_M4) | ||||
| mkinstalldirs = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| CONFIG_HEADER = $(top_builddir)/config.h | ||||
| CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES = | ||||
| SOURCES = | ||||
| DIST_SOURCES = | ||||
| man1dir = $(mandir)/man1 | ||||
| am__installdirs = "$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)" "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)" \
 | ||||
| 	"$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)" "$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)" | ||||
| man3dir = $(mandir)/man3 | ||||
| man5dir = $(mandir)/man5 | ||||
| man7dir = $(mandir)/man7 | ||||
| NROFF = nroff | ||||
| MANS = $(man_MANS) | ||||
| DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(DIST_SOURCES) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST) | ||||
| ACLOCAL = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run aclocal-1.9 | ||||
| AMDEP_FALSE = # | ||||
| AMDEP_TRUE =  | ||||
| AMTAR = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run tar | ||||
| AUTOCONF = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run autoconf | ||||
| AUTOHEADER = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run autoheader | ||||
| AUTOMAKE = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run automake-1.9 | ||||
| AWK = nawk | ||||
| CC = gcc | ||||
| CCDEPMODE = depmode=gcc3 | ||||
| CFLAGS = -g -O2 | ||||
| CPP = gcc -E | ||||
| CPPFLAGS =  | ||||
| CYGPATH_W = echo | ||||
| DEFS = -DHAVE_CONFIG_H | ||||
| DEPDIR = .deps | ||||
| ECHO_C =  | ||||
| ECHO_N = -n | ||||
| ECHO_T =  | ||||
| EGREP = egrep | ||||
| EXEEXT =  | ||||
| INSTALL_DATA = ${INSTALL} -m 644 | ||||
| INSTALL_PROGRAM = ${INSTALL} | ||||
| INSTALL_SCRIPT = ${INSTALL} | ||||
| INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM = ${SHELL} $(install_sh) -c -s | ||||
| LDFLAGS =  | ||||
| LIBOBJS =  | ||||
| LIBS =  | ||||
| LTLIBOBJS =  | ||||
| MAKEINFO = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run makeinfo | ||||
| OBJEXT = o | ||||
| PACKAGE = WordNet | ||||
| PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = wordnet@princeton.edu | ||||
| PACKAGE_NAME = WordNet | ||||
| PACKAGE_STRING = WordNet 3.0 | ||||
| PACKAGE_TARNAME = wordnet | ||||
| PACKAGE_VERSION = 3.0 | ||||
| PATH_SEPARATOR = : | ||||
| RANLIB = ranlib | ||||
| SET_MAKE =  | ||||
| SHELL = /bin/bash | ||||
| STRIP =  | ||||
| TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC = -I/usr/csl/include | ||||
| TCL_LIB_SPEC = -L/usr/csl/lib -ltcl8.4 | ||||
| TK_LIBS = -L/usr/openwin/lib -lX11 -ldl  -lpthread -lsocket -lnsl -lm | ||||
| TK_LIB_SPEC = -L/usr/csl/lib -ltk8.4 | ||||
| TK_PREFIX = /usr/csl | ||||
| TK_XINCLUDES = -I/usr/openwin/include | ||||
| VERSION = 3.0 | ||||
| ac_ct_CC = gcc | ||||
| ac_ct_RANLIB = ranlib | ||||
| ac_ct_STRIP =  | ||||
| ac_prefix = /usr/local/WordNet-3.0 | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_FALSE = # | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_TRUE =  | ||||
| am__include = include | ||||
| am__leading_dot = . | ||||
| am__quote =  | ||||
| am__tar = ${AMTAR} chof - "$$tardir" | ||||
| am__untar = ${AMTAR} xf - | ||||
| bindir = ${exec_prefix}/bin | ||||
| build_alias =  | ||||
| datadir = ${prefix}/share | ||||
| exec_prefix = ${prefix} | ||||
| host_alias =  | ||||
| includedir = ${prefix}/include | ||||
| infodir = ${prefix}/info | ||||
| install_sh = /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/install-sh | ||||
| libdir = ${exec_prefix}/lib | ||||
| libexecdir = ${exec_prefix}/libexec | ||||
| localstatedir = ${prefix}/var | ||||
| mandir = ${prefix}/man | ||||
| mkdir_p = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| oldincludedir = /usr/include | ||||
| prefix = /usr/local/WordNet-3.0 | ||||
| program_transform_name = s,x,x, | ||||
| sbindir = ${exec_prefix}/sbin | ||||
| sharedstatedir = ${prefix}/com | ||||
| sysconfdir = ${prefix}/etc | ||||
| target_alias =  | ||||
| man_MANS = binsrch.3 cntlist.5 grind.1 lexnames.5 morph.3 morphy.7 senseidx.5 uniqbeg.7 wn.1 wnb.1 wndb.5 wngloss.7 wngroups.7 wninput.5 wnintro.1 wnintro.3 wnintro.5 wnintro.7 wnlicens.7 wnpkgs.7 wnsearch.3 wnstats.7 wnutil.3 | ||||
| all: all-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SUFFIXES: | ||||
| $(srcdir)/Makefile.in:  $(srcdir)/Makefile.am  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	@for dep in $?; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case '$(am__configure_deps)' in \
 | ||||
| 	    *$$dep*) \
 | ||||
| 	      cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh \
 | ||||
| 		&& exit 0; \
 | ||||
| 	      exit 1;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	echo ' cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/man/Makefile'; \
 | ||||
| 	cd $(top_srcdir) && \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/man/Makefile | ||||
| .PRECIOUS: Makefile | ||||
| Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status | ||||
| 	@case '$?' in \
 | ||||
| 	  *config.status*) \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) \
 | ||||
| 	    echo ' cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe)'; \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe);; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_builddir)/config.status: $(top_srcdir)/configure $(CONFIG_STATUS_DEPENDENCIES) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_srcdir)/configure:  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| $(ACLOCAL_M4):  $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| uninstall-info-am: | ||||
| install-man1: $(man1_MANS) $(man_MANS) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(man1dir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(man1_MANS) $(dist_man1_MANS) $(nodist_man1_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.1*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $(srcdir)/$$i; then file=$(srcdir)/$$i; \
 | ||||
| 	  else file=$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    1*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='1' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) '$$file' '$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(INSTALL_DATA) "$$file" "$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| uninstall-man1: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(man1_MANS) $(dist_man1_MANS) $(nodist_man1_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.1*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    1*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='1' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install-man3: $(man3_MANS) $(man_MANS) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(man3dir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(man3_MANS) $(dist_man3_MANS) $(nodist_man3_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.3*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $(srcdir)/$$i; then file=$(srcdir)/$$i; \
 | ||||
| 	  else file=$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    3*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='3' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) '$$file' '$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(INSTALL_DATA) "$$file" "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| uninstall-man3: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(man3_MANS) $(dist_man3_MANS) $(nodist_man3_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.3*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    3*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='3' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install-man5: $(man5_MANS) $(man_MANS) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(man5dir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(man5_MANS) $(dist_man5_MANS) $(nodist_man5_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.5*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $(srcdir)/$$i; then file=$(srcdir)/$$i; \
 | ||||
| 	  else file=$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    5*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='5' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) '$$file' '$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(INSTALL_DATA) "$$file" "$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| uninstall-man5: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(man5_MANS) $(dist_man5_MANS) $(nodist_man5_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.5*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    5*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='5' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install-man7: $(man7_MANS) $(man_MANS) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(man7dir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(man7_MANS) $(dist_man7_MANS) $(nodist_man7_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.7*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $(srcdir)/$$i; then file=$(srcdir)/$$i; \
 | ||||
| 	  else file=$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    7*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='7' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) '$$file' '$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(INSTALL_DATA) "$$file" "$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| uninstall-man7: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(man7_MANS) $(dist_man7_MANS) $(nodist_man7_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.7*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    7*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='7' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| tags: TAGS | ||||
| TAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ctags: CTAGS | ||||
| CTAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distdir: $(DISTFILES) | ||||
| 	@srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	topsrcdirstrip=`echo "$(top_srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(DISTFILES)'; for file in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case $$file in \
 | ||||
| 	    $(srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(top_srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$topsrcdirstrip/|$(top_builddir)/|"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $$file || test -d $$file; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  dir=`echo "$$file" | sed -e 's,/[^/]*$$,,'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$dir" != "$$file" && test "$$dir" != "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dir="/$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    dir=''; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -d $$d/$$file; then \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -d $(srcdir)/$$file && test $$d != $(srcdir); then \
 | ||||
| 	      cp -pR $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    fi; \
 | ||||
| 	    cp -pR $$d/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || cp -p $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| check-am: all-am | ||||
| check: check-am | ||||
| all-am: Makefile $(MANS) | ||||
| installdirs: | ||||
| 	for dir in "$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)" "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)" "$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)" "$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)"; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test -z "$$dir" || $(mkdir_p) "$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install: install-am | ||||
| install-exec: install-exec-am | ||||
| install-data: install-data-am | ||||
| uninstall: uninstall-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-am: all-am | ||||
| 	@$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) install-exec-am install-data-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck: installcheck-am | ||||
| install-strip: | ||||
| 	$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) INSTALL_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" \
 | ||||
| 	  install_sh_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" INSTALL_STRIP_FLAG=-s \
 | ||||
| 	  `test -z '$(STRIP)' || \
 | ||||
| 	    echo "INSTALL_PROGRAM_ENV=STRIPPROG='$(STRIP)'"` install | ||||
| mostlyclean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-generic: | ||||
| 	-test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean-generic: | ||||
| 	@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use" | ||||
| 	@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild." | ||||
| clean: clean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-am: clean-generic mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean: distclean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| distclean-am: clean-am distclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi: dvi-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| html: html-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info: info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-data-am: install-man | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-exec-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-info: install-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-man: install-man1 install-man3 install-man5 install-man7 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| maintainer-clean-am: distclean-am maintainer-clean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean: mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf: pdf-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps: ps-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-am: uninstall-info-am uninstall-man | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-man: uninstall-man1 uninstall-man3 uninstall-man5 \ | ||||
| 	uninstall-man7 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .PHONY: all all-am check check-am clean clean-generic distclean \ | ||||
| 	distclean-generic distdir dvi dvi-am html html-am info info-am \
 | ||||
| 	install install-am install-data install-data-am install-exec \
 | ||||
| 	install-exec-am install-info install-info-am install-man \
 | ||||
| 	install-man1 install-man3 install-man5 install-man7 \
 | ||||
| 	install-strip installcheck installcheck-am installdirs \
 | ||||
| 	maintainer-clean maintainer-clean-generic mostlyclean \
 | ||||
| 	mostlyclean-generic pdf pdf-am ps ps-am uninstall uninstall-am \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-info-am uninstall-man uninstall-man1 uninstall-man3 \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-man5 uninstall-man7 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
 | ||||
| # Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
 | ||||
| .NOEXPORT: | ||||
							
								
								
									
										1
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/Makefile.am
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										1
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/Makefile.am
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1 @@ | |||
| man_MANS = binsrch.3 cntlist.5 grind.1 lexnames.5 morph.3 morphy.7 senseidx.5 uniqbeg.7 wn.1 wnb.1 wndb.5 wngloss.7 wngroups.7 wninput.5 wnintro.1 wnintro.3 wnintro.5 wnintro.7 wnlicens.7 wnpkgs.7 wnsearch.3 wnstats.7 wnutil.3 | ||||
							
								
								
									
										478
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/Makefile.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										478
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/Makefile.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,478 @@ | |||
| # Makefile.in generated by automake 1.9 from Makefile.am.
 | ||||
| # @configure_input@
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
 | ||||
| # 2003, 2004  Free Software Foundation, Inc.
 | ||||
| # This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
 | ||||
| # gives unlimited permission to copy and/or distribute it,
 | ||||
| # with or without modifications, as long as this notice is preserved.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | ||||
| # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law; without
 | ||||
| # even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A
 | ||||
| # PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| @SET_MAKE@ | ||||
| srcdir = @srcdir@ | ||||
| top_srcdir = @top_srcdir@ | ||||
| VPATH = @srcdir@ | ||||
| pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| pkglibdir = $(libdir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| top_builddir = ../.. | ||||
| am__cd = CDPATH="$${ZSH_VERSION+.}$(PATH_SEPARATOR)" && cd | ||||
| INSTALL = @INSTALL@ | ||||
| install_sh_DATA = $(install_sh) -c -m 644 | ||||
| install_sh_PROGRAM = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| install_sh_SCRIPT = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| INSTALL_HEADER = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| transform = $(program_transform_name) | ||||
| NORMAL_INSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_INSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_INSTALL = : | ||||
| NORMAL_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| subdir = doc/man | ||||
| DIST_COMMON = $(srcdir)/Makefile.am $(srcdir)/Makefile.in | ||||
| ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4 | ||||
| am__aclocal_m4_deps = $(top_srcdir)/acinclude.m4 \
 | ||||
| 	$(top_srcdir)/configure.ac | ||||
| am__configure_deps = $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES) \
 | ||||
| 	$(ACLOCAL_M4) | ||||
| mkinstalldirs = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| CONFIG_HEADER = $(top_builddir)/config.h | ||||
| CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES = | ||||
| SOURCES = | ||||
| DIST_SOURCES = | ||||
| man1dir = $(mandir)/man1 | ||||
| am__installdirs = "$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)" "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)" \
 | ||||
| 	"$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)" "$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)" | ||||
| man3dir = $(mandir)/man3 | ||||
| man5dir = $(mandir)/man5 | ||||
| man7dir = $(mandir)/man7 | ||||
| NROFF = nroff | ||||
| MANS = $(man_MANS) | ||||
| DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(DIST_SOURCES) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST) | ||||
| ACLOCAL = @ACLOCAL@ | ||||
| AMDEP_FALSE = @AMDEP_FALSE@ | ||||
| AMDEP_TRUE = @AMDEP_TRUE@ | ||||
| AMTAR = @AMTAR@ | ||||
| AUTOCONF = @AUTOCONF@ | ||||
| AUTOHEADER = @AUTOHEADER@ | ||||
| AUTOMAKE = @AUTOMAKE@ | ||||
| AWK = @AWK@ | ||||
| CC = @CC@ | ||||
| CCDEPMODE = @CCDEPMODE@ | ||||
| CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@ | ||||
| CPP = @CPP@ | ||||
| CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@ | ||||
| CYGPATH_W = @CYGPATH_W@ | ||||
| DEFS = @DEFS@ | ||||
| DEPDIR = @DEPDIR@ | ||||
| ECHO_C = @ECHO_C@ | ||||
| ECHO_N = @ECHO_N@ | ||||
| ECHO_T = @ECHO_T@ | ||||
| EGREP = @EGREP@ | ||||
| EXEEXT = @EXEEXT@ | ||||
| INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@ | ||||
| INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@ | ||||
| INSTALL_SCRIPT = @INSTALL_SCRIPT@ | ||||
| INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM@ | ||||
| LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@ | ||||
| LIBOBJS = @LIBOBJS@ | ||||
| LIBS = @LIBS@ | ||||
| LTLIBOBJS = @LTLIBOBJS@ | ||||
| MAKEINFO = @MAKEINFO@ | ||||
| OBJEXT = @OBJEXT@ | ||||
| PACKAGE = @PACKAGE@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = @PACKAGE_BUGREPORT@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_NAME = @PACKAGE_NAME@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_STRING = @PACKAGE_STRING@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_TARNAME = @PACKAGE_TARNAME@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_VERSION = @PACKAGE_VERSION@ | ||||
| PATH_SEPARATOR = @PATH_SEPARATOR@ | ||||
| RANLIB = @RANLIB@ | ||||
| SET_MAKE = @SET_MAKE@ | ||||
| SHELL = @SHELL@ | ||||
| STRIP = @STRIP@ | ||||
| TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC = @TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC@ | ||||
| TCL_LIB_SPEC = @TCL_LIB_SPEC@ | ||||
| TK_LIBS = @TK_LIBS@ | ||||
| TK_LIB_SPEC = @TK_LIB_SPEC@ | ||||
| TK_PREFIX = @TK_PREFIX@ | ||||
| TK_XINCLUDES = @TK_XINCLUDES@ | ||||
| VERSION = @VERSION@ | ||||
| ac_ct_CC = @ac_ct_CC@ | ||||
| ac_ct_RANLIB = @ac_ct_RANLIB@ | ||||
| ac_ct_STRIP = @ac_ct_STRIP@ | ||||
| ac_prefix = @ac_prefix@ | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_FALSE = @am__fastdepCC_FALSE@ | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_TRUE = @am__fastdepCC_TRUE@ | ||||
| am__include = @am__include@ | ||||
| am__leading_dot = @am__leading_dot@ | ||||
| am__quote = @am__quote@ | ||||
| am__tar = @am__tar@ | ||||
| am__untar = @am__untar@ | ||||
| bindir = @bindir@ | ||||
| build_alias = @build_alias@ | ||||
| datadir = @datadir@ | ||||
| exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@ | ||||
| host_alias = @host_alias@ | ||||
| includedir = @includedir@ | ||||
| infodir = @infodir@ | ||||
| install_sh = @install_sh@ | ||||
| libdir = @libdir@ | ||||
| libexecdir = @libexecdir@ | ||||
| localstatedir = @localstatedir@ | ||||
| mandir = @mandir@ | ||||
| mkdir_p = @mkdir_p@ | ||||
| oldincludedir = @oldincludedir@ | ||||
| prefix = @prefix@ | ||||
| program_transform_name = @program_transform_name@ | ||||
| sbindir = @sbindir@ | ||||
| sharedstatedir = @sharedstatedir@ | ||||
| sysconfdir = @sysconfdir@ | ||||
| target_alias = @target_alias@ | ||||
| man_MANS = binsrch.3 cntlist.5 grind.1 lexnames.5 morph.3 morphy.7 senseidx.5 uniqbeg.7 wn.1 wnb.1 wndb.5 wngloss.7 wngroups.7 wninput.5 wnintro.1 wnintro.3 wnintro.5 wnintro.7 wnlicens.7 wnpkgs.7 wnsearch.3 wnstats.7 wnutil.3 | ||||
| all: all-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SUFFIXES: | ||||
| $(srcdir)/Makefile.in:  $(srcdir)/Makefile.am  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	@for dep in $?; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case '$(am__configure_deps)' in \
 | ||||
| 	    *$$dep*) \
 | ||||
| 	      cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh \
 | ||||
| 		&& exit 0; \
 | ||||
| 	      exit 1;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	echo ' cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/man/Makefile'; \
 | ||||
| 	cd $(top_srcdir) && \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/man/Makefile | ||||
| .PRECIOUS: Makefile | ||||
| Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status | ||||
| 	@case '$?' in \
 | ||||
| 	  *config.status*) \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) \
 | ||||
| 	    echo ' cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe)'; \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe);; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_builddir)/config.status: $(top_srcdir)/configure $(CONFIG_STATUS_DEPENDENCIES) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_srcdir)/configure:  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| $(ACLOCAL_M4):  $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| uninstall-info-am: | ||||
| install-man1: $(man1_MANS) $(man_MANS) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(man1dir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(man1_MANS) $(dist_man1_MANS) $(nodist_man1_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.1*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $(srcdir)/$$i; then file=$(srcdir)/$$i; \
 | ||||
| 	  else file=$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    1*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='1' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) '$$file' '$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(INSTALL_DATA) "$$file" "$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| uninstall-man1: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(man1_MANS) $(dist_man1_MANS) $(nodist_man1_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.1*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    1*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='1' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install-man3: $(man3_MANS) $(man_MANS) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(man3dir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(man3_MANS) $(dist_man3_MANS) $(nodist_man3_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.3*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $(srcdir)/$$i; then file=$(srcdir)/$$i; \
 | ||||
| 	  else file=$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    3*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='3' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) '$$file' '$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(INSTALL_DATA) "$$file" "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| uninstall-man3: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(man3_MANS) $(dist_man3_MANS) $(nodist_man3_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.3*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    3*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='3' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install-man5: $(man5_MANS) $(man_MANS) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(man5dir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(man5_MANS) $(dist_man5_MANS) $(nodist_man5_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.5*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $(srcdir)/$$i; then file=$(srcdir)/$$i; \
 | ||||
| 	  else file=$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    5*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='5' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) '$$file' '$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(INSTALL_DATA) "$$file" "$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| uninstall-man5: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(man5_MANS) $(dist_man5_MANS) $(nodist_man5_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.5*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    5*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='5' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install-man7: $(man7_MANS) $(man_MANS) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(man7dir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(man7_MANS) $(dist_man7_MANS) $(nodist_man7_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.7*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $(srcdir)/$$i; then file=$(srcdir)/$$i; \
 | ||||
| 	  else file=$$i; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    7*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='7' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) '$$file' '$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(INSTALL_DATA) "$$file" "$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| uninstall-man7: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(man7_MANS) $(dist_man7_MANS) $(nodist_man7_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	l2='$(man_MANS) $(dist_man_MANS) $(nodist_man_MANS)'; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$l2; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$i" in \
 | ||||
| 	    *.7*) list="$$list $$i" ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	for i in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  ext=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/^.*\\.//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  case "$$ext" in \
 | ||||
| 	    7*) ;; \
 | ||||
| 	    *) ext='7' ;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$i | sed -e 's/\\.[0-9a-z]*$$//'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed -e 's/^.*\///'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  inst=`echo $$inst | sed '$(transform)'`.$$ext; \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)/$$inst'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)/$$inst"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| tags: TAGS | ||||
| TAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ctags: CTAGS | ||||
| CTAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distdir: $(DISTFILES) | ||||
| 	@srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	topsrcdirstrip=`echo "$(top_srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(DISTFILES)'; for file in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case $$file in \
 | ||||
| 	    $(srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(top_srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$topsrcdirstrip/|$(top_builddir)/|"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $$file || test -d $$file; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  dir=`echo "$$file" | sed -e 's,/[^/]*$$,,'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$dir" != "$$file" && test "$$dir" != "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dir="/$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    dir=''; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -d $$d/$$file; then \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -d $(srcdir)/$$file && test $$d != $(srcdir); then \
 | ||||
| 	      cp -pR $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    fi; \
 | ||||
| 	    cp -pR $$d/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || cp -p $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| check-am: all-am | ||||
| check: check-am | ||||
| all-am: Makefile $(MANS) | ||||
| installdirs: | ||||
| 	for dir in "$(DESTDIR)$(man1dir)" "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)" "$(DESTDIR)$(man5dir)" "$(DESTDIR)$(man7dir)"; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test -z "$$dir" || $(mkdir_p) "$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install: install-am | ||||
| install-exec: install-exec-am | ||||
| install-data: install-data-am | ||||
| uninstall: uninstall-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-am: all-am | ||||
| 	@$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) install-exec-am install-data-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck: installcheck-am | ||||
| install-strip: | ||||
| 	$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) INSTALL_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" \
 | ||||
| 	  install_sh_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" INSTALL_STRIP_FLAG=-s \
 | ||||
| 	  `test -z '$(STRIP)' || \
 | ||||
| 	    echo "INSTALL_PROGRAM_ENV=STRIPPROG='$(STRIP)'"` install | ||||
| mostlyclean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-generic: | ||||
| 	-test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean-generic: | ||||
| 	@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use" | ||||
| 	@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild." | ||||
| clean: clean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-am: clean-generic mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean: distclean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| distclean-am: clean-am distclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi: dvi-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| html: html-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info: info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-data-am: install-man | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-exec-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-info: install-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-man: install-man1 install-man3 install-man5 install-man7 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| maintainer-clean-am: distclean-am maintainer-clean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean: mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf: pdf-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps: ps-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-am: uninstall-info-am uninstall-man | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-man: uninstall-man1 uninstall-man3 uninstall-man5 \ | ||||
| 	uninstall-man7 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .PHONY: all all-am check check-am clean clean-generic distclean \ | ||||
| 	distclean-generic distdir dvi dvi-am html html-am info info-am \
 | ||||
| 	install install-am install-data install-data-am install-exec \
 | ||||
| 	install-exec-am install-info install-info-am install-man \
 | ||||
| 	install-man1 install-man3 install-man5 install-man7 \
 | ||||
| 	install-strip installcheck installcheck-am installdirs \
 | ||||
| 	maintainer-clean maintainer-clean-generic mostlyclean \
 | ||||
| 	mostlyclean-generic pdf pdf-am ps ps-am uninstall uninstall-am \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-info-am uninstall-man uninstall-man1 uninstall-man3 \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-man5 uninstall-man7 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
 | ||||
| # Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
 | ||||
| .NOEXPORT: | ||||
							
								
								
									
										66
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/binsrch.3
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										66
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/binsrch.3
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,66 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .TH BINSRCH 3WN  "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm Library Functions" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| bin_search, copyfile, replace_line, insert_line | ||||
| .SH SYNOPSIS | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBchar *bin_search(char *key, FILE *fp);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBvoid copyfile(FILE *fromfp, FILE *tofp);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBchar *replace_line(char *new_line, char *key, FILE *fp);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBchar *insert_line(char *new_line, char *key, FILE *fp);\fP | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| The WordNet library contains several general purpose functions for | ||||
| performing a binary search and modifying sorted files. | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| .B bin_search(\|) | ||||
| is the primary binary search algorithm to search for \fIkey\fP as the | ||||
| first item on a line in the file pointed to by \fIfp\fP.  The | ||||
| delimiter between the key and the rest of the fields on the line, if | ||||
| any, must be a space.  A pointer to a static variable containing the | ||||
| entire line is returned. | ||||
| .SB NULL  | ||||
| is returned if a match is not found. | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| The remaining functions are not used by WordNet, and are only briefly | ||||
| described. | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| .B copyfile(\|) | ||||
| copies the contents of one file to another. | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| .B replace_line(\|) | ||||
| replaces a line in a file having searchkey \fIkey\fP | ||||
| with the contents of \fInew_line\fP. | ||||
| It returns the original line or | ||||
| .SB NULL | ||||
| in case of error. | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| .B insert_line(\|) | ||||
| finds the proper place to insert the contents of \fInew_line\fP, | ||||
| having searchkey \fIkey\fP in the sorted file pointed to by \fIfp\fP. | ||||
| It returns | ||||
| .SB NULL  | ||||
| if a line with this searchkey is already in the file. | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| The maximum length of \fIkey\fP is 1024. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The maximum line length in a file is 25K. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| If there are no additional fields after the search key, the key must | ||||
| be followed by at least one space before the newline character. | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wnintro (3WN), | ||||
| .BR morph (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnsearch (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnutil (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (5WN). | ||||
| .SH WARNINGS | ||||
| \fBbinsearch(\|)\fP returns a pointer to a static character buffer. | ||||
| The returned string should be copied by the caller if the results need | ||||
| to be saved, as a subsequent call will replace the contents of the | ||||
| static buffer. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
							
								
								
									
										92
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/cntlist.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										92
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/cntlist.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,92 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH CNTLIST 5WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm File Formats" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| cntlist \- file listing number of times each tagged sense occurs in a | ||||
| semantic concordance, sorted most to least frequently tagged | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| cntlist.rev \- file listing number of times each tagged sense occurs | ||||
| in a semantic concordance, sorted by sense key | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| A cntlist file for a semantic concordance lists the number of times | ||||
| each semantically tagged sense occurs in the concordance and its | ||||
| sense number in the WordNet database.  Each line in the file | ||||
| corresponds to a sense in the WordNet database to which at least one | ||||
| semantic tag points.  Only senses that are tagged in a concordance are | ||||
| in the concordance's cntlist file. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SS WordNet Database \fIcntlist\fP File | ||||
| In the WordNet database, words are assigned sense numbers based on | ||||
| frequency of use in semantically tagged corpora.  The cntlist file used | ||||
| by | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN)  | ||||
| to build the WordNet database and assign the sense numbers is a union | ||||
| of the cntlist files from the various semantic concordances that were | ||||
| formerly released by Princeton University.  This | ||||
| combined cntlist file is provided with the WordNet package and is | ||||
| found in the \fBWNSEARCHDIR\fP directory. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fIcntlist.rev\fP file is used at run-time by the WordNet | ||||
| library code and browser interfaces to print in the output display the | ||||
| number of times each sense has been tagged. | ||||
| .SS File Format | ||||
| Each line in a cntlist file contains information for one sense.  The | ||||
| file is ordered from most to least frequently tagged sense.  The | ||||
| fields are separated by one space, and each line is terminated with a | ||||
| newline character.  Senses having the same \fItag_cnt\fP value are | ||||
| listed in reverse alphabetical order of the \fIlemma\fP field of the | ||||
| \fIsense_key\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Each line in \fBcntlist\fP is of the form: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| \fItag_cnt~~sense_key~~sense_number\fP | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| where \fItag_cnt\fP is the decimal number of times the sense is tagged | ||||
| in the corresponding semantic concordance.  \fIsense_key\fP is a | ||||
| WordNet sense encoding and \fIsense_number\fP is a WordNet sense | ||||
| number as described in | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fIcntlist.rev\fP file contains the same fields described above, | ||||
| in the following order: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| \fIsense_key~~sense_number~~tag_cnt\fP | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| Princeton no longer maintains or releases the Semantic Concordance | ||||
| files.  The \fIcntlist\fP file used to order the senses in WordNet | ||||
| 3.0 was generated from the Semantic Concordance files at the point | ||||
| that they were last updated in 2001.  In general, the order of senses | ||||
| presented usually reflects what the user would expect, however sense | ||||
| ordering is now less reliable than in prior releases and should not be | ||||
| construed as an accurate indicator of frequency of use. | ||||
| .SH ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNHOME | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fB/usr/local/WordNet-3.0\fP. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNSEARCHDIR | ||||
| Directory in which the WordNet database has been installed.   | ||||
| Default is \fBWNHOME/dict\fP. | ||||
| .SH REGISTRY (WINDOWS) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\eSOFTWARE\eWordNet\e3.0\eWNHome | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fBC:\eProgram~Files\eWordNet\e3.0\fP. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B HKEY_CURRENT_USER\eSOFTWARE\eWordNet\e3.0\ewnres | ||||
| User's default browser options. | ||||
| .SH FILES | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B cntlist, cntlist.rev | ||||
| file of combined semantic concordance \fBcntlist\fP files.  Used to | ||||
| assign sense numbers in WordNet database | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (5WN), | ||||
| .BR senseidx (5WN). | ||||
							
								
								
									
										161
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/grind.1
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										161
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/grind.1
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,161 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH GRIND 1 "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm User Commands" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| grind \- process WordNet lexicographer files | ||||
| .SH SYNOPSIS | ||||
| \fBgrind\fP [ \fB\-v\fP ] [ \fB\-s\fP ] [ \fB\-L\fP\fIlogfile\fP ] [ \fB\-a\fP ] [ \fB\-d\fP ] [ \fB\-i\fP ] [ \fB\-o\fP ] [ \fB\-n\fP ] \fIfilename\fP [ \fIfilename\fP\&.\|.\|. ] | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| \fBgrind(\|)\fP processes WordNet lexicographer files, producing | ||||
| database files suitable for use with the WordNet search and interface | ||||
| code and other applications.  The syntactic and structural integrity | ||||
| of the input files is verified.  Warnings and errors are reported via | ||||
| \fBstderr\fP and a run-time log is produced on \fBstdout\fP.  A | ||||
| database is generated only if there are no errors. | ||||
| .SS Input Files | ||||
| Input files correspond to the syntactic categories implemented in | ||||
| WordNet \- | ||||
| .BR noun ", "  | ||||
| .BR verb ", "  | ||||
| .BR adjective " and "  | ||||
| .BR adverb . | ||||
| Each input lexicographer file consists of a list of synonym sets | ||||
| (\fIsynsets\fP) for one part of speech.  Although the basic synset | ||||
| syntax is the same for all of the parts of speech, some parts of the | ||||
| syntax only apply to a particular part of speech.  See | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN)  | ||||
| for a description of the input file format. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Each \fIfilename\fP specified is of the form: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .IB pathname / pos . suffix | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| where \fIpathname\fP is optional and \fIpos\fP is either | ||||
| .BR noun ", "  | ||||
| .BR verb ", "  | ||||
| .BR adj " or "  | ||||
| .BR adv . | ||||
| \fIsuffix\fP may be used to separate groups of synsets into different | ||||
| files, for example \fBnoun.animal\fP and \fBnoun.plant\fP.  One or | ||||
| more input files, in any combination of syntactic categories, may be | ||||
| specified.  See | ||||
| .BR lexnames (5WN) | ||||
| for a list of the lexicographer files used to build the complete | ||||
| WordNet database. | ||||
| .SS Output Files | ||||
| \fBgrind(\|)\fP produces the following output files: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TS  | ||||
| center box ; | ||||
| c | c | ||||
| l | l. | ||||
| \fBFilename	Description\fP | ||||
| _ | ||||
| \fBindex.\fIpos\fR	Index file for each syntactic category | ||||
| \fBdata.\fIpos\fR	Data file for each syntactic category | ||||
| \fBindex.sense\fP	Sense index | ||||
| .TE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| See  | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN)  | ||||
| for a description of the database file formats. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Each time \fBgrind(\|)\fP is run, any existing database files are | ||||
| overwritten with the database files generated from the specified input | ||||
| files.  If no input files from a syntactic category are specified, | ||||
| the corresponding database files are not overwritten. | ||||
| .SS Sense Numbers | ||||
| Senses are generally ordered from most to least frequently used, with | ||||
| the most common sense numbered \fB1\fP.  Frequency of use is | ||||
| determined by the number of times a sense is tagged in the various | ||||
| semantic concordance texts.  Senses that are not semantically tagged | ||||
| follow the ordered senses in an arbitrary order.   | ||||
| Note that this ordering is only an | ||||
| estimate based on usage in a small corpus. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fItagsense_cnt\fP field for each | ||||
| entry in the \fBindex.\fIpos\fR files indicates how many of the senses | ||||
| in the list have been tagged. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fBcntlist\fP file provided with the database lists the number of | ||||
| times each sense is tagged in the semantic concordances. | ||||
| \fBgrind(\|)\fP uses the data from \fBcntlist\fP to order the senses | ||||
| of each word.  When the \fBindex\fP.\fIpos\fP files are generated, the | ||||
| \fIsynset_offset\fPs are output in sense number order, with sense 1 | ||||
| first in the list.  Senses with the same number of semantic tags are | ||||
| assigned unique but consecutive sense numbers.  The WordNet | ||||
| .SB OVERVIEW | ||||
| search displays all senses of the specified word, in all syntactic | ||||
| categories, and indicates which of the senses are represented in the | ||||
| semantically tagged texts. | ||||
| .SH OPTIONS | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-v | ||||
| Verify integrity of input without generating database. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-s | ||||
| Suppress generation of warning messages.  Usually \fBgrind\fP is run | ||||
| with this option until all syntactic and structural errors are corrected | ||||
| since the warning messages may make it difficult to spot error | ||||
| messages. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .BI \-L logfile | ||||
| Write all messages to \fIlogfile\fP instead of \fBstderr\fP. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-a | ||||
| Generate statistical report on input files processed. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-d | ||||
| Generate distribution of senses by string length report on input files | ||||
| processed.  | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-i | ||||
| Generate sense index file. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-o | ||||
| Order senses using \fBcntlist\fP. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-n | ||||
| Generate nominalization (derivational morphology) links in database. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I filename | ||||
| Input file of the form described in  | ||||
| .SB Input Files. | ||||
| .SH FILES | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B \fIpos\fP.* | ||||
| lexicographer files to use to build database | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B cntlist | ||||
| file of combined semantic concordance \fBcntlist\fP files.  Used to | ||||
| assign sense numbers in WordNet database | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR cntlist (5WN), | ||||
| .BR lexnames (5WN), | ||||
| .BR senseidx (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN), | ||||
| .BR uniqbeg (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wngloss (7WN). | ||||
| .SH DIAGNOSTICS | ||||
| Exit status is normally 0. | ||||
| Exit status is -1 if non-specific error occurs. | ||||
| If syntactic or structural errors exist, exit status is number of | ||||
| errors detected. | ||||
| .TP  | ||||
| .B "usage: grind [\-v] [\-s] [\-Llogfile] [\-a ] [\-d] [\-i] [\-o] [\-n] filename [filename...]" | ||||
| Invalid options were specified on the command line. | ||||
| .TP  | ||||
| .B No input files processed. | ||||
| None of the filenames specified were of the appropriate form. | ||||
| .TP  | ||||
| .B \fIn\fP syntactic errors found. | ||||
| Syntax errors were found while parsing the input files. | ||||
| .TP  | ||||
| .B \fIn\fP structural errors found. | ||||
| Pointer errors were found that could not be automatically corrected. | ||||
| .SH BUGS | ||||
| Please report bugs to \fBwordnet@princeton.edu\fP. | ||||
							
								
								
									
										123
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/lexnames.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										123
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/lexnames.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,123 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH LEXNAMES 5WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm File Formats" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| List of WordNet lexicographer file names and numbers | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| During WordNet development synsets are organized into forty-five | ||||
| lexicographer files based on syntactic category and logical groupings. | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN) | ||||
| processes these files and produces a database suitable for use with | ||||
| the WordNet library, interface code, and other applications.  The | ||||
| format of the lexicographer files is described in | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| A file number corresponds to each lexicographer file.  File numbers | ||||
| are encoded in several parts of the WordNet system as an efficient way | ||||
| to indicate a lexicographer file name.  The file \fBlexnames\fP lists | ||||
| the mapping between file names and numbers, and can be used by | ||||
| programs or end users to correlate the two. | ||||
| .SS File Format | ||||
| Each line in \fBlexnames\fP contains 3 tab separated fields, and is | ||||
| terminated with a newline character.  The first field is the two digit | ||||
| decimal integer file number.  (The first file in the list is numbered | ||||
| \fB00\fP.)  The second field is the name of the lexicographer file that | ||||
| is represented by that number, and the third field is an integer that | ||||
| indicates the syntactic category of the synsets contained in the file. | ||||
| This is simply a shortcut for programs and scripts, since the | ||||
| syntactic category is also part of the lexicographer file's name. | ||||
| .SS Syntactic Category | ||||
| The syntactic category field is encoded as follows: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB1\fP	NOUN | ||||
| \fB2\fP	VERB | ||||
| \fB3\fP	ADJECTIVE | ||||
| \fB4\fP	ADVERB | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .SS Lexicographer Files | ||||
| The names of the lexicographer files and their corresponding file | ||||
| numbers are listed below along with a brief description each file's | ||||
| contents.  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .TS | ||||
| center ; | ||||
| l l l. | ||||
| \fBFile Number\fP	\fBName\fP	\fBContents\fP | ||||
| _ | ||||
| 00	adj.all	all adjective clusters | ||||
| 01	adj.pert	relational adjectives (pertainyms)	   | ||||
| 02	adv.all	all adverbs | ||||
| 03	noun.Tops	unique beginner for nouns | ||||
| 04	noun.act	nouns denoting acts or actions  | ||||
| 05	noun.animal	nouns denoting animals | ||||
| 06	noun.artifact	nouns denoting man-made objects	   | ||||
| 07	noun.attribute	nouns denoting attributes of people and objects   | ||||
| 08	noun.body	nouns denoting body parts   | ||||
| 09	noun.cognition	nouns denoting cognitive processes and contents | ||||
| 10	noun.communication	nouns denoting communicative processes and contents   | ||||
| 11	noun.event	nouns denoting natural events   | ||||
| 12	noun.feeling	nouns denoting feelings and emotions   | ||||
| 13	noun.food	nouns denoting foods and drinks   | ||||
| 14	noun.group	nouns denoting groupings of people or objects   | ||||
| 15	noun.location	nouns denoting spatial position  | ||||
| 16	noun.motive	nouns denoting goals   | ||||
| 17	noun.object	nouns denoting natural objects (not man-made)   | ||||
| 18	noun.person  	nouns denoting people | ||||
| 19	noun.phenomenon	nouns denoting natural phenomena   | ||||
| 20	noun.plant	nouns denoting plants  | ||||
| 21	noun.possession	nouns denoting possession and transfer of possession   | ||||
| 22	noun.process	nouns denoting natural processes   | ||||
| 23	noun.quantity	nouns denoting quantities and units of measure   | ||||
| 24	noun.relation	nouns denoting relations between people or things or ideas   | ||||
| 25	noun.shape	nouns denoting two and three dimensional shapes   | ||||
| 26	noun.state	nouns denoting stable states of affairs   | ||||
| 27	noun.substance	nouns denoting substances   | ||||
| 28	noun.time	nouns denoting time and temporal relations   | ||||
| 29	verb.body	verbs of grooming, dressing and bodily care   | ||||
| 30	verb.change	verbs of size, temperature change, intensifying, etc.   | ||||
| 31	verb.cognition	verbs of thinking, judging, analyzing, doubting   | ||||
| 32	verb.communication	verbs of telling, asking, ordering, singing   | ||||
| 33	verb.competition	verbs of fighting, athletic activities   | ||||
| 34	verb.consumption	verbs of eating and drinking   | ||||
| 35	verb.contact	verbs of touching, hitting, tying, digging   | ||||
| 36	verb.creation	verbs of sewing, baking, painting, performing   | ||||
| 37	verb.emotion	verbs of feeling   | ||||
| 38	verb.motion	verbs of walking, flying, swimming   | ||||
| 39	verb.perception	verbs of seeing, hearing, feeling  | ||||
| 40	verb.possession	verbs of buying, selling, owning   | ||||
| 41	verb.social	verbs of political and social activities and events   | ||||
| 42	verb.stative	verbs of being, having, spatial relations   | ||||
| 43	verb.weather	verbs of raining, snowing, thawing, thundering   | ||||
| 44	adj.ppl	participial adjectives | ||||
| .TE | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| The lexicographer files are not included in the WordNet database package. | ||||
| .SH ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNHOME | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fB/usr/local/WordNet-3.0\fP. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNSEARCHDIR | ||||
| Directory in which the WordNet database has been installed.   | ||||
| Default is \fBWNHOME/dict\fP. | ||||
| .SH REGISTRY (WINDOWS) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\eSOFTWARE\eWordNet\e3.0\eWNHome | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fBC:\eProgram~Files\eWordNet\e3.0\fP. | ||||
| .SH FILES | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B lexnames | ||||
| list of lexicographer file names and numbers | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN). | ||||
							
								
								
									
										110
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/morph.3
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										110
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/morph.3
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,110 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .TH MORPH 3WN  "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm Library Functions" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| morphinit, re_morphinit, morphstr, morphword | ||||
| .SH SYNOPSIS | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fB#include "wn.h"\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBint morphinit(void);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBint re_morphinit(void);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBchar *morphstr(char *origstr, int pos);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBchar *morphword(char *word, int pos);\fP | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| The WordNet morphological processor, Morphy, is accessed through these | ||||
| functions: | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| .B morphinit(\|) | ||||
| is used to open the exception list files.  It returns \fB0\fP if | ||||
| successful, \fB-1\fP otherwise.  The exception list files must be | ||||
| opened before | ||||
| .B morphstr(\|)  | ||||
| or | ||||
| .B morphword(\) | ||||
| are called. | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| .B re_morphinit(\|) | ||||
| is used to close the exception list files and reopen them, and is used | ||||
| exclusively for WordNet development.  Return codes are as described | ||||
| above. | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| .B morphstr(\|) | ||||
| is the basic user interface to Morphy.  It tries to find the base form | ||||
| (lemma) of the word or collocation \fIorigstr\fP in the specified | ||||
| \fIpos\fP.  The first call (with \fIorigstr\fP specified) returns a | ||||
| pointer to the first base form found.  Subsequent calls requesting | ||||
| base forms of the same string must be made with the first argument of | ||||
| .SB NULL. | ||||
| When no more base forms for \fIorigstr\fP can be found, | ||||
| .SB NULL | ||||
| is returned.  Note that \fBmorphstr()\fP returns a pointer to a static | ||||
| character buffer.  A subsequent call to \fBmorphstr()\fP with a new | ||||
| string (instead of \fBNULL\fP) will overwrite the string pointed to by | ||||
| a previous call.  Users should copy the returned string into a local | ||||
| buffer, or use the C library function \fBstrdup\fP to duplicate the | ||||
| returned string into a \fImalloc'd\fP buffer. | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| .B morphword(\|) | ||||
| tries to find the base form of \fIword\fP in the specified \fIpos\fP. | ||||
| This function is called by | ||||
| .B morphstr(\|) | ||||
| for each individual word in a collocation. | ||||
| Note that \fBmorphword()\fP returns a pointer to a static | ||||
| character buffer.  A subsequent call to \fBmorphword()\fP  | ||||
| will overwrite the string pointed to by | ||||
| a previous call.  Users should copy the returned string into a local | ||||
| buffer, or use the C library function \fBstrdup\fP to duplicate the | ||||
| returned string into a \fImalloc'd\fP buffer. | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| .B morphinit(\|) | ||||
| is called by  | ||||
| .B wninit(\|)  | ||||
| and is not intended to be called directly by an application. | ||||
| Applications wishing to use WordNet and/or the morphological functions | ||||
| must call \fBwninit(\|)\fP at the start of the program.  See | ||||
| .BR wnutil (3WN) | ||||
| for more information. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIorigstr\fP may be either a word or a collocation formed by joining | ||||
| individual words with underscore characters (\fB_\fP). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Usually only \fBmorphstr(\|)\fP is called from applications, as it | ||||
| works on both words and collocations. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIpos\fP must be one of the following: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB1\fP	NOUN | ||||
| \fB2\fP	VERB | ||||
| \fB3\fP	ADJECTIVE | ||||
| \fB4\fP	ADVERB | ||||
| \fB5\fP	ADJECTIVE_SATELLITE | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| If  | ||||
| .SB ADJECTIVE_SATELLITE  | ||||
| is passed, it is treated by \fBmorphstr(\|)\fP as | ||||
| .SB ADJECTIVE. | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wnintro (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnsearch (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN), | ||||
| .BR morphy (7WN). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SH WARNINGS | ||||
| Passing an invalid part of speech will result in a core dump. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The WordNet database files must be open to use \fBmorphstr(\|)\fP or | ||||
| \fBmorphword(\|).  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SH BUGS | ||||
| Morphy will allow non-words to be converted to words, if they follow | ||||
| one of the rules described above.  For example, it will happily | ||||
| convert \fBplantes\fP to \fBplants\fP. | ||||
							
								
								
									
										180
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/morphy.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										180
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/morphy.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,180 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH MORPHY 7WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| morphy \- discussion of WordNet's morphological processing | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| Although only base forms of words are usually stored in WordNet, | ||||
| searches may be done on inflected forms.  A set of morphology | ||||
| functions, Morphy, is applied to the search string to generate a form | ||||
| that is present in WordNet. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Morphology in WordNet uses two types of processes to try to convert | ||||
| the string passed into one that can be found in the WordNet database. | ||||
| There are lists of inflectional endings, based on syntactic category, | ||||
| that can be detached from individual words in an attempt to find a | ||||
| form of the word that is in WordNet.  There are also exception list | ||||
| files, one for each syntactic category, in which a search for an | ||||
| inflected form is done.  Morphy tries to use these two processes in an | ||||
| intelligent manner to translate the string passed to the base form | ||||
| found in WordNet.  Morphy first checks for exceptions, then uses the | ||||
| rules of detachment.  The Morphy functions are not independent from | ||||
| WordNet. After each transformation, WordNet is searched for the | ||||
| resulting string in the syntactic category specified. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The Morphy functions are passed a string and a syntactic category.  A | ||||
| string is either a single word or a collocation.  Since some words, | ||||
| such as \fBaxes\fP can have more than one base form (\fBaxe\fP and | ||||
| \fBaxis\fP), Morphy works in the following manner.  The first time | ||||
| that Morphy is called with a specific string, it returns a base form. | ||||
| For each subsequent call to Morphy made with a  | ||||
| .SB NULL  | ||||
| string argument, Morphy returns another base form.  Whenever Morphy | ||||
| cannot perform a transformation, whether on the first call for a word | ||||
| or subsequent calls, | ||||
| .SB NULL  | ||||
| is returned.  A transformation to a valid English string will return  | ||||
| .SB NULL | ||||
| if the base form of the string is not in WordNet. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The morphological functions are found in the WordNet library.  See | ||||
| .BR morph (3WN) | ||||
| for information on using these functions.   | ||||
| .SS Rules of Detachment | ||||
| The following table shows the rules of detachment used by Morphy.  If | ||||
| a word ends with one of the suffixes, it is stripped from the word and | ||||
| the corresponding ending is added.  Then WordNet is searched for the | ||||
| resulting string.  No rules are applicable to adverbs. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TS | ||||
| center, tab(+) ; | ||||
| c | c | c | ||||
| l | l | l. | ||||
| \fBPOS\fP+\fBSuffix\fP+\fBEnding\fP | ||||
| _ | ||||
| NOUN+"s"+"" | ||||
| NOUN+"ses"+"s" | ||||
| NOUN+"xes"+"x" | ||||
| NOUN+"zes"+"z" | ||||
| NOUN+"ches"+"ch" | ||||
| NOUN+"shes"+"sh" | ||||
| NOUN+"men"+"man" | ||||
| NOUN+"ies"+"y" | ||||
| VERB+"s"+"" | ||||
| VERB+"ies"+"y" | ||||
| VERB+"es"+"e" | ||||
| VERB+"es"+"" | ||||
| VERB+"ed"+"e" | ||||
| VERB+"ed"+"" | ||||
| VERB+"ing"+"e" | ||||
| VERB+"ing"+"" | ||||
| ADJ+"er"+"" | ||||
| ADJ+"est"+"" | ||||
| ADJ+"er"+"e" | ||||
| ADJ+"est"+"e" | ||||
| .TE | ||||
| .SS Exception Lists | ||||
| There is one exception list file for each syntactic category.  The | ||||
| exception lists contain the morphological transformations for strings | ||||
| that are not regular and therefore cannot be processed in an | ||||
| algorithmic manner.  Each line of an exception list contains an | ||||
| inflected form of a word or collocation, followed by one or more base | ||||
| forms.  The list is kept in alphabetical order and a binary search is | ||||
| used to find words in these lists.  See | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN) | ||||
| for information on the format of the exception list files. | ||||
| .SS Single Words | ||||
| In general, single words are relatively easy to process.  Morphy first | ||||
| looks for the word in the exception list.  If it is found the first | ||||
| base form is returned.  Subsequent calls with a | ||||
| .SB NULL  | ||||
| argument return additional base forms, if present.  A | ||||
| .SB NULL | ||||
| is returned when there are no more base forms of the word. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| If the word is not found in the exception list corresponding to the | ||||
| syntactic category, an algorithmic process using the rules of | ||||
| detachment looks for a matching suffix.  If a matching suffix is | ||||
| found, a corresponding ending is applied (sometimes this ending is a | ||||
| .SB NULL | ||||
| string, so in effect the suffix is removed from the word), and WordNet | ||||
| is consulted to see if the resulting word is found in the desired part | ||||
| of speech. | ||||
| .SS Collocations | ||||
| As opposed to single words, collocations can be quite difficult to | ||||
| transform into a base form that is present in WordNet.  In general, | ||||
| only base forms of words, even those comprising collocations, are | ||||
| stored in WordNet, such as \fBattorney~general\fP.  Transforming the | ||||
| collocation \fBattorneys~general\fP is then simply a matter of finding | ||||
| the base forms of the individual words comprising the collocation. | ||||
| This usually works for nouns, therefore non-conforming nouns, such as | ||||
| \fBcustoms~duty\fP are presently entered in the noun exception list. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Verb collocations that contain prepositions, such as \fBask~for~it\fP, | ||||
| are more difficult.  As with single words, the exception list is | ||||
| searched first.  If the collocation is not found, special code in | ||||
| Morphy determines whether a verb collocation includes a preposition. | ||||
| If it does, a function is called to try to find the base form in the | ||||
| following manner.  It is assumed that the first word in the | ||||
| collocation is a verb and that the last word is a noun.  The algorithm | ||||
| then builds a search string with the base forms of the verb and noun, | ||||
| leaving the remainder of the collocation (usually just the | ||||
| preposition, but more words may be involved) in the middle.  For | ||||
| example, passed \fBasking~for~it\fP, the database search would be | ||||
| performed with \fBask~for~it\fP, which is found in WordNet, and | ||||
| therefore returned from Morphy.  If a verb collocation does not | ||||
| contain a preposition, then the base form of each word in the | ||||
| collocation is found and WordNet is searched for the resulting string. | ||||
| .SS Hyphenation | ||||
| Hyphenation also presents special difficulties when searching WordNet. | ||||
| It is often a subjective decision as to whether a word is hyphenated, | ||||
| joined as one word, or is a collocation of several words, and which of | ||||
| the various forms are entered into WordNet.  When Morphy breaks a | ||||
| string into "words", it looks for both spaces and hyphens as | ||||
| delimiters.  It also looks for periods in strings and removes them if | ||||
| an exact match is not found.  A search for an abbreviation like | ||||
| \fBoct.\fP return the synset for \fB{~October,~Oct~}\fP.  Not every | ||||
| pattern of hyphenated and collocated string is searched for properly, | ||||
| so it may be advantageous to specify several search strings if the | ||||
| results of a search attempt seem incomplete. | ||||
| .SS Special Processing for nouns ending with 'ful' | ||||
| Morphy contains code that searches for nouns ending with \fBful\fP | ||||
| and performs a transformation on the substring preceeding it.  It then | ||||
| appends 'ful' back onto the resulting string and returns it. For | ||||
| example, if passed the nouns \fBboxesful\fP, it will return \fBboxful\fP. | ||||
| .SH BUGS | ||||
| Since many noun collocations contains prepositions, such as | ||||
| \fBline~of~products\fP, an algorithm similar to that used for verbs | ||||
| should be written for nouns.  In the present scheme, if Morphy is | ||||
| passed \fBlines~of~products\fP, the search string becomes | ||||
| \fBline~of~product\fP, which is not in WordNet | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Morphy will allow non-words to be converted to words, if they follow | ||||
| one of the rules described above.  For example, it will happily | ||||
| convert \fBplantes\fP to \fBplants\fP. | ||||
| .SH ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNHOME | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fB/usr/local/WordNet-3.0\fP. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNSEARCHDIR | ||||
| Directory in which the WordNet database has been installed.   | ||||
| Default is \fBWNHOME/dict\fP. | ||||
| .SH REGISTRY (WINDOWS) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\eSOFTWARE\eWordNet\e3.0\eWNHome | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fBC:\eProgram~Files\eWordNet\e3.0\fP. | ||||
| .SH FILES | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B \fIpos\fP.exc | ||||
| morphology exception lists | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wn (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnb (1WN), | ||||
| .BR binsrch (3WN), | ||||
| .BR morph (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wninput (7WN). | ||||
							
								
								
									
										344
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/prologdb.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										344
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/prologdb.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,344 @@ | |||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH PROLOGDB 5WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm File Formats" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| wn_\*.pl \- description of Prolog database files | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| The files \fBwn_\fP\fI*\fP\fB.pl\fP contain the WordNet database in a | ||||
| prolog-readable format.  A prolog interface to WordNet is not | ||||
| implemented. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The prolog database is very large and may take many minutes to load | ||||
| into the Prolog workspace.  A separate file has been created for each | ||||
| WordNet relation giving the user the ability to load only those parts | ||||
| of the database that they are interested. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| See \fBFILES\fP, below, for a list of the database files and | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN) | ||||
| and | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN)  | ||||
| for detailed descriptions of the various WordNet relations (referred to | ||||
| as \fIoperators\fP in this manual page). | ||||
| .SS File Format | ||||
| Each prolog database file contains information corresponding to the | ||||
| synsets and word senses contained in the WordNet database.  In the | ||||
| prolog version of the database, the \fIsynset_id\fPs (defined below) | ||||
| are used as unique synset identifiers. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Each line of a file contains an operator that corresponds to a WordNet | ||||
| relation.  All lines with the same \fIoperator\fP value are stored in | ||||
| the file \fBwn_\fP\fIoperator\fP\fB.pl\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The general format of a line in a prolog database file is as follows: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fIoperator\fB(\fIfield1\fB,\fI~~...~~\fB,\fIfieldn\fB).\fR | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Each line contains the name of the operator, followed by a left | ||||
| parenthesis, a comma-separated list of fields, a right parenthesis, | ||||
| and a period.  Note there are no spaces, and each line is terminated | ||||
| with a newline character.  | ||||
| .SS Operators | ||||
| Each WordNet relation is represented in a separate file by | ||||
| \fIoperator\fP name.  Some operators are reflexive (i.e. the "reverse" | ||||
| relation is implicit).  So, for example, if \fBx\fP is a hypernym of | ||||
| \fBy\fP, \fBy\fP is necessarily a hyponym of \fBx\fP.  In the prolog | ||||
| database, reflected pointers are usually implied for semantic | ||||
| relations. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Semantic relations are represented by a pair of \fIsynset_id\fPs, in | ||||
| which the first \fIsynset_id\fP is generally the source of the | ||||
| relation and the second is the target.  If two pairs | ||||
| \fIsynset_id\fP\fB,\fP\fIw_num\fP are present, the operator represents | ||||
| a lexical relation between word forms. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBs(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIw_num\fB,'\fIword\fB',\fIss_type\fB,\fIsense_number\fB,\fItag_count\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| A \fBs\fP operator is present for every word sense in WordNet.  In | ||||
| \fBwn_s.pl\fP, \fIw_num\fP specifies the word number for \fIword\fP in | ||||
| the synset. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBg(\fIsynset_id\fB,'(\fIgloss\fB)'). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBg\fP operator specifies the gloss for a synset.   | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBhyp(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIsynset_id\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBhyp\fP operator specifies that the second synset is a | ||||
| hypernym of the first synset.  This relation holds for nouns and | ||||
| verbs.  The reflexive operator, hyponym, implies that the first | ||||
| synset is a hyponym of the second synset. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBent(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIsynset_id\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBent\fP operator specifies that the second synset is | ||||
| an entailment of first synset.  This relation only holds for verbs. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBsim(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIsynset_id\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBsim\fP operator specifies that the second synset is similar in | ||||
| meaning to the first synset.  This means that the second synset is a | ||||
| satellite the first synset, which is the cluster head.  This relation | ||||
| only holds for adjective synsets contained in adjective clusters. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBmm(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIsynset_id\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBmm\fP operator specifies that the second synset is a | ||||
| member meronym of the first synset.  This relation only holds for | ||||
| nouns.  The reflexive operator, member holonym, can be implied. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBms(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIsynset_id\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBms\fP operator specifies that the second synset is a | ||||
| substance meronym of the first synset.  This relation only holds for | ||||
| nouns.  The reflexive operator, substance holonym, can be implied. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBmp(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIsynset_id\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBmp\fP operator specifies that the second synset is a | ||||
| part meronym of the first synset.  This relation only holds for | ||||
| nouns.  The reflexive operator, part holonym, can be implied. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBcs(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIsynset_id\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBcs\fP operator specifies that the second synset is a cause | ||||
| of the first synset.  This relation only holds for verbs. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBvgp(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIsynset_id\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBvgp\fP operator specifies verb synsets that are similar in | ||||
| meaning and should be grouped together when displayed in response to a | ||||
| grouped synset search. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBat(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIsynset_id\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBat\fP operator defines the attribute relation between noun and | ||||
| adjective synset pairs in which the adjective is a value of the noun. | ||||
| For each pair, both relations are listed (ie. each \fIsynset_id\fP is | ||||
| both a source and target). | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBant(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIw_num\fB,\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIw_num\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBant\fP operator specifies antonymous \fIword\fPs.  This is a | ||||
| lexical relation that holds for all syntactic categories.  For each | ||||
| antonymous pair, both relations are listed (ie. each | ||||
| \fIsynset_id,w_num\fP pair is both a source and target word.) | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBsa(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIw_num\fB,\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIw_num\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBsa\fP operator specifies that additional information about the | ||||
| first word can be obtained by seeing the second word.  This | ||||
| operator is only defined for verbs and adjectives.  There is no reflexive | ||||
| relation (ie. it cannot be inferred that the additional information | ||||
| about the second word can be obtained from the first word). | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBppl(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIw_num\fB,\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIw_num\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBppl\fP operator specifies that the adjective first word is a | ||||
| participle of the verb second word.  The reflexive operator can be | ||||
| implied.  | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBper(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIw_num\fB,\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIw_num\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBper\fP operator specifies two different relations based on the | ||||
| parts of speech involved.  If the first word is in an adjective | ||||
| synset, that word pertains to either the noun or adjective second | ||||
| word.  If the first word is in an adverb synset, that word is derived | ||||
| from the adjective second word. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBfr(\fIsynset_id\fB,\fIf_num\fB,\fIw_num\fB). | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| The \fBfr\fP operator specifies a generic sentence frame for one or | ||||
| all words in a synset.  The operator is defined only for verbs. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .SS Field Definitions | ||||
| A \fIsynset_id\fP is a nine byte field in which the first | ||||
| byte defines the syntactic category of the synset and the remaining | ||||
| eight bytes are a \fIsynset_offset\fP, as defined in  | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN), | ||||
| indicating the byte offset in the \fBdata.\fP\fIpos\fP file that | ||||
| corresponds to the syntactic category. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The syntactic category is encoded as:   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB1\fP	NOUN | ||||
| \fB2\fP	VERB | ||||
| \fB3\fP	ADJECTIVE | ||||
| \fB4\fP	ADVERB | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIw_num\fP, if present, indicates which word in the synset is being | ||||
| referred to.  Word numbers are assigned to the \fIword\fP fields in a | ||||
| synset, from left to right, beginning with 1.  When used to represent | ||||
| lexical WordNet relations \fIw_num\fP may be 0, indicating that the | ||||
| relation holds for all words in the synset indicated by the preceding | ||||
| \fIsynset_id\fP.  See | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN) | ||||
| for a discussion of semantic and lexical relations. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIss_type\fP is a one character code indicating the synset type: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBn\fP	NOUN | ||||
| \fBv\fP	VERB | ||||
| \fBa\fP	ADJECTIVE | ||||
| \fBs\fP	ADJECTIVE~SATELLITE | ||||
| \fBr\fP	ADVERB | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIsense_number\fP specifies the sense number of the word, within the | ||||
| part of speech encoded in the \fIsynset_id\fP, in the WordNet | ||||
| database. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIword\fP is the ASCII text of the word as entered in the synset by | ||||
| the lexicographer, with spaces replaced by underscore characters | ||||
| (\fB_\fP).  The text of the word is case sensitive.  An adjective | ||||
| \fIword\fP is immediately followed by a syntactic marker if one was | ||||
| specified in the lexicographer file.  A syntactic marker is appended, | ||||
| in parentheses, onto \fIword\fP without any intervening spaces.  See | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN) | ||||
| for a list of the syntactic markers for adjectives. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Each synset has a \fIgloss\fP that may contain a definition, one or | ||||
| more example sentences, or both.  Note that glosses are enclosed in | ||||
| single forward quotes and parentheses:~~\fB'(\fIgloss\fB)'\fR. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIf_num\fP specifies the generic sentence frame number for word | ||||
| \fIw_num\fP in the synset indicated by \fIsynset_id\fP.  Note that | ||||
| when \fIw_num\fP is \fB0\fP, the frame number applies to all words in | ||||
| the synset.  If non-zero, the frame applies to that word in the | ||||
| synset. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| In WordNet, sense numbers are assigned as described in  | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN). | ||||
| \fItag_count\fP is the number of times the sense was tagged in the | ||||
| Semantic Concordances, and \fB0\fP if it was not instantiated. | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| Since single forward quotes are used to enclose character strings, | ||||
| single quote characters found in \fIword\fP and \fIgloss\fP fields are | ||||
| represented as two adjacent single quote characters. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The load time can be greatly reduced by creating "object language" | ||||
| versions of the files, an option that is supported by some | ||||
| implementations, such as Quintus Prolog.  | ||||
| .SH ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNHOME | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fB/usr/local/WordNet-3.0\fP. | ||||
| .SH REGISTRY (WINDOWS) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\eSOFTWARE\eWordNet\e3.0\eWNHome | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fBC:\eProgram~Files\eWordNet\e3.0\fP. | ||||
| .SH FILES | ||||
| All files are in \fBWNHOME/prolog\fP on Unix platforms and | ||||
| \fBWNHome\eprolog\fP on Windows platforms | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_s.pl | ||||
| synset pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_g.pl | ||||
| gloss pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_hyp.pl | ||||
| hypernym pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_ent.pl | ||||
| entailment pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_sim.pl | ||||
| similar pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_mm.pl | ||||
| member meronym pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_ms.pl | ||||
| substance meronym pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_mp.pl | ||||
| part meronym pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_cs.pl | ||||
| cause pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_vgp.pl | ||||
| grouped verb pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_at.pl | ||||
| attribute pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_ant.pl | ||||
| antonym pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_sa.pl | ||||
| see also pointers  | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_ppl.pl | ||||
| participle pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_per.pl | ||||
| pertainym pointers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn_fr.pl | ||||
| frame pointers | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wngroups (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wnpkgs (7WN). | ||||
							
								
								
									
										164
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/senseidx.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										164
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/senseidx.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,164 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH SENSEIDX 5WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm File Formats" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| index.sense, sense.idx \- WordNet's sense index | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| The WordNet sense index provides an alternate method for accessing | ||||
| synsets and word senses in the WordNet database.  It is useful to | ||||
| applications that retrieve synsets or other information related to a | ||||
| specific sense in WordNet, rather than all the senses of a word or | ||||
| collocation.  It can also be used with tools like \fBgrep\fP and Perl | ||||
| to find all senses of a word in one or more parts of speech.  A | ||||
| specific WordNet sense, encoded as a \fIsense_key\fP, can be used as | ||||
| an index into this file to obtain its WordNet sense number, the | ||||
| database byte offset of the synset containing the sense, and the | ||||
| number of times it has been tagged in the semantic concordance texts. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Concatenating the \fIlemma\fP and \fIlex_sense\fP fields of a | ||||
| semantically tagged word (represented in a \fB<wf~\fP...~\fB>\fP | ||||
| attribute/value pair) in a semantic concordance file, using \fB%\fP as | ||||
| the concatenation character, creates the \fIsense_key\fP for that | ||||
| sense, which can in turn be used to search the sense index file. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| A \fIsense_key\fP is the best way to represent a sense in semantic | ||||
| tagging or other systems that refer to WordNet senses. | ||||
| \fIsense_key\fPs are independent of WordNet sense numbers and | ||||
| \fIsynset_offset\fPs, which vary between versions of the database. | ||||
| Using the sense index and a \fIsense_key\fP, the corresponding synset | ||||
| (via the \fIsynset_offset\fP) and WordNet sense number can easily be | ||||
| obtained.  A mapping from noun \fIsense_key\fPs in WordNet 1.6 to | ||||
| corresponding 2.0 \fIsense_key\fPs is provided with version 2.0, | ||||
| and is described in | ||||
| .BR sensemap (5WN). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| See | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN) | ||||
| for a thorough discussion of the WordNet database files. | ||||
| .SS File Format | ||||
| The sense index file lists all of the senses in the WordNet database | ||||
| with each line representing one sense.  The file is in alphabetical | ||||
| order, fields are separated by one space, and each line is terminated | ||||
| with a newline character. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Each line is of the form: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| \fIsense_key~~synset_offset~~sense_number~~tag_cnt\fP | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIsense_key\fP is an encoding of the word sense.  Programs can | ||||
| construct a sense key in this format and use it as a binary search key | ||||
| into the sense index file.   | ||||
| The format of a \fIsense_key\fP is | ||||
| described below. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIsynset_offset\fP is the byte offset that the synset containing the | ||||
| sense is found at in the database "data" file corresponding to the | ||||
| part of speech encoded in the \fIsense_key\fP.  \fIsynset_offset\fP is | ||||
| an 8 digit, zero-filled decimal integer, and can be used with | ||||
| .BR fseek (3) | ||||
| to read a synset from the data file.  When passed to the WordNet library | ||||
| function \fBread_synset(\|)\fP along with the syntactic category, a data | ||||
| structure containing the parsed synset is returned. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIsense_number\fP is a decimal integer indicating the sense number of | ||||
| the word, within the part of speech encoded in \fIsense_key\fP, in the | ||||
| WordNet database.  See | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN) | ||||
| for information about how sense numbers are assigned. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fItag_cnt\fP represents the decimal number of times the sense is | ||||
| tagged in various semantic concordance texts.  A \fItag_cnt\fP of | ||||
| \fB0\fP indicates that the sense has not been semantically tagged. | ||||
| .SS Sense Key Encoding | ||||
| A \fIsense_key\fP is represented as: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| \fIlemma\fP\fB%\fP\fIlex_sense\fP | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| where \fIlex_sense\fP is encoded as: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| \fIss_type\fB:\fIlex_filenum\fB:\fIlex_id\fB:\fIhead_word\fB:\fIhead_id\fR | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIlemma\fP is the ASCII text of the word or collocation as found in | ||||
| the WordNet database index file corresponding to \fIpos\fP. | ||||
| \fIlemma\fP is in lower case, and collocations are formed by joining | ||||
| individual words with an underscore (\fB_\fP) character. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIss_type\fP is a one digit decimal integer representing the synset type | ||||
| for the sense.  See | ||||
| .SB "Synset Type" | ||||
| below for a listing of the numbers corresponding to each synset type. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIlex_filenum\fP is a two digit decimal integer representing the | ||||
| name of the lexicographer file containing the synset for the sense. | ||||
| See | ||||
| .BR lexnames (5WN) | ||||
| for the list of lexicographer file names and their corresponding numbers. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIlex_id\fP is a two digit decimal integer that, when appended onto | ||||
| \fIlemma\fP, uniquely identifies a sense within a lexicographer file. | ||||
| \fIlex_id\fP numbers usually start with \fB00\fP, and are incremented | ||||
| as additional senses of the word are added to the same file, although | ||||
| there is no requirement that the numbers be consecutive or begin with | ||||
| \fB00\fP.  Note that a value of \fB00\fP is the default, and therefore | ||||
| is not present in lexicographer files.  Only non-default \fIlex_id\fP | ||||
| values must be explicitly assigned in lexicographer files.  See | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN) | ||||
| for information on the format of lexicographer files. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIhead_word\fP is only present if the sense is in an adjective | ||||
| satellite synset.  It is the lemma of the first word of the | ||||
| satellite's head synset. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIhead_id\fP is a two digit decimal integer that, when appended onto | ||||
| \fIhead_word\fP, uniquely identifies the sense of \fIhead_word\fP | ||||
| within a lexicographer file, as described for \fIlex_id\fP.  There is | ||||
| a value in this field only if \fIhead_word\fP is present. | ||||
| .SS Synset Type | ||||
| The synset type is encoded as follows: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB1\fP	NOUN | ||||
| \fB2\fP	VERB | ||||
| \fB3\fP	ADJECTIVE | ||||
| \fB4\fP	ADVERB | ||||
| \fB5\fP	ADJECTIVE SATELLITE | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| For non-satellite senses the \fIhead_word\fP and \fIhead_id\fP fields | ||||
| have no values, however the field separator character (\fB:\fP) is | ||||
| present.  | ||||
| .SH ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNHOME | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fB/usr/local/WordNet-3.0\fP. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNSEARCHDIR | ||||
| Directory in which the WordNet database has been installed.   | ||||
| Default is \fBWNHOME/dict\fP. | ||||
| .SH REGISTRY (WINDOWS) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\eSOFTWARE\eWordNet\e3.0\eWNHome | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fBC:\eProgram~Files\eWordNet\e3.0\fP. | ||||
| .SH FILES | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B index.sense | ||||
| sense index | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR binsrch (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnsearch (3WN), | ||||
| .BR lexnames (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (5WN), | ||||
| .BR sensemap (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN). | ||||
							
								
								
									
										28
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/uniqbeg.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										28
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/uniqbeg.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,28 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .TH UNIQBEG 7WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| uniqbeg \- unique beginners for noun hierarchies | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| All of the WordNet noun synsets are organized into hierarchies, headed | ||||
| by the unique beginner synset for \fBentity\fP in the file | ||||
| \fBnoun.Tops\fP.  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| { entity (that which is perceived or known or inferred to have its own  | ||||
| distinct existence (living or nonliving)) } | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| The lexicographer files are not included in the WordNet database package. | ||||
| .SH FILES | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B noun.Tops | ||||
| unique beginners for nouns | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wngloss (7WN). | ||||
							
								
								
									
										340
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wn.1
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										340
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wn.1
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,340 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH WN 1WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm User Commands" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| wn \- command line interface to WordNet lexical database   | ||||
| .SH SYNOPSIS | ||||
| \fBwn\fP [ \fIsearchstr\fP ] [ \fB\-h\fP] [ \fB\-g\fP ] [ \fB\-a\fP ] [ \fB\-l\fP ] [ \fB\-o\fP ] [ \fB\-s\fP ] [ \fB\-n\fI#\fR ] [ \fIsearch_option\fP... ] | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| \fBwn(\|)\fP provides a command line interface to the WordNet | ||||
| database, allowing synsets and relations to be displayed as formatted | ||||
| text.  For each word, different searches are provided, based on | ||||
| syntactic category and pointer types.  Although only base forms of | ||||
| words are usually stored in WordNet, users may search for inflected | ||||
| forms.  A morphological process is applied to the search string to | ||||
| generate a form that is present in WordNet. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The command line interface is often useful when writing scripts to | ||||
| extract information from the WordNet database.  Post-processing of the | ||||
| output with various scripting tools can reformat the results as | ||||
| desired. | ||||
| .SH OPTIONS | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-h | ||||
| Print help text before search results. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-g | ||||
| Display textual glosses associated with synsets. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-a | ||||
| Display lexicographer file information. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-o | ||||
| Display synset offset of each synset. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-s | ||||
| Display each word's sense numbers in synsets. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-l | ||||
| Display the WordNet copyright notice, version number, and license. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-n\fI#\fP | ||||
| Perform search on sense number \fI#\fP only. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB-over\fP | ||||
| Display overview of all senses of \fIsearchstr\fP in all syntactic | ||||
| categories.  | ||||
| .SS Search Options | ||||
| Note that the last letter of \fIsearch_option\fP generally denotes the | ||||
| part of speech that the search applies to: \fBn\fP for nouns, \fBv\fP | ||||
| for verbs, \fBa\fP for adjectives, and \fBr\fP for adverbs.  Multiple | ||||
| searches may be done for \fIsearchstr\fP with a single command by | ||||
| specifying all the appropriate search options. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB\-syns\fP(\fIn\fP | \fIv\fP | \fIa\fP | \fIr\fP)  | ||||
| Display synonyms | ||||
| and immediate hypernyms of synsets containing \fIsearchstr\fP. | ||||
| Synsets are ordered by estimated frequency of use.  For adjectives, if | ||||
| \fIsearchstr\fP is in a head synset, the cluster's satellite synsets | ||||
| are displayed in place of hypernyms.  If \fIsearchstr\fP is in a | ||||
| satellite synset, its head synset is also displayed. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB\-simsv\fP | ||||
| Display verb synonyms and | ||||
| immediate hypernyms of synsets containing \fIsearchstr\fP.  Synsets | ||||
| are grouped by similarity of meaning. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB\-ants\fP(\fIn\fP | \fIv\fP | \fIa\fP | \fIr\fP) | ||||
| Display synsets containing antonyms of \fIsearchstr\fP. | ||||
| For adjectives, if \fIsearchstr\fP is | ||||
| in a head synset, \fIsearchstr\fP has a direct antonym. | ||||
| The head synset for the direct antonym is displayed along | ||||
| with the direct antonym's satellite synsets.  If \fIsearchstr\fP is in a | ||||
| satellite synset, \fIsearchstr\fP has an indirect antonym via the | ||||
| head synset, which is displayed. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB\-faml\fP(\fIn\fP | \fIv\fP | \fIa\fP | \fIr\fP) | ||||
| Display familiarity and polysemy information for \fIsearchstr\fP. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB\-hype\fP(\fIn\fP | \fIv\fP) | ||||
| Recursively display hypernym (superordinate) tree for \fIsearchstr\fP | ||||
| (\fIsearchstr\fP \fIIS A KIND OF _____\fP relation). | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB\-hypo\fP(\fIn\fP | \fIv\fP) | ||||
| Display immediate hyponyms (subordinates) for \fIsearchstr\fP | ||||
| (\fI_____ IS A KIND OF\fP \fIsearchstr\fP relation). | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB\-tree\fP(\fIn\fP | \fIv\fP) | ||||
| Display hyponym (subordinate) tree for \fIsearchstr\fP.  This is | ||||
| a recursive search that finds the hyponyms of each hyponym. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB\-coor\fP(\fIn\fP | \fIv\fP) | ||||
| Display the coordinates (sisters) of \fIsearchstr\fP.  This | ||||
| search prints the immediate hypernym for each synset that contains | ||||
| \fIsearchstr\fP and the hypernym's immediate hyponyms. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB\-deri\fP(\fIn\fP | \fIv\fP) | ||||
| Display derivational morphology links between noun and verb forms. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB\-domn\fP(\fIn\fP | \fIv\fP | \fIa\fP | \fIr\fP) | ||||
| Display domain that \fIsearchstr\fP has been classified in. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB\-domt\fP(\fIn\fP | \fIv\fP | \fIa\fP | \fIr\fP) | ||||
| Display all terms classified as members of the \fIsearchstr\fP's domain. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-subsn | ||||
| Display substance meronyms of \fIsearchstr\fP | ||||
| (\fIHAS SUBSTANCE\fP relation). | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-partn | ||||
| Display part meronyms of \fIsearchstr\fP | ||||
| (\fIHAS PART\fP relation). | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-membn | ||||
| Display member meronyms of \fIsearchstr\fP | ||||
| (\fIHAS MEMBER\fP relation). | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-meron | ||||
| Display all meronyms of \fIsearchstr\fP | ||||
| (\fIHAS PART, HAS MEMBER, HAS SUBSTANCE\fP relations). | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-hmern | ||||
| Display meronyms for \fIsearchstr\fP tree.  This is a recursive search | ||||
| that prints all the meronyms of \fIsearchstr\fP and all of | ||||
| its hypernyms. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-sprtn | ||||
| Display \fIpart of\fP holonyms of \fIsearchstr\fP | ||||
| (\fIPART OF\fP relation). | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-smemn | ||||
| Display \fImember of\fP holonyms of \fIsearchstr\fP | ||||
| (\fIMEMBER OF\fP relation). | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-ssubn | ||||
| Display \fIsubstance of\fP holonyms of \fIsearchstr\fP | ||||
| (\fISUBSTANCE OF\fP relation). | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-holon | ||||
| Display all holonyms of \fIsearchstr\fP | ||||
| (\fIPART OF, MEMBER OF, SUBSTANCE OF\fP relations). | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-hholn | ||||
| Display holonyms for \fIsearchstr\fP tree.  This is a recursive search | ||||
| that prints all the holonyms of \fIsearchstr\fP and all of each | ||||
| holonym's holonyms. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-entav | ||||
| Display entailment relations of \fIsearchstr\fP. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-framv | ||||
| Display applicable verb sentence frames for \fIsearchstr\fP.  | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .B \-causv | ||||
| Display \fIcause to\fP relations of \fIsearchstr\fP. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB \-pert\fP(\fIa\fP | \fIr\fP) | ||||
| Display pertainyms of \fIsearchstr\fP. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB \-attr\fP(\fIn\fP | \fIa\fP) | ||||
| Display adjective values for noun attribute, or noun attributes of | ||||
| adjective values. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| \fB\-grep\fP(\fIn\fP | \fIv\fP | \fIa\fP | \fIr\fP) | ||||
| List compound words containing \fIsearchstr\fP as a substring. | ||||
| .SH SEARCH RESULTS | ||||
| The results of a search are written to the standard output.  For each | ||||
| search, the output consists a one line description of the search, | ||||
| followed by the search results. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| All searches other than \fB\-over\fP list all senses matching the | ||||
| search results in the following general format.  Items enclosed in | ||||
| italicized square brackets (\fI[~...~]\fP) may not be present. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| One line listing the number of senses matching the search request. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Each sense matching the search requested displayed as follows: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| 	\fBSense \fIn\fR | ||||
| 	\fI[\fB{\fIsynset_offset\fB}\fI] [\fB<\fIlex_filename\fB>\fI]~~word1[\fB#\fIsense_number][,~~word2...]\fR | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Where \fIn\fP is the sense number of the search word, | ||||
| \fIsynset_offset\fP is the byte offset of the synset in the | ||||
| \fBdata.\fIpos\fR file corresponding to the syntactic category, | ||||
| \fIlex_filename\fP is the name of the lexicographer file that the | ||||
| synset comes from, \fIword1\fP is the first word in the synset (note | ||||
| that this is not necessarily the search word) and \fIsense_number\fP | ||||
| is the WordNet sense number assigned to the preceding word. | ||||
| \fIsynset_offset, lex_filename\fP, and \fIsense_number\fP are | ||||
| generated when the \fB\-o, \-a,\fP and \fB\-s\fP options, | ||||
| respectively, are specified. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The synsets matching the search requested are printed below each sense's | ||||
| synset output described above.  Each line of output is preceded by a | ||||
| marker (usually \fB=>\fP), then a synset, formatted as described | ||||
| above.  If a search traverses more one level of the tree, then | ||||
| successive lines are indented by spaces corresponding to its level in | ||||
| the hierarchy.  When the \fB\-g\fP option is specified, synset glosses | ||||
| are displayed in parentheses at the end of each synset.  Each synset | ||||
| is printed on one line. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Senses are generally ordered from most to least frequently used, with | ||||
| the most common sense numbered \fB1\fP.  Frequency of use is | ||||
| determined by the number of times a sense is tagged in the various | ||||
| semantic concordance texts.  Senses that are not semantically tagged | ||||
| follow the ordered senses.  Note that this ordering is only an | ||||
| estimate based on usage in a small corpus. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Verb senses can be grouped by similarity of meaning, rather | ||||
| than ordered by frequency of use.  The \fB\-simsv\fP search prints all | ||||
| senses that are close in meaning together, with a line of dashes | ||||
| indicating the end of a group.  See | ||||
| .BR wngroups (7WN) | ||||
| for a discussion of how senses are grouped. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fB\-over\fP search displays an overview of all the senses of the | ||||
| search word in all syntactic categories.  The results of this search | ||||
| are similar to the \fB\-syns\fP search, however no additional | ||||
| (ex. hypernym) synsets are displayed, and synset glosses are always | ||||
| printed.  The senses are grouped by syntactic category, and each | ||||
| synset is annotated as described above with \fIsynset_offset\fP, | ||||
| \fIlex_filename\fP, and \fIsense_number\fP as dictated by the | ||||
| \fB\-o, \-a,\fP and \fB\-s\fP options.  The overview search also | ||||
| indicates how many of the senses in each syntactic category are | ||||
| represented in the tagged texts.  This is a way for the user to | ||||
| determine whether a sense's sense number is based on semantic tagging | ||||
| data, or was arbitrarily assigned.   For each sense that has | ||||
| appeared in such texts, the number of semantic tags to that sense are | ||||
| indicated in parentheses after the sense number. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| If a search cannot be performed on some senses of \fIsearchstr\fP, the | ||||
| search results are headed by a string of the form: | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| 	X of Y senses of \fIsearchstr\fP | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The output of the \fB\-deri\fP search shows word forms that are | ||||
| morphologically related to \fBsearchstr\fP. Each word form pointed to | ||||
| from \fIsearchstr\fP is displayed, preceded by \fBRELATED TO->\fP and | ||||
| the syntactic category of the link, followed, on the next line, by its | ||||
| synset.  Printed after the word form is \fB#\fP\fIn\fP where \fIn\fP | ||||
| indicates the WordNet sense number of the term pointed to. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fB\-domn\fP and \fB\-domt\fP searches show the domain that a | ||||
| synset has been classified in and, conversely, all of the terms that | ||||
| have been assigned to a specific domain.  A domain is | ||||
| either a \fBTOPIC,\fP \fBREGION\fP or \fBUSAGE,\fP as reflected in | ||||
| the specific pointer character stored in the database, and displayed | ||||
| in the output.  A \fB\-domn\fP search on a term shows the domain, if | ||||
| any, that each synset containing \fIsearchstr\fP has been classified | ||||
| in.  The output display shows the domain type (\fBTOPIC,\fP | ||||
| \fBREGION\fP or \fBUSAGE\fP), followed by the syntactic category of | ||||
| the domain synset and the terms in the synset.  Each term is followed | ||||
| by \fB#\fP\fIn\fP where \fIn\fP indicates the WordNet sense number of | ||||
| the term.  The converse search, \fB\-domt\fP, shows all of the synsets | ||||
| that have been placed into the domain \fIsearchstr\fP, with analogous | ||||
| markers.  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| When \fB\-framv\fP is specified, sample illustrative sentences and | ||||
| generic sentence frames are displayed.  If a sample sentence is found, | ||||
| the base form of \fIsearch\fP is substituted into the sentence, and it | ||||
| is printed below the synset, preceded with the \fBEX:\fP marker.  When | ||||
| no sample sentences are found, the generic sentence frames are | ||||
| displayed.  Sentence frames that are acceptable for all words in a | ||||
| synset are preceded by the marker \fB*>\fP.  If a frame is acceptable | ||||
| for the search word only, it is preceded by the marker \fB=>\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Search results for adjectives are slightly different from those for | ||||
| other parts of speech.  When an adjective is printed, its direct | ||||
| antonym, if it has one, is also printed in parentheses.  When | ||||
| \fIsearchstr\fP is in a head synset, all of the head synset's | ||||
| satellites are also displayed.  The position of an adjective in | ||||
| relation to the noun may be restricted to the \fIprenominal\fP, | ||||
| \fIpostnominal\fP or \fIpredicative\fP position.  Where present, these | ||||
| restrictions are noted in parentheses. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| When an adjective is a participle of a verb, the output indicates the | ||||
| verb and displays its synset. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| When an adverb is derived from an adjective, the specific adjectival | ||||
| sense on which it is based is indicated. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The morphological transformations performed by the search code may | ||||
| result in more than one word to search for.  WordNet automatically | ||||
| performs the requested search on all of the strings and returns the | ||||
| results grouped by word.  For example, the verb \fBsaw\fP is both the | ||||
| present tense of \fBsaw\fP and the past tense of \fBsee\fP.  When | ||||
| passed \fIsearchstr\fP \fBsaw\fP, WordNet performs the desired search | ||||
| first on \fBsaw\fP and next on \fBsee\fP, returning the list of | ||||
| \fBsaw\fP senses and search results, followed by those for \fBsee\fP. | ||||
| .SH EXIT STATUS | ||||
| \fBwn(\|)\fP normally exits with the number of senses displayed.  If | ||||
| \fIsearchword\fP is not found in WordNet, it exits with \fB0\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| If the WordNet database cannot be opened, an error messages is | ||||
| displayed and \fBwn(\|)\fP exits with \fB-1\fP. | ||||
| .SH ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNHOME | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fB/usr/local/WordNet-3.0\fP. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNSEARCHDIR | ||||
| Directory in which the WordNet database has been installed.   | ||||
| Default is \fBWNHOME/dict\fP. | ||||
| .SH REGISTRY (WINDOWS) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\eSOFTWARE\eWordNet\e3.0\eWNHome | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fBC:\eProgram~Files\eWordNet\e3.0\fP. | ||||
| .SH FILES | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B index.\fIpos\fP | ||||
| database index files | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B data.\fIpos\fP | ||||
| database data files | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B *.vrb | ||||
| files of sentences illustrating the use of verbs | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B \fIpos\fP.exc | ||||
| morphology exception lists | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wnintro (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnb (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (3WN), | ||||
| .BR lexnames (5WN), | ||||
| .BR senseidx (5WN) | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN),  | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN), | ||||
| .BR morphy (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wngloss (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wngroups (7WN). | ||||
| .SH BUGS | ||||
| Please report bugs to wordnet@princeton.edu. | ||||
							
								
								
									
										461
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnb.1
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										461
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnb.1
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,461 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH WNB 1WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm User Commands" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| wnb \- WordNet window-based browser interface  | ||||
| .SH SYNOPSIS | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBwnb\fP | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| \fBwnb(\|)\fP provides a window-based interface for browsing the | ||||
| WordNet database, allowing synsets and relations to be displayed as | ||||
| formatted text.  For each search word, different searches are | ||||
| available based on syntactic category and information available in the | ||||
| database.   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBwnb\fP is written in Tcl/Tk, which is available for Unix and Windows | ||||
| platforms.  This allows the same code to work on all | ||||
| supported WordNet platforms without modification. | ||||
| .SH WNB WINDOWS | ||||
| \fBwnb(\|)\fP was developed with the philosophy that only those | ||||
| searches and buttons that are applicable at the current time are | ||||
| displayed.  As a result, the appearance of the interface changes as it | ||||
| is used.  Use the standard windowing system mouse functions to open | ||||
| and close the WordNet Browser Window, move the window, and change its | ||||
| size. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The WordNet Browser Window contains the following areas, from top to | ||||
| bottom: | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| Menubar | ||||
| A menubar runs along the top of the browser window with pulldown menus | ||||
| and button | ||||
| entitled \fBFile\fP, \fBHistory\fP, \fBOptions\fP, and \fBHelp\fP. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| Search Word Entry  | ||||
| Below the Menubar is a line for entering the search | ||||
| word.  A search word can be a single word, hyphenated string, or a | ||||
| collocation.  Case is ignored.  Although only uninflected forms of | ||||
| words are usually stored in WordNet, users may search for inflected | ||||
| forms.  WordNet's morphological processor finds the base form | ||||
| automatically. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| Search Selection | ||||
| Below the Search Word Entry line is an area for selecting the search | ||||
| type and senses to search.  Until a search word is entered this area | ||||
| is blank.  After a search word is entered, buttons appear | ||||
| corresponding to each syntactic category (\fBNoun\fP, \fBVerb\fP, | ||||
| \fBAdjective\fP, \fBAdverb\fP) in which the search string is defined | ||||
| in WordNet.   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| At the right edge of the Search Selection line is a box for entering | ||||
| sense numbers.  When this box is empty, search results for all senses | ||||
| of the search word that match the search type are displayed.  The | ||||
| search may be restricted to one or more specific senses by entering a | ||||
| comma or space separated list of sense numbers in the \fBSenses\fP | ||||
| box.  These sense numbers remain in effect until either the user | ||||
| changes or deletes them, or a new search word is entered. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| Results Window | ||||
| Most of the browser window consists of a large text buffer for | ||||
| displaying the results of WordNet searches.  Horizontal and vertical | ||||
| scroll bars are present for scrolling through the output. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| Status Line  | ||||
| A status line is at the bottom of the browser window. | ||||
| When search results are displayed in the Results Window, this status | ||||
| line reflects the type of search selected.  When there is no search | ||||
| word entered, your are prompted to \fB"Enter search word and press | ||||
| return."\fP  If the search word entered is not in WordNet, the message | ||||
| \fB"Sorry, no matches found."\fP is displayed. | ||||
| .SH SEARCHING THE DATABASE | ||||
| The WordNet browser navigates through WordNet in two steps.  First a | ||||
| search word is entered and an overview of all the senses of the word | ||||
| in all syntactic categories is displayed in the Results Window.   | ||||
| The senses are | ||||
| grouped by syntactic category, and each synset is annotated as | ||||
| described above with \fIsynset_offset\fP, \fIlex_filename\fP, and | ||||
| \fIsense_number\fP as dictated by the advanced search options set. | ||||
| The overview search also indicates how many of the senses in each | ||||
| syntactic category are represented in the tagged texts.  This is a way | ||||
| for the user to determine whether a sense's sense number is based on | ||||
| semantic tagging data, or was arbitrarily assigned.  For each sense that | ||||
| has appeared in such texts, the number of semantic tags to that sense | ||||
| are indicated in parentheses after the sense number. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Then, within a syntactic category, a specific search is selected.  The | ||||
| desired search is performed and the search results are displayed in | ||||
| the Results Window.  Additional searches on the same word can be | ||||
| performed, or a new search word can be entered. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| To enter a search word, click the mouse in the horizontal box labeled | ||||
| \fBSearch Word\fP, type a single word, hyphenated string, or | ||||
| collocation and press | ||||
| .SB RETURN. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBwnb(\|)\fP responds by making a set of Part of Speech buttons appear in | ||||
| the Search Selection line.  Each button corresponds to a syntactic | ||||
| category in which the search string is defined in WordNet.  At the | ||||
| same time, an Overview of the synsets for all senses of the search | ||||
| word is displayed in the Results Window.  The Overview includes the | ||||
| gloss for each synset and also indicates which of the senses have | ||||
| appeared in the semantically tagged texts.  For each sense that has | ||||
| appeared in such texts, the number of semantic tags to that sense are | ||||
| indicated in parentheses after the sense number. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The pulldown menus in the Search Selection line list all of the | ||||
| WordNet searches that can be performed for the search word in that | ||||
| part of speech.  To select a search, highlight it by dragging the | ||||
| mouse to it, and release the mouse while it is highlighted.  Drag the | ||||
| mouse outside of the pulldown list and release to hide the menu | ||||
| without making a selection.  Dragging the mouse across the Part of | ||||
| Speech buttons displays the available searches for each syntactic | ||||
| category. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| To restrict a search to one or more senses within a syntactic | ||||
| category, enter a comma or space separated list of sense numbers in | ||||
| the \fBSenses\fP box before selecting a search. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| After a search is selected, \fBwnb(\|)\fP performs the search on the | ||||
| WordNet database and displays the formatted results in the Results | ||||
| Window.  Whenever search results are displayed, a button entitled | ||||
| \fBRedisplay Overview\fP is present at the right edge of the Search Word | ||||
| Entry line.  Clicking on this button redisplays the Overview of all | ||||
| synsets for the search word in the Results Window. | ||||
| .SS Changing the Search Word | ||||
| A new search word can be entered at any time by moving to the Search | ||||
| Word Entry box, if necessary highlighting it by clicking, erasing the | ||||
| old string, typing a new one and pressing | ||||
| .SB RETURN. | ||||
| The \fBSenses\fP box is cleared if necessary, the Part of Speech buttons | ||||
| applicable to the new search word appear, and the Overview for the new | ||||
| search word is displayed.   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The middle mouse button can also be used to select a new search word | ||||
| by placing the mouse over any word in the Results Window and | ||||
| clicking.  The selected word will replace the text in the Search Word | ||||
| Entry box, and the overview for that word will automatically be | ||||
| displayed. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| To select a new search string collocation from text in the | ||||
| Results Window, highlight the text with the mouse and press | ||||
| .SB CONTROL-S. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SS Interrupting a Search | ||||
| When a search is in progress the message \fB"Searching...(press escape | ||||
| to abort)"\fP is displayed in the Status Line.  Note that most | ||||
| searches return very quickly, so this message isn't noticeable.  As | ||||
| indicated, pressing the | ||||
| .SB ESCAPE | ||||
| key will interrupt the search.  The results of the search obtained | ||||
| before the time the search was interrupted are displayed in the | ||||
| Results Window. | ||||
| .SH MENUS | ||||
| .SS File Menu | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .IP "Find keywords by substring" | ||||
| Display a popup window for specifying a search of WordNet for words or | ||||
| collocations that contain a specific substring.  If a search word is | ||||
| currently entered in the \fBSearch Word\fP box, it is used as the | ||||
| substring to search for by default.  The Substring Search Window | ||||
| contains a box for entering a substring, a pulldown menu to its right | ||||
| for specifying the part of speech to search, a large area for | ||||
| displaying the search results, and action buttons at the bottom | ||||
| entitled \fBSearch\fP, \fBSave\fP, \fBPrint\fP \fBDismiss\fP.  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Once a substring is entered and a part of speech selected, clicking on | ||||
| the \fBSearch\fP button causes a search to be done for all words and | ||||
| collocations in WordNet, in that syntactic category, that contain the | ||||
| substring according to the following criteria: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 1. The substring can appear at the beginning or end of a word, hyphenated | ||||
| string o collocation. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 2. The substring can appear in the middle of a hyphenated string or | ||||
| collocation, but only delimited on both sides by spaces or | ||||
| hyphens. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The search results are displayed in the large buffer.  Clicking on an | ||||
| item from the search results list causes \fBwnb(\|)\fP to automatically | ||||
| enter that word in the \fBSearch Word\fP box of the WordNet Browser | ||||
| Window and perform the Overview search. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Clicking the \fBSave\fP button generates a popup dialog for specifying | ||||
| a filename to save the substring search results to.  Clicking the | ||||
| \fBPrint\fP button generates a popup dialog in which a print command | ||||
| can be specified. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Selecting \fBDismiss\fP closes the Substring Search Window. | ||||
| .IP "Save current display" | ||||
| Display a popup dialog for specifying a filename to save the current | ||||
| Results Window contents to. | ||||
| .IP "Print current display" | ||||
| Display a popup dialog in which to specify a print command to which | ||||
| the current Results Window contents can be piped. Note - this option | ||||
| does not exist in the Windows version. | ||||
| .IP "Clear current display" | ||||
| Clear the \fBSearch Word\fP and \fBSenses\fP boxes, and Results | ||||
| Window. | ||||
| .IP "Exit" | ||||
| Does what you would expect. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .SS History | ||||
| This pulldown menu contains a list of the last searches performed. | ||||
| Selecting an item from this list performs that search again.  The | ||||
| maximum number of searches stored in the list can be adjusted from the | ||||
| \fBOptions\fP menu.  The default is 10. | ||||
| .SS Options | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .IP "Show help with each search" | ||||
| When this checkbox is selected search results are preceded by some | ||||
| explanatory text about the type of search selected. This is off by | ||||
| default. | ||||
| .IP "Show descriptive gloss" | ||||
| When this checkbox is selected, synset glosses are displayed in all | ||||
| search results.  This is set by default.  Note that glosses are always | ||||
| displayed in the Overview. | ||||
| .IP "Wrap Lines" | ||||
| When this checkbox is selected, lines in the Results Window that are | ||||
| wider than the window are automatically wrapped.  This is set by | ||||
| default.  If not selected, a horizontal scroll bar is present if any | ||||
| lines are longer than the width of the window. | ||||
| .IP "Set advanced search options..." | ||||
| Selecting this item displays a popup window for setting the following | ||||
| search options:  \fBLexical file information; Synset location in database | ||||
| file; Sense number\fP.  Choices for each are: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| 	\fBDon't show\fP (default) | ||||
| 	\fBShow with searches\fP | ||||
| 	\fBShow with searches and overview\fP | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| When lexical file information is shown, the name of the lexicographer | ||||
| file is printed before each synset, enclosed in angle brackets | ||||
| (\fB<~~\fI...\fB~~>\fR).  When both lexical file information and | ||||
| synset location information are displayed, the synset location | ||||
| information appears first.  If within one lexicographer file more than | ||||
| one sense of a word is entered, an integer \fIlex_id\fP is appended | ||||
| onto all but one of the word's instances to uniquely identify it.  In | ||||
| each synset, each word having a non-zero \fIlex_id\fP is printed with | ||||
| the \fIlex_id\fP value printed immediately following the word.  If | ||||
| both lexicographer information and sense numbers are displayed, | ||||
| \fIlex_id\fPs, if present, precede sense numbers. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| When synset location is shown, the byte offset of the synset in the | ||||
| database "data" file corresponding to the syntactic category of the | ||||
| synset is printed before each synset, enclosed in curly braces | ||||
| (\fB{~~\fI...\fB~~}\fR).  When both lexical file information and | ||||
| synset location information are displayed, the synset location | ||||
| information appears first. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| When sense numbers are shown, the sense number of each word in each | ||||
| synset is printed immediately after the word, and is preceded by a | ||||
| number sign (\fB#\fP). | ||||
| .IP "Set maximum history length..." | ||||
| Display a popup dialog in which the maximum number of previous | ||||
| searches to be kept on the History list can be set. | ||||
| .IP "Set font...~~~~~~~~~~~" | ||||
| Display a popup window for setting the font (typeface) and font size | ||||
| to use for the Results Window.  Choices for typeface are: \fBCourier\fP, | ||||
| \fBHelvetica\fP, and \fBTimes\fP (default).  Font size can be | ||||
| \fBsmall\fP, \fBmedium\fP (default), or \fBlarge\fP. | ||||
| .IP "Save current options as default" | ||||
| Save the currently set options.  Next time the browser is started, | ||||
| these options will be used as the user defaults. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .SS Help | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .IP "Help on using the WordNet browser" | ||||
| Display this manual page. | ||||
| .IP "Help on WordNet terminology" | ||||
| Display the  | ||||
| .BR wngloss (7WN) | ||||
| manual page. | ||||
| .IP "Display the WordNet license" | ||||
| Display the WordNet copyright notice and license agreement. | ||||
| .IP "About the WordNet browser" | ||||
| Information about this application. | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .SH SHORCUTS | ||||
| Clicking on any word in the Results Window while holding down the  | ||||
| .SB SHIFT | ||||
| key on the keyboard causes the browser to replace \fBSearch | ||||
| Word\fP with the word and display its Overview and available searches. | ||||
| Clicking on any word in the Results Window with the middle mouse | ||||
| button does the same thing. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Pressing the | ||||
| .SB CONTROL-S | ||||
| keys causes the browser to do as above on the text that is currently | ||||
| highlighted.  Under Unix, this will work even if the highlighted text | ||||
| is in another window.  This works on | ||||
| hyphenated strings and collocations, as well as individual words. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Pressing the | ||||
| .SB CONTROL-G  | ||||
| keys displays the Substring Search Window. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SH SEARCH RESULTS | ||||
| The results of a search of the WordNet database are displayed in the | ||||
| Results Window.  Horizontal and vertical scroll bars are present for | ||||
| scrolling through the search results. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| All searches other than the Overview list all senses matching the | ||||
| search results in the following general format.  Items enclosed in | ||||
| italicized square brackets (\fI[~...~]\fP) may not be present. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| If a search cannot be performed on some senses of \fIsearchstr\fP, the | ||||
| search results are headed by a string of the form: | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| 	X of Y senses of \fIsearchstr\fP | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| One line listing the number of senses matching the search selected. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Each sense matching the search selected displayed as follows: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| 	\fBSense \fIn\fR | ||||
| 	\fI[\fB{\fIsynset_offset\fB}\fI] [\fB<\fIlex_filename\fB>\fI]~~word1[\fB#\fIsense_number][,~~word2...]\fR | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Where \fIn\fP is the sense number of the search word, | ||||
| \fIsynset_offset\fP is the byte offset of the synset in the | ||||
| \fBdata.\fIpos\fR file corresponding to the syntactic category, | ||||
| \fIlex_filename\fP is the name of the lexicographer file that the | ||||
| synset comes from, \fIword1\fP is the first word in the synset (note | ||||
| that this is not necessarily the search word) and \fIsense_number\fP | ||||
| is the WordNet sense number assigned to the preceding word. | ||||
| \fIsynset_offset\fP, \fIlex_filename\fP, and \fIsense_number\fP are | ||||
| generated if the appropriate Options are specified. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The synsets matching the search selected are printed below each | ||||
| sense's synset output described above.  Each line of output is | ||||
| preceded by a marker (usually \fB=>\fP), then a synset, formatted as | ||||
| described above.  If a search traverses more one level of the tree, | ||||
| then successive lines are indented by spaces corresponding to its | ||||
| level in the hierarchy.  Glosses are displayed in parentheses at the | ||||
| end of each synset if the appropriate Option is set.  Each synset is | ||||
| printed on one line. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Senses are ordered from most to least frequently used, with | ||||
| the most common sense numbered \fB1\fP.  Frequency of use is | ||||
| determined by the number of times a sense is tagged in the various | ||||
| semantic concordance texts.  Senses that are not semantically tagged | ||||
| follow the ordered senses. Note that this ordering is only an | ||||
| estimate based on usage in a small corpus. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Verb senses can be grouped by similarity of meaning, rather | ||||
| than ordered by frequency of use.  When the \fB"Synonyms, grouped by | ||||
| similarity"\fP search is selected, senses that are close | ||||
| in meaning are printed together, with a line of dashes indicating the | ||||
| end of a group.  See | ||||
| .BR wngroups (7WN) | ||||
| for a discussion how senses are grouped. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The output of the \fB"Derivationally Related Forms"\fP  | ||||
| search shows word forms that are | ||||
| morphologically related to \fBsearchstr\fP. Each word form pointed to | ||||
| from \fIsearchstr\fP is displayed, preceded by \fBRELATED TO->\fP and | ||||
| the syntactic category of the link, followed, on the next line, by its | ||||
| synset.  Printed after the word form is \fB#\fP\fIn\fP where \fIn\fP | ||||
| indicates the WordNet sense number of the term pointed to. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fB"Domain"\fP and \fB"Domain Terms"\fP searches show the domain that a | ||||
| synset has been classified in and, conversely, all of the terms that | ||||
| have been assigned to a specific domain.  A domain is | ||||
| either a \fBTOPIC,\fP \fBREGION\fP or \fBUSAGE,\fP as reflected in | ||||
| the specific pointer character stored in the database, and displayed | ||||
| in the output.  A \fBDomain\fP search on a term shows the domain, if | ||||
| any, that each synset containing \fIsearchstr\fP has been classified | ||||
| in.  The output display shows the domain type (\fBTOPIC,\fP | ||||
| \fBREGION\fP or \fBUSAGE\fP), followed by the syntactic category of | ||||
| the domain synset and the terms in the synset.  Each term is followed | ||||
| by \fB#\fP\fIn\fP where \fIn\fP indicates the WordNet sense number of | ||||
| the term.  The converse search, \fBDomain Terms\fP, shows all of the synsets | ||||
| that have been placed into the domain \fIsearchstr\fP, with analogous | ||||
| markers.  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| When the \fB"Sentence Frames"\fP search is specified, sample | ||||
| illustrative sentences and generic sentence frames are displayed.  If | ||||
| a sample sentence is found, the base form of the search word is | ||||
| substituted into the sentence, and it is printed below the synset, | ||||
| preceded with the \fBEX:\fP marker.  When no sample sentences are | ||||
| found, the generic sentence frames are displayed.  Sentence frames | ||||
| that are acceptable for all words in a synset are preceded by the | ||||
| marker \fB*>\fP.  If a frame is acceptable for the search word only, | ||||
| it is preceded by the marker \fB=>\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Search results for adjectives are slightly different from those for | ||||
| other parts of speech.  When an adjective is printed, its direct | ||||
| antonym, if it has one, is also printed in parentheses.  When | ||||
| the search word is in a head synset, all of the head synset's | ||||
| satellites are also displayed.  The position of an adjective in | ||||
| relation to the noun may be restricted to the \fIprenominal\fP, | ||||
| \fIpostnominal\fP or \fIpredicative\fP position.  Where present, these | ||||
| restrictions are noted in parentheses. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| When an adjective is a participle of a verb, the output indicates the | ||||
| verb and displays its synset. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| When an adverb is derived from an adjective, the specific adjectival | ||||
| sense on which it is based is indicated. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The morphological transformations performed by the search code may | ||||
| result in more than one word to search for.  \fBwnb(\|)\fP | ||||
| automatically performs the requested search on all of the strings and | ||||
| returns the results grouped by word.  For example, the verb \fBsaw\fP | ||||
| is both the present tense of \fBsaw\fP and the past tense of | ||||
| \fBsee\fP.  When there is more than one word to search for, search | ||||
| results are grouped by word. | ||||
| .SH DIAGNOSTICS | ||||
| If the WordNet database files cannot be opened, error messages are | ||||
| displayed.  This is usually corrected by setting the environment | ||||
| variables described below to the proper location of the WordNet | ||||
| database for your installation. | ||||
| .SH ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNHOME | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fB/usr/local/WordNet-3.0\fP. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNSEARCHDIR | ||||
| Directory in which the WordNet database has been installed.   | ||||
| Default is \fBWNHOME/dict\fP. | ||||
| .SH REGISTRY (WINDOWS) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\eSOFTWARE\eWordNet\e3.0\eWNHome | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fBC:\eProgram~Files\eWordNet\e3.0\fP. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B HKEY_CURRENT_USER\eSOFTWARE\eWordNet\e3.0\ewnres | ||||
| User's default browser options. | ||||
| .SH FILES | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B index.\fIpos\fP | ||||
| database index files | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B data.\fIpos\fP | ||||
| database data files | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B *.vrb | ||||
| files of sentences illustrating the use of verbs | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B \fIpos\fP.exc | ||||
| morphology exception lists | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wnintro (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wn (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (3WN), | ||||
| .BR lexnames (5WN), | ||||
| .BR senseidx (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN),  | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN), | ||||
| .BR morphy (7WN),  | ||||
| .BR wngloss (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wngroups (7WN). | ||||
| .SH BUGS | ||||
| Please reports bugs to wordnet@princeton.edu. | ||||
							
								
								
									
										362
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wndb.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										362
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wndb.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,362 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH WNDB 5WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm File Formats" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| index.noun, data.noun, index.verb, data.verb, index.adj, data.adj, index.adv, data.adv \- WordNet database files | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| noun.exc, verb.exc. adj.exc adv.exc \- morphology exception lists | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| sentidx.vrb, sents.vrb \- files used by search code to display | ||||
| sentences illustrating the use of some specific verbs | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| For each syntactic category, two files are needed to represent the | ||||
| contents of the WordNet database \- \fBindex.\fP\fIpos\fP and | ||||
| \fBdata.\fP\fIpos\fP, where \fIpos\fP is \fBnoun\fP, \fBverb\fP, | ||||
| \fBadj\fP and \fBadv\fP.  The other auxiliary files are used by the | ||||
| WordNet library's searching functions and are needed to run the | ||||
| various WordNet browsers. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Each index file is an alphabetized list of all the words found in | ||||
| WordNet in the corresponding part of speech.  On each line, following | ||||
| the word, is a list of byte offsets (\fIsynset_offset\fPs) in the | ||||
| corresponding data file, one for each synset containing the word. | ||||
| Words in the index file are in lower case only, regardless of how they | ||||
| were entered in the lexicographer files.  This folds various | ||||
| orthographic representations of the word into one line enabling | ||||
| database searches to be case insensitive.  See | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN) | ||||
| for a detailed description of the lexicographer files | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| A data file for a syntactic category contains information | ||||
| corresponding to the synsets that were specified in the lexicographer | ||||
| files, with relational pointers resolved to \fIsynset_offset\fPs. | ||||
| Each line corresponds to a synset.  Pointers are followed and | ||||
| hierarchies traversed by moving from one synset to another via the | ||||
| \fIsynset_offset\fPs.   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The exception list files, \fIpos\fP\fB.exc\fP, are used to help the | ||||
| morphological processor find base forms from irregular inflections. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The files \fBsentidx.vrb\fP and \fBsents.vrb\fP contain sentences | ||||
| illustrating the use of specific senses of some verbs.  These files | ||||
| are used by the searching software in response to a request for verb | ||||
| sentence frames.  Generic sentence frames are displayed when an | ||||
| illustrative sentence is not present. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The various database files are in ASCII formats that are easily read | ||||
| by both humans and machines.  All fields, unless otherwise noted, are | ||||
| separated by one space character, and all lines are terminated by a | ||||
| newline character.  Fields enclosed in italicized square brackets may | ||||
| not be present. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| See  | ||||
| .BR wngloss (7WN) | ||||
| for a glossary of WordNet terminology and a discussion of the | ||||
| database's content and logical organization. | ||||
| .SS Index File Format | ||||
| Each index file begins with several lines containing a copyright | ||||
| notice, version number and license agreement.  These lines all begin | ||||
| with two spaces and the line number so they do not interfere with the | ||||
| binary search algorithm that is used to look up entries in the index | ||||
| files.  All other lines are in the following format.  In the field | ||||
| descriptions, \fBnumber\fP always refers to a decimal integer unless | ||||
| otherwise defined. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fIlemma~~pos~~synset_cnt~~p_cnt~~[ptr_symbol...]~~sense_cnt~~tagsense_cnt ~~synset_offset~~[synset_offset...]\fP | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I lemma | ||||
| lower case ASCII text of word or collocation.  Collocations are formed | ||||
| by joining individual words with an underscore (\fB_\fP) character. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I pos | ||||
| Syntactic category: \fBn\fP for noun files,  | ||||
| \fBv\fP for verb files, \fBa\fP for adjective files, \fBr\fP for | ||||
| adverb files. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| All remaining fields are with respect to senses of \fIlemma\fP in | ||||
| \fIpos\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I synset_cnt | ||||
| Number of synsets that \fIlemma\fP is in.  This is the | ||||
| number of senses of the word in WordNet. See  | ||||
| .SM \fBSense Numbers\fP | ||||
| below for a discussion of how sense numbers are assigned and the order | ||||
| of \fIsynset_offset\fPs in the index files. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I p_cnt | ||||
| Number of different pointers that \fIlemma\fP has in all synsets | ||||
| containing it. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I ptr_symbol | ||||
| A space separated list of \fIp_cnt\fP different types of pointers that | ||||
| \fIlemma\fP has in all synsets containing it. See | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN) | ||||
| for a list of \fIpointer_symbol\fPs.  If all senses of \fIlemma\fP | ||||
| have no pointers, this field is omitted and \fIp_cnt\fP is \fB0\fP. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I sense_cnt | ||||
| Same as \fIsense_cnt\fP above.  This is redundant, but the field was | ||||
| preserved for compatibility reasons. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I tagsense_cnt | ||||
| Number of senses of \fIlemma\fP that are ranked according to | ||||
| their frequency of occurrence in semantic concordance texts. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I synset_offset | ||||
| Byte offset in \fBdata.\fIpos\fR file of a synset containing | ||||
| \fIlemma\fP.  Each \fIsynset_offset\fP in the list corresponds to a | ||||
| different sense of \fIlemma\fP in WordNet.  \fIsynset_offset\fP is an | ||||
| 8 digit, zero-filled decimal integer that can be used with | ||||
| .BR fseek (3) | ||||
| to read a synset from the data file.  When passed to | ||||
| .BR read_synset (3WN) | ||||
| along with the syntactic category, a data structure containing the | ||||
| parsed synset is returned. | ||||
| .SS Data File Format | ||||
| Each data file begins with several lines containing a copyright | ||||
| notice, version number and license agreement.  These lines all begin | ||||
| with two spaces and the line number.  All other lines are in the | ||||
| following format.  Integer fields are of fixed length, and are | ||||
| zero-filled. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fIsynset_offset~~lex_filenum~~ss_type~~w_cnt~~word~~lex_id~~[word~~lex_id...]~~p_cnt~~[ptr...]~~[frames...]~~\fB|\fP\fI~~gloss\fP | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I synset_offset | ||||
| Current byte offset in the file represented as an 8 digit decimal | ||||
| integer.  | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I lex_filenum | ||||
| Two digit decimal integer corresponding to the lexicographer file name | ||||
| containing the synset.  See | ||||
| .BR lexnames (5WN) | ||||
| for the list of filenames and their corresponding numbers. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I ss_type | ||||
| One character code indicating the synset type:  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fBn\fP	NOUN | ||||
| \fBv\fP	VERB | ||||
| \fBa\fP	ADJECTIVE | ||||
| \fBs\fP	ADJECTIVE SATELLITE | ||||
| \fBr\fP	ADVERB | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I w_cnt | ||||
| Two digit hexadecimal integer indicating the number of words in the | ||||
| synset. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I word | ||||
| ASCII form of a word as entered in the synset by the lexicographer, | ||||
| with spaces replaced by underscore characters (\fB_\fP).  The text of | ||||
| the word is case sensitive, in contrast to its form in the | ||||
| corresponding \fBindex.\fP\fIpos\fP file, that contains only | ||||
| lower-case forms.  In \fBdata.adj\fP, a \fIword\fP is followed by a | ||||
| syntactic marker if one was specified in the lexicographer file.  A | ||||
| syntactic marker is appended, in parentheses, onto \fIword\fP without | ||||
| any intervening spaces.  See | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN) | ||||
| for a list of the syntactic markers for adjectives. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I lex_id | ||||
| One digit hexadecimal integer that, when appended onto \fIlemma\fP, | ||||
| uniquely identifies a sense within a lexicographer file.  \fIlex_id\fP | ||||
| numbers usually start with \fB0\fP, and are incremented as additional | ||||
| senses of the word are added to the same file, although there is no | ||||
| requirement that the numbers be consecutive or begin with \fB0\fP. | ||||
| Note that a value of \fB0\fP is the default, and therefore is not | ||||
| present in lexicographer files.  | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I p_cnt | ||||
| Three digit decimal integer indicating the number of pointers from | ||||
| this synset to other synsets.  If \fIp_cnt\fP is \fB000\fP the synset | ||||
| has no pointers. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I ptr | ||||
| A pointer from this synset to another.  \fIptr\fP is of the form: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fIpointer_symbol~~synset_offset~~pos~~source/target\fR | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| where \fIsynset_offset\fP is the byte offset of the target synset in | ||||
| the data file corresponding to \fIpos\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fIsource/target\fP field distinguishes lexical and semantic | ||||
| pointers.  It is a four byte field, containing two two-digit | ||||
| hexadecimal integers.  The first two digits indicates the word number | ||||
| in the current (source) synset, the last two digits indicate the word | ||||
| number in the target synset.  A value of \fB0000\fP means that | ||||
| \fIpointer_symbol\fP represents a semantic relation between the | ||||
| current (source) synset and the target synset indicated by | ||||
| \fIsynset_offset\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| A lexical relation between two words in different synsets is | ||||
| represented by non-zero values in the source and target word numbers. | ||||
| The first and last two bytes of this field indicate the word numbers | ||||
| in the source and target synsets, respectively, between which the | ||||
| relation holds.  Word numbers are assigned to the \fIword\fP fields in | ||||
| a synset, from left to right, beginning with \fB1\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| See  | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN) | ||||
| for a list of \fIpointer_symbol\fPs, and semantic and lexical pointer | ||||
| classifications. | ||||
| .TP 15 | ||||
| .I frames | ||||
| In \fBdata.verb\fP only, a list of numbers corresponding to the | ||||
| generic verb sentence frames for \fIword\fPs in the synset.   | ||||
| \fIframes\fP is of the form: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fIf_cnt~~\fP \fB+\fP \fI~~f_num~~w_num~~[\fP \fB+\fP \fI~~f_num~~w_num...]\fP | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| where \fIf_cnt\fP a two digit decimal integer indicating the number of | ||||
| generic frames listed, \fIf_num\fP is a two digit decimal integer | ||||
| frame number, and \fIw_num\fP is a two digit hexadecimal integer | ||||
| indicating the word in the synset that the frame applies to.  As with | ||||
| pointers, if this number is \fB00\fP, \fIf_num\fP applies to all | ||||
| \fIword\fPs in the synset.  If non-zero, it is applicable only to the | ||||
| word indicated.  Word numbers are assigned as described for pointers. | ||||
| Each \fIf_num~~w_num\fP pair is preceded by a \fB+\fP. | ||||
| See | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN) | ||||
| for the text of the generic sentence frames. | ||||
| .TP | ||||
| .I gloss | ||||
| Each synset contains a gloss.  A \fIgloss\fP is represented as a | ||||
| vertical bar (\fB|\fP), followed by a text string that continues until | ||||
| the end of the line.  The gloss may contain a definition, one or more | ||||
| example sentences, or both. | ||||
| .SS Sense Numbers | ||||
| Senses in WordNet are generally ordered from most to least frequently | ||||
| used, with the most common sense numbered \fB1\fP.  Frequency of use is | ||||
| determined by the number of times a sense is tagged in the various | ||||
| semantic concordance texts.  Senses that are not semantically tagged | ||||
| follow the ordered senses.  The \fItagsense_cnt\fP field for each | ||||
| entry in the \fBindex.\fIpos\fR files indicates how many of the senses | ||||
| in the list have been tagged. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The  | ||||
| .BR cntlist (5WN) | ||||
| file provided with the database lists the number of times each sense | ||||
| is tagged in the semantic concordances.  The data from \fBcntlist\fP | ||||
| is used by | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN) | ||||
| to order the senses of each word.  When the \fBindex\fP.\fIpos\fP | ||||
| files are generated, the \fIsynset_offset\fPs are output in sense | ||||
| number order, with sense 1 first in the list.  Senses with the same | ||||
| number of semantic tags are assigned unique but consecutive sense | ||||
| numbers.  The WordNet  | ||||
| .SB OVERVIEW | ||||
| search displays all senses of the | ||||
| specified word, in all syntactic categories, and indicates which of | ||||
| the senses are represented in the semantically tagged texts. | ||||
| .SS Exception List File Format | ||||
| Exception lists are alphabetized lists of inflected forms of words and | ||||
| their base forms.  The first field of each line is an inflected form, | ||||
| followed by a space separated list of one or more base forms of the | ||||
| word.  There is one exception list file for each syntactic category. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Note that the noun and verb exception lists were automatically | ||||
| generated from a machine-readable dictionary, and contain many words | ||||
| that are not in WordNet.  Also, for many of the inflected forms, base | ||||
| forms could be easily derived using the standard rules of detachment | ||||
| programmed into Morphy (See | ||||
| .BR morph (7WN)). | ||||
| These anomalies are allowed to remain in the exception list files, | ||||
| as they do no harm. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SS Verb Example Sentences | ||||
| For some verb senses, example sentences illustrating the use of the | ||||
| verb sense can be displayed.  Each line of the file \fBsentidx.vrb\fP | ||||
| contains a \fIsense_key\fP followed by a space and a comma separated | ||||
| list of example sentence template numbers, in decimal.  The file | ||||
| \fBsents.vrb\fP lists all of the example sentence templates.  Each | ||||
| line begins with the template number followed by a space.  The rest of | ||||
| the line is the text of a template example sentence, with \fB%s\fP | ||||
| used as a placeholder in the text for the verb.  Both files are sorted | ||||
| alphabetically so that the \fIsense_key\fP and template sentence | ||||
| number can be used as indices, via | ||||
| .BR binsrch (3WN),  | ||||
| into the appropriate file. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| When a request for  | ||||
| .SB FRAMES | ||||
| is made, the WordNet search code looks | ||||
| for the sense in \fBsentidx.vrb\fP.  If found, the sentence | ||||
| template(s) listed is retrieved from \fBsents.vrb\fP, and the \fB%s\fP | ||||
| is replaced with the verb.  If the sense is not found, the applicable | ||||
| generic sentence frame(s) listed in \fIframes\fP is displayed. | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| Information in the \fBdata.\fIpos\fR and \fBindex.\fIpos\fR files | ||||
| represents all of the word senses and synsets in the WordNet database. | ||||
| The \fIword\fP, \fIlex_id\fP, and \fIlex_filenum\fP fields together | ||||
| uniquely identify each word sense in WordNet.  These can be encoded in | ||||
| a \fIsense_key\fP as described in | ||||
| .BR senseidx (5WN). | ||||
| Each synset in the database can be uniquely identified by combining | ||||
| the \fIsynset_offset\fP for the synset with a code for the syntactic | ||||
| category (since it is possible for synsets in different | ||||
| \fBdata.\fIpos\fR files to have the same \fIsynset_offset\fP). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The WordNet system provide both command line and window-based browser | ||||
| interfaces to the database.  Both interfaces utilize a common library | ||||
| of search and morphology code.  The source code for the library and | ||||
| interfaces is included in the WordNet package.  See | ||||
| .BR wnintro (3WN) | ||||
| for an overview of the WordNet source code. | ||||
| .SH ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNHOME | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fB/usr/local/WordNet-3.0\fP. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNSEARCHDIR | ||||
| Directory in which the WordNet database has been installed.   | ||||
| Default is \fBWNHOME/dict\fP. | ||||
| .SH REGISTRY (WINDOWS) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\eSOFTWARE\eWordNet\e3.0\eWNHome | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fBC:\eProgram~Files\eWordNet\e3.0\fP. | ||||
| .SH FILES | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B index.\fIpos\fP | ||||
| database index files | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B data.\fIpos\fP | ||||
| database data files | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B *.vrb | ||||
| files of sentences illustrating the use of verbs | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B \fIpos\fP.exc | ||||
| morphology exception lists | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wn (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnb (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (3WN), | ||||
| .BR binsrch (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (5WN), | ||||
| .BR cntlist (5WN), | ||||
| .BR lexnames (5WN), | ||||
| .BR senseidx (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN), | ||||
| .BR morphy (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wngloss (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wngroups (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wnstats (7WN). | ||||
							
								
								
									
										291
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wngloss.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										291
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wngloss.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,291 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH WNGLOSS 7WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| wngloss \- glossary of terms used in WordNet system | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| The \fIWordNet Reference Manual\fP consists of Unix-style manual pages | ||||
| divided into sections as follows: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TS | ||||
| center box ; | ||||
| c | c | ||||
| c | l. | ||||
| \fBSection\fP	\fBDescription\fP | ||||
| _ | ||||
| 1	WordNet User Commands | ||||
| 3	WordNet Library Functions | ||||
| 5	WordNet File Formats | ||||
| 7	Miscellaneous Information about WordNet | ||||
| .TE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SS System Description | ||||
| The WordNet system consists of lexicographer files, code to convert | ||||
| these files into a database, and search routines and interfaces that | ||||
| display information from the database.  The lexicographer files | ||||
| organize nouns, verbs, adjectives and adverbs into groups of synonyms, | ||||
| and describe relations between synonym groups. | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN) | ||||
| converts the lexicographer files into a database that encodes the | ||||
| relations between the synonym groups.  The different interfaces to the | ||||
| WordNet database utilize a common library of search routines to | ||||
| display these relations.  Note that the lexicographer files and  | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN) | ||||
| program are not generally distributed.   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SS Database Organization | ||||
| Information in WordNet is organized around logical groupings called | ||||
| synsets.  Each synset consists of a list of synonymous words or | ||||
| collocations (eg. \fB"fountain pen"\fP, \fB"take in"\fP), and pointers | ||||
| that describe the relations between this synset and other synsets.  A | ||||
| word or collocation may appear in more than one synset, and in more | ||||
| than one part of speech.  The words in a synset are grouped | ||||
| such that they are interchangeable in some context. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Two kinds of relations are represented by pointers: lexical and | ||||
| semantic.  Lexical relations hold between semantically related  | ||||
| word forms; semantic | ||||
| relations hold between word meanings.  These relations include (but | ||||
| are not limited to) hypernymy/hyponymy (superordinate/subordinate),  | ||||
| antonymy, entailment, and meronymy/holonymy. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Nouns and verbs are organized into hierarchies based on the | ||||
| hypernymy/hyponymy relation between synsets.  Additional pointers are | ||||
| be used to indicate other relations.   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Adjectives are arranged in clusters containing head synsets and | ||||
| satellite synsets.  Each cluster is organized around antonymous pairs | ||||
| (and occasionally antonymous triplets).  The antonymous pairs (or | ||||
| triplets) are indicated in the head synsets of a cluster.  Most head | ||||
| synsets have one or more satellite synsets, each of which represents a | ||||
| concept that is similar in meaning to the concept represented by the | ||||
| head synset.  One way to think of the adjective cluster organization | ||||
| is to visualize a wheel, with a head synset as the hub and satellite | ||||
| synsets as the spokes.  Two or more wheels are logically connected via | ||||
| antonymy, which can be thought of as an axle between the wheels. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Pertainyms are relational adjectives and do not follow the structure | ||||
| just described.  Pertainyms do not have antonyms; the synset for a | ||||
| pertainym most often contains only one word or collocation and a | ||||
| lexical pointer to the noun that the adjective is "pertaining | ||||
| to".  Participial adjectives have lexical pointers to the verbs that | ||||
| they are derived from. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Adverbs are often derived from adjectives, and sometimes have | ||||
| antonyms; therefore the synset for an adverb usually contains a | ||||
| lexical pointer to the adjective from which it is derived. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| See | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN) | ||||
| for a detailed description of the database files and how the data are | ||||
| represented.  | ||||
| .SH GLOSSARY OF TERMS | ||||
| Many terms used in the \fIWordNet Reference Manual\fP are unique to | ||||
| the WordNet system.  Other general terms have specific meanings when | ||||
| used in the WordNet documentation.  Definitions for many of these | ||||
| terms are given to help with the interpretation and understanding of | ||||
| the reference manual, and in the use of the WordNet system. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| In following definitions \fBword\fP is used in place of \fBword or | ||||
| collocation\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B adjective cluster | ||||
| A group of adjective synsets that are organized around antonymous | ||||
| pairs or triplets.  An adjective cluster contains two or more \fBhead | ||||
| synsets\fR which represent antonymous concepts. | ||||
| Each head synset has one or more \fBsatellite synsets\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B attribute | ||||
| A noun for which adjectives express values. | ||||
| The noun \fBweight\fP is an attribute, for which the adjectives  | ||||
| \fBlight\fP and \fBheavy\fP express values.  | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B base form | ||||
| The base form of a word or collocation is the form to which | ||||
| inflections are added. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B basic synset | ||||
| Syntactically, same as \fBsynset\fP.  Term is used in  | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN)  | ||||
| to help explain differences in entering synsets in lexicographer | ||||
| files. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B collocation | ||||
| A collocation in WordNet is a string of two or more words, connected | ||||
| by spaces or hyphens.  Examples are: \fBman-eating~shark\fP, | ||||
| \fBblue-collar\fP, \fBdepend~on\fP, \fBline~of~products\fP.  In the | ||||
| database files spaces are represented as underscore (\fB_\fP) | ||||
| characters. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B coordinate | ||||
| Coordinate terms are nouns or verbs that have the same \fBhypernym\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25  | ||||
| .B cross-cluster pointer | ||||
| A \fBsemantic pointer\fP from one adjective cluster to another. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B derivationally related forms | ||||
| Terms in different | ||||
| syntactic categories that have the same root form and are semantically | ||||
| related.  | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B direct antonyms | ||||
| A pair of words between which there is an associative bond resulting | ||||
| from their frequent | ||||
| co-occurrence.  In \fBadjective clusters\fP, direct antonyms appears | ||||
| only in \fBhead synsets\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B domain | ||||
| A topical classification to which a synset has been linked with a | ||||
| CATEGORY, REGION or USAGE pointer. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B domain term | ||||
| A synset belonging to a topical class.  A domain term is further | ||||
| identified as being a CATEGORY_TERM, REGION_TERM or USAGE_TERM. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B entailment | ||||
| A verb \fBX\fP entails \fBY\fP if \fBX\fP cannot be done unless \fBY\fP is,  | ||||
| or has been, done. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B exception list | ||||
| Morphological transformations for words that are not regular and | ||||
| therefore cannot be processed in an algorithmic manner. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B group | ||||
| Verb senses that similar in meaning and have been manually grouped | ||||
| together. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B gloss | ||||
| Each synset contains \fBgloss\fP consisting of a definition and | ||||
| optionally example sentences. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B head synset | ||||
| Synset in an adjective \fBcluster\fP containing at least one word | ||||
| that has a \fBdirect antonym\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B holonym | ||||
| The name of the whole of which the meronym names a part.  \fBY\fP  | ||||
| is a holonym of \fBX\fP if \fBX\fP is a part of \fBY\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B hypernym | ||||
| The generic term used to designate a whole class of specific instances. | ||||
| \fBY\fP is a hypernym of \fBX\fP if \fBX\fP is a (kind of) \fBY\fP.   | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B hyponym | ||||
| The specific | ||||
| term used to designate a member of a class.  \fBX\fP is a hyponym of  | ||||
| \fBY\fP if \fBX\fP is a (kind of) \fBY\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B indirect antonym | ||||
| An adjective in a \fBsatellite synset\fP that does not have a | ||||
| \fBdirect antonym\fP | ||||
| has an indirect antonyms via the direct antonym of the \fBhead | ||||
| synset\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B instance | ||||
| A proper noun that refers | ||||
| to a particular, unique referent (as distinguished from nouns that | ||||
| refer to classes).  This is a specific form of hyponym. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B lemma | ||||
| Lower case ASCII text of word as found in the WordNet database index | ||||
| files.  Usually the \fBbase form\fP for a word or collocation. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B lexical pointer | ||||
| A lexical pointer indicates a relation between words in synsets (word | ||||
| forms). | ||||
| .TP | ||||
| .B lexicographer file | ||||
| Files containing the raw data for WordNet synsets, edited by lexicographers, | ||||
| that are input to the \fBgrind\fP program to generate a WordNet database. | ||||
| .TP | ||||
| .B lexicographer id (lex id) | ||||
| A decimal integer that, when appended onto \fBlemma\fP, uniquely | ||||
| identifies a sense within a lexicographer file.  | ||||
| .TP | ||||
| .B monosemous | ||||
| Having only one sense in a syntactic category. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B meronym | ||||
| The name of a constituent part of, the substance of, or a member of | ||||
| something.  \fBX\fP is a meronym of \fBY\fP if \fBX\fP is a part of \fBY\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B part of speech | ||||
| WordNet defines "part of speech" as either noun, verb, adjective, or | ||||
| adverb.  Same as \fBsyntactic category\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B participial adjective | ||||
| An adjective that is derived from a verb. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B pertainym | ||||
| A relational adjective.  Adjectives that are pertainyms are usually | ||||
| defined by such phrases as "of or pertaining to" and do not have | ||||
| antonyms.  A pertainym can point to a noun or another pertainym. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B polysemous | ||||
| Having more than one sense in a syntactic category. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B polysemy count | ||||
| Number of senses of a word in a syntactic category, in WordNet. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B postnominal | ||||
| A postnominal adjective occurs only immediately following the noun  | ||||
| that it modifies. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B predicative | ||||
| An adjective that can be used only in predicate positions.  If \fBX\fP | ||||
| is a predicate adjective, it can only be used in such phrases as "it is | ||||
| \fBX\fP" and never prenominally. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B prenominal | ||||
| An adjective that can occur only before the noun that it modifies: it | ||||
| cannot be used predicatively. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B satellite synset | ||||
| Synset in an adjective \fBcluster\fP representing a concept that is | ||||
| similar in meaning to the concept represented by its \fBhead | ||||
| synset\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B semantic concordance | ||||
| A textual corpus (e.g. the Brown Corpus) and a lexicon (e.g. WordNet) | ||||
| so combined  | ||||
| that every substantive word in the text is linked to its appropriate | ||||
| sense in the lexicon via a \fBsemantic tag\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B semantic tag | ||||
| A pointer from a word in a text file to a specific sense of that word in the | ||||
| WordNet database.  A semantic tag in a semantic concordance is | ||||
| represented by a \fBsense key\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B semantic pointer | ||||
| A semantic pointer indicates a relation between synsets (concepts). | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B sense | ||||
| A meaning of a word in WordNet.  Each sense of a word is in a | ||||
| different \fBsynset\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B sense key | ||||
| Information necessary to find a sense in the WordNet database.  A | ||||
| sense key combines a \fBlemma\fP field and codes for the synset type, | ||||
| lexicographer id, lexicographer file number, and information about a | ||||
| satellite's \fBhead synset\fP, if required.  See | ||||
| .BR senseidx (5WN) | ||||
| for a description of the format of a sense key. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B subordinate | ||||
| Same as \fBhyponym\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B superordinate | ||||
| Same as \fBhypernym\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B synset | ||||
| A synonym set; a set of words that are interchangeable in some | ||||
| context without changing the truth value of the preposition in which | ||||
| they are embedded. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B troponym | ||||
| A verb expressing a specific manner elaboration of another verb. | ||||
| \fBX\fP is a troponym of \fBY\fP if \fBto X\fP is \fBto Y\fP in some manner. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B unique beginner | ||||
| A noun synset with no \fBsuperordinate\fP. | ||||
							
								
								
									
										43
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wngroups.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										43
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wngroups.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,43 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH WNGROUPS 7WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| wngroups \- discussion of WordNet search code to group similar verb senses | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| Some similar senses of verbs have been grouped by the lexicographers. | ||||
| This grouping is done statically in the lexicographer source files | ||||
| using the semantic \fIpointer_symbol\fP \fB$\fP. | ||||
| Transitivity is used to combine groups of overlapping | ||||
| senses into the largest sense groups possible. | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| Coverage of verb groups is incomplete. | ||||
| .SH ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNHOME | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fB/usr/local/WordNet-3.0\fP. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNSEARCHDIR | ||||
| Directory in which the WordNet database has been installed.   | ||||
| Default is \fBWNHOME/dict\fP. | ||||
| .SH REGISTRY (WINDOWS) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\eSOFTWARE\eWordNet\e3.0\eWNHome | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fBC:\eProgram~Files\eWordNet\e3.0\fP. | ||||
| .SH FILES | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B sentidx.vrb | ||||
| verb sense keys and sentence frame numbers | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B sents.vrb | ||||
| example sentence frames | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wn (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnb (1WN), | ||||
| .BR senseidx (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wnsearch (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (7WN). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
							
								
								
									
										513
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wninput.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										513
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wninput.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,513 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH WNINPUT 5WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm File Formats" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| noun.\fIsuffix\fP, verb.\fIsuffix\fP, adj.\fIsuffix\fP, adv.\fIsuffix\fP \- | ||||
| WordNet lexicographer files that are input to  | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN) | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| WordNet's source files are written by lexicographers.  They are the | ||||
| product of a detailed relational analysis of lexical semantics: a | ||||
| variety of lexical and semantic relations are used to represent the | ||||
| organization of lexical knowledge.  Two kinds of building blocks are | ||||
| distinguished in the source files: word forms and word meanings.  Word | ||||
| forms are represented in their familiar orthography; word meanings are | ||||
| represented by synonym sets (\fIsynset\fPs) \- lists of synonymous | ||||
| word forms that are interchangeable in some context.  Two kinds of | ||||
| relations are recognized: lexical and semantic.  Lexical relations | ||||
| hold between word forms; semantic relations hold between word | ||||
| meanings. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Lexicographer files correspond to the syntactic categories implemented | ||||
| in WordNet \- noun, verb, adjective and adverb.  All of the synsets in | ||||
| a lexicographer file are in the same syntactic category.  Each synset | ||||
| consists of a list of synonymous words or collocations | ||||
| (eg. \fB"fountain pen"\fP, \fB"take in"\fP), and pointers that | ||||
| describe the relations between this synset and other synsets.  These | ||||
| relations include (but are not limited to) hypernymy/hyponymy, | ||||
| antonymy, entailment, and meronymy/holonymy.  A word or collocation | ||||
| may appear in more than one synset, and in more than one part of | ||||
| speech.  Each use of a word in a synset represents a sense of that | ||||
| word in the part of speech corresponding to the synset. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Adjectives may be organized into clusters containing head synsets and | ||||
| satellite synsets.  Adverbs generally point to the adjectives from | ||||
| which they are derived. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| See  | ||||
| .BR wngloss (7WN) | ||||
| for a glossary of WordNet terminology and a discussion of the | ||||
| database's content and logical organization. | ||||
| .SS Lexicographer File Names | ||||
| The names of the lexicographer files are of the form: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .IR pos . suffix | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| where \fIpos\fP is either \fBnoun\fP, \fBverb\fP, \fBadj\fP or | ||||
| \fBadv\fP.  \fIsuffix\fP may be used to organize groups of synsets | ||||
| into different files, for example \fBnoun.animal\fP and | ||||
| \fBnoun.plant\fP.  See | ||||
| .BR lexnames (5WN) | ||||
| for a list of lexicographer file names that are used in building | ||||
| WordNet. | ||||
| .SS Pointers | ||||
| Pointers are used to represent the relations between the words in one | ||||
| synset and another.  Semantic pointers represent relations between | ||||
| word meanings, and therefore pertain to all of the words in the source | ||||
| and target synsets.  Lexical pointers represent relations between word | ||||
| forms, and pertain only to specific words in the source and target | ||||
| synsets.  The following pointer types are usually used to indicate | ||||
| lexical relations: Antonym, Pertainym, Participle, Also See, Derivationally | ||||
| Related.  The remaining pointer types are generally used to represent semantic | ||||
| relations. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| A relation from a source to a target synset is formed by specifying | ||||
| a word from the target synset in the source synset, followed by the | ||||
| \fIpointer_symbol\fP indicating the pointer type.  The location of a pointer | ||||
| within a synset defines it as either lexical or semantic.   | ||||
| The | ||||
| .SB "Lexicographer File Format" | ||||
| section describes the syntax for entering a semantic pointer, and | ||||
| .SB "Word Syntax" | ||||
| describes the syntax for entering a lexical pointer. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Although there are many pointer types, only certain types of relations | ||||
| are permitted between synsets of each syntactic category. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fIpointer_symbol\fPs for nouns are: | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB!\fP 	Antonym | ||||
| \fB@\fP	Hypernym | ||||
| \fB@i\fP	Instance Hypernym | ||||
| \fB\(ap\fP	Hyponym | ||||
| \fB\(api\fP	Instance Hyponym | ||||
| \fB#m\fP	Member holonym | ||||
| \fB#s\fP	Substance holonym | ||||
| \fB#p\fP	Part holonym | ||||
| \fB%m\fP	Member meronym | ||||
| \fB%s\fP	Substance meronym | ||||
| \fB%p\fP	Part meronym | ||||
| \fB=\fP	Attribute | ||||
| \fB+\fP	Derivationally related form		 | ||||
| \fB;c\fP	Domain of synset - TOPIC | ||||
| \fB-c\fP	Member of this domain - TOPIC | ||||
| \fB;r\fP	Domain of synset - REGION | ||||
| \fB-r\fP	Member of this domain - REGION | ||||
| \fB;u\fP	Domain of synset - USAGE | ||||
| \fB-u\fP	Member of this domain - USAGE | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fIpointer_symbol\fPs for verbs are: | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB!\fP 	Antonym | ||||
| \fB@\fP	Hypernym | ||||
| \fB\(ap\fP	Hyponym | ||||
| \fB*\fP	Entailment | ||||
| \fB>\fP	Cause | ||||
| \fB^\fP	Also see | ||||
| \fB$\fP	Verb Group | ||||
| \fB+\fP	Derivationally related form		 | ||||
| \fB;c\fP	Domain of synset - TOPIC | ||||
| \fB;r\fP	Domain of synset - REGION | ||||
| \fB;u\fP	Domain of synset - USAGE | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fIpointer_symbol\fPs for adjectives are: | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB!\fP	Antonym | ||||
| \fB&\fP	Similar to | ||||
| \fB<\fP	Participle of verb | ||||
| \fB\e\fP	Pertainym (pertains to noun) | ||||
| \fB=\fP	Attribute | ||||
| \fB^\fP	Also see | ||||
| \fB;c\fP	Domain of synset - TOPIC | ||||
| \fB;r\fP	Domain of synset - REGION | ||||
| \fB;u\fP	Domain of synset - USAGE | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fIpointer_symbol\fPs for adverbs are: | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB!\fP	Antonym | ||||
| \fB\e\fP	Derived from adjective | ||||
| \fB;c\fP	Domain of synset - TOPIC | ||||
| \fB;r\fP	Domain of synset - REGION | ||||
| \fB;u\fP	Domain of synset - USAGE | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Many pointer types are reflexive, meaning that if a synset contains a | ||||
| pointer to another synset, the other synset should contain a | ||||
| corresponding reflexive pointer.   | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN) | ||||
| automatically inserts missing reflexive pointers for the following | ||||
| pointer types: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TS | ||||
| center box ; | ||||
| c | c  | ||||
| l | l . | ||||
| \fBPointer\fP	\fBReflect\fP | ||||
| _ | ||||
| Antonym	Antonym | ||||
| Hyponym	Hypernym | ||||
| Hypernym	Hyponym | ||||
| Instance Hyponym	Instance Hypernym | ||||
| Instance Hypernym	Instance Hyponym | ||||
| Holonym	Meronym | ||||
| Meronym	Holonym | ||||
| Similar to	Similar to | ||||
| Attribute	Attribute | ||||
| Verb Group	Verb Group | ||||
| Derivationally Related	Derivationally Related | ||||
| Domain of synset	Member of Doman | ||||
| .TE | ||||
| .SS Verb Frames | ||||
| Each verb synset contains a list of generic sentence frames | ||||
| illustrating the types of simple sentences in which the verbs in the | ||||
| synset can be used.  For some verb senses, example sentences | ||||
| illustrating actual uses of the verb are provided.  (See | ||||
| .SB "Verb Example Sentences" | ||||
| in | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN).) | ||||
| Whenever there is no example sentence, the generic sentence frames | ||||
| specified by the lexicographer are used.  The generic sentence frames | ||||
| are entered in a synset as a comma-separated list of integer frame | ||||
| numbers.  The following list is the text of the generic frames, | ||||
| preceded by their frame numbers: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| 1	Something ----s | ||||
| 2	Somebody ----s | ||||
| 3	It is ----ing | ||||
| 4	Something is ----ing PP | ||||
| 5	Something ----s something Adjective/Noun | ||||
| 6	Something ----s Adjective/Noun | ||||
| 7	Somebody ----s Adjective | ||||
| 8	Somebody ----s something | ||||
| 9	Somebody ----s somebody | ||||
| 10	Something ----s somebody | ||||
| 11	Something ----s something | ||||
| 12	Something ----s to somebody | ||||
| 13	Somebody ----s on something | ||||
| 14	Somebody ----s somebody something | ||||
| 15	Somebody ----s something to somebody | ||||
| 16	Somebody ----s something from somebody | ||||
| 17	Somebody ----s somebody with something | ||||
| 18	Somebody ----s somebody of something | ||||
| 19	Somebody ----s something on somebody | ||||
| 20	Somebody ----s somebody PP | ||||
| 21	Somebody ----s something PP | ||||
| 22	Somebody ----s PP | ||||
| 23	Somebody's (body part) ----s | ||||
| 24	Somebody ----s somebody to INFINITIVE | ||||
| 25	Somebody ----s somebody INFINITIVE | ||||
| 26	Somebody ----s that CLAUSE | ||||
| 27	Somebody ----s to somebody | ||||
| 28	Somebody ----s to INFINITIVE | ||||
| 29	Somebody ----s whether INFINITIVE | ||||
| 30	Somebody ----s somebody into V-ing something | ||||
| 31	Somebody ----s something with something | ||||
| 32	Somebody ----s INFINITIVE | ||||
| 33	Somebody ----s VERB-ing | ||||
| 34	It ----s that CLAUSE | ||||
| 35	Something ----s INFINITIVE | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .SS Lexicographer File Format | ||||
| Synsets are entered one per line, and each line is terminated with a | ||||
| newline character.  A line containing a synset may be as long as | ||||
| necessary, but no newlines can be entered within a synset.  Within a | ||||
| synset, spaces or tabs may be used to separate entities.  Items | ||||
| enclosed in italicized square brackets may not be present. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The general synset syntax is: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB{\fP \fI~~words~~pointers~~\fP \fB(\fP \fI~gloss~\fP \fB)~~}\fR | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Synsets of this form are valid for all syntactic categories except | ||||
| verb, and are referred to as basic synsets.  At least one \fIword\fP | ||||
| and a \fIgloss\fP are required to form a valid synset.  Pointers | ||||
| entered following all the \fIwords\fP in a synset represent semantic | ||||
| relations between all the words in the source and target synsets. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| For verbs, the basic synset syntax is defined as follows: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .KS | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB{\fP \fI~~words~~pointers~~frames~~\fP \fB(\fP ~\fIgloss~\fP \fB)~~}\fR | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Adjective may be organized into clusters containing one or more head | ||||
| synsets and optional satellite synsets.  Adjective clusters are of the | ||||
| form: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB[ | ||||
| \fIhead synset | ||||
| [satellite synsets] | ||||
| [\-] | ||||
| [additional head/satellite synsets] | ||||
| \fB]\fR | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .KE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Each adjective cluster is enclosed in square brackets, and may have | ||||
| one or more parts.  Each part consists of a head synset and optional | ||||
| satellite synsets that are conceptually similar to the head synset's | ||||
| meaning.  Parts of a cluster are separated by one or more hyphens | ||||
| (\fB\-\fP) on a line by themselves, with the terminating square | ||||
| bracket following the last synset.  Head and satellite synsets follow | ||||
| the syntax of basic synsets, however a "Similar to" pointer must be | ||||
| specified in a head synset for each of its satellite synsets.  Most | ||||
| adjective clusters contain two antonymous parts.  See | ||||
| .BR wngloss (7WN) | ||||
| for a discussion of adjective clusters, and | ||||
| .SB "Special Adjective Syntax" | ||||
| for more information on adjective cluster syntax. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Synsets for relational adjectives (pertainyms) and participial | ||||
| adjectives do not adhere to the cluster structure.  They use the basic | ||||
| synset syntax. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Comments can be entered in a lexicographer file by enclosing the text | ||||
| of the comment in parentheses.  Note that comments \fBcannot\fP appear | ||||
| within a synset, as parentheses within a synset have an entirely | ||||
| different meaning (see | ||||
| .SB "Gloss Syntax" | ||||
| ).  However, entire synsets (or adjective clusters) can be "commented | ||||
| out" by enclosing them in parentheses.  This is often used by the | ||||
| lexicographers to verify the syntax of files under development or to | ||||
| leave a note to oneself while working on entries. | ||||
| .SS Word Syntax | ||||
| A synset must have at least one word, and the words of a synset must | ||||
| appear after the opening brace and before any other synset constructs. | ||||
| A word may be entered in either the simple word or word/pointer | ||||
| syntax. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| A simple word is of the form: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fIword[\fP \fB(\fP \fImarker\fP \fB)\fP \fI][lex_id]\fP \fB,\fR | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIword\fP may be entered in any combination of upper and lower case | ||||
| unless it is in an adjective cluster.  A collocation is entered by | ||||
| joining the individual words with an underscore character (\fB_\fP). | ||||
| Numbers (integer or real) may be entered, either by themselves or as | ||||
| part of a word string, by following the number with a double quote | ||||
| (\fB"\fP). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| See  | ||||
| .SB "Special Adjective Syntax" | ||||
| for a description of adjective clusters and markers. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fIword\fP may be followed by an integer \fIlex_id\fP from \fB1\fP to | ||||
| \fB15\fP.  The \fIlex_id\fP is used to distinguish different senses of | ||||
| the same word within a lexicographer file.  The lexicographer assigns | ||||
| \fIlex_id\fP values, usually in ascending order, although there is no | ||||
| requirement that the numbers be consecutive.  The default is \fB0\fP, | ||||
| and does not have to be specified.  A \fIlex_id\fP must be used on | ||||
| pointers if the desired sense has a non-zero \fIlex_id\fP in its | ||||
| synset specification. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Word/pointer syntax is of the form: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB[~~\fP \fIword[\fP \fB(\fP \fImarker\fP \fB)\fP \fI][lex_id]\fP \fB,\fP \fI~~pointers~~\fP \fB]\fR | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| This syntax is used when one or more pointers correspond only to the | ||||
| specific word in the word/pointer set, rather than all the words in | ||||
| the synset, and represents a lexical relation.  Note that a | ||||
| word/pointer set appears within a synset, therefore the square | ||||
| brackets used to enclose it are treated differently from those used to | ||||
| define an adjective cluster.  Only one word can be specified in each | ||||
| word/pointer set, and any number of pointers may be included.  A | ||||
| synset can have any number of word/pointer sets.  Each is treated by | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN)  | ||||
| essentially as a \fIword\fP, so they all must appear | ||||
| before any synset \fIpointers\fP representing semantic relations. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| For verbs, the word/pointer syntax is extended in the following manner | ||||
| to allow the user to specify generic sentence frames that, like | ||||
| pointers, correspond only to a specific word, rather than all the | ||||
| words in the synset.  In this case, \fIpointers\fP are optional. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB[~~\fP \fIword\fP \fB,\fP ~~\fI[pointers]~~frames~~\fP \fB]\fR | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .SS Pointer Syntax | ||||
| Pointers are optional in synsets.  If a pointer is specified outside | ||||
| of a word/pointer set, the relation is applied to all of the words in | ||||
| the synset, including any words specified using the word/pointer | ||||
| syntax.  This indicates a semantic relation between the meanings of | ||||
| the words in the synsets.  If specified within a word/pointer set, the | ||||
| relation corresponds only to the word in the set and represents a | ||||
| lexical relation. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| A pointer is of the form: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fI[lex_filename\fP\fB:\fP \fI]word[lex_id]\fP\fB,\fP\fIpointer_symbol\fR | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| or: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fI[lex_filename\fP\fB:\fP \fI]word[lex_id]\fP\fB^\fP\fIword[lex_id]\fP\fB,\fP\fIpointer_symbol\fR | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| For pointers, \fIword\fP indicates a word in another synset.  When the | ||||
| second form of a pointer is used, the first \fIword\fP indicates a | ||||
| word in a head synset, and the second is a word in a satellite of that | ||||
| cluster.  \fIword\fP may be followed by a \fIlex_id\fP that is used to | ||||
| match the pointer to the correct target synset.  The synset containing | ||||
| \fIword\fP may reside in another lexicographer file.  In this case, | ||||
| \fIword\fP is preceded by \fIlex_filename\fP as shown. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| See | ||||
| .SB "Pointers" | ||||
| for a list of \fIpointer_symbol\fPs and their meanings. | ||||
| .SS Verb Frame List Syntax | ||||
| Frame numbers corresponding to generic sentence frames must be entered | ||||
| in each verb synset.  If a frame list is specified outside of a | ||||
| word/pointer set, the verb frames in the list apply to all of the | ||||
| words in the synset, including any words specified using the | ||||
| word/pointer syntax.  If specified within a word/pointer set, the verb | ||||
| frames in the list correspond only to the word in the set. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| A frame number list is entered as follows: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| \fBframes:\fP~~\fIf_num\fP[\fB,\fP\fIf_num...]\fR | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Where \fIf_num\fP specifies a generic frame number. | ||||
| See | ||||
| .SB "Verb Frames" | ||||
| for a list of generic sentences and their corresponding frame numbers. | ||||
| .SS Gloss Syntax | ||||
| A gloss is included in all synsets.  The lexicographer may enter a | ||||
| text string of any length desired.  A gloss is simply a string | ||||
| enclosed in parentheses with no embedded carriage returns.  It | ||||
| provides a definition of what the synset represents and/or example | ||||
| sentences. | ||||
| .SS Special Adjective Syntax | ||||
| The syntax for representing antonymous adjective synsets requires | ||||
| several additional conditions. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The first word of a head synset \fBmust\fP be entered in upper case, | ||||
| and can be thought of as the head word of the head synset.  The | ||||
| \fIword\fP part of a pointer from one head synset to another head | ||||
| synset within the same cluster (usually an antonym) must also be | ||||
| entered in upper case.  Usually antonymous adjectives are entered | ||||
| using the word/pointer syntax described in | ||||
| .SB "Word Syntax" | ||||
| to indicate a lexical relation.  There is no restriction on the number | ||||
| of parts that a cluster may have, and some clusters have three parts, | ||||
| representing antonymous triplets, such as \fBsolid\fP, \fBliquid\fP, | ||||
| and \fBgas\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| A cross-cluster pointer may be specified, allowing a head or satellite | ||||
| synset to point to a head synset in a different cluster.  A | ||||
| cross-cluster pointer is indicated by entering the \fIword\fP part of | ||||
| the pointer in upper case. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| An adjective may be annotated with a syntactic marker indicating a | ||||
| limitation on the syntactic position the adjective may have in | ||||
| relation to noun that it modifies.  If so marked, the marker appears | ||||
| between the word and its following comma.  If a \fIlex_id\fP is | ||||
| specified, the marker immediately follows it.  The syntactic markers | ||||
| are: | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB(p)\fP	predicate position | ||||
| \fB(a)\fP	prenominal (attributive) position | ||||
| \fB(ip)\fP	immediately postnominal position		 | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .SH EXAMPLES | ||||
| \fI(Note that these are hypothetical examples not found in the WordNet | ||||
| lexicographer files.)\fP | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Sample noun synsets: | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| { canine, [ dog1, cat,! ] pooch, canid,@ } | ||||
| { collie, dog1,@ (large multi-colored dog with pointy nose) } | ||||
| { hound, hunting_dog, pack,#m dog1,@ } | ||||
| { dog, } | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Sample verb synsets: | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| { [ confuse, clarify,! frames: 1 ] blur, obscure, frames: 8, 10 } | ||||
| { [ clarify, confuse,! ] make_clear, interpret,@ frames: 8 } | ||||
| { interpret, construe, understand,@ frames: 8 } | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Sample adjective clusters: | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| [ | ||||
| { [ HOT, COLD,! ] lukewarm(a), TEPID,^ (hot to the touch) } | ||||
| { warm, } | ||||
| \- | ||||
| { [ COLD, HOT,! ] frigid, (cold to the touch) } | ||||
| { freezing, } | ||||
| ] | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Sample adverb synsets: | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| { [ basically, adj.all:essential^basic,\e ] [ essentially, adj.all:basic^fundamental,\e ] ( by one's very nature )} | ||||
| { pointedly, adj.all:pungent^pointed,\e } | ||||
| { [ badly, adj.all:bad,\e well,! ] ill, ("He was badly prepared") } | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (5WN), | ||||
| .BR lexnames (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN), | ||||
| .BR uniqbeg (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wngloss (7WN). | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| Fellbaum, C. (1998), ed. | ||||
| \fI"WordNet: An Electronic Lexical Database"\fP. | ||||
| MIT Press, Cambridge, MA. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
							
								
								
									
										53
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnintro.1
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										53
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnintro.1
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,53 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH WNINTRO 1WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm User Commands" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| wnintro \- WordNet user commands | ||||
| .SH SYNOPSIS | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBwn\fP \- command line interface to WordNet database | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBwnb\fP \- window based WordNet browser | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| This section of the \fIWordNet Reference Manual\fP contains manual | ||||
| pages that describe commands available with the various WordNet system | ||||
| packages. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The WordNet interfaces  | ||||
| .BR wn (1WN) | ||||
| and | ||||
| .BR wnb (1WN) | ||||
| allow the user to search the WordNet database and display the | ||||
| information textually.   | ||||
| .SH ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNHOME | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fB/usr/local/WordNet-3.0\fP. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNSEARCHDIR | ||||
| Directory in which the WordNet database has been installed.   | ||||
| Default is \fBWNHOME/dict\fP. | ||||
| .SH REGISTRY (WINDOWS) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\eSOFTWARE\eWordNet\e3.0\eWNHome | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fBC:\eProgram~Files\eWordNet\e3.0\fP. | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wn (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnb (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (7WN). | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| Fellbaum, C. (1998), ed. | ||||
| \fI"WordNet: An Electronic Lexical Database"\fP. | ||||
| MIT Press, Cambridge, MA. | ||||
| .SH AVAILABILITY | ||||
| WordNet has a World Wide Web site at | ||||
| \fBhttp://wordnet.princeton.edu\fP.  From this web site | ||||
| users can learn about the WordNet project, run several different | ||||
| interfaces to the WordNet database, and download various WordNet | ||||
| system packages and \fI"Five Papers on WordNet"\fP. | ||||
							
								
								
									
										280
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnintro.3
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										280
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnintro.3
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,280 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH WNINTRO 3WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm Library Functions" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| wnintro \- introduction to WordNet library functions | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| This section of the \fIWordNet Reference Manual\fP contains manual | ||||
| pages that describe the WordNet library functions and API. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Functions are organized into the following categories:  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TS | ||||
| center box ; | ||||
| l | l | l. | ||||
| \fBCategory\fP	\fBManual Page\fP	\fBObject File\fP | ||||
| _ | ||||
| Database Search	wnsearch (3WN)	search.o | ||||
| Morphology	morph (3WN)	morph.o | ||||
| Misc. Utility	wnutil (3WN)	wnutil.o | ||||
| Binary Search	binsrch (3WN)	binsrch.o | ||||
| .TE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The WordNet library is used by all of the searching interfaces | ||||
| provided with the various WordNet packages.  Additional programs in | ||||
| the system, such as | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN), | ||||
| also use functions in this library. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The WordNet library is provided in both source and binary forms (on | ||||
| some platforms) to allow users to build applications and tools to | ||||
| their own specifications that utilize the WordNet database.  We do not | ||||
| provide programming support or assistance. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The code conforms to ANSI C standards.  Functions are defined with | ||||
| function prototypes.  If you do not have a compiler that accepts | ||||
| prototypes, you must edit the source code and remove the prototypes | ||||
| before compiling. | ||||
| .SH LIST OF WORDNET LIBRARY FUNCTIONS | ||||
| Not all library functions are listed below. Missing are mainly | ||||
| functions that are called by documented ones, or ones that were | ||||
| written for specific applications or tools used during WordNet | ||||
| development.  Data structures are defined in | ||||
| \fBwn.h\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SS Database Searching Functions (search.o) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B findtheinfo  | ||||
| Primary search function for WordNet database.  Returns | ||||
| formatted search results in text buffer.  Used by WordNet interfaces | ||||
| to perform requested search. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B findtheinfo_ds | ||||
| Primary search function for WordNet database.  Returns search results | ||||
| in linked list data structure. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B is_defined | ||||
| Set bit for each search type that is valid for the search word passed | ||||
| and return bit mask. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B in_wn | ||||
| Set bit for each syntactic category that search word is in. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B index_lookup | ||||
| Find word in index file and return parsed entry in data structure. | ||||
| Input word must be exact match of string in database.  Called by | ||||
| \fBgetindex(\|)\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B getindex | ||||
| Find word in index file, trying different techniques \- replace hyphens | ||||
| with underscores, replace underscores with hyphens, strip hyphens and | ||||
| underscores, strip periods. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B read_synset | ||||
| Read synset from data file at byte offset passed and return parsed | ||||
| entry in data structure.  Calls \fBparse_synset(\|)\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B parse_synset | ||||
| Read synset at current byte offset in file and return parsed entry in | ||||
| data structure. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B free_syns | ||||
| Free a synset linked list allocated by \fBfindtheinfo_ds(\|)\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B free_synset | ||||
| Free a synset structure. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B free_index | ||||
| Free an index structure. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B traceptrs_ds | ||||
| Recursive search algorithm to trace a pointer tree and return results | ||||
| in linked list. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B do_trace | ||||
| Do requested search on synset passed returning formatted output in | ||||
| buffer. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SS Morphology Functions (morph.o) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B morphinit | ||||
| Open exception list files. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B re_morphinit | ||||
| Close exception list files and reopen. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B morphstr | ||||
| Try to find base form (lemma) of word or collocation in syntactic | ||||
| category passed.  Calls \fBmorphword(\|)\fP for each word in string | ||||
| passed. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B morphword | ||||
| Try to find base form (lemma) of individual word in syntactic category | ||||
| passed. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SS Utility Functions (wnutil.o) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B wninit | ||||
| Top level function to open database files and morphology exception | ||||
| lists. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B re_wninit | ||||
| Top level function to close and reopen database files and morphology | ||||
| exception lists. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B cntwords | ||||
| Count the number of underscore or space separated words in a string. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B strtolower | ||||
| Convert string to lower case and remove trailing adjective marker if | ||||
| found. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B ToLowerCase | ||||
| Convert string passed to lower case. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B strsubst | ||||
| Replace all occurrences of \fIfrom\fP with \fIto\fP in \fIstr\fP. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B getptrtype | ||||
| Return code for pointer type character passed. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B getpos | ||||
| Return syntactic category code for string passed. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B getsstype | ||||
| Return synset type code for string passed. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B FmtSynset | ||||
| Reconstruct synset string from synset pointer. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B StrToPos | ||||
| Passed string for syntactic category, returns corresponding integer | ||||
| value. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B GetSynsetForSense | ||||
| Return synset for sense key passed. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B GetDataOffset | ||||
| Find synset offset for sense. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B GetPolyCount | ||||
| Find polysemy count for sense passed. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B GetWORD | ||||
| Return word part of sense key. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B GetPOS | ||||
| Return syntactic category code for sense key passed. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B WNSnsToStr | ||||
| Generate sense key for index entry passed. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B GetValidIndexPointer | ||||
| Search for string and/or base form of word in database and return index | ||||
| structure for word if found. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B GetWNSense | ||||
| Return sense number in database for sense key. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B GetSenseIndex | ||||
| Return parsed sense index entry for sense key passed. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B default_display_message | ||||
| Default function to use as value of \fBdisplay_message\fP.  Simply | ||||
| returns \fB-1\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SS Binary Search Functions (binsrch.o) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B bin_search | ||||
| General purpose binary search function to search for key as first item | ||||
| on line in sorted file. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B copyfile | ||||
| Copy contents from one file to another. | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B replace_line | ||||
| Replace a line in a sorted file.  | ||||
| .TP 25 | ||||
| .B insert_line | ||||
| Insert a line into a sorted file. | ||||
| .SH HEADER FILE | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B wn.h | ||||
| WordNet include file of constants, data structures, external | ||||
| declarations for global variables initialized in \fBwnglobal.c\fP. | ||||
| Also lists function prototypes for library API. It must be included to | ||||
| use any WordNet library functions. | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| All library functions that access the database files expect the files | ||||
| to be open.  The function | ||||
| .BR wninit (3WN) | ||||
| must be called before other database access functions such as | ||||
| .BR findtheinfo (3WN) | ||||
| or | ||||
| .BR read_synset (3WN).   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Inclusion of the header file \fBwn.h\fP is necessary. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The command line interface is a good example of a simple application | ||||
| that uses several WordNet library functions.  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Many of the library functions are passed or return syntactic category | ||||
| or synset type information.  The following table lists the possible | ||||
| categories as integer codes, synset type constant names, syntactic | ||||
| category constant names, single characters and character strings. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TS | ||||
| center box ; | ||||
| c | c | c | c | c | ||||
| c | l | l | c | l. | ||||
| \fBInteger\fP	\fBSynset Type\fP	\fBSyntactic Category\fP	\fBChar\fP	\fBString\fP  | ||||
| _ | ||||
| 1	NOUN	NOUN	n	noun | ||||
| 2	VERB	VERB	v	verb | ||||
| 3	ADJ	ADJ	a	adj | ||||
| 4	ADV	ADV	r	adv | ||||
| 5	SATELLITE	ADJ	s	\fIn/a\fP | ||||
| .TE | ||||
| .SH ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES (UNIX) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNHOME | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fB/usr/local/WordNet-3.0\fP. | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B WNSEARCHDIR | ||||
| Directory in which the WordNet database has been installed.   | ||||
| Default is \fBWNHOME/dict\fP. | ||||
| .SH REGISTRY (WINDOWS) | ||||
| .TP 20 | ||||
| .B HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\eSOFTWARE\eWordNet\e3.0\eWNHome | ||||
| Base directory for WordNet.  Default is | ||||
| \fBC:\eProgram~Files\eWordNet\e3.0\fP. | ||||
| .SH FILES | ||||
| .TP 30 | ||||
| .B lib/libwn.a | ||||
| WordNet library (Unix) | ||||
| .TP 30 | ||||
| .B lib\ewn.lib | ||||
| WordNet library (Windows) | ||||
| .TP 30 | ||||
| .B include | ||||
| header files for use with WordNet library | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wnintro (1WN), | ||||
| .BR binsrch (3WN), | ||||
| .BR morph (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnsearch (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnutil (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (7WN). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Fellbaum, C. (1998), ed. | ||||
| \fI"WordNet: An Electronic Lexical Database"\fP. | ||||
| MIT Press, Cambridge, MA. | ||||
| .SH BUGS | ||||
| Please report bugs to \fBwordnet@princeton.edu\fP. | ||||
							
								
								
									
										54
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnintro.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										54
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnintro.5
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,54 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH WNINTRO 5WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm File Formats" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| wnintro \- introduction to descriptions of WordNet file formats | ||||
| .SH SYNOPSIS | ||||
| .LP  | ||||
| \fBcntlist\fP \- format of \fBcntlist\fP and \fBcntlist.rev\fP files | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBlexnames\fP \- list of lexicographer file names and numbers | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBprologdb\fP \- description of Prolog database files | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBsenseidx\fP \- format of sense index file | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBsensemap\fP \- mapping from senses in WordNet 2.1 to corresponding | ||||
| 3.0 senses | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBwndb\fP \- format of WordNet database files  | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBwninput\fP \- format of WordNet lexicographer files | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| This section of the \fIWordNet Reference Manual\fP contains manual pages | ||||
| that describe the formats of the various files included in different | ||||
| WordNet 3.0 packages. | ||||
| .SH NOMENCLATURE | ||||
| All files are in ASCII.  Fields are generally separated by one space, | ||||
| unless otherwise noted, and each line is terminated with a newline | ||||
| character.  In the file format descriptions, terms in \fIitalics\fP | ||||
| refer to field names.  Characters or strings in \fBboldface\fP | ||||
| represent an actual character or string as it appears in the file. | ||||
| Items enclosed in italicized square brackets (\fI[~~]\fP) may not be present. | ||||
| Since several files contain fields that have the identical meaning, | ||||
| field names are consistently defined.  For example, several WordNet | ||||
| files contain one or more \fIsynset_offset\fP fields.  In each case, | ||||
| the definition of \fIsynset_offset\fP is identical. | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wnintro (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (3WN), | ||||
| .BR cntlist (5WN), | ||||
| .BR lexnames (5WN), | ||||
| .BR prologdb (5WN), | ||||
| .BR senseidx (5WN), | ||||
| .BR sensemap (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wninput (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wngloss (7WN). | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| Fellbaum, C. (1998), ed. | ||||
| \fI"WordNet: An Electronic Lexical Database"\fP. | ||||
| MIT Press, Cambridge, MA. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
							
								
								
									
										40
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnintro.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										40
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnintro.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,40 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH WNINTRO 7WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "Miscellaneous WordNet\(tm Topics" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| wnintro \- introduction to miscellaneous WordNet information | ||||
| .SH SYNOPSIS | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBmorphy\fP \- discussion of WordNet's morphological processing | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBuniqbeg\fP \- unique beginners for noun hierarchies | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBwngloss\fP \- glossary of terms used in WordNet | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBwngroups\fP \- discussion of WordNet search code to group similar senses | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBwnlicens\fP \- text of WordNet license agreement | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBwnpkgs\fP \- information about WordNet packages and distribution | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBwnstats\fP \- database statistics | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| This section of the \fIWordNet Reference Manual\fP contains manual pages | ||||
| that describe various topics related to WordNet and the semantic | ||||
| concordances, and a glossary of terms. | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wnintro (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (5WN), | ||||
| .BR morphy (7WN), | ||||
| .BR uniqbeg (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wngroups (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wnlicens (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wnpkgs (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wnstats (7WN), | ||||
| .BR wngloss (7WN). | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| Fellbaum, C. (1998), ed. | ||||
| \fI"WordNet: An Electronic Lexical Database"\fP. | ||||
| MIT Press, Cambridge, MA. | ||||
							
								
								
									
										37
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnlicens.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										37
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnlicens.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,37 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .TH WNLICENS 7WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| wnlicens \- text of WordNet license | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| WordNet Release 3.0 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| This software and database is being provided to you, the LICENSEE, by   | ||||
| Princeton University under the following license.  By obtaining, using   | ||||
| and/or copying this software and database, you agree that you have   | ||||
| read, understood, and will comply with these terms and conditions.:   | ||||
|    | ||||
| Permission to use, copy, modify and distribute this software and   | ||||
| database and its documentation for any purpose and without fee or   | ||||
| royalty is hereby granted, provided that you agree to comply with   | ||||
| the following copyright notice and statements, including the disclaimer,   | ||||
| and that the same appear on ALL copies of the software, database and   | ||||
| documentation, including modifications that you make for internal   | ||||
| use or for distribution.   | ||||
|    | ||||
| WordNet 3.0 Copyright 2006 by Princeton University.  All rights reserved.   | ||||
|    | ||||
| THIS SOFTWARE AND DATABASE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND PRINCETON   | ||||
| UNIVERSITY MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR   | ||||
| IMPLIED.  BY WAY OF EXAMPLE, BUT NOT LIMITATION, PRINCETON   | ||||
| UNIVERSITY MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES OF MERCHANT-   | ||||
| ABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR THAT THE USE   | ||||
| OF THE LICENSED SOFTWARE, DATABASE OR DOCUMENTATION WILL NOT   | ||||
| INFRINGE ANY THIRD PARTY PATENTS, COPYRIGHTS, TRADEMARKS OR   | ||||
| OTHER RIGHTS.   | ||||
|    | ||||
| The name of Princeton University or Princeton may not be used in   | ||||
| advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software   | ||||
| and/or database.  Title to copyright in this software, database and   | ||||
| any associated documentation shall at all times remain with   | ||||
| Princeton University and LICENSEE agrees to preserve same.   | ||||
							
								
								
									
										77
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnpkgs.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										77
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnpkgs.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,77 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .tr ~ | ||||
| .TH WNPKGS 7WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| wnpkgs \- description of various WordNet system packages | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| WordNet 3.0 is distributed in several formats and in various packages. | ||||
| All of the packages are available via anonymous FTP from | ||||
| \fBftp.cogsci.princeton.edu\fP and from the WordNet Web | ||||
| site at \fBhttp://wordnet.princeton.edu\fP. | ||||
| .SS "Packages Available Via FTP and WWW" | ||||
| The following WordNet packages can be downloaded using a web browser | ||||
| from \fBftp://ftp.cogsci.princeton.edu/wordnet/3.0\fP, or | ||||
| from the Web site noted above.  Users can also FTP directly from | ||||
| \fBftp.cogsci.princeton.edu\fP, directory \fBwordnet/3.0\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TS | ||||
| center box ; | ||||
| c | c | c | c  | ||||
| lt | l | l | lt. | ||||
| \fBPackage\fP	\fBFilename\fP	\fBPlatform\fP	\fBDescription\fP | ||||
| _ | ||||
| .na | ||||
| Database	\fBWordNet-3.0.tar.gz\fP	Unix/OS X	T{ | ||||
| WordNet 3.0 database, interfaces, sense index, interface | ||||
| and library source code, documentation. | ||||
| T} | ||||
| Database	\fBWordNet-3.0.exe\fP	Windows	T{ | ||||
| WordNet 3.0 database, interfaces, sense index, interface | ||||
| and library source code, documentation. | ||||
| T} | ||||
| Prolog Database	\fBWNprolog-3.0.tar.gz\fP	All	T{ | ||||
| WordNet 3.0 database files in Prolog-readable format, documentation. | ||||
| T} | ||||
| Sense Map	\fBWNsnsmap-3.0.tar.gz\fP	All	T{ | ||||
| Mapping of 2.1 to 3.0 senses, documentation. | ||||
| T} | ||||
| .TE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SS "Database Package" | ||||
| The database package is a complete installation for WordNet 3.0 users. | ||||
| It includes the 3.0 database files, source code for the WordNet browsers and | ||||
| library, and documentation.  The other packages are not included \- | ||||
| they must be downloaded and installed separately. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Note that with this version of WordNet for Unix platforms, only source | ||||
| code is provided.  Users should carefully read the README and INSTALL | ||||
| files for detailed information on compiling WordNet and dependencies. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SS Prolog Database Package | ||||
| The WordNet 3.0 database files are available in this package in a | ||||
| Prolog-readable format.  Documentation describing the file format is | ||||
| included.  This package is only downloadable in compressed tar file | ||||
| format, although once unpackaged it can be used from Windows | ||||
| systems since the files are in ASCII.  Many Windows utilities, such as | ||||
| WinZip, can deal with a | ||||
| compressed tar file. | ||||
| .SS Sense Map Package | ||||
| To help users automatically convert 2.1 noun and verb senses to their | ||||
| corresponding 3.0 senses, we provide sense mapping information in | ||||
| this package.  This package contains files to map polysemous and | ||||
| monosemous words, and documentation that describes the format of these | ||||
| files.  As with the Prolog database, this package is only downloadable | ||||
| in compressed tar format, but the files are also in ASCII. | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| The lexicographer files and | ||||
| .BR grind (1WN) | ||||
| program are not generally distributed. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| All of the packages described above may not be available at the time | ||||
| of release of the 3.0 database package. | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wnintro (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (7WN). | ||||
							
								
								
									
										343
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnsearch.3
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										343
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnsearch.3
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,343 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .TH WNSEARCH 3WN  "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm Library Functions" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| findtheinfo, findtheinfo_ds, is_defined, in_wn, index_lookup, parse_index, getindex, read_synset, parse_synset, free_syns, free_synset, free_index, traceptrs_ds, do_trace | ||||
| .SH SYNOPSIS | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fB#include "wn.h" | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBchar *findtheinfo(char *searchstr, int pos, int ptr_type, int sense_num);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBSynsetPtr findtheinfo_ds(char *searchstr, int pos, int ptr_type, int sense_num );\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBunsigned int is_defined(char *searchstr, int pos);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBunsigned int in_wn(char *searchstr, int pos);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBIndexPtr index_lookup(char *searchstr, int pos);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBIndexPtr parse_index(long offset, int dabase, char *line);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBIndexPtr getindex(char *searchstr, int pos);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBSynsetPtr read_synset(int pos, long synset_offset, char *searchstr);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBSynsetPtr parse_synset(FILE *fp, int pos, char *searchstr);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBvoid free_syns(SynsetPtr synptr);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBvoid free_synset(SynsetPtr synptr);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBvoid free_index(IndexPtr idx);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBSynsetPtr traceptrs_ds(SynsetPtr synptr, int ptr_type, int pos, int depth);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBchar *do_trace(SynsetPtr synptr, int ptr_type, int pos, int depth);\fP | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| These functions are used for searching the WordNet database.  They | ||||
| generally fall into several categories: functions for reading and | ||||
| parsing index file entries; functions for reading and parsing synsets | ||||
| in data files; functions for tracing pointers and hierarchies; | ||||
| functions for freeing space occupied by data structures allocated with | ||||
| .BR malloc (3). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| In the following function descriptions, \fIpos\fP is one of the | ||||
| following: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| \fB1\fP	NOUN | ||||
| \fB2\fP	VERB | ||||
| \fB3\fP	ADJECTIVE | ||||
| \fB4\fP	ADVERB | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B findtheinfo(\|) | ||||
| is the primary search algorithm for use with database interface | ||||
| applications.  Search results are automatically formatted, and a | ||||
| pointer to the text buffer is returned.  All searches listed in  | ||||
| .B WNHOME/include/wn.h | ||||
| can be done by  | ||||
| .BR findtheinfo(\|) . | ||||
| .B findtheinfo_ds(\|) | ||||
| can be used to perform most of the searches, with results returned in | ||||
| a linked list data structure.  This is for use with applications that | ||||
| need to analyze the search results rather than just display them. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Both functions are passed the same arguments: \fIsearchstr\fP is the | ||||
| word or collocation to search for; \fIpos\fP indicates the syntactic | ||||
| category to search in; \fIptr_type\fP is one of the valid search types | ||||
| for \fIsearchstr\fP in \fIpos\fP.  (Available searches can be obtained | ||||
| by calling | ||||
| .B is_defined(\|) | ||||
| described below.)  \fIsense_num\fP should be | ||||
| .SB ALLSENSES | ||||
| if the search is to be done on all senses of \fIsearchstr\fP in | ||||
| \fIpos\fP, or a positive integer indicating which sense to search. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBfindtheinfo_ds(\|)\fP returns a linked list data structures | ||||
| representing synsets.  Senses are linked through the \fInextss\fP | ||||
| field of a \fBSynset\fP data structure.  For each sense, synsets that | ||||
| match the search specified with \fIptr_type\fP are linked through the | ||||
| \fIptrlist\fP field.  See | ||||
| .SB "Synset Navigation", | ||||
| below, for detailed information on the linked lists returned. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBis_defined(\|)\fP sets a bit for each search type that is valid for | ||||
| \fIsearchstr\fP in \fIpos\fP, and returns the resulting unsigned | ||||
| integer.  Each bit number corresponds to a pointer type constant | ||||
| defined in \fBWNHOME/include/wn.h\fP.  For example, if bit 2 is | ||||
| set, the | ||||
| .SB HYPERPTR | ||||
| search is valid for \fIsearchstr\fP.  There are 29 possible searches. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBin_wn(\|)\fP is used to find the syntactic categories in the | ||||
| WordNet database that contain one or more senses of \fIsearchstr\fP. | ||||
| If \fIpos\fP is | ||||
| .SB ALL_POS, | ||||
| all syntactic categories are checked.  Otherwise, only the part of | ||||
| speech passed is checked.  An unsigned integer is returned with a bit | ||||
| set corresponding to each syntactic category containing | ||||
| \fIsearchstr\fP.  The bit number matches the number for the part of | ||||
| speech.  \fB0\fP is returned if \fIsearchstr\fP is not present in | ||||
| \fIpos\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBindex_lookup(\|)\fP finds \fIsearchstr\fP in the index file for | ||||
| \fIpos\fP and returns a pointer to the parsed entry in an \fBIndex\fP | ||||
| data structure.  \fIsearchstr\fP must exactly match the form of the | ||||
| word (lower case only, hyphens and underscores in the same places) in | ||||
| the index file. | ||||
| .SB NULL  | ||||
| is returned if a match is not found. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBparse_index(\|)\fP parses an entry from an index file and returns a | ||||
| pointer to the parsed entry in an \fBIndex\fP data structure. | ||||
| Passed the byte \fIoffset\fP and syntactic category, it reads the index | ||||
| entry at the desired location in the corresponding file.  If passed | ||||
| \fIline\fP, \fIline\fP contains an index file entry and the database | ||||
| index file is not consulted.  However, \fIoffset\fP and \fIdbase\fP | ||||
| should still be passed so the information can be stored in the | ||||
| \fBIndex\fP structure. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBgetindex(\|)\fP is a "smart" search for \fIsearchstr\fP in the | ||||
| index file corresponding to \fIpos\fP.  It applies to \fIsearchstr\fP | ||||
| an algorithm that replaces underscores with hyphens, hyphens with | ||||
| underscores, removes hyphens and underscores, and removes periods in | ||||
| an attempt to find a form of the string that is an exact match for an | ||||
| entry in the index file corresponding to \fIpos\fP. | ||||
| \fBindex_lookup(\|)\fP is called on each transformed string until a | ||||
| match is found or all the different strings have been tried.  It | ||||
| returns a pointer to the parsed \fBIndex\fP data structure for | ||||
| \fIsearchstr\fP, or | ||||
| .SB NULL | ||||
| if a match is not found. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBread_synset(\|)\fP is used to read a synset from a byte offset in a | ||||
| data file.  It performs an \fBfseek\fP(3) to \fIsynset_offset\fP in | ||||
| the data file corresponding to \fIpos\fP, and calls | ||||
| \fBparse_synset(\|)\fP to read and parse the synset.  A pointer to the | ||||
| \fBSynset\fP data structure containing the parsed synset is returned. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBparse_synset(\|)\fP reads the synset at the current offset in the | ||||
| file indicated by \fIfp\fP.  \fIpos\fP is the syntactic category, and | ||||
| \fIsearchstr\fP, if not | ||||
| .SB NULL, | ||||
| indicates the word in the synset that the caller is interested in.  An | ||||
| attempt is made to match \fIsearchstr\fP to one of the words in the | ||||
| synset.  If an exact match is found, the \fIwhichword\fP field in the | ||||
| \fBSynset\fP structure is set to that word's number in the synset | ||||
| (beginning to count from \fB1\fP). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBfree_syns(\|)\fP is used to free a linked list of \fBSynset\fP | ||||
| structures allocated by \fBfindtheinfo_ds(\|)\fP.  \fIsynptr\fP is a | ||||
| pointer to the list to free. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBfree_synset(\|)\fP frees the \fBSynset\fP structure pointed to by | ||||
| \fIsynptr\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBfree_index(\|)\fP frees the \fBIndex\fP structure pointed to by | ||||
| \fIidx\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBtraceptrs_ds(\|)\fP is a recursive search algorithm that traces | ||||
| pointers matching \fIptr_type\fP starting with the synset pointed to | ||||
| by \fIsynptr\fP.  Setting \fIdepth\fP to \fB1\fP when | ||||
| \fBtraceptrs_ds(\|)\fP is called indicates a recursive search; \fB0\fP | ||||
| indicates a non-recursive call.  \fIsynptr\fP points to the data | ||||
| structure representing the synset to search for a pointer of type | ||||
| \fIptr_type\fP.  When a pointer type match is found, the synset | ||||
| pointed to is read is linked onto the \fInextss\fP chain.  Levels of | ||||
| the tree generated by a recursive search are linked via the | ||||
| \fIptrlist\fP field structure until | ||||
| .SB NULL | ||||
| is found, indicating the top (or bottom) of the tree.  This function | ||||
| is usually called from \fBfindtheinfo_ds(\|)\fP for each sense of the | ||||
| word.  See | ||||
| .SB "Synset Navigation", | ||||
| below, for detailed information on the linked lists returned. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBdo_trace(\|)\fP performs the search indicated by \fIptr_type\fP on | ||||
| synset \fPsynptr\fP in syntactic category \fIpos\fP.  \fIdepth\fP is | ||||
| defined as above.  \fBdo_trace(\|)\fP returns the search results | ||||
| formatted in a text buffer. | ||||
| .SS Synset Navigation | ||||
| Since the \fBSynset\fP structure is used to represent the synsets for | ||||
| both word senses and pointers, the \fIptrlist\fP and \fInextss\fP | ||||
| fields have different meanings depending on whether the structure is a | ||||
| word sense or pointer.  This can make navigation through the lists | ||||
| returned by \fBfindtheinfo_ds(\|)\fP confusing. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Navigation through the returned list involves the following: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Following the \fInextss\fP chain from the synset returned moves | ||||
| through the various senses of \fIsearchstr\fP. | ||||
| .SB NULL | ||||
| indicates that end of the chain of senses. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Following the \fIptrlist\fP chain from a \fBSynset\fP structure | ||||
| representing a sense traces the hierarchy of the search results for | ||||
| that sense.  Subsequent links in the \fIptrlist\fP chain indicate the | ||||
| next level (up or down, depending on the search) in the hierarchy. | ||||
| .SB NULL | ||||
| indicates the end of the chain of search result synsets. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| If a synset pointed to by \fIptrlist\fP has a value in the | ||||
| \fInextss\fP field, it represents another pointer of the same type at | ||||
| that level in the hierarchy.  For example, some noun synsets have two | ||||
| hypernyms.  Following this \fInextss\fP pointer, and then the | ||||
| \fIptrlist\fP chain from the \fBSynset\fP structure pointed to, traces | ||||
| another, parallel, hierarchy, until the end is indicated by | ||||
| .SB NULL | ||||
| on that \fIptrlist\fP chain.  So, a \fBsynset\fP representing a | ||||
| pointer (versus a sense of \fIsearchstr\fP) having a non-NULL | ||||
| value in \fInextss\fP has another chain of search results linked | ||||
| through the \fIptrlist\fP chain of the synset pointed to by | ||||
| \fInextss\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| If \fIsearchstr\fP contains more than one base form in WordNet (as in | ||||
| the noun \fBaxes\fP, which has base forms \fBaxe\fP and \fBaxis\fP), | ||||
| synsets representing the search results for each base form are linked | ||||
| through the \fInextform\fP pointer of the \fBSynset\fP structure. | ||||
| .SS WordNet Searches | ||||
| There is no extensive description of what each search type is or the | ||||
| results returned.  Using the WordNet interface, examining the source | ||||
| code, and reading | ||||
| .BR wndb (5WN)  | ||||
| are the best ways to see what types of searches are available and the | ||||
| data returned for each. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Listed below are the valid searches | ||||
| that can be passed as \fIptr_type\fP | ||||
| to \fBfindtheinfo(\|)\fP.  Passing a negative value (when applicable) | ||||
| causes a recursive, hierarchical search by setting \fIdepth\fP to | ||||
| \fB1\fP when \fBtraceptrs(\|)\fP is called. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .bp | ||||
| .TS | ||||
| center box ; | ||||
| l | c | c | l | ||||
| l | c | c | l | ||||
| l | c | c | l . | ||||
| \fBptr_type\fP	\fBValue\fP	\fBPointer\fP	\fBSearch\fP | ||||
| 		\fBSymbol\fP | ||||
| _ | ||||
| ANTPTR	1	!	Antonyms | ||||
| HYPERPTR	2	@	Hypernyms | ||||
| HYPOPTR	3	\(ap	Hyponyms | ||||
| ENTAILPTR	4	*	Entailment | ||||
| SIMPTR	5	&	Similar | ||||
| ISMEMBERPTR	6	#m	Member meronym | ||||
| ISSTUFFPTR	7	#s	Substance meronym | ||||
| ISPARTPTR	8	#p	Part meronym | ||||
| HASMEMBERPTR	9	%m	Member holonym | ||||
| HASSTUFFPTR	10	%s	Substance holonym | ||||
| HASPARTPTR	11	%p	Part holonym | ||||
| MERONYM	12	%	All meronyms | ||||
| HOLONYM	13	#	All holonyms | ||||
| CAUSETO	14	>	Cause | ||||
| PPLPTR	15	<	Participle of verb | ||||
| SEEALSOPTR	16	^	Also see | ||||
| PERTPTR	17	\e	Pertains to noun or derived from adjective | ||||
| ATTRIBUTE	18	\\=	Attribute | ||||
| VERBGROUP	19	$	Verb group | ||||
| DERIVATION	20	+	Derivationally related form | ||||
| CLASSIFICATION	21	;	Domain of synset | ||||
| CLASS	22	-	Member of this domain | ||||
| SYNS	23	\fIn/a\fP	Find synonyms  | ||||
| FREQ	24	\fIn/a\fP	Polysemy | ||||
| FRAMES	25	\fIn/a\fP	Verb example sentences and generic frames | ||||
| COORDS	26	\fIn/a\fP	Noun coordinates | ||||
| RELATIVES	27	\fIn/a\fP	Group related senses | ||||
| HMERONYM	28	\fIn/a\fP	Hierarchical meronym search | ||||
| HHOLONYM	29	\fIn/a\fP	Hierarchical holonym search | ||||
| WNGREP	30	\fIn/a\fP	Find keywords by substring | ||||
| OVERVIEW	31	\fIn/a\fP	Show all synsets for word | ||||
| CLASSIF_CATEGORY	32	;c	Show domain topic | ||||
| CLASSIF_USAGE	33	;u	Show domain usage | ||||
| CLASSIF_REGIONAL	34	;r	Show domain region | ||||
| CLASS_CATEGORY	35	-c	Show domain terms for topic | ||||
| CLASS_USAGE	36	-u	Show domain terms for usage | ||||
| CLASS_REGIONAL	37	-r	Show domain terms for region | ||||
| INSTANCE	38	@i	Instance of | ||||
| INSTANCES	39	\(api	Show instances | ||||
| .TE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| \fBfindtheinfo_ds(\|)\fP cannot perform the following searches: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .RS | ||||
| .nf | ||||
| SEEALSOPTR | ||||
| PERTPTR | ||||
| VERBGROUP | ||||
| FREQ | ||||
| FRAMES | ||||
| RELATIVES | ||||
| WNGREP | ||||
| OVERVIEW | ||||
| .fi | ||||
| .RE | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| Applications that use WordNet and/or the morphological functions | ||||
| must call \fBwninit(\|)\fP at the start of the program.  See | ||||
| .BR wnutil (3WN) | ||||
| for more information. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| In all function calls, \fIsearchstr\fP may be either a word or a | ||||
| collocation formed by joining individual words with underscore | ||||
| characters (\fB_\fP). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fBSearchResults\fP structure defines fields in the | ||||
| \fIwnresults\fP global variable that are set by the various search | ||||
| functions.  This is a way to get additional information, such as the | ||||
| number of senses the word has, from the search functions. | ||||
| The \fIsearchds\fP field is set by \fBfindtheinfo_ds(\|)\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The \fIpos\fP passed to \fBtraceptrs_ds(\|)\fP is not used. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wn (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnb (1WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (3WN), | ||||
| .BR binsrch (3WN), | ||||
| .BR malloc (3), | ||||
| .BR morph (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnutil (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (5WN). | ||||
| .SH WARNINGS | ||||
| \fBparse_synset(\|)\fP must find an exact match between the | ||||
| \fIsearchstr\fP passed and a word in the synset to set | ||||
| \fIwhichword\fP.  No attempt is made to translate hyphens and | ||||
| underscores, as is done in \fBgetindex(\|)\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The WordNet database and exception list files must be opened with | ||||
| \fBwninit\fP prior to using any of the searching functions. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| A large search may cause \fBfindtheinfo(\|)\fP to run out of buffer | ||||
| space.  The maximum buffer size is determined by computer platform. | ||||
| If the buffer size is exceeded the following message is printed in the | ||||
| output buffer: \fB"Search too large.  Narrow search and try | ||||
| again..."\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| Passing an invalid \fIpos\fP will probably result in a core dump. | ||||
							
								
								
									
										65
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnstats.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										65
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnstats.7
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,65 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .TH WNSTATS 7WN "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| wnstats \- WordNet 3.0 database statistics | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| .SS Number of words, synsets, and senses | ||||
| .TS | ||||
| center box tab(/); | ||||
| c | c | c | c | ||||
| c | c | c | c | ||||
| l | r | r | r. | ||||
| \fBPOS\fP/\fBUnique\fP/\fBSynsets\fP/\fBTotal\fP | ||||
| /\fBStrings\fP//\fBWord-Sense Pairs\fP/ | ||||
| _ | ||||
| Noun/117798/82115/146312 | ||||
| Verb/11529/13767/25047 | ||||
| Adjective/21479/18156/30002 | ||||
| Adverb/4481/3621/5580 | ||||
| = | ||||
| Totals/155287/117659/206941 | ||||
| .TE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SS Polysemy information | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TS | ||||
| center box tab(/); | ||||
| c | c | c | c | ||||
| c | c | c | c | ||||
| l | r | r | r. | ||||
| \fBPOS\fP/\fBMonosemous\fP/\fBPolysemous\fP/\fBPolysemous\fP | ||||
| /\fBWords and Senses\fP/\fBWords\fP/\fBSenses\fP | ||||
| _ | ||||
| Noun/101863/15935/44449 | ||||
| Verb/6277/5252/18770 | ||||
| Adjective/16503/4976/14399 | ||||
| Adverb/3748/733/1832 | ||||
| = | ||||
| Totals/128391/26896/79450 | ||||
| .TE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .TS | ||||
| center box tab(/); | ||||
| c | c | c | ||||
| c | c | c | ||||
| l | r | r. | ||||
| \fBPOS\fP/\fBAverage Polysemy\fP/\fBAverage Polysemy\fP | ||||
| /\fBIncluding Monosemous Words\fP/\fBExcluding Monosemous Words\fP | ||||
| _ | ||||
| Noun/1.24/2.79 | ||||
| Verb/2.17/3.57 | ||||
| Adjective/1.40/2.71 | ||||
| Adverb/1.25/2.50 | ||||
| .TE | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| Statistics for all types of adjectives and adjective satellites are | ||||
| combined.   | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| The total of all unique noun, verb, adjective, and adverb strings is | ||||
| actually 147278. | ||||
| However, many strings are unique within a | ||||
| syntactic category, but are in more than one syntactic category.  The | ||||
| figures in the table represent the unique strings in each syntactic category. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
							
								
								
									
										177
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnutil.3
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										177
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/man/wnutil.3
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,177 @@ | |||
| '\" t | ||||
| .\" $Id$ | ||||
| .TH WNUTIL 3WN  "Dec 2006" "WordNet 3.0" "WordNet\(tm Library Functions" | ||||
| .SH NAME | ||||
| wninit, re_wninit, cntwords, strtolower, ToLowerCase, strsubst, | ||||
| getptrtype, getpos, getsstype, StrToPos, GetSynsetForSense, | ||||
| GetDataOffset, GetPolyCount, WNSnsToStr, | ||||
| GetValidIndexPointer, GetWNSense, GetSenseIndex, default_display_message | ||||
| .SH SYNOPSIS | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fB#include "wn.h"\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBint wninit(void);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBint re_wninit(void);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBint cntwords(char *str, char separator);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBchar *strtolower(char *str);\fP | ||||
| .LP  | ||||
| \fBchar *ToLowerCase(char *str);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBchar *strsubst(char *str, char from, char to);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBint getptrtype(char *ptr_symbol);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBint getpos(char *ss_type);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBint getsstype(char *ss_type);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBint StrToPos(char \**pos);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBSynsetPtr GetSynsetForSense(char *sense_key);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBlong GetDataOffset(char *sense_key);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBint GetPolyCount(char *sense_key);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBchar *WNSnsToStr(IndexPtr idx, int sense_num);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBIndexPtr GetValidIndexPointer(char *str, int pos);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBint GetWNSense(char *lemma, *lex_sense);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBSnsIndexPtr GetSenseIndex(char *sense_key);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBint GetTagcnt(IndexPtr idx, int sense);\fP | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| \fBint default_display_message(char *msg);\fP | ||||
| .SH DESCRIPTION | ||||
| .LP | ||||
| The WordNet library contains many utility functions used by the | ||||
| interface code, other library functions, and various applications and | ||||
| tools.  Only those of importance to the WordNet search code, or which | ||||
| are generally useful are described here. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B wninit(\|) | ||||
| opens the files necessary for using WordNet with the WordNet library | ||||
| functions.  The database files are opened, and  | ||||
| .B morphinit(\|) | ||||
| is called to open the exception list files.  Returns \fB0\fP if | ||||
| successful, \fB-1\fP otherwise.  The database and exception list files | ||||
| must be open before the WordNet search and morphology functions are | ||||
| used.  If the database is successfully opened, the global variable | ||||
| \fBOpenDB\fP is set to \fB1\fP.  Note that it is possible for the | ||||
| database files to be opened (\fBOpenDB == 1\fP), but not the exception | ||||
| list files. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B re_wninit(\|) | ||||
| is used to close the database files and reopen them, and is used | ||||
| exclusively for WordNet development. | ||||
| .B re_morphinit(\|)  | ||||
| is called to close and reopen the exception list files.  Return codes | ||||
| are as described above. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B cntwords(\|) | ||||
| counts the number of underscore or space separated words in \fIstr\fP. | ||||
| A hyphen is passed in \fIseparator\fP if is is to be considered a | ||||
| word delimiter.  Otherwise \fIseparator\fP can be any other | ||||
| character, or an underscore if another character is not desired. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B strtolower(\|) | ||||
| converts \fIstr\fP to lower case and removes a trailing adjective | ||||
| marker, if present.  \fIstr\fP is actually modified by this function, | ||||
| and a pointer to the modified string is returned. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B ToLowerCase(\|) | ||||
| converts \fIstr\fP to lower case as above, without removing an | ||||
| adjective marker. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B strsubst(\|) | ||||
| replaces all occurrences of \fIfrom\fP with \fIto\fP in \fIstr\fP and | ||||
| returns resulting string. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B getptrtype(\|) | ||||
| returns the integer \fIptr_type\fP corresponding to the pointer | ||||
| character passed in \fIptr_symbol\fP.  See | ||||
| .BR wnsearch (3WN) | ||||
| for a table of pointer symbols and types. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B getpos(\|) | ||||
| returns the integer constant corresponding to the synset type passed. | ||||
| \fIss_type\fP may be one of the following: \fBn, v, a, r, s\fP.  If | ||||
| \fBs\fP is passed, | ||||
| .SB ADJ | ||||
| is returned.  Exits with \fB-1\fP if \fIss_type\fP is invalid. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B getsstype(\|) | ||||
| works like \fBgetpos(\|)\fP, but returns | ||||
| .SB SATELLITE | ||||
| if \fIss_type\fP is \fBs\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B StrToPos(\|) | ||||
| returns the integer constant corresponding to the syntactic category | ||||
| passed in \fIpos\fP.  \fIstring\fP must be one of the following: | ||||
| \fBnoun, verb, adj, adv\fP.  \fB-1\fP is returned if \fIpos\fP is | ||||
| invalid. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B GetSynsetForSense(\|) | ||||
| returns the synset that contains the word sense \fIsense_key\fP and | ||||
| .SB NULL | ||||
| in case of error. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B GetDataOffset(\|) | ||||
| returns the synset offset for synset that contains the word sense | ||||
| \fIsense_key\fP, and \fB0\fP if \fIsense_key\fP is not in sense index | ||||
| file.  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B GetPolyCount(\|) | ||||
| returns the polysemy count (number of senses in WordNet) for | ||||
| \fIlemma\fP encoded in \fIsense_key\fP and \fB0\fP if word is not | ||||
| found.  | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B WNSnsToStr(\|) | ||||
| returns sense key encoding for \fIsense_num\fP entry in \fIidx\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B GetValidIndexPointer(\|) | ||||
| returns the Index structure for \fIword\fP in \fIpos\fP.  Calls | ||||
| .BR morphstr (3WN) | ||||
| to find a valid base form if \fIword\fP is inflected. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B GetWNSense(\|) | ||||
| returns the WordNet sense number for the sense key encoding | ||||
| represented by \fIlemma\fP and \fIlex_sense\fP. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B GetSenseIndex(\|) | ||||
| returns parsed sense index entry for \fIsense_key\fP and  | ||||
| .SB NULL | ||||
| if \fIsense_key\fP is not in sense index. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B GetTagcnt(\|) | ||||
| returns the number of times the sense passed has been tagged according | ||||
| to the \fIcntlist\fP file. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .B default_display_message(\|) | ||||
| simply returns \fB-1\fP.  This is the default value for the global | ||||
| variable \fBdisplay_message\fP, that points to a function to call to | ||||
| display an error message.  In general, applications (including the | ||||
| WordNet interfaces) define an application specific function and set | ||||
| \fBdisplay_message\fP to point to it. | ||||
| .SH NOTES | ||||
| \fBinclude/wn.h\fP lists all the pointer and search | ||||
| types and their corresponding constant values.  There is no | ||||
| description of what each search type is or the results returned. | ||||
| Using the WordNet interface is the best way to see what types of | ||||
| searches are available, and the data returned for each. | ||||
| .SH SEE ALSO | ||||
| .BR wnintro (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnsearch (3WN), | ||||
| .BR morph (3WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (5WN), | ||||
| .BR wnintro (7WN). | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SH WARNINGS | ||||
| Error checking on passed arguments is not rigorous.  Passing  | ||||
| .SB NULL | ||||
| pointers or invalid values will often cause an application to die. | ||||
							
								
								
									
										313
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/pdf/Makefile
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										313
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/pdf/Makefile
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,313 @@ | |||
| # Makefile.in generated by automake 1.9 from Makefile.am.
 | ||||
| # doc/pdf/Makefile.  Generated from Makefile.in by configure.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
 | ||||
| # 2003, 2004  Free Software Foundation, Inc.
 | ||||
| # This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
 | ||||
| # gives unlimited permission to copy and/or distribute it,
 | ||||
| # with or without modifications, as long as this notice is preserved.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | ||||
| # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law; without
 | ||||
| # even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A
 | ||||
| # PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| srcdir = . | ||||
| top_srcdir = ../.. | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/WordNet | ||||
| pkglibdir = $(libdir)/WordNet | ||||
| pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/WordNet | ||||
| top_builddir = ../.. | ||||
| am__cd = CDPATH="$${ZSH_VERSION+.}$(PATH_SEPARATOR)" && cd | ||||
| INSTALL = /usr/csl/bin/install -c | ||||
| install_sh_DATA = $(install_sh) -c -m 644 | ||||
| install_sh_PROGRAM = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| install_sh_SCRIPT = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| INSTALL_HEADER = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| transform = $(program_transform_name) | ||||
| NORMAL_INSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_INSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_INSTALL = : | ||||
| NORMAL_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| subdir = doc/pdf | ||||
| DIST_COMMON = $(srcdir)/Makefile.am $(srcdir)/Makefile.in | ||||
| ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4 | ||||
| am__aclocal_m4_deps = $(top_srcdir)/acinclude.m4 \
 | ||||
| 	$(top_srcdir)/configure.ac | ||||
| am__configure_deps = $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES) \
 | ||||
| 	$(ACLOCAL_M4) | ||||
| mkinstalldirs = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| CONFIG_HEADER = $(top_builddir)/config.h | ||||
| CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES = | ||||
| SOURCES = | ||||
| DIST_SOURCES = | ||||
| am__vpath_adj_setup = srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; | ||||
| am__vpath_adj = case $$p in \
 | ||||
|     $(srcdir)/*) f=`echo "$$p" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
|     *) f=$$p;; \
 | ||||
|   esac; | ||||
| am__strip_dir = `echo $$p | sed -e 's|^.*/||'`; | ||||
| am__installdirs = "$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)" | ||||
| pdfDATA_INSTALL = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| DATA = $(pdf_DATA) | ||||
| DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(DIST_SOURCES) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST) | ||||
| ACLOCAL = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run aclocal-1.9 | ||||
| AMDEP_FALSE = # | ||||
| AMDEP_TRUE =  | ||||
| AMTAR = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run tar | ||||
| AUTOCONF = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run autoconf | ||||
| AUTOHEADER = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run autoheader | ||||
| AUTOMAKE = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run automake-1.9 | ||||
| AWK = nawk | ||||
| CC = gcc | ||||
| CCDEPMODE = depmode=gcc3 | ||||
| CFLAGS = -g -O2 | ||||
| CPP = gcc -E | ||||
| CPPFLAGS =  | ||||
| CYGPATH_W = echo | ||||
| DEFS = -DHAVE_CONFIG_H | ||||
| DEPDIR = .deps | ||||
| ECHO_C =  | ||||
| ECHO_N = -n | ||||
| ECHO_T =  | ||||
| EGREP = egrep | ||||
| EXEEXT =  | ||||
| INSTALL_DATA = ${INSTALL} -m 644 | ||||
| INSTALL_PROGRAM = ${INSTALL} | ||||
| INSTALL_SCRIPT = ${INSTALL} | ||||
| INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM = ${SHELL} $(install_sh) -c -s | ||||
| LDFLAGS =  | ||||
| LIBOBJS =  | ||||
| LIBS =  | ||||
| LTLIBOBJS =  | ||||
| MAKEINFO = ${SHELL} /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/missing --run makeinfo | ||||
| OBJEXT = o | ||||
| PACKAGE = WordNet | ||||
| PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = wordnet@princeton.edu | ||||
| PACKAGE_NAME = WordNet | ||||
| PACKAGE_STRING = WordNet 3.0 | ||||
| PACKAGE_TARNAME = wordnet | ||||
| PACKAGE_VERSION = 3.0 | ||||
| PATH_SEPARATOR = : | ||||
| RANLIB = ranlib | ||||
| SET_MAKE =  | ||||
| SHELL = /bin/bash | ||||
| STRIP =  | ||||
| TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC = -I/usr/csl/include | ||||
| TCL_LIB_SPEC = -L/usr/csl/lib -ltcl8.4 | ||||
| TK_LIBS = -L/usr/openwin/lib -lX11 -ldl  -lpthread -lsocket -lnsl -lm | ||||
| TK_LIB_SPEC = -L/usr/csl/lib -ltk8.4 | ||||
| TK_PREFIX = /usr/csl | ||||
| TK_XINCLUDES = -I/usr/openwin/include | ||||
| VERSION = 3.0 | ||||
| ac_ct_CC = gcc | ||||
| ac_ct_RANLIB = ranlib | ||||
| ac_ct_STRIP =  | ||||
| ac_prefix = /usr/local/WordNet-3.0 | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_FALSE = # | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_TRUE =  | ||||
| am__include = include | ||||
| am__leading_dot = . | ||||
| am__quote =  | ||||
| am__tar = ${AMTAR} chof - "$$tardir" | ||||
| am__untar = ${AMTAR} xf - | ||||
| bindir = ${exec_prefix}/bin | ||||
| build_alias =  | ||||
| datadir = ${prefix}/share | ||||
| exec_prefix = ${prefix} | ||||
| host_alias =  | ||||
| includedir = ${prefix}/include | ||||
| infodir = ${prefix}/info | ||||
| install_sh = /people/wn/src/Release/3.0/Unix/install-sh | ||||
| libdir = ${exec_prefix}/lib | ||||
| libexecdir = ${exec_prefix}/libexec | ||||
| localstatedir = ${prefix}/var | ||||
| mandir = ${prefix}/man | ||||
| mkdir_p = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| oldincludedir = /usr/include | ||||
| prefix = /usr/local/WordNet-3.0 | ||||
| program_transform_name = s,x,x, | ||||
| sbindir = ${exec_prefix}/sbin | ||||
| sharedstatedir = ${prefix}/com | ||||
| sysconfdir = ${prefix}/etc | ||||
| target_alias =  | ||||
| pdfdir = $(prefix)/doc/pdf | ||||
| pdf_DATA = binsrch.3.pdf cntlist.5.pdf grind.1.pdf lexnames.5.pdf morph.3.pdf morphy.7.pdf senseidx.5.pdf uniqbeg.7.pdf wn.1.pdf wnb.1.pdf wndb.5.pdf wngloss.7.pdf wngroups.7.pdf wninput.5.pdf wnintro.1.pdf wnintro.3.pdf wnintro.5.pdf wnintro.7.pdf wnlicens.7.pdf wnpkgs.7.pdf wnsearch.3.pdf wnstats.7.pdf wnutil.3.pdf | ||||
| all: all-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SUFFIXES: | ||||
| $(srcdir)/Makefile.in:  $(srcdir)/Makefile.am  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	@for dep in $?; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case '$(am__configure_deps)' in \
 | ||||
| 	    *$$dep*) \
 | ||||
| 	      cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh \
 | ||||
| 		&& exit 0; \
 | ||||
| 	      exit 1;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	echo ' cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/pdf/Makefile'; \
 | ||||
| 	cd $(top_srcdir) && \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/pdf/Makefile | ||||
| .PRECIOUS: Makefile | ||||
| Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status | ||||
| 	@case '$?' in \
 | ||||
| 	  *config.status*) \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) \
 | ||||
| 	    echo ' cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe)'; \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe);; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_builddir)/config.status: $(top_srcdir)/configure $(CONFIG_STATUS_DEPENDENCIES) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_srcdir)/configure:  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| $(ACLOCAL_M4):  $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| uninstall-info-am: | ||||
| install-pdfDATA: $(pdf_DATA) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(pdfdir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(pdf_DATA)'; for p in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f "$$p"; then d=; else d="$(srcdir)/"; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  f=$(am__strip_dir) \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(pdfDATA_INSTALL) '$$d$$p' '$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)/$$f'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(pdfDATA_INSTALL) "$$d$$p" "$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)/$$f"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-pdfDATA: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(pdf_DATA)'; for p in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  f=$(am__strip_dir) \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)/$$f'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)/$$f"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| tags: TAGS | ||||
| TAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ctags: CTAGS | ||||
| CTAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distdir: $(DISTFILES) | ||||
| 	@srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	topsrcdirstrip=`echo "$(top_srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(DISTFILES)'; for file in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case $$file in \
 | ||||
| 	    $(srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(top_srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$topsrcdirstrip/|$(top_builddir)/|"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $$file || test -d $$file; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  dir=`echo "$$file" | sed -e 's,/[^/]*$$,,'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$dir" != "$$file" && test "$$dir" != "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dir="/$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    dir=''; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -d $$d/$$file; then \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -d $(srcdir)/$$file && test $$d != $(srcdir); then \
 | ||||
| 	      cp -pR $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    fi; \
 | ||||
| 	    cp -pR $$d/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || cp -p $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| check-am: all-am | ||||
| check: check-am | ||||
| all-am: Makefile $(DATA) | ||||
| installdirs: | ||||
| 	for dir in "$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)"; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test -z "$$dir" || $(mkdir_p) "$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install: install-am | ||||
| install-exec: install-exec-am | ||||
| install-data: install-data-am | ||||
| uninstall: uninstall-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-am: all-am | ||||
| 	@$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) install-exec-am install-data-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck: installcheck-am | ||||
| install-strip: | ||||
| 	$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) INSTALL_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" \
 | ||||
| 	  install_sh_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" INSTALL_STRIP_FLAG=-s \
 | ||||
| 	  `test -z '$(STRIP)' || \
 | ||||
| 	    echo "INSTALL_PROGRAM_ENV=STRIPPROG='$(STRIP)'"` install | ||||
| mostlyclean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-generic: | ||||
| 	-test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean-generic: | ||||
| 	@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use" | ||||
| 	@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild." | ||||
| clean: clean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-am: clean-generic mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean: distclean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| distclean-am: clean-am distclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi: dvi-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| html: html-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info: info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-data-am: install-pdfDATA | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-exec-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-info: install-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-man: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| maintainer-clean-am: distclean-am maintainer-clean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean: mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf: pdf-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps: ps-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-am: uninstall-info-am uninstall-pdfDATA | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .PHONY: all all-am check check-am clean clean-generic distclean \ | ||||
| 	distclean-generic distdir dvi dvi-am html html-am info info-am \
 | ||||
| 	install install-am install-data install-data-am install-exec \
 | ||||
| 	install-exec-am install-info install-info-am install-man \
 | ||||
| 	install-pdfDATA install-strip installcheck installcheck-am \
 | ||||
| 	installdirs maintainer-clean maintainer-clean-generic \
 | ||||
| 	mostlyclean mostlyclean-generic pdf pdf-am ps ps-am uninstall \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-am uninstall-info-am uninstall-pdfDATA | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
 | ||||
| # Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
 | ||||
| .NOEXPORT: | ||||
							
								
								
									
										2
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/pdf/Makefile.am
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										2
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/pdf/Makefile.am
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,2 @@ | |||
| pdfdir=$(prefix)/doc/pdf | ||||
| pdf_DATA =binsrch.3.pdf cntlist.5.pdf grind.1.pdf lexnames.5.pdf morph.3.pdf morphy.7.pdf senseidx.5.pdf uniqbeg.7.pdf wn.1.pdf wnb.1.pdf wndb.5.pdf wngloss.7.pdf wngroups.7.pdf wninput.5.pdf wnintro.1.pdf wnintro.3.pdf wnintro.5.pdf wnintro.7.pdf wnlicens.7.pdf wnpkgs.7.pdf wnsearch.3.pdf wnstats.7.pdf wnutil.3.pdf | ||||
							
								
								
									
										313
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/pdf/Makefile.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							
							
						
						
									
										313
									
								
								corpora/en/wordnet/doc/pdf/Makefile.in
									
									
									
									
									
										Normal file
									
								
							|  | @ -0,0 +1,313 @@ | |||
| # Makefile.in generated by automake 1.9 from Makefile.am.
 | ||||
| # @configure_input@
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
 | ||||
| # 2003, 2004  Free Software Foundation, Inc.
 | ||||
| # This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
 | ||||
| # gives unlimited permission to copy and/or distribute it,
 | ||||
| # with or without modifications, as long as this notice is preserved.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | ||||
| # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law; without
 | ||||
| # even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A
 | ||||
| # PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| @SET_MAKE@ | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| srcdir = @srcdir@ | ||||
| top_srcdir = @top_srcdir@ | ||||
| VPATH = @srcdir@ | ||||
| pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| pkglibdir = $(libdir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/@PACKAGE@ | ||||
| top_builddir = ../.. | ||||
| am__cd = CDPATH="$${ZSH_VERSION+.}$(PATH_SEPARATOR)" && cd | ||||
| INSTALL = @INSTALL@ | ||||
| install_sh_DATA = $(install_sh) -c -m 644 | ||||
| install_sh_PROGRAM = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| install_sh_SCRIPT = $(install_sh) -c | ||||
| INSTALL_HEADER = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| transform = $(program_transform_name) | ||||
| NORMAL_INSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_INSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_INSTALL = : | ||||
| NORMAL_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| PRE_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| POST_UNINSTALL = : | ||||
| subdir = doc/pdf | ||||
| DIST_COMMON = $(srcdir)/Makefile.am $(srcdir)/Makefile.in | ||||
| ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4 | ||||
| am__aclocal_m4_deps = $(top_srcdir)/acinclude.m4 \
 | ||||
| 	$(top_srcdir)/configure.ac | ||||
| am__configure_deps = $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES) \
 | ||||
| 	$(ACLOCAL_M4) | ||||
| mkinstalldirs = $(install_sh) -d | ||||
| CONFIG_HEADER = $(top_builddir)/config.h | ||||
| CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES = | ||||
| SOURCES = | ||||
| DIST_SOURCES = | ||||
| am__vpath_adj_setup = srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; | ||||
| am__vpath_adj = case $$p in \
 | ||||
|     $(srcdir)/*) f=`echo "$$p" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
|     *) f=$$p;; \
 | ||||
|   esac; | ||||
| am__strip_dir = `echo $$p | sed -e 's|^.*/||'`; | ||||
| am__installdirs = "$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)" | ||||
| pdfDATA_INSTALL = $(INSTALL_DATA) | ||||
| DATA = $(pdf_DATA) | ||||
| DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(DIST_SOURCES) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST) | ||||
| ACLOCAL = @ACLOCAL@ | ||||
| AMDEP_FALSE = @AMDEP_FALSE@ | ||||
| AMDEP_TRUE = @AMDEP_TRUE@ | ||||
| AMTAR = @AMTAR@ | ||||
| AUTOCONF = @AUTOCONF@ | ||||
| AUTOHEADER = @AUTOHEADER@ | ||||
| AUTOMAKE = @AUTOMAKE@ | ||||
| AWK = @AWK@ | ||||
| CC = @CC@ | ||||
| CCDEPMODE = @CCDEPMODE@ | ||||
| CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@ | ||||
| CPP = @CPP@ | ||||
| CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@ | ||||
| CYGPATH_W = @CYGPATH_W@ | ||||
| DEFS = @DEFS@ | ||||
| DEPDIR = @DEPDIR@ | ||||
| ECHO_C = @ECHO_C@ | ||||
| ECHO_N = @ECHO_N@ | ||||
| ECHO_T = @ECHO_T@ | ||||
| EGREP = @EGREP@ | ||||
| EXEEXT = @EXEEXT@ | ||||
| INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@ | ||||
| INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@ | ||||
| INSTALL_SCRIPT = @INSTALL_SCRIPT@ | ||||
| INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM@ | ||||
| LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@ | ||||
| LIBOBJS = @LIBOBJS@ | ||||
| LIBS = @LIBS@ | ||||
| LTLIBOBJS = @LTLIBOBJS@ | ||||
| MAKEINFO = @MAKEINFO@ | ||||
| OBJEXT = @OBJEXT@ | ||||
| PACKAGE = @PACKAGE@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = @PACKAGE_BUGREPORT@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_NAME = @PACKAGE_NAME@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_STRING = @PACKAGE_STRING@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_TARNAME = @PACKAGE_TARNAME@ | ||||
| PACKAGE_VERSION = @PACKAGE_VERSION@ | ||||
| PATH_SEPARATOR = @PATH_SEPARATOR@ | ||||
| RANLIB = @RANLIB@ | ||||
| SET_MAKE = @SET_MAKE@ | ||||
| SHELL = @SHELL@ | ||||
| STRIP = @STRIP@ | ||||
| TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC = @TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC@ | ||||
| TCL_LIB_SPEC = @TCL_LIB_SPEC@ | ||||
| TK_LIBS = @TK_LIBS@ | ||||
| TK_LIB_SPEC = @TK_LIB_SPEC@ | ||||
| TK_PREFIX = @TK_PREFIX@ | ||||
| TK_XINCLUDES = @TK_XINCLUDES@ | ||||
| VERSION = @VERSION@ | ||||
| ac_ct_CC = @ac_ct_CC@ | ||||
| ac_ct_RANLIB = @ac_ct_RANLIB@ | ||||
| ac_ct_STRIP = @ac_ct_STRIP@ | ||||
| ac_prefix = @ac_prefix@ | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_FALSE = @am__fastdepCC_FALSE@ | ||||
| am__fastdepCC_TRUE = @am__fastdepCC_TRUE@ | ||||
| am__include = @am__include@ | ||||
| am__leading_dot = @am__leading_dot@ | ||||
| am__quote = @am__quote@ | ||||
| am__tar = @am__tar@ | ||||
| am__untar = @am__untar@ | ||||
| bindir = @bindir@ | ||||
| build_alias = @build_alias@ | ||||
| datadir = @datadir@ | ||||
| exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@ | ||||
| host_alias = @host_alias@ | ||||
| includedir = @includedir@ | ||||
| infodir = @infodir@ | ||||
| install_sh = @install_sh@ | ||||
| libdir = @libdir@ | ||||
| libexecdir = @libexecdir@ | ||||
| localstatedir = @localstatedir@ | ||||
| mandir = @mandir@ | ||||
| mkdir_p = @mkdir_p@ | ||||
| oldincludedir = @oldincludedir@ | ||||
| prefix = @prefix@ | ||||
| program_transform_name = @program_transform_name@ | ||||
| sbindir = @sbindir@ | ||||
| sharedstatedir = @sharedstatedir@ | ||||
| sysconfdir = @sysconfdir@ | ||||
| target_alias = @target_alias@ | ||||
| pdfdir = $(prefix)/doc/pdf | ||||
| pdf_DATA = binsrch.3.pdf cntlist.5.pdf grind.1.pdf lexnames.5.pdf morph.3.pdf morphy.7.pdf senseidx.5.pdf uniqbeg.7.pdf wn.1.pdf wnb.1.pdf wndb.5.pdf wngloss.7.pdf wngroups.7.pdf wninput.5.pdf wnintro.1.pdf wnintro.3.pdf wnintro.5.pdf wnintro.7.pdf wnlicens.7.pdf wnpkgs.7.pdf wnsearch.3.pdf wnstats.7.pdf wnutil.3.pdf | ||||
| all: all-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .SUFFIXES: | ||||
| $(srcdir)/Makefile.in:  $(srcdir)/Makefile.am  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	@for dep in $?; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case '$(am__configure_deps)' in \
 | ||||
| 	    *$$dep*) \
 | ||||
| 	      cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh \
 | ||||
| 		&& exit 0; \
 | ||||
| 	      exit 1;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	done; \
 | ||||
| 	echo ' cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/pdf/Makefile'; \
 | ||||
| 	cd $(top_srcdir) && \
 | ||||
| 	  $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu  doc/pdf/Makefile | ||||
| .PRECIOUS: Makefile | ||||
| Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status | ||||
| 	@case '$?' in \
 | ||||
| 	  *config.status*) \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh;; \
 | ||||
| 	  *) \
 | ||||
| 	    echo ' cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe)'; \
 | ||||
| 	    cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe);; \
 | ||||
| 	esac; | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_builddir)/config.status: $(top_srcdir)/configure $(CONFIG_STATUS_DEPENDENCIES) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| $(top_srcdir)/configure:  $(am__configure_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| $(ACLOCAL_M4):  $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) | ||||
| 	cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh | ||||
| uninstall-info-am: | ||||
| install-pdfDATA: $(pdf_DATA) | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_INSTALL) | ||||
| 	test -z "$(pdfdir)" || $(mkdir_p) "$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)" | ||||
| 	@list='$(pdf_DATA)'; for p in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f "$$p"; then d=; else d="$(srcdir)/"; fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  f=$(am__strip_dir) \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " $(pdfDATA_INSTALL) '$$d$$p' '$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)/$$f'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  $(pdfDATA_INSTALL) "$$d$$p" "$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)/$$f"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-pdfDATA: | ||||
| 	@$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) | ||||
| 	@list='$(pdf_DATA)'; for p in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  f=$(am__strip_dir) \
 | ||||
| 	  echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)/$$f'"; \
 | ||||
| 	  rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)/$$f"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| tags: TAGS | ||||
| TAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ctags: CTAGS | ||||
| CTAGS: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distdir: $(DISTFILES) | ||||
| 	@srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	topsrcdirstrip=`echo "$(top_srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
 | ||||
| 	list='$(DISTFILES)'; for file in $$list; do \
 | ||||
| 	  case $$file in \
 | ||||
| 	    $(srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(top_srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$topsrcdirstrip/|$(top_builddir)/|"`;; \
 | ||||
| 	  esac; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -f $$file || test -d $$file; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  dir=`echo "$$file" | sed -e 's,/[^/]*$$,,'`; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test "$$dir" != "$$file" && test "$$dir" != "."; then \
 | ||||
| 	    dir="/$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	    $(mkdir_p) "$(distdir)$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    dir=''; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	  if test -d $$d/$$file; then \
 | ||||
| 	    if test -d $(srcdir)/$$file && test $$d != $(srcdir); then \
 | ||||
| 	      cp -pR $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	    fi; \
 | ||||
| 	    cp -pR $$d/$$file $(distdir)$$dir || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  else \
 | ||||
| 	    test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || cp -p $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file \
 | ||||
| 	    || exit 1; \
 | ||||
| 	  fi; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| check-am: all-am | ||||
| check: check-am | ||||
| all-am: Makefile $(DATA) | ||||
| installdirs: | ||||
| 	for dir in "$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)"; do \
 | ||||
| 	  test -z "$$dir" || $(mkdir_p) "$$dir"; \
 | ||||
| 	done | ||||
| install: install-am | ||||
| install-exec: install-exec-am | ||||
| install-data: install-data-am | ||||
| uninstall: uninstall-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-am: all-am | ||||
| 	@$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) install-exec-am install-data-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck: installcheck-am | ||||
| install-strip: | ||||
| 	$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) INSTALL_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" \
 | ||||
| 	  install_sh_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" INSTALL_STRIP_FLAG=-s \
 | ||||
| 	  `test -z '$(STRIP)' || \
 | ||||
| 	    echo "INSTALL_PROGRAM_ENV=STRIPPROG='$(STRIP)'"` install | ||||
| mostlyclean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-generic: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean-generic: | ||||
| 	-test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES) | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean-generic: | ||||
| 	@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use" | ||||
| 	@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild." | ||||
| clean: clean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| clean-am: clean-generic mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| distclean: distclean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| distclean-am: clean-am distclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi: dvi-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| dvi-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| html: html-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info: info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| info-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-data-am: install-pdfDATA | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-exec-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-info: install-info-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| install-man: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| installcheck-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-am | ||||
| 	-rm -f Makefile | ||||
| maintainer-clean-am: distclean-am maintainer-clean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean: mostlyclean-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-generic | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf: pdf-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| pdf-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps: ps-am | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| ps-am: | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| uninstall-am: uninstall-info-am uninstall-pdfDATA | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| .PHONY: all all-am check check-am clean clean-generic distclean \ | ||||
| 	distclean-generic distdir dvi dvi-am html html-am info info-am \
 | ||||
| 	install install-am install-data install-data-am install-exec \
 | ||||
| 	install-exec-am install-info install-info-am install-man \
 | ||||
| 	install-pdfDATA install-strip installcheck installcheck-am \
 | ||||
| 	installdirs maintainer-clean maintainer-clean-generic \
 | ||||
| 	mostlyclean mostlyclean-generic pdf pdf-am ps ps-am uninstall \
 | ||||
| 	uninstall-am uninstall-info-am uninstall-pdfDATA | ||||
| 
 | ||||
| # Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
 | ||||
| # Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
 | ||||
| .NOEXPORT: | ||||
Some files were not shown because too many files have changed in this diff Show More
		Loading…
	
		Reference in New Issue
	
	Block a user